Product Folder Sample & Buy Technical Documents Tools & Software Support & Community AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 AM571x Sitara™ Processors Silicon Revision 2.0 1 Device Overview 1.1 Features • For Silicon Revision 1.1 information, see SPRS919 • ARM® Cortex®-A15 Microprocessor Subsystem • C66x Floating-Point VLIW DSP – Fully Object-Code Compatible With C67x and C64x+ – Up to Thirty-two 16 × 16-Bit Fixed-Point Multiplies per Cycle • Up to 512KB of On-Chip L3 RAM • Level 3 (L3) and Level 4 (L4) Interconnects • DDR3/DDR3L Memory Interface (EMIF) Module – Supports up to DDR3-1333 (667 MHz) – Up to 2GB across single chip select • Dual ARM® Cortex®-M4 Coprocessors • IVA-HD Subsystem • Display Subsystem – Full-HD Video (1920 × 1080p, 60 fps) – Multiple Video Input and Video Output – 2D and 3D Graphics – Display Controller With DMA Engine and up to Three Pipelines – HDMI™ Encoder: HDMI 1.4a and DVI 1.0 Compliant • 2x Dual-Core Programmable Real-Time Unit and Industrial Communication Subsystem (PRU-ICSS) • Accelerator (BB2D) Subsystem – Vivante™ GC320 Core • Video Processing Engine (VPE) • Available Single-Core PowerVR® SGX544 3D GPU • One Video Input Port (VIP) Module – Support for up to Four Multiplexed Input Ports • General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) • Enhanced Direct Memory Access (EDMA) Controller • Ethernet Subsystem • Sixteen 32-Bit General-Purpose Timers • 32-Bit MPU Watchdog Timer • Five High-Speed Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Ports • HDQ™/1-Wire® Interface • Ten Configurable UART/IrDA/CIR Modules • Four Multichannel Serial Peripheral Interfaces (MCSPIs) • Quad SPI Interface (QSPI) • SATA Gen2 Interface • Multichannel Audio Serial Port (MCASP) • SuperSpeed USB 3.0 Dual-Role Device • High-Speed USB 2.0 Dual-Role Device • PCI-Express® 2.0 Subsystems With Two 5-Gbps Lanes – One 2-lane Gen2-Compliant Port – or Two 1-lane Gen2-Compliant Ports • Dual Controller Area Network (DCAN) Modules – CAN 2.0B Protocol • MIPI® CSI-2 Camera Serial Interface • Up to 215 General-Purpose I/O (GPIO) Pins • Power, Reset, and Clock Management • On-Chip Debug With CTools Technology • 28-nm CMOS Technology • 23 mm × 23 mm, 0.8-mm Pitch, 760-Pin BGA (ABC) 1 An IMPORTANT NOTICE at the end of this data sheet addresses availability, warranty, changes, use in safety-critical applications, intellectual property matters and other important disclaimers. ADVANCE INFORMATION for pre-production products; subject to change without notice. ADVANCE INFORMATION 1 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 1.2 • • • Applications Industrial Communication Human Machine Interface (HMI) Automation and Control 1.3 www.ti.com • • High Performance Applications Other General Use Description AM571x Sitara ARM applications processors are built to meet the intense processing needs of the modern embedded products. AM571x devices bring high processing performance through the maximum flexibility of a fully integrated mixed processor solution. The devices also combine programmable video processing with a highly integrated peripheral set. Programmability is provided by a single-core ARM Cortex-A15 RISC CPU with Neon™ extensions and TI C66x VLIW floating-point DSP cores. The ARM processor lets developers keep control functions separate from vision algorithms programmed on the DSP and coprocessors, thus reducing the complexity of the system software. ADVANCE INFORMATION Additionally, TI provides a complete set of development tools for the ARM and C66x DSP, including C compilers, a DSP assembly optimizer to simplify programming and scheduling, and a debugging interface for visibility into source code execution. Device Information PART NUMBER AM571x 2 PACKAGE BODY SIZE FCBGA (760) 23.0 mm × 23.0 mm Device Overview Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com 1.4 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Functional Block Diagram Figure 1-1 is functional block diagram for the device. AM571x Display Subsystem MPU IVA HD (1x ARM Cortex–A15) 1080p Video Co-Processor 1x GFX Pipeline LCD1 LCD2 3x Video Pipeline GPU BB2D (1x SGX544 3D) (GC320 2D) Blend / Scale HDMI 1.4a IPU1 (2x Cortex–M4) IPU2 ADVANCE INFORMATION DSP (1x C66x Co-Processor) LCD3 CSI2 x2 CAL (2x Cortex–M4) EDMA MMU x2 sDMA VPE VIP High-Speed Interconnect System Spinlock Timers x16 Connectivity PWM SS x3 USB 3.0 PCIe SS x2 Dual Role FS/HS/SS w/ PHYs PRU-ICCS x2 Mailbox x13 WDT HDQ GPIO x8 RTC SS KBD USB 2.0 Dual Role FS/HS w/ PHY Program/Data Storage Serial Interfaces UART x10 GMAC_SW QSPI MCSPI x4 MCASP x8 DCAN x2 I2C x5 MMC / SD x4 SATA DMM 512-KB OCMC_RAM w/ ECC GPMC / ELM (NAND/NOR/ Async) EMIF 1x 32-bit DDR3(L) ECC intro-001 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Figure 1-1. AM571x Block Diagram Device Overview Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 3 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table of Contents 1 Device Overview ......................................... 1 7.11 General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) ..... 225 1.1 Features .............................................. 1 7.12 Timers .............................................. 249 1.2 Applications ........................................... 2 7.13 Inter-Integrated Circuit Interface (I2C) ............. 249 1.3 Description ............................................ 2 7.14 7.15 HDQ / 1-Wire Interface (HDQ1W) ................. 252 Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART) ............................................. 254 7.16 Multichannel Serial Peripheral Interface (MCSPI) . 256 7.17 Quad Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI) 262 7.18 Multichannel Audio Serial Port (McASP) 266 ........................... 3 Revision History ......................................... 5 Device Comparison ..................................... 6 3.1 Device Comparison Table ............................ 6 Terminal Configuration and Functions .............. 8 4.1 Terminal Assignment ................................. 8 4.2 Ball Characteristics ................................... 9 4.3 Multiplexing Characteristics ......................... 80 4.4 Signal Descriptions .................................. 97 Specifications ......................................... 139 5.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings........................ 139 5.2 ESD Ratings ....................................... 140 5.3 Power on Hours (POH) Limits ..................... 140 5.4 Recommended Operating Conditions ............. 141 5.5 Operating Performance Points ..................... 144 5.6 Electrical Characteristics ........................... 163 5.7 Thermal Characteristics ............................ 172 5.8 Power Supply Sequences ......................... 174 Clock Specifications ................................. 179 6.1 Input Clock Specifications ......................... 180 6.2 DPLLs, DLLs Specifications ....................... 189 1.4 2 3 4 5 ADVANCE INFORMATION 6 7 Functional Block Diagram 7.20 7.21 8 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics ........................................ 193 7.1 Timing Test Conditions ............................ 193 7.2 Interface Clock Specifications ..................... Timing Parameters and Information ............... 7.3 7.4 4 7.19 193 193 Recommended Clock and Control Signal Transition Behavior............................................ 195 9 .......... .......... Universal Serial Bus (USB) ........................ Serial Advanced Technology Attachment (SATA) . 286 286 Peripheral Component Interconnect Express (PCIe) .............................................. 286 7.22 Controller Area Network Interface (DCAN) ........ 287 7.23 Ethernet Interface (GMAC_SW) ................... 288 7.24 eMMC/SD/SDIO 7.25 General-Purpose Interface (GPIO) ................ 324 7.26 PRU-ICSS Interfaces 7.27 System and Miscellaneous interfaces ............. 348 7.28 Test Interfaces ..................................... 348 ................................... .............................. 301 324 Applications, Implementation, and Layout ...... 353 8.1 Power Supply Mapping ............................ 353 8.2 DDR3 Board Design and Layout Guidelines....... 354 8.3 8.4 High Speed Differential Signal Routing Guidance . 377 Power Distribution Network Implementation Guidance ........................................... 377 8.5 Single-Ended Interfaces 8.6 Clock Routing Guidelines .......................... 379 ........................... 377 Device and Documentation Support .............. 381 .................................... 9.1 Device Support 9.2 Documentation Support ............................ 382 9.3 Related Links 9.4 Community Resources............................. 383 ...................................... 381 383 7.5 Virtual and Manual I/O Timing Modes ............. 195 7.6 Video Input Ports (VIP) ............................ 197 9.5 Trademarks ........................................ 383 7.7 7.8 Display Subsystem – Video Output Ports ......... 216 Display Subsystem – High-Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI) ................................... 224 9.6 Electrostatic Discharge Caution 9.7 Glossary............................................ 383 7.9 Camera Serial Interface 2 CAL bridge (CSI2) ..... 225 7.10 External Memory Interface (EMIF)................. 225 ................... 383 10 Mechanical Packaging and Orderable Information ............................................. 384 10.1 Mechanical Data ................................... 384 Table of Contents Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 2 Revision History NOTE: Page numbers for previous revisions may differ from page numbers in the current version. Changes from Original to Revision A Added PCIe Gen 2 support .......................................................................................................... 1 ADVANCE INFORMATION • Page Revision History Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 5 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 3 Device Comparison 3.1 Device Comparison Table Table 3-1 shows a comparison between devices, highlighting the differences. Table 3-1. Device Comparison DEVICE FEATURES AM5718 AM5716 Processors/ Accelerators Speed Grades X X, D ADVANCE INFORMATION ARM Single Cortex-A15 Microprocessor Subsystem (MPU) MPU core 0 Yes C66x VLIW DSP DSP1 Yes BitBLT 2D Hardware Acceleration Engine (BB2D) BB2D Yes No Display Subsystem VOUT1 Yes No VOUT2 Yes No VOUT3 Yes No HDMI Yes ARM Dual Cortex-M4 Image Processing Unit (IPU) No IPU1 Yes IPU2(2) Yes Image Video Accelarator (IVA) IVA Yes SGX544 Single-Core 3D Graphics Processing Unit (GPU) GPU Yes Video Input Port 1 (VIP1) vin1a Yes vin1b Yes vin2a Yes vin2b Yes VPE Yes Video Processing Engine (VPE) No No Program/Data Storage On-Chip Shared Memory (RAM) OCMC_RAM1 General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) GPMC Yes DDR3 Memory Controller EMIF1 up to 2GB across single chip select Dynamic Memory Manager (DMM) 512KB SECDED / ECC Yes DMM Yes Radio Support Audio Tracking Logic (ATL) ATL Not Supported (1) Viterbi Coprocessor (VCP) VCP1 Not Supported (1) VCP2 Not Supported (1) Peripherals Dual Controller Area Network (DCAN) Interface DCAN1 Yes DCAN2 Yes Enhanced DMA (EDMA) EDMA Yes System DMA (DMA_SYSTEM) DMA_SYSTEM Ethernet Subsystem (Ethernet SS) GMAC_SW[0] MII, RMII, or RGMII GMAC_SW[1] MII, RMII, or RGMII General Purpose I/O (GPIO) GPIO Inter-Integrated Circuit (I2C) Interface I2C System Mailbox Module MAILBOX Yes Yes 5 13 13 Media Local Bus Subsystem MLB Camera Adaptation Layer (CAL) Camera Serial Interface 2 (CSI2) CSI2_0 Yes CSI2_1 Yes 6 Device Comparison Not Supported (1) Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 3-1. Device Comparison (continued) DEVICE Multichannel Audio Serial Port (McASP) MultiMedia Card/Secure Digital/Secure Digital Input Output Interface (MMC/SD/SDIO) AM5718 MCASP1 16 serializers MCASP2 16 serializers MCASP3 4 serializers MCASP4 4 serializers MCASP5 4 serializers MCASP6 4 serializers MCASP7 4 serializers MCASP8 4 serializers MMC1 1x UHSI 4b MMC2 1x eMMC 8b MMC3 1x SDIO 8b MMC4 PCI-Express 2.0 Port with Integrated PHY AM5716 1x SDIO 4b PCIe_SS1 up to two lanes (second lane shared with PCIe_SS2 and USB1) PCIe_SS2 Single lane (shared with PCIe_SS1 and USB1) 2x Programmable Real-Time Unit Subsystem and Industrial Communication Subsystem (PRU-ICSS) PRU-ICSS1 Serial Advanced Technology Attachment (SATA) SATA Yes Real-Time Clock Subsystem (RTCSS)(3) RTCSS Yes Multichannel Serial Peripheral Interface (McSPI) McSPI HDQ1W HDQ1W Yes Quad SPI (QSPI) QSPI Yes Spinlock Module SPINLOCK Yes Keyboard Controller (KBD) KBD Yes Timers, General-Purpose TIMERS GP 16 Timer, Watchdog WD TIMER Yes Pulse-Width Modulation Subsystem (PWMSS) PWMSS1 Yes PWMSS2 Yes PWMSS3 Yes ADVANCE INFORMATION FEATURES Yes PRU-ICSS2 4 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter (UART) UART Universal Serial Bus (USB3.0) USB1 (SuperSpeed, DualRole-Device [DRD] Yes 10 Universal Serial Bus (USB2.0) USB2 (HighSpeed, Dual-RoleDevice [DRD], with embedded HS PHY) Yes USB3 (Highspeed, OTG2.0, with ULPI) Not Supported (1) USB4 (Highspeed, OTG2.0, with ULPI) Not Supported (1) (1) Features noted as “not supported,” must not be used. Their functionality is not supported by TI for this family of devices. These features are subject to removal without notice on future device revisions. Any information regarding the unsupported features has been retained in the documentation solely for the purpose of clarifying signal names or for consistency with previous feature descriptions. (2) IPU2 subsystem is dedicated to IVA support and is not available for other processing. (3) RTC only mode is not supported feature. Device Comparison Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 7 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 4 Terminal Configuration and Functions 4.1 Terminal Assignment Figure 4-1 shows the ball locations for the 760 plastic ball grid array (PBGA) package and are used in conjunction with Table 4-2 through Table 4-35 to locate signal names and ball grid numbers. ADVANCE INFORMATION SPRS906_BALL_01 Figure 4-1. ABC S-PBGA-N760 Package (Bottom View) NOTE The following bottom balls are not pinned out: AF7 / AF10 / AF13 / AF16 / AF19 / AE4 / AE25 / AB26 / W3 / W26 / T3 / T26 / N3 / N26 / K3 / K26 / G3 / D4 / D25 / C10 / C13 / C16 / C19 / C22. These balls do not exist on the package. NOTE The following bottom balls are not connected: AH11 / AH12 / AG2 / AG8 / AG11 / AG12 / AF4 / AF6 / AF8 / AF9 / AE3 / AE5 / AE6 / AE8 / AE9 / AD3 / AD8 / AD9 / Y15 / Y16 / V18 / V19 / U18 / U19 / U22 / U23 / U24 / U25 / U26 / U27 / U28 / T22 / T23 / T27 / T28 / R20 / R22 / R23 / R24 / R25 / R26 / R27 / R28 / P19 / P22 / P23 / P24 / P25 / P26 / P27 / N20 / N22 / N23 / N27 / N28 / M20 / M21 / M22 / M23 / M24 / M25 / M26 / M27 / M28 / L20 / L21 / L22 / L23 / L24 / L25 / L26 / L27 / L28 / K20 / K21 / K22 / K23 / K27 / K28 / J20 / J21 / J22 / J23 / J24 / J25 / J26 / J27 / H20 / H21 / H22 / H23 / H24 / H25 / H26 / H27 / H28 / G22 / G23 / G24 / G25 / G26 / G27 / G28 / F24 / F25 / F26 / F27 / F28 / E24 / E26 / E27 / E28. These balls can be connected as desired, including to vss. 4.1.1 Unused Balls Connection Requirements This section describes the Unused/Reserved balls connection requirements. NOTE The following balls are reserved: A27 / K14 / Y5 / Y10 / B28 These balls must be left unconnected. 8 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 NOTE All unused power supply balls must be supplied with the voltages specified in the Section 5.4, Recommended Operating Conditions, unless alternative tie-off options are included in Section 4.4, Signal Descriptions. Table 4-1. Unused Balls Specific Connection Requirements BALLS CONNECTION REQUIREMENTS AE15 / AC15 / AE14 / D20 / AD17 / AC16 / V27 These balls must be connected to GND through an external pull resistor if unused E20 / D21 / E23 / C20 / C21 / AF14 / V28 / F18 These balls must be connect to the corresponding power supply through an external pull resistor if unused AB17 These balls must be connected to F22 (porz) if unused NOTE NOTE All other unused signal balls without Pad Configuration Register can be left unconnected. 4.2 Ball Characteristics Table 4-2 describes the terminal characteristics and the signals multiplexed on each ball. The following list describes the table column headers: 1. BALL NUMBER: Ball number(s) on the bottom side associated with each signal on the bottom. 2. BALL NAME: Mechanical name from package device (name is taken from muxmode 0). 3. SIGNAL NAME: Names of signals multiplexed on each ball (also notice that the name of the ball is the signal name in muxmode 0). NOTE Table 4-2 does not take into account the subsystem multiplexing signals. Subsystem multiplexing signals are described in Section 4.4, Signal Descriptions. NOTE In the Driver off mode, the buffer is configured in high-impedance. NOTE In some cases Table 4-2 may present more than one signal name per muxmode for the same ball. First signal in the list is the dominant function as selected via CTRL_CORE_PAD_* register. All other signals are virtual functions that present alternate multiplexing options. This virtual functions are controlled via CTRL_CORE_ALT_SELECT_MUX or CTRL_CORE_VIP_MUX_SELECT register. For more information on how to use this options, please refer to Device TRM, Chapter Control Module, Section Pad Configuration Registers. 4. 18/16: This column shows if the functionality is applicable for AM5718 / AM5716 devices. Note that the ball characteristics table presents the functionality of AM5718 device. If the cell is empty it means that the signal is available in all devices. Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 9 ADVANCE INFORMATION All other unused signal balls with a Pad Configuration Register can be left unconnected with their internal pullup or pulldown resistor enabled. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 18 - AM5718 16 - AM5716 5. MUXMODE: Multiplexing mode number: (a) MUXMODE 0 is the primary mode; this means that when MUXMODE=0 is set, the function mapped on the pin corresponds to the name of the pin. The primary muxmode is not necessarily the default muxmode. NOTE The default mode is the mode at the release of the reset; also see the RESET REL. MUXMODE column. ADVANCE INFORMATION (b) MUXMODE 1 through 15 are possible muxmodes for alternate functions. On each pin, some muxmodes are effectively used for alternate functions, while some muxmodes are not used. Only MUXMODE values which correspond to defined functions should be used. 6. TYPE: Signal type and direction: – I = Input – O = Output – IO = Input or Output – D = Open drain – DS = Differential Signaling – A = Analog – PWR = Power – GND = Ground – CAP = LDO Capacitor 7. BALL RESET STATE: The state of the terminal at power-on reset: – drive 0 (OFF): The buffer drives VOL (pulldown or pullup resistor not activated). – drive 1 (OFF): The buffer drives VOH (pulldown or pullup resistor not activated). – OFF: High-impedance – PD: High-impedance with an active pulldown resistor – PU: High-impedance with an active pullup resistor 8. BALL RESET REL. STATE: The state of the terminal at the deactivation of the rstoutn signal (also mapped to the PRCM SYS_WARM_OUT_RST signal). – drive 0 (OFF): The buffer drives VOL (pulldown or pullup resistor not activated). – drive clk (OFF): The buffer drives a toggling clock (pulldown or pullup resistor not activated). – drive 1 (OFF): The buffer drives VOH (pulldown or pullup resistor not activated). – OFF: High-impedance – PD: High-impedance with an active pulldown resistor – PU: High-impedance with an active pullup resistor NOTE For more information on the CORE_PWRON_RET_RST reset signal and its reset sources, see the Power, Reset, and Clock Management / PRCM Reset Management Functional Description section of the Device TRM. 9. BALL RESET REL. MUXMODE: This muxmode is automatically configured at the release of the rstoutn signal (also mapped to the PRCM SYS_WARM_OUT_RST signal). 10. IO VOLTAGE VALUE: This column describes the IO voltage value (VDDS supply). 11. POWER: The voltage supply that powers the terminal IO buffers. 10 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 NOTE VOUT1, VOUT2 and VOUT3 are only supported at 1.8V and not at 3.3V. This must be considered in the pin mux programming and VDDSHVx supply connections. 12. HYS: Indicates if the input buffer is with hysteresis: – Yes: With hysteresis – No: Without hysteresis An empty box means "Yes". NOTE For more information, see the hysteresis values in Section 5.6, Electrical Characteristics. 13. BUFFER TYPE: Drive strength of the associated output buffer. 14. PULLUP / PULLDOWN TYPE: Denotes the presence of an internal pullup or pulldown resistor. Pullup and pulldown resistors can be enabled or disabled via software. 15. DSIS: The deselected input state (DSIS) indicates the state driven on the peripheral input (logic "0" or logic "1") when the peripheral pin function is not selected by any of the PINCNTLx registers. – 0: Logic 0 driven on the peripheral's input signal port. – 1: Logic 1 driven on the peripheral's input signal port. – blank: Not Applicable. NOTE Configuring two pins to the same input signal is not supported as it can yield unexpected results. This can be easily prevented with the proper software configuration (Hi-Z mode is not an input signal). NOTE When a pad is set into a multiplexing mode which is not defined by pin multiplexing, that pad’s behavior is undefined. This should be avoided. NOTE Some of the EMIF1 signals have an additional state change at the release of porz. The state that the signals change to at the release of porz is as follows: drive 0 (OFF) for: ddr1_csn0, ddr1_ck, ddr1_nck, ddr1_nck, ddr1_casn, ddr1_rasn, ddr1_wen, ddr1_ba[2:0], ddr1_a[15:0]. OFF for: ddr1_ecc_d[7:0], ddr1_dqm[3:0], ddr1_dqm_ecc, ddr1_dqs[3:0], ddr1_dqsn[3:0], ddr1_dqs_ecc, ddr1_dqsn_ecc, ddr1_d[31:0]. NOTE Dual rank support is not available on this device, but signal names are retained for consistency with the AM57xx family of devices. Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 11 ADVANCE INFORMATION NOTE For programmable buffer strength: – The default value is given in Table 4-2. – A note describes all possible values according to the selected muxmode. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] ADVANCE INFORMATION K9 cap_vbbldo_dsp cap_vbbldo_dsp CAP Y14 cap_vbbldo_gpu cap_vbbldo_gpu CAP J10 cap_vbbldo_iva cap_vbbldo_iva CAP J16 cap_vbbldo_mpu cap_vbbldo_mpu CAP T20 cap_vddram_core1 cap_vddram_core1 CAP L9 cap_vddram_core3 cap_vddram_core3 CAP J19 cap_vddram_core4 cap_vddram_core4 CAP J9 cap_vddram_dsp cap_vddram_dsp CAP Y13 cap_vddram_gpu cap_vddram_gpu CAP K16 cap_vddram_iva cap_vddram_iva CAP K19 cap_vddram_mpu cap_vddram_mpu AE1 csi2_0_dx0 csi2_0_dx0 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AF1 csi2_0_dx1 csi2_0_dx1 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AF2 csi2_0_dx2 csi2_0_dx2 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AH4 csi2_0_dx3 csi2_0_dx3 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AH3 csi2_0_dx4 csi2_0_dx4 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AD2 csi2_0_dy0 csi2_0_dy0 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AE2 csi2_0_dy1 csi2_0_dy1 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AF3 csi2_0_dy2 csi2_0_dy2 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AG4 csi2_0_dy3 csi2_0_dy3 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AG3 csi2_0_dy4 csi2_0_dy4 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AG5 csi2_1_dx0 csi2_1_dx0 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AG6 csi2_1_dx1 csi2_1_dx1 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AH7 csi2_1_dx2 csi2_1_dx2 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AH5 csi2_1_dy0 csi2_1_dy0 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AH6 csi2_1_dy1 csi2_1_dy1 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA AG7 csi2_1_dy2 csi2_1_dy2 0 I 1.8 vdda_csi NA LVCMOS CSI2 NA 12 CAP Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) G19 BALL NAME [2] dcan1_rx SIGNAL NAME [3] dcan1_tx MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] dcan1_rx 0 IO uart8_txd 2 O mmc2_sdwp 3 I sata1_led 4 O 6 IO gpio1_15 14 IO Driver off 15 I dcan1_tx 0 IO uart8_rxd 2 I 3 I 6 IO gpio1_14 14 IO Driver off 15 I hdmi1_cec G20 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No mmc2_sdcd hdmi1_hpd Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS AD20 ddr1_a0 ddr1_a0 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AC19 ddr1_a1 ddr1_a1 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AC20 ddr1_a2 ddr1_a2 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB19 ddr1_a3 ddr1_a3 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AF21 ddr1_a4 ddr1_a4 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AH22 ddr1_a5 ddr1_a5 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AG23 ddr1_a6 ddr1_a6 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AE21 ddr1_a7 ddr1_a7 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AF22 ddr1_a8 ddr1_a8 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AE22 ddr1_a9 ddr1_a9 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AD21 ddr1_a10 ddr1_a10 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AD22 ddr1_a11 ddr1_a11 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AC21 ddr1_a12 ddr1_a12 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AF18 ddr1_a13 ddr1_a13 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AE17 ddr1_a14 ddr1_a14 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 13 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] ADVANCE INFORMATION AD18 ddr1_a15 ddr1_a15 0 O PD drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AF17 ddr1_ba0 ddr1_ba0 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AE18 ddr1_ba1 ddr1_ba1 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB18 ddr1_ba2 ddr1_ba2 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AC18 ddr1_casn ddr1_casn 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AG24 ddr1_ck ddr1_ck 0 O PD drive 0 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AG22 ddr1_cke ddr1_cke 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AH23 ddr1_csn0 ddr1_csn0 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB16 ddr1_csn1 ddr1_csn1 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AF25 ddr1_d0 ddr1_d0 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AF26 ddr1_d1 ddr1_d1 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AG26 ddr1_d2 ddr1_d2 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AH26 ddr1_d3 ddr1_d3 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AF24 ddr1_d4 ddr1_d4 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AE24 ddr1_d5 ddr1_d5 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AF23 ddr1_d6 ddr1_d6 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AE23 ddr1_d7 ddr1_d7 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AC23 ddr1_d8 ddr1_d8 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AF27 ddr1_d9 ddr1_d9 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AG27 ddr1_d10 ddr1_d10 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AF28 ddr1_d11 ddr1_d11 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AE26 ddr1_d12 ddr1_d12 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AC25 ddr1_d13 ddr1_d13 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy 14 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] AC24 ddr1_d14 ddr1_d14 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AD25 ddr1_d15 ddr1_d15 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy V20 ddr1_d16 ddr1_d16 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy W20 ddr1_d17 ddr1_d17 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB28 ddr1_d18 ddr1_d18 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AC28 ddr1_d19 ddr1_d19 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AC27 ddr1_d20 ddr1_d20 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y19 ddr1_d21 ddr1_d21 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB27 ddr1_d22 ddr1_d22 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y20 ddr1_d23 ddr1_d23 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA23 ddr1_d24 ddr1_d24 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y22 ddr1_d25 ddr1_d25 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y23 ddr1_d26 ddr1_d26 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA24 ddr1_d27 ddr1_d27 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y24 ddr1_d28 ddr1_d28 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA26 ddr1_d29 ddr1_d29 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA25 ddr1_d30 ddr1_d30 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA28 ddr1_d31 ddr1_d31 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AD23 ddr1_dqm0 ddr1_dqm0 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AB23 ddr1_dqm1 ddr1_dqm1 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AC26 ddr1_dqm2 ddr1_dqm2 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AA27 ddr1_dqm3 ddr1_dqm3 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy V26 ddr1_dqm_ecc ddr1_dqm_ecc 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 15 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] ADVANCE INFORMATION AH25 ddr1_dqs0 ddr1_dqs0 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AE27 ddr1_dqs1 ddr1_dqs1 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AD27 ddr1_dqs2 ddr1_dqs2 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y28 ddr1_dqs3 ddr1_dqs3 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AG25 ddr1_dqsn0 ddr1_dqsn0 0 IO PU PU 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AE28 ddr1_dqsn1 ddr1_dqsn1 0 IO PU PU 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AD28 ddr1_dqsn2 ddr1_dqsn2 0 IO PU PU 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y27 ddr1_dqsn3 ddr1_dqsn3 0 IO PU PU 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy V28 ddr1_dqsn_ecc ddr1_dqsn_ecc 0 IO PU PU 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy V27 ddr1_dqs_ecc ddr1_dqs_ecc 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 NA LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy W22 ddr1_ecc_d0 ddr1_ecc_d0 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy V23 ddr1_ecc_d1 ddr1_ecc_d1 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy W19 ddr1_ecc_d2 ddr1_ecc_d2 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy W23 ddr1_ecc_d3 ddr1_ecc_d3 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y25 ddr1_ecc_d4 ddr1_ecc_d4 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy V24 ddr1_ecc_d5 ddr1_ecc_d5 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy V25 ddr1_ecc_d6 ddr1_ecc_d6 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy Y26 ddr1_ecc_d7 ddr1_ecc_d7 0 IO PD PD 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AH24 ddr1_nck ddr1_nck 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AE20 ddr1_odt0 ddr1_odt0 0 O PD drive 0 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AC17 ddr1_odt1 ddr1_odt1 0 O PD drive 0 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AF20 ddr1_rasn ddr1_rasn 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy AG21 ddr1_rst ddr1_rst 0 O PD drive 0 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy 16 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] Y18 ddr1_vref0 ddr1_vref0 0 PWR OFF drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR NA AH21 ddr1_wen ddr1_wen 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.35/1.5 vdds_ddr1 No LVCMOS DDR PUx/PDy G21 emu0 emu0 0 IO PU PU 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes gpio8_30 14 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS emu1 0 IO PU PU 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes gpio8_31 14 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS gpio6_10 0 IO PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes mdio_mclk 1 O Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS i2c3_sda 2 IO vin2b_hsync1 4 I vin1a_clk0 9 I ehrpwm2A 10 O pr2_mii_mt1_clk 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi0 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo0 13 O gpio6_10 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpio6_11 0 IO PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes mdio_d 1 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS i2c3_scl 2 IO vin2b_vsync1 4 I vin1a_de0 9 I ehrpwm2B 10 O pr2_mii1_txen 11 O pr2_pru0_gpi1 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo1 13 O gpio6_11 14 IO Driver off 15 I D24 AC5 AB4 emu1 gpio6_10 gpio6_11 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 17 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] E21 BALL NAME [2] gpio6_14 SIGNAL NAME [3] ADVANCE INFORMATION gpio6_15 gpio6_16 0 IO 1 IO dcan2_tx 2 IO uart10_rxd 3 I 6 O vin2a_hsync0 vin1a_hsync0 8 I i2c3_sda 9 IO timer1 10 IO gpio6_14 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpio6_15 0 IO mcasp1_axr9 1 IO dcan2_rx 2 IO uart10_txd 3 O 6 O vin2a_vsync0 vin1a_vsync0 8 I i2c3_scl 9 IO timer2 10 IO gpio6_15 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpio6_16 0 IO mcasp1_axr10 1 IO vout2_fld 18 TYPE [6] mcasp1_axr8 vout2_vsync F21 MUXMODE [5] gpio6_14 vout2_hsync F20 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No Yes / No 6 O vin2a_fld0 vin1a_fld0 Yes / No 8 I clkout1 9 O timer3 10 IO gpio6_16 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) R6 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_a0 SIGNAL NAME [3] gpmc_a1 gpmc_a2 TYPE [6] 0 O vin1a_d16 2 I 3 O vin2a_d0 vin1a_d0 4 I vin1b_d0 6 I i2c4_scl 7 IO uart5_rxd 8 I gpio7_3 gpmc_a26 gpmc_a16 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a1 0 O vin1a_d17 2 I vout3_d17 T6 MUXMODE [5] gpmc_a0 vout3_d16 T9 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No 3 O vin2a_d1 vin1a_d1 4 I vin1b_d1 6 I i2c4_sda 7 IO uart5_txd 8 O gpio7_4 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a2 0 O vin1a_d18 2 I vout3_d18 Yes / No 3 O vin2a_d2 vin1a_d2 Yes / No 4 I vin1b_d2 6 I uart7_rxd 7 I uart5_ctsn 8 I gpio7_5 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 19 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] T7 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_a3 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] 0 O qspi1_cs2 1 O 2 I 3 O vin2a_d3 vin1a_d3 4 I vin1b_d3 6 I uart7_txd 7 O uart5_rtsn 8 O gpio7_6 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a4 0 O qspi1_cs3 1 O 2 I 3 O vin2a_d4 vin1a_d4 4 I vin1b_d4 6 I i2c5_scl 7 IO uart6_rxd 8 I gpio1_26 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a5 0 O vin1a_d21 2 I vout3_d19 ADVANCE INFORMATION gpmc_a4 Yes / No vin1a_d20 vout3_d20 R9 gpmc_a5 vout3_d21 20 TYPE [6] gpmc_a3 vin1a_d19 P6 MUXMODE [5] Yes / No 3 O vin2a_d5 vin1a_d5 Yes / No 4 I vin1b_d5 6 I i2c5_sda 7 IO uart6_txd 8 O gpio1_27 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) R5 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_a6 SIGNAL NAME [3] gpmc_a7 gpmc_a8 0 O 2 I 3 O vin2a_d6 vin1a_d6 4 I vin1b_d6 6 I uart8_rxd 7 I uart6_ctsn 8 I gpio1_28 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a7 0 O vin1a_d23 2 I gpmc_a9 Yes / No 3 O vin2a_d7 vin1a_d7 4 I vin1b_d7 6 I uart8_txd 7 O uart6_rtsn 8 O gpio1_29 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a8 0 O vin1a_hsync0 2 I vout3_hsync R4 TYPE [6] vin1a_d22 vout3_d23 N7 MUXMODE [5] gpmc_a6 vout3_d22 P5 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No 3 O vin1b_hsync1 6 I timer12 7 IO spi4_sclk 8 IO gpio1_30 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a9 0 O vin1a_vsync0 2 I vout3_vsync Yes / No 3 O vin1b_vsync1 Yes / No 6 I timer11 7 IO spi4_d1 8 IO gpio1_31 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 21 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] N9 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_a10 SIGNAL NAME [3] ADVANCE INFORMATION gpmc_a11 R3 22 gpmc_a12 gpmc_a13 TYPE [6] 0 O vin1a_de0 2 I 3 O vin1b_clk1 6 I timer10 7 IO spi4_d0 8 IO gpio2_0 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a11 0 O vin1a_fld0 2 I vout3_fld P4 MUXMODE [5] gpmc_a10 vout3_de P9 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No 3 O vin2a_fld0 vin1a_fld0 Yes / No 4 I vin1b_de1 6 I timer9 7 IO spi4_cs0 8 IO gpio2_1 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a12 0 O vin2a_clk0 vin1a_clk0 4 I gpmc_a0 5 O vin1b_fld1 6 I timer8 7 IO spi4_cs1 8 IO dma_evt1 9 I gpio2_2 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a13 0 O qspi1_rtclk 1 I vin2a_hsync0 vin1a_hsync0 4 I timer7 7 IO spi4_cs2 8 IO dma_evt2 9 I gpio2_3 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) T2 U2 U1 P3 R2 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_a14 gpmc_a15 gpmc_a16 gpmc_a17 gpmc_a18 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] gpmc_a14 0 O qspi1_d3 1 IO vin2a_vsync0 vin1a_vsync0 4 I timer6 7 IO spi4_cs3 8 IO gpio2_4 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a15 0 O qspi1_d2 1 IO vin2a_d8 vin1a_d8 4 I timer5 7 IO gpio2_5 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a16 0 O qspi1_d0 1 IO vin2a_d9 vin1a_d9 4 I gpio2_6 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a17 0 O qspi1_d1 1 IO vin2a_d10 vin1a_d10 4 I gpio2_7 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a18 0 O qspi1_sclk 1 IO vin2a_d11 vin1a_d11 4 I gpio2_8 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 23 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] K7 ADVANCE INFORMATION M7 J5 K6 24 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_a19 gpmc_a20 gpmc_a21 gpmc_a22 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] gpmc_a19 0 O mmc2_dat4 1 IO gpmc_a13 2 O vin2a_d12 vin1a_d12 4 I vin2b_d0 vin1b_d0 6 I gpio2_9 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a20 0 O mmc2_dat5 1 IO gpmc_a14 2 O vin2a_d13 vin1a_d13 4 I vin2b_d1 vin1b_d1 6 I gpio2_10 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a21 0 O mmc2_dat6 1 IO gpmc_a15 2 O vin2a_d14 vin1a_d14 4 I vin2b_d2 vin1b_d2 6 I gpio2_11 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a22 0 O mmc2_dat7 1 IO gpmc_a16 2 O vin2a_d15 vin1a_d15 4 I vin2b_d3 vin1b_d3 6 I gpio2_12 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv11 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv11 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv11 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv11 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) J7 J4 J6 H4 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_a23 gpmc_a24 gpmc_a25 gpmc_a26 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] gpmc_a23 0 O mmc2_clk 1 IO gpmc_a17 2 O vin2a_fld0 vin1a_fld0 4 I vin2b_d4 vin1b_d4 6 I gpio2_13 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a24 0 O mmc2_dat0 1 IO gpmc_a18 2 O vin2a_d8 vin1a_d8 4 I vin2b_d5 vin1b_d5 6 I gpio2_14 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a25 0 O mmc2_dat1 1 IO gpmc_a19 2 O vin2a_d9 vin1a_d9 4 I vin2b_d6 vin1b_d6 6 I gpio2_15 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_a26 0 O mmc2_dat2 1 IO gpmc_a20 2 O vin2a_d10 vin1a_d10 4 I vin2b_d7 vin1b_d7 6 I gpio2_16 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv11 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv11 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv11 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv11 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 25 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] H5 ADVANCE INFORMATION M6 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_a27 gpmc_ad0 SIGNAL NAME [3] gpmc_ad1 gpmc_ad2 0 O 1 IO gpmc_a21 2 O vin2a_d11 vin1a_d11 4 I vin2b_hsync1 vin1b_hsync1 6 I gpio2_17 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_ad0 0 IO vin1a_d0 2 I 3 O gpio1_6 14 IO sysboot0 15 I gpmc_ad1 0 IO vin1a_d1 2 I gpmc_ad3 3 O 14 IO sysboot1 15 I gpmc_ad2 0 IO vin1a_d2 2 I gpmc_ad4 3 O 14 IO sysboot2 15 I gpmc_ad3 0 IO vin1a_d3 2 I Yes / No 3 O gpio1_9 14 IO sysboot3 15 I gpmc_ad4 0 IO vin1a_d4 2 I vout3_d4 26 Yes / No gpio1_8 vout3_d3 L6 Yes / No gpio1_7 vout3_d2 M1 TYPE [6] mmc2_dat3 vout3_d1 L5 MUXMODE [5] gpmc_a27 vout3_d0 M2 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No 3 O gpio1_10 Yes / No 14 IO sysboot4 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv11 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) L4 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_ad5 SIGNAL NAME [3] gpmc_ad6 gpmc_ad7 0 IO 2 I 3 O gpio1_11 14 IO sysboot5 15 I gpmc_ad6 0 IO vin1a_d6 2 I gpmc_ad8 3 O 14 IO sysboot6 15 I gpmc_ad7 0 IO vin1a_d7 2 I gpmc_ad9 3 O 14 IO sysboot7 15 I gpmc_ad8 0 IO vin1a_d8 2 I gpmc_ad10 3 O 14 IO sysboot8 15 I gpmc_ad9 0 IO vin1a_d9 2 I gpmc_ad11 Yes / No 3 O gpio7_19 14 IO sysboot9 15 I gpmc_ad10 0 IO vin1a_d10 2 I vout3_d10 J2 Yes / No gpio7_18 vout3_d9 J1 Yes / No gpio1_13 vout3_d8 K2 Yes / No gpio1_12 vout3_d7 L1 TYPE [6] vin1a_d5 vout3_d6 L2 MUXMODE [5] gpmc_ad5 vout3_d5 L3 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No 3 O gpio7_28 14 IO sysboot10 15 I gpmc_ad11 0 IO vin1a_d11 2 I vout3_d11 Yes / No 3 O gpio7_29 Yes / No 14 IO sysboot11 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 27 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] H1 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_ad12 SIGNAL NAME [3] gpmc_ad13 ADVANCE INFORMATION gpmc_ad14 0 IO 2 I 3 O gpio1_18 14 IO sysboot12 15 I gpmc_ad13 0 IO vin1a_d13 2 I gpmc_ad15 3 O 14 IO sysboot13 15 I gpmc_ad14 0 IO vin1a_d14 2 I 28 gpmc_advn_ale Yes / No 3 O gpio1_20 14 IO sysboot14 15 I gpmc_ad15 0 IO vin1a_d15 2 I vout3_d15 N1 Yes / No gpio1_19 vout3_d14 H3 TYPE [6] vin1a_d12 vout3_d13 H2 MUXMODE [5] gpmc_ad12 vout3_d12 J3 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No 3 O gpio1_21 Yes / No 14 IO sysboot15 15 I gpmc_advn_ale 0 O gpmc_cs6 1 O clkout2 2 O gpmc_wait1 3 I vin2a_vsync0 vin1a_vsync0 4 I gpmc_a2 5 O gpmc_a23 6 O timer3 7 IO i2c3_sda 8 IO dma_evt2 9 I gpio2_23 gpmc_a19 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS OFF OFF 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) N6 M4 P7 T1 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_ben0 gpmc_ben1 gpmc_clk gpmc_cs0 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] gpmc_ben0 0 O gpmc_cs4 1 O vin2b_de1 vin1b_de1 6 I timer2 7 IO dma_evt3 9 I gpio2_26 gpmc_a21 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_ben1 0 O gpmc_cs5 1 O vin2b_clk1 vin1b_clk1 4 I gpmc_a3 5 O vin2b_fld1 vin1b_fld1 6 I timer1 7 IO dma_evt4 9 I gpio2_27 gpmc_a22 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_clk 0 IO gpmc_cs7 1 O clkout1 2 O gpmc_wait1 3 I vin2a_hsync0 vin1a_hsync0 4 I vin2a_de0 vin1a_de0 5 I vin2b_clk1 vin1b_clk1 6 I timer4 7 IO i2c3_scl 8 IO dma_evt1 9 I gpio2_22 gpmc_a20 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_cs0 0 O gpio2_19 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 29 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] H6 ADVANCE INFORMATION P2 P1 BALL NAME [2] gpmc_cs1 gpmc_cs2 gpmc_cs3 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] 0 O mmc2_cmd 1 IO gpmc_a22 2 O vin2a_de0 vin1a_de0 4 I vin2b_vsync1 vin1b_vsync1 6 I gpio2_18 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_cs2 0 O qspi1_cs0 1 IO gpio2_20 gpmc_a23 gpmc_a13 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_cs3 0 O qspi1_cs1 1 O 2 I 3 O gpmc_a1 5 O gpio2_21 gpmc_a24 gpmc_a14 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_oen_ren 0 O gpio2_24 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_wait0 0 I gpio2_28 gpmc_a25 gpmc_a15 14 IO Driver off 15 I gpmc_wen 0 O gpio2_25 14 IO vout3_clk N2 M3 gpmc_oen_ren gpmc_wait0 gpmc_wen TYPE [6] gpmc_cs1 vin1a_clk0 M5 MUXMODE [5] Yes / No Driver off BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv11 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv10 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 15 I AG16 hdmi1_clockx hdmi1_clockx Yes / No 0 O 1.8 vdda_hdmi NA HDMIPHY Pdy AH16 hdmi1_clocky hdmi1_clocky Yes / No 0 O 1.8 vdda_hdmi NA HDMIPHY Pdy AG17 hdmi1_data0x hdmi1_data0x Yes / No 0 O 1.8 vdda_hdmi NA HDMIPHY Pdy AH17 hdmi1_data0y hdmi1_data0y Yes / No 0 O 1.8 vdda_hdmi NA HDMIPHY Pdy AG18 hdmi1_data1x hdmi1_data1x Yes / No 0 O 1.8 vdda_hdmi NA HDMIPHY Pdy AH18 hdmi1_data1y hdmi1_data1y Yes / No 0 O 1.8 vdda_hdmi NA HDMIPHY Pdy 30 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] AG19 hdmi1_data2x hdmi1_data2x Yes / No 0 O 1.8 vdda_hdmi NA HDMIPHY Pdy AH19 hdmi1_data2y hdmi1_data2y Yes / No 0 O 1.8 vdda_hdmi NA HDMIPHY Pdy C20 i2c1_scl i2c1_scl 0 IO 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Driver off 15 I Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS I2C C21 i2c1_sda i2c1_sda 0 IO 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Driver off 15 I Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS I2C 0 IO 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes 1 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS I2C Driver off 15 I i2c2_sda 0 IO 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes 1 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS I2C F17 i2c2_scl i2c2_scl hdmi1_ddc_sda C25 i2c2_sda hdmi1_ddc_scl Yes / No Yes / No Driver off 15 I AH15 ljcb_clkn ljcb_clkn 0 IO 1.8 vdda_pcie NA LJCB NA AG15 ljcb_clkp ljcb_clkp 0 IO 1.8 vdda_pcie NA LJCB NA B14 mcasp1_aclkr mcasp1_aclkr 0 IO 1 IO 6 O vin2a_d0 vin1a_d0 8 I i2c4_sda 10 IO gpio5_0 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp1_aclkx 0 IO vin1a_fld0 7 I i2c3_sda 10 IO pr2_mdio_mdclk 11 O pr2_pru1_gpi7 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo7 13 O gpio7_31 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp7_axr2 vout2_d0 C14 mcasp1_aclkx Yes / No PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 31 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] G12 ADVANCE INFORMATION F12 G13 BALL NAME [2] mcasp1_axr0 mcasp1_axr1 mcasp1_axr2 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] 0 IO uart6_rxd 3 I vin1a_vsync0 7 I i2c5_sda 10 IO pr2_mii0_rxer 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi8 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo8 13 O gpio5_2 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp1_axr1 0 IO uart6_txd 3 O vin1a_hsync0 7 I i2c5_scl 10 IO pr2_mii_mt0_clk 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi9 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo9 13 O gpio5_3 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp1_axr2 0 IO mcasp6_axr2 1 IO 3 I 6 O vin2a_d2 vin1a_d2 8 I gpio5_4 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp1_axr3 0 IO mcasp6_axr3 1 IO 3 O 6 O vin2a_d3 vin1a_d3 8 I gpio5_5 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout2_d2 mcasp1_axr3 Yes / No uart6_rtsn vout2_d3 32 TYPE [6] mcasp1_axr0 uart6_ctsn J11 MUXMODE [5] Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) E12 BALL NAME [2] mcasp1_axr4 SIGNAL NAME [3] mcasp1_axr5 mcasp1_axr6 0 IO 1 IO 6 O vin2a_d4 vin1a_d4 8 I gpio5_6 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp1_axr5 0 IO mcasp4_axr3 1 IO mcasp1_axr7 6 O 8 I gpio5_7 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp1_axr6 0 IO mcasp5_axr2 1 IO mcasp1_axr8 Yes / No 6 O vin2a_d6 vin1a_d6 8 I gpio5_8 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp1_axr7 0 IO mcasp5_axr3 1 IO vout2_d7 B12 Yes / No vin2a_d5 vin1a_d5 vout2_d6 D12 TYPE [6] mcasp4_axr2 vout2_d5 C12 MUXMODE [5] mcasp1_axr4 vout2_d4 F13 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No 6 O vin2a_d7 vin1a_d7 Yes / No 8 I timer4 10 IO gpio5_9 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp1_axr8 0 IO mcasp6_axr0 1 IO spi3_sclk 3 IO vin1a_d15 7 I timer5 10 IO pr2_mii0_txen 11 O pr2_pru1_gpi10 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo10 13 O gpio5_10 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 33 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] A11 ADVANCE INFORMATION B13 A12 34 BALL NAME [2] mcasp1_axr9 mcasp1_axr10 mcasp1_axr11 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] mcasp1_axr9 0 IO mcasp6_axr1 1 IO spi3_d1 3 IO vin1a_d14 7 I timer6 10 IO pr2_mii0_txd3 11 O pr2_pru1_gpi11 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo11 13 O gpio5_11 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp1_axr10 0 IO mcasp6_aclkx 1 IO mcasp6_aclkr 2 IO spi3_d0 3 IO vin1a_d13 7 I timer7 10 IO pr2_mii0_txd2 11 O pr2_pru1_gpi12 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo12 13 O gpio5_12 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp1_axr11 0 IO mcasp6_fsx 1 IO mcasp6_fsr 2 IO spi3_cs0 3 IO vin1a_d12 7 I timer8 10 IO pr2_mii0_txd1 11 O pr2_pru1_gpi13 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo13 13 O gpio4_17 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) E14 A13 G14 BALL NAME [2] mcasp1_axr12 mcasp1_axr13 mcasp1_axr14 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] mcasp1_axr12 0 IO mcasp7_axr0 1 IO spi3_cs1 3 IO vin1a_d11 7 I timer9 10 IO pr2_mii0_txd0 11 O pr2_pru1_gpi14 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo14 13 O gpio4_18 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp1_axr13 0 IO mcasp7_axr1 1 IO vin1a_d10 7 I timer10 10 IO pr2_mii_mr0_clk 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi15 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo15 13 O gpio6_4 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp1_axr14 0 IO mcasp7_aclkx 1 IO mcasp7_aclkr 2 IO vin1a_d9 7 I timer11 10 IO pr2_mii0_rxdv 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi16 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo16 13 O gpio6_5 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 35 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] F14 ADVANCE INFORMATION J14 BALL NAME [2] mcasp1_axr15 mcasp1_fsr SIGNAL NAME [3] E15 mcasp1_fsx mcasp2_aclkr 36 mcasp2_aclkx TYPE [6] 0 IO mcasp7_fsx 1 IO mcasp7_fsr 2 IO vin1a_d8 7 I timer12 10 IO pr2_mii0_rxd3 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi20 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo20 13 O gpio6_6 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp1_fsr 0 IO mcasp7_axr3 1 IO 6 O vin2a_d1 vin1a_d1 8 I i2c4_scl 10 IO gpio5_1 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp1_fsx 0 IO vin1a_de0 7 I i2c3_scl 10 IO pr2_mdio_data 11 IO gpio7_30 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp2_aclkr 0 IO mcasp8_axr2 1 IO vout2_d8 A19 MUXMODE [5] mcasp1_axr15 vout2_d1 D14 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No 6 O vin2a_d8 vin1a_d8 Yes / No 8 I Driver off 15 I mcasp2_aclkx 0 IO vin1a_d7 7 I pr2_mii0_rxd2 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi18 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo18 13 O Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) B15 BALL NAME [2] mcasp2_axr0 SIGNAL NAME [3] mcasp2_axr0 mcasp2_axr1 A16 D15 mcasp2_axr2 mcasp2_axr3 mcasp2_axr4 TYPE [6] IO 6 O vin2a_d10 vin1a_d10 8 I Driver off 15 I mcasp2_axr1 0 IO 6 O vin2a_d11 vin1a_d11 8 I Driver off 15 I mcasp2_axr2 0 IO mcasp3_axr2 1 IO vin1a_d5 7 I pr2_mii0_rxd0 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi16 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo16 13 O gpio6_8 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp2_axr3 0 IO mcasp3_axr3 1 IO vin1a_d4 7 I pr2_mii0_rxlink 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi17 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo17 13 O gpio6_9 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp2_axr4 0 IO mcasp8_axr0 1 IO vout2_d11 C15 MUXMODE [5] 0 vout2_d10 A15 18 / 16 [4] vout2_d12 Yes / No Yes / No 6 O vin2a_d12 vin1a_d12 Yes / No 8 I gpio1_4 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 37 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] B16 BALL NAME [2] mcasp2_axr5 SIGNAL NAME [3] mcasp2_axr6 0 IO 1 IO ADVANCE INFORMATION 6 O vin2a_d13 vin1a_d13 8 I gpio6_7 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp2_axr6 0 IO mcasp8_aclkx 1 IO 2 IO 6 O vin2a_d14 vin1a_d14 8 I gpio2_29 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp2_axr7 0 IO mcasp8_fsx 1 IO 2 IO 6 O vin2a_d15 vin1a_d15 8 I gpio1_5 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp2_fsr 0 IO mcasp8_axr3 1 IO vout2_d14 mcasp2_axr7 Yes / No Yes / No mcasp8_fsr vout2_d15 A20 mcasp2_fsr vout2_d9 A18 38 mcasp2_fsx TYPE [6] mcasp8_axr1 mcasp8_aclkr A17 MUXMODE [5] mcasp2_axr5 vout2_d13 B17 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No 6 O vin2a_d9 vin1a_d9 Yes / No 8 I Driver off 15 I mcasp2_fsx 0 IO vin1a_d6 7 I pr2_mii0_rxd1 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi19 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo19 13 O Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) B18 B19 C17 BALL NAME [2] mcasp3_aclkx mcasp3_axr0 mcasp3_axr1 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] mcasp3_aclkx 0 IO mcasp3_aclkr 1 IO mcasp2_axr12 2 IO uart7_rxd 3 I vin1a_d3 7 I pr2_mii0_crs 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi12 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo12 13 O gpio5_13 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp3_axr0 0 IO mcasp2_axr14 2 IO uart7_ctsn 3 I uart5_rxd 4 I vin1a_d1 7 I pr2_mii1_rxer 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi14 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo14 13 O Driver off 15 I mcasp3_axr1 0 IO mcasp2_axr15 2 IO uart7_rtsn 3 O uart5_txd 4 O vin1a_d0 7 I vin1a_fld0 9 I pr2_mii1_rxlink 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi15 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo15 13 O Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 39 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] F15 ADVANCE INFORMATION C18 BALL NAME [2] mcasp3_fsx mcasp4_aclkx SIGNAL NAME [3] mcasp4_axr0 TYPE [6] 0 IO mcasp3_fsr 1 IO mcasp2_axr13 2 IO uart7_txd 3 O vin1a_d2 7 I pr2_mii0_col 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi13 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo13 13 O gpio5_14 14 IO Driver off 15 I mcasp4_aclkx 0 IO mcasp4_aclkr 1 IO spi3_sclk 2 IO uart8_rxd 3 I i2c4_sda 4 IO 6 O vin2a_d16 vin1a_d16 8 I vin1a_d15 9 I Driver off 15 I mcasp4_axr0 0 IO spi3_d0 2 IO uart8_ctsn 3 I uart4_rxd 4 I 6 O vin2a_d18 vin1a_d18 8 I vin1a_d13 9 I Driver off 15 I vout2_d18 40 MUXMODE [5] mcasp3_fsx vout2_d16 G16 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) D17 BALL NAME [2] mcasp4_axr1 SIGNAL NAME [3] mcasp4_fsx mcasp5_aclkx TYPE [6] 0 IO spi3_cs0 2 IO uart8_rtsn 3 O uart4_txd 4 O 6 O vin2a_d19 vin1a_d19 8 I vin1a_d12 9 I pr2_pru1_gpi0 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo0 13 O Driver off 15 I mcasp4_fsx 0 IO mcasp4_fsr 1 IO spi3_d1 2 IO uart8_txd 3 O i2c4_scl 4 IO 6 O vin2a_d17 vin1a_d17 8 I vin1a_d14 9 I Driver off 15 I mcasp5_aclkx 0 IO mcasp5_aclkr 1 IO spi4_sclk 2 IO uart9_rxd 3 I i2c5_sda 4 IO 6 O vin2a_d20 vin1a_d20 8 I vin1a_d11 9 I pr2_pru1_gpi1 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo1 13 O Driver off 15 I vout2_d17 AA3 MUXMODE [5] mcasp4_axr1 vout2_d19 A21 18 / 16 [4] vout2_d20 Yes / No Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 41 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] AB3 BALL NAME [2] mcasp5_axr0 SIGNAL NAME [3] ADVANCE INFORMATION mcasp5_axr1 mcasp5_fsx 0 IO 2 IO uart9_ctsn 3 I uart3_rxd 4 I 6 O vin2a_d22 vin1a_d22 8 I vin1a_d9 9 I pr2_mdio_mdclk 11 O pr2_pru1_gpi3 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo3 13 O Driver off 15 I mcasp5_axr1 0 IO spi4_cs0 2 IO uart9_rtsn 3 O uart3_txd 4 O 6 O vin2a_d23 vin1a_d23 8 I vin1a_d8 9 I pr2_mdio_data 11 IO pr2_pru1_gpi4 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo4 13 O Driver off 15 I mcasp5_fsx 0 IO mcasp5_fsr 1 IO spi4_d1 2 IO uart9_txd 3 O i2c5_scl 4 IO 6 O vin2a_d21 vin1a_d21 8 I vin1a_d10 9 I pr2_pru1_gpi2 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo2 13 O Driver off 15 I vout2_d21 42 TYPE [6] spi4_d0 vout2_d23 AB9 MUXMODE [5] mcasp5_axr0 vout2_d22 AA4 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) U4 V1 BALL NAME [2] mdio_d mdio_mclk SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] mdio_d 0 IO uart3_ctsn 1 I mii0_txer 3 O vin2a_d0 4 I vin1b_d0 5 I pr1_mii0_rxlink 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi1 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo1 13 O gpio5_16 14 IO Driver off 15 I mdio_mclk 0 O uart3_rtsn 1 O mii0_col 3 I vin2a_clk0 4 I vin1b_clk1 5 I pr1_mii0_col 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi0 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo0 13 O gpio5_15 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS AB2 mlbp_clk_n mlbp_clk_n 0 I vdds_mlbp NA BMLB18 NA AB1 mlbp_clk_p mlbp_clk_p 0 I vdds_mlbp NA BMLB18 NA AA2 mlbp_dat_n mlbp_dat_n 0 IO OFF OFF vdds_mlbp NA BMLB18 NA AA1 mlbp_dat_p mlbp_dat_p 0 IO OFF OFF vdds_mlbp NA BMLB18 NA AC2 mlbp_sig_n mlbp_sig_n 0 IO OFF OFF vdds_mlbp NA BMLB18 NA AC1 mlbp_sig_p mlbp_sig_p 0 IO OFF OFF vdds_mlbp NA BMLB18 NA W6 mmc1_clk mmc1_clk 0 IO PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv8 Yes gpio6_21 14 IO SDIO2KV183 PUx/PDy 3 Driver off 15 I mmc1_cmd 0 IO PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv8 Yes gpio6_22 14 IO SDIO2KV183 PUx/PDy 3 Driver off 15 I mmc1_dat0 0 IO PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv8 Yes gpio6_23 14 IO SDIO2KV183 PUx/PDy 3 Driver off 15 I mmc1_dat1 0 IO PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv8 Yes gpio6_24 14 IO SDIO2KV183 PUx/PDy 3 Driver off 15 I Y6 AA6 Y4 mmc1_cmd mmc1_dat0 mmc1_dat1 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 43 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] AA5 Y3 W7 ADVANCE INFORMATION Y9 AD4 AC4 44 BALL NAME [2] mmc1_dat2 mmc1_dat3 mmc1_sdcd mmc1_sdwp mmc3_clk mmc3_cmd SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] mmc1_dat2 0 IO gpio6_25 14 IO Driver off 15 I mmc1_dat3 0 IO gpio6_26 14 IO Driver off 15 I mmc1_sdcd 0 I uart6_rxd 3 I i2c4_sda 4 IO gpio6_27 14 IO Driver off 15 I mmc1_sdwp 0 I uart6_txd 3 O i2c4_scl 4 IO gpio6_28 14 IO Driver off 15 I mmc3_clk 0 IO vin2b_d7 4 I vin1a_d7 9 I ehrpwm2_tripzone_input 10 IO pr2_mii1_txd3 11 O pr2_pru0_gpi2 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo2 13 O gpio6_29 14 IO Driver off 15 I mmc3_cmd 0 IO spi3_sclk 1 IO vin2b_d6 4 I vin1a_d6 9 I eCAP2_in_PWM2_out 10 IO pr2_mii1_txd2 11 O pr2_pru0_gpi3 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo3 13 O gpio6_30 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv8 Yes SDIO2KV183 PUx/PDy 3 PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv8 Yes SDIO2KV183 PUx/PDy 3 PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv8 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv8 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) AC7 AC6 AC9 BALL NAME [2] mmc3_dat0 mmc3_dat1 mmc3_dat2 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] mmc3_dat0 0 IO spi3_d1 1 IO uart5_rxd 2 I vin2b_d5 4 I vin1a_d5 9 I eQEP3A_in 10 I pr2_mii1_txd1 11 O pr2_pru0_gpi4 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo4 13 O gpio6_31 14 IO Driver off 15 I mmc3_dat1 0 IO spi3_d0 1 IO uart5_txd 2 O vin2b_d4 4 I vin1a_d4 9 I eQEP3B_in 10 I pr2_mii1_txd0 11 O pr2_pru0_gpi5 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo5 13 O gpio7_0 14 IO Driver off 15 I mmc3_dat2 0 IO spi3_cs0 1 IO uart5_ctsn 2 I vin2b_d3 4 I vin1a_d3 9 I eQEP3_index 10 IO pr2_mii_mr1_clk 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi6 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo6 13 O gpio7_1 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 45 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] AC3 ADVANCE INFORMATION AC8 AD6 46 BALL NAME [2] mmc3_dat3 mmc3_dat4 mmc3_dat5 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] mmc3_dat3 0 IO spi3_cs1 1 IO uart5_rtsn 2 O vin2b_d2 4 I vin1a_d2 9 I eQEP3_strobe 10 IO pr2_mii1_rxdv 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi7 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo7 13 O gpio7_2 14 IO Driver off 15 I mmc3_dat4 0 IO spi4_sclk 1 IO uart10_rxd 2 I vin2b_d1 4 I vin1a_d1 9 I ehrpwm3A 10 O pr2_mii1_rxd3 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi8 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo8 13 O gpio1_22 14 IO Driver off 15 I mmc3_dat5 0 IO spi4_d1 1 IO uart10_txd 2 O vin2b_d0 4 I vin1a_d0 9 I ehrpwm3B 10 O pr2_mii1_rxd2 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi9 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo9 13 O gpio1_23 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) AB8 AB5 BALL NAME [2] mmc3_dat6 mmc3_dat7 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] mmc3_dat6 0 IO spi4_d0 1 IO uart10_ctsn 2 I vin2b_de1 4 I vin1a_hsync0 9 I ehrpwm3_tripzone_input 10 IO pr2_mii1_rxd1 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi10 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo10 13 O gpio1_24 14 IO Driver off 15 I mmc3_dat7 0 IO spi4_cs0 1 IO uart10_rtsn 2 O vin2b_clk1 4 I vin1a_vsync0 9 I eCAP3_in_PWM3_out 10 IO pr2_mii1_rxd0 11 I pr2_pru0_gpi11 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo11 13 O gpio1_25 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv7 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS D21 nmin_dsp nmin_dsp 0 I PD PD 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Y11 on_off on_off 0 O PU drive 1 (OFF) 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes BC1833IHHV PU/PD AG13 pcie_rxn0 pcie_rxn0 0 I OFF OFF 1.8 vdda_pcie0 NA SERDES NA AH13 pcie_rxp0 pcie_rxp0 0 I OFF OFF 1.8 vdda_pcie0 NA SERDES NA AG14 pcie_txn0 pcie_txn0 0 O 1.8 vdda_pcie0 NA SERDES NA AH14 pcie_txp0 pcie_txp0 0 O 1.8 vdda_pcie0 NA SERDES NA F22 porz porz 0 I 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes IHHV1833 PU/PD E23 resetn resetn 0 I 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 47 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] U5 ADVANCE INFORMATION V5 W2 48 BALL NAME [2] rgmii0_rxc rgmii0_rxctl rgmii0_rxd0 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] rgmii0_rxc 0 I rmii1_txen 2 O mii0_txclk 3 I vin2a_d5 4 I vin1b_d5 5 I pr1_mii_mt0_clk 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi11 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo11 13 O gpio5_26 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_rxctl 0 I rmii1_txd1 2 O mii0_txd3 3 O vin2a_d6 4 I vin1b_d6 5 I pr1_mii0_txd3 11 O pr2_pru1_gpi12 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo12 13 O gpio5_27 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_rxd0 0 I rmii0_txd0 1 O mii0_txd0 3 O vin2a_fld0 4 I vin1b_fld1 5 I pr1_mii0_txd0 11 O pr2_pru1_gpi16 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo16 13 O gpio5_31 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) Y2 V3 V4 BALL NAME [2] rgmii0_rxd1 rgmii0_rxd2 rgmii0_rxd3 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] rgmii0_rxd1 0 I rmii0_txd1 1 O mii0_txd1 3 O vin2a_d9 4 I pr1_mii0_txd1 11 O pr2_pru1_gpi15 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo15 13 O gpio5_30 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_rxd2 0 I rmii0_txen 1 O mii0_txen 3 O vin2a_d8 4 I pr1_mii0_txen 11 O pr2_pru1_gpi14 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo14 13 O gpio5_29 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_rxd3 0 I rmii1_txd0 2 O mii0_txd2 3 O vin2a_d7 4 I vin1b_d7 5 I pr1_mii0_txd2 11 O pr2_pru1_gpi13 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo13 13 O gpio5_28 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 49 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] W9 ADVANCE INFORMATION V9 U6 50 BALL NAME [2] rgmii0_txc rgmii0_txctl rgmii0_txd0 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] rgmii0_txc 0 O uart3_ctsn 1 I rmii1_rxd1 2 I mii0_rxd3 3 I vin2a_d3 4 I vin1b_d3 5 I spi3_d0 7 IO spi4_cs2 8 IO pr1_mii0_rxd3 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi5 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo5 13 O gpio5_20 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_txctl 0 O uart3_rtsn 1 O rmii1_rxd0 2 I mii0_rxd2 3 I vin2a_d4 4 I vin1b_d4 5 I spi3_cs0 7 IO spi4_cs3 8 IO pr1_mii0_rxd2 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi6 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo6 13 O gpio5_21 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_txd0 0 O rmii0_rxd0 1 I mii0_rxd0 3 I vin2a_d10 4 I spi4_cs0 7 IO uart4_rtsn 8 O pr1_mii0_rxd0 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi10 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo10 13 O gpio5_25 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) V6 U7 V7 BALL NAME [2] rgmii0_txd1 rgmii0_txd2 rgmii0_txd3 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] rgmii0_txd1 0 O rmii0_rxd1 1 I mii0_rxd1 3 I vin2a_vsync0 4 I vin1b_vsync1 5 I spi4_d0 7 IO uart4_ctsn 8 IO pr1_mii0_rxd1 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi9 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo9 13 O gpio5_24 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_txd2 0 O rmii0_rxer 1 I mii0_rxer 3 I vin2a_hsync0 4 I vin1b_hsync1 5 I spi4_d1 7 IO uart4_txd 8 O pr1_mii0_rxer 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi8 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo8 13 O gpio5_23 14 IO Driver off 15 I rgmii0_txd3 0 O rmii0_crs 1 I mii0_crs 3 I vin2a_de0 4 I vin1b_de1 5 I spi4_sclk 7 IO uart4_rxd 8 I pr1_mii0_crs 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi7 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo7 13 O gpio5_22 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 51 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] U3 BALL NAME [2] RMII_MHZ_50_CLK SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] RMII_MHZ_50_CLK 0 IO vin2a_d11 4 I pr2_pru1_gpi2 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo2 13 O gpio5_17 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] PD PD ADVANCE INFORMATION F23 rstoutn rstoutn 0 O PD PD E18 rtck rtck 0 O PU OFF gpio8_29 14 IO 15 0 HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS AF14 rtc_iso rtc_iso 0 I 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes IHHV1833 PU/PD AE14 rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 0 I 1.8 vdda_rtc No LVCMOS OSC NA AD14 rtc_osc_xo rtc_osc_xo 0 O 1.8 vdda_rtc No LVCMOS OSC NA AB17 rtc_porz rtc_porz 0 I 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes IHHV1833 PU/PD AH9 sata1_rxn0 sata1_rxn0 0 I OFF OFF 1.8 vdda_sata NA SATAPHY NA AG9 sata1_rxp0 sata1_rxp0 0 I OFF OFF 1.8 vdda_sata NA SATAPHY NA AG10 sata1_txn0 sata1_txn0 0 O 1.8 vdda_sata NA SATAPHY NA AH10 sata1_txp0 sata1_txp0 0 O 1.8 vdda_sata NA SATAPHY NA A24 spi1_cs0 spi1_cs0 0 IO gpio7_10 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi1_cs1 0 IO sata1_led 2 O spi2_cs1 3 IO gpio7_11 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi1_cs2 0 IO uart4_rxd 1 I mmc3_sdcd 2 I spi2_cs2 3 IO dcan2_tx 4 IO mdio_mclk 5 O 6 IO gpio7_12 14 IO Driver off 15 I A22 B21 spi1_cs1 spi1_cs2 hdmi1_hpd 52 Yes / No PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) B20 BALL NAME [2] spi1_cs3 SIGNAL NAME [3] F16 A25 B24 G17 B22 A26 E20 spi1_d0 spi1_d1 spi1_sclk spi2_cs0 spi2_d0 spi2_d1 spi2_sclk tclk MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] spi1_cs3 0 IO uart4_txd 1 O mmc3_sdwp 2 I spi2_cs3 3 IO dcan2_rx 4 IO mdio_d 5 IO 6 IO gpio7_13 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi1_d0 0 IO gpio7_9 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi1_d1 0 IO gpio7_8 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi1_sclk 0 IO gpio7_7 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi2_cs0 0 IO uart3_rtsn 1 O uart5_txd 2 O gpio7_17 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi2_d0 0 IO uart3_ctsn 1 I uart5_rxd 2 I gpio7_16 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi2_d1 0 IO uart3_txd 1 O gpio7_15 14 IO Driver off 15 I spi2_sclk 0 IO uart3_rxd 1 I gpio7_14 14 IO Driver off 15 I tclk 0 I hdmi1_cec B25 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes IQ1833 PU/PD Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 53 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] D23 F19 BALL NAME [2] tdi tdo SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] tdi 0 I gpio8_27 14 I tdo 0 O gpio8_28 14 IO BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PU PU 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 0 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS ADVANCE INFORMATION F18 tms tms 0 I PU PU D20 trstn trstn 0 I PD PD E25 uart1_ctsn uart1_ctsn 0 I PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv4 Yes uart9_rxd 2 I Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS mmc4_clk 3 IO gpio7_24 14 IO Driver off 15 I uart1_rtsn 0 O PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv4 Yes uart9_txd 2 O Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS mmc4_cmd 3 IO gpio7_25 14 IO Driver off 15 I uart1_rxd 0 I PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv4 Yes mmc4_sdcd 3 I Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS gpio7_22 14 IO Driver off 15 I uart1_txd 0 O PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv4 Yes mmc4_sdwp 3 I Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS gpio7_23 14 IO Driver off 15 I uart2_ctsn 0 I PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv4 Yes uart3_rxd 2 I Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS mmc4_dat2 3 IO uart10_rxd 4 I uart1_dtrn 5 O gpio1_16 14 IO Driver off 15 I C27 B27 C26 D27 54 uart1_rtsn uart1_rxd uart1_txd uart2_ctsn Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) C28 D28 D26 V2 BALL NAME [2] uart2_rtsn uart2_rxd uart2_txd uart3_rxd SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] uart2_rtsn 0 O uart3_txd 1 O uart3_irtx 2 O mmc4_dat3 3 IO uart10_txd 4 O uart1_rin 5 I gpio1_17 14 IO Driver off 15 I uart2_rxd 0 I uart3_ctsn 1 I uart3_rctx 2 O mmc4_dat0 3 IO uart2_rxd 4 I uart1_dcdn 5 I gpio7_26 14 IO Driver off 15 I uart2_txd 0 O uart3_rtsn 1 O uart3_sd 2 O mmc4_dat1 3 IO uart2_txd 4 O uart1_dsrn 5 I gpio7_27 14 IO Driver off 15 I uart3_rxd 0 I rmii1_crs 2 I mii0_rxdv 3 I vin2a_d1 4 I vin1b_d1 5 I spi3_sclk 7 IO pr1_mii0_rxdv 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi3 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo3 13 O gpio5_18 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv4 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv4 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PU PU 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv4 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 55 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] Y1 BALL NAME [2] uart3_txd SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] ADVANCE INFORMATION uart3_txd 0 O rmii1_rxer 2 I mii0_rxclk 3 I vin2a_d2 4 I vin1b_d2 5 I spi3_d1 7 IO spi4_cs1 8 IO pr1_mii_mr0_clk 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi4 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo4 13 O gpio5_19 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv9 HYS [12] Yes BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS AC12 usb1_dm usb1_dm 0 IO OFF OFF 3.3 vdda33v_usb NA 1 USBPHY NA AD12 usb1_dp usb1_dp 0 IO OFF OFF 3.3 vdda33v_usb NA 1 USBPHY NA AB10 usb1_drvvbus usb1_drvvbus 0 O PD PD 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 timer16 7 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS gpio6_12 14 IO Driver off 15 I 15 Yes AF11 usb2_dm usb2_dm 0 IO 3.3 vdda33v_usb No 2 USBPHY NA AE11 usb2_dp usb2_dp 0 IO 3.3 vdda33v_usb No 2 USBPHY NA AC10 usb2_drvvbus usb2_drvvbus 0 O 1.8/3.3 vddshv6 Yes timer15 7 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS gpio6_13 14 IO Driver off 15 I usb_rxn0 0 I pcie_rxn1 1 I usb_rxp0 0 I pcie_rxp1 1 I usb_txn0 0 O pcie_txn1 1 O usb_txp0 0 O pcie_txp1 1 O AF12 AE12 AC11 AD11 56 usb_rxn0 usb_rxp0 usb_txn0 usb_txp0 PD PD OFF OFF 1.8 vdda_usb1 NA SERDES NA OFF OFF 1.8 vdda_usb1 NA SERDES NA 1.8 vdda_usb1 NA SERDES NA 1.8 vdda_usb1 NA SERDES NA Terminal Configuration and Functions 15 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] H13, H14, J17, J18, L7, L8, N10, N13, P11, P12, P13, R11, R16, R19, T13, T16, T19, U13, U16, U8, U9, V16, V8 vdd vdd PWR AA12 vdda33v_usb1 vdda33v_usb1 PWR Y12 vdda33v_usb2 vdda33v_usb2 PWR P14 vdda_core_gmac vdda_core_gmac PWR W12 vdda_csi vdda_csi PWR R17 vdda_ddr vdda_ddr PWR N11 vdda_debug vdda_debug PWR N12 vdda_dsp_iva vdda_dsp_iva PWR R14 vdda_gpu vdda_gpu PWR Y17 vdda_hdmi vdda_hdmi PWR N16 vdda_mpu_abe vdda_mpu_abe PWR AD16, AE16 vdda_osc vdda_osc PWR AA16 vdda_pcie0 vdda_pcie0 PWR AA17 vdda_pcie vdda_pcie PWR M14 vdda_per vdda_per PWR P15 vdda_pll_spare vdda_pll_spare PWR AB13 vdda_rtc vdda_rtc PWR V13 vdda_sata vdda_sata PWR AA13 vdda_usb1 vdda_usb1 PWR AB12 vdda_usb2 vdda_usb2 PWR W14 vdda_usb3 vdda_usb3 PWR P16 vdda_video vdda_video PWR G18, H17, M8, M9, N8, P8, R8, T8, V21, V22, W17, W18 vdds18v vdds18v PWR AA18, AA19, N21, vdds18v_ddr1 P20, P21, W21, Y21 vdds18v_ddr1 PWR E3, E5, G4, G5, H8, H9 vddshv1 vddshv1 PWR B6, D10, E10, H10, H11 vddshv2 vddshv2 PWR B23, D16, D22, E16, E22, G15, H15, H16, H18, H19 vddshv3 vddshv3 PWR C24 vddshv4 vddshv4 PWR BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 57 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] ADVANCE INFORMATION V12 vddshv5 vddshv5 PWR AD5, AD7, AE7, AF5 vddshv6 vddshv6 PWR AB6, AB7 vddshv7 vddshv7 PWR W8, Y8 vddshv8 vddshv8 PWR U10, W4, W5 vddshv9 vddshv9 PWR N4, N5, P10, R10, vddshv10 R7, T4, T5 vddshv10 PWR J8, K8 vddshv11 vddshv11 PWR AA21, AA22, AB21, AB22, AB24, AB25, AC22, AD26, AG20, AG28, AH27, T24, T25, W16, W27 vdds_ddr1 vdds_ddr1 PWR AA7, Y7 vdds_mlbp vdds_mlbp PWR K10, K11, L10, L11, M10, M11 vdd_dsp vdd_dsp PWR U11, U12, V10, V11, V14, W10, W11, W13 vdd_gpu vdd_gpu PWR J13, K12, K13, L12, M12, M13 vdd_iva vdd_iva PWR K17, K18, L15, L16, L17, L18, L19, M15, M16, M17, M18, N17, N18, P17, P18, R18 vdd_mpu vdd_mpu PWR AB15 vdd_rtc vdd_rtc E1 vin2a_clk0 vin2a_clk0 58 BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PWR 0 I 4 O emu5 5 O kbd_row0 9 I eQEP1A_in 10 I pr1_edio_data_in0 12 I pr1_edio_data_out0 13 O gpio3_28 gpmc_a27 gpmc_a17 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout2_fld BALL RESET STATE [7] Yes / No PD Terminal Configuration and Functions PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) F2 BALL NAME [2] vin2a_d0 SIGNAL NAME [3] vin2a_d0 vin2a_d1 vin2a_d2 TYPE [6] I 4 O emu10 5 O uart9_ctsn 7 I spi4_d0 8 IO kbd_row4 9 I ehrpwm1B 10 O pr1_uart0_rxd 11 I pr1_edio_data_in5 12 I pr1_edio_data_out5 13 O gpio4_1 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d1 0 I 4 O emu11 5 O uart9_rtsn 7 O spi4_cs0 8 IO kbd_row5 9 I ehrpwm1_tripzone_input 10 IO pr1_uart0_txd 11 O pr1_edio_data_in6 12 I pr1_edio_data_out6 13 O gpio4_2 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d2 0 I 4 O emu12 5 O uart10_rxd 8 I kbd_row6 9 I eCAP1_in_PWM1_out 10 IO pr1_ecap0_ecap_capin_apwm_o 11 IO pr1_edio_data_in7 12 I pr1_edio_data_out7 13 O gpio4_3 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout2_d22 D1 MUXMODE [5] 0 vout2_d23 F3 18 / 16 [4] vout2_d21 Yes / No Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 59 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] E2 BALL NAME [2] vin2a_d3 SIGNAL NAME [3] vin2a_d3 ADVANCE INFORMATION vin2a_d4 vin2a_d5 I O emu13 5 O uart10_txd 8 O kbd_col0 9 O ehrpwm1_synci 10 I pr1_edc_latch0_in 11 I pr1_pru1_gpi0 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo0 13 O gpio4_4 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d4 0 I 4 O emu14 5 O uart10_ctsn 8 I kbd_col1 9 O ehrpwm1_synco 10 O pr1_edc_sync0_out 11 O pr1_pru1_gpi1 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo1 13 O gpio4_5 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d5 0 I 4 O emu15 5 O uart10_rtsn 8 O kbd_col2 9 O eQEP2A_in 10 I pr1_edio_sof 11 O pr1_pru1_gpi2 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo2 13 O gpio4_6 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout2_d18 60 TYPE [6] 4 vout2_d19 F4 MUXMODE [5] 0 vout2_d20 D2 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) C1 BALL NAME [2] vin2a_d6 SIGNAL NAME [3] vin2a_d6 vin2a_d7 vin2a_d8 TYPE [6] I 4 O emu16 5 O mii1_rxd1 8 I kbd_col3 9 O eQEP2B_in 10 I pr1_mii_mt1_clk 11 I pr1_pru1_gpi3 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo3 13 O gpio4_7 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d7 0 I 4 O emu17 5 O mii1_rxd2 8 I kbd_col4 9 O eQEP2_index 10 IO pr1_mii1_txen 11 O pr1_pru1_gpi4 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo4 13 O gpio4_8 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d8 0 I 4 O emu18 5 O mii1_rxd3 8 I kbd_col5 9 O eQEP2_strobe 10 IO pr1_mii1_txd3 11 O pr1_pru1_gpi5 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo5 13 O gpio4_9 gpmc_a26 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout2_d16 F5 MUXMODE [5] 0 vout2_d17 E4 18 / 16 [4] vout2_d15 Yes / No Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 61 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] E6 BALL NAME [2] vin2a_d9 SIGNAL NAME [3] vin2a_d9 ADVANCE INFORMATION vin2a_d10 vin2a_d11 I O emu19 5 O mii1_rxd0 8 I kbd_col6 9 O ehrpwm2A 10 O pr1_mii1_txd2 11 O pr1_pru1_gpi6 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo6 13 O gpio4_10 gpmc_a25 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d10 0 I mdio_mclk 3 O Yes / No 4 O kbd_col7 9 O ehrpwm2B 10 O pr1_mdio_mdclk 11 O pr1_pru1_gpi7 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo7 13 O gpio4_11 gpmc_a24 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d11 0 I mdio_d 3 IO vout2_d12 62 TYPE [6] 4 vout2_d13 F6 MUXMODE [5] 0 vout2_d14 D3 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No 4 O kbd_row7 Yes / No 9 I ehrpwm2_tripzone_input 10 IO pr1_mdio_data 11 IO pr1_pru1_gpi8 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo8 13 O gpio4_12 gpmc_a23 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) D5 BALL NAME [2] vin2a_d12 SIGNAL NAME [3] vin2a_d13 vin2a_d14 TYPE [6] 0 I rgmii1_txc 3 O 4 O mii1_rxclk 8 I kbd_col8 9 O eCAP2_in_PWM2_out 10 IO pr1_mii1_txd1 11 O pr1_pru1_gpi9 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo9 13 O gpio4_13 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d13 0 I rgmii1_txctl 3 O vout2_d10 C3 MUXMODE [5] vin2a_d12 vout2_d11 C2 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No 4 O mii1_rxdv 8 I kbd_row8 9 I eQEP3A_in 10 I pr1_mii1_txd0 11 O pr1_pru1_gpi10 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo10 13 O gpio4_14 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d14 0 I rgmii1_txd3 3 O vout2_d9 Yes / No 4 O mii1_txclk Yes / No 8 I eQEP3B_in 10 I pr1_mii_mr1_clk 11 I pr1_pru1_gpi11 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo11 13 O gpio4_15 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 63 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] C4 BALL NAME [2] vin2a_d15 SIGNAL NAME [3] ADVANCE INFORMATION vin2a_d16 0 I 3 O 4 O mii1_txd0 8 O eQEP3_index 10 IO pr1_mii1_rxdv 11 I pr1_pru1_gpi12 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo12 13 O gpio4_16 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d16 0 I vin2b_d7 2 I 3 O 4 O mii1_txd1 8 O eQEP3_strobe 10 IO pr1_mii1_rxd3 11 I pr1_pru1_gpi13 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo13 13 O gpio4_24 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d17 0 I vin2b_d6 2 I 3 O 4 O mii1_txd2 8 O ehrpwm3A 10 O pr1_mii1_rxd2 11 I pr1_pru1_gpi14 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo14 13 O gpio4_25 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout2_d7 vin2a_d17 Yes / No Yes / No rgmii1_txd0 vout2_d6 64 TYPE [6] rgmii1_txd2 rgmii1_txd1 D6 MUXMODE [5] vin2a_d15 vout2_d8 B2 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) C5 BALL NAME [2] vin2a_d18 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] 0 I vin2b_d5 2 I 3 I 4 O mii1_txd3 8 O ehrpwm3B 10 O pr1_mii1_rxd1 11 I pr1_pru1_gpi15 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo15 13 O gpio4_26 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d19 0 I vin2b_d4 2 I 3 I 4 O mii1_txer 8 O ehrpwm3_tripzone_input 10 IO pr1_mii1_rxd0 11 I pr1_pru1_gpi16 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo16 13 O gpio4_27 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d20 0 I vin2b_d3 2 I 3 I 4 O mii1_rxer 8 I eCAP3_in_PWM3_out 10 IO pr1_mii1_rxer 11 I pr1_pru1_gpi17 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo17 13 O gpio4_28 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout2_d5 vin2a_d19 Yes / No rgmii1_rxctl vout2_d4 B3 vin2a_d20 TYPE [6] vin2a_d18 rgmii1_rxc A3 MUXMODE [5] Yes / No rgmii1_rxd3 vout2_d3 Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 65 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] B4 BALL NAME [2] vin2a_d21 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] 0 I vin2b_d2 2 I 3 I 4 O mii1_col 8 I pr1_mii1_rxlink 11 I pr1_pru1_gpi18 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo18 13 O gpio4_29 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d22 0 I vin2b_d1 2 I 3 I 4 O mii1_crs 8 I pr1_mii1_col 11 I pr1_pru1_gpi19 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo19 13 O gpio4_30 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_d23 0 I vin2b_d0 2 I 3 I 4 O mii1_txen 8 O pr1_mii1_crs 11 I pr1_pru1_gpi20 12 I pr1_pru1_gpo20 13 O gpio4_31 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout2_d2 ADVANCE INFORMATION vin2a_d22 Yes / No rgmii1_rxd1 vout2_d1 A4 vin2a_d23 Yes / No rgmii1_rxd0 vout2_d0 66 TYPE [6] vin2a_d21 rgmii1_rxd2 B5 MUXMODE [5] Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) G2 BALL NAME [2] vin2a_de0 SIGNAL NAME [3] vin2a_fld0 vin2a_hsync0 TYPE [6] 0 I vin2a_fld0 1 I vin2b_fld1 2 I vin2b_de1 3 I 4 O emu6 5 O kbd_row1 9 I eQEP1B_in 10 I pr1_edio_data_in1 12 I pr1_edio_data_out1 13 O gpio3_29 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_fld0 0 I vin2b_clk1 2 I vout2_clk G1 MUXMODE [5] vin2a_de0 vout2_de H7 18 / 16 [4] Yes / No 4 O emu7 5 O eQEP1_index 10 IO pr1_edio_data_in2 12 I pr1_edio_data_out2 13 O gpio3_30 gpmc_a27 gpmc_a18 14 IO Driver off 15 I vin2a_hsync0 0 I vin2b_hsync1 3 I vout2_hsync Yes / No 4 O emu8 Yes / No 5 O uart9_rxd 7 I spi4_sclk 8 IO kbd_row2 9 I eQEP1_strobe 10 IO pr1_uart0_cts_n 11 I pr1_edio_data_in3 12 I pr1_edio_data_out3 13 O gpio3_31 gpmc_a27 14 IO Driver off 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 67 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] G6 BALL NAME [2] vin2a_vsync0 SIGNAL NAME [3] ADVANCE INFORMATION F11 68 vout1_clk vout1_d0 MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] vin2a_vsync0 0 I vin2b_vsync1 3 I vout2_vsync D11 18 / 16 [4] 4 O emu9 5 O uart9_txd 7 O spi4_d1 8 IO kbd_row3 9 I ehrpwm1A 10 O pr1_uart0_rts_n 11 O pr1_edio_data_in4 12 I pr1_edio_data_out4 13 O gpio4_0 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O vin2a_fld0 vin1a_fld0 3 I vin1a_fld0 4 I spi3_cs0 8 IO gpio4_19 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O uart5_rxd 2 I vin2a_d16 vin1a_d16 3 I vin1a_d16 4 I spi3_cs2 8 IO pr1_uart0_cts_n 10 I pr2_pru1_gpi18 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo18 13 O gpio8_0 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_clk vout1_d0 Yes / No Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv1 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) G10 F10 G11 BALL NAME [2] vout1_d1 vout1_d2 vout1_d3 SIGNAL NAME [3] vout1_d1 18 / 16 [4] TYPE [6] 0 O uart5_txd 2 O vin2a_d17 vin1a_d17 3 I vin1a_d17 4 I pr1_uart0_rts_n 10 O pr2_pru1_gpi19 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo19 13 O gpio8_1 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O emu2 2 O vin2a_d18 vin1a_d18 3 I vin1a_d18 4 I obs0 5 O obs16 6 O obs_irq1 7 O pr1_uart0_rxd 10 I pr2_pru1_gpi20 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo20 13 O gpio8_2 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O emu5 2 O vin2a_d19 vin1a_d19 3 I vin1a_d19 4 I obs1 5 O obs17 6 O obs_dmarq1 7 O pr1_uart0_txd 10 O pr2_pru0_gpi0 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo0 13 O gpio8_3 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d2 vout1_d3 Yes / No MUXMODE [5] Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 69 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] E9 ADVANCE INFORMATION F9 F8 70 BALL NAME [2] vout1_d4 vout1_d5 vout1_d6 SIGNAL NAME [3] vout1_d4 18 / 16 [4] TYPE [6] 0 O emu6 2 O vin2a_d20 vin1a_d20 3 I vin1a_d20 4 I obs2 5 O obs18 6 O pr1_ecap0_ecap_capin_apwm_o 10 IO pr2_pru0_gpi1 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo1 13 O gpio8_4 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O emu7 2 O vin2a_d21 vin1a_d21 3 I vin1a_d21 4 I obs3 5 O obs19 6 O pr2_edc_latch0_in 10 I pr2_pru0_gpi2 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo2 13 O gpio8_5 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O emu8 2 O vin2a_d22 vin1a_d22 3 I vin1a_d22 4 I obs4 5 O obs20 6 O pr2_edc_latch1_in 10 I pr2_pru0_gpi3 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo3 13 O gpio8_6 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d5 vout1_d6 Yes / No MUXMODE [5] Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) E7 E8 D9 BALL NAME [2] vout1_d7 vout1_d8 vout1_d9 SIGNAL NAME [3] vout1_d7 18 / 16 [4] TYPE [6] 0 O emu9 2 O vin2a_d23 vin1a_d23 3 I vin1a_d23 4 I pr2_edc_sync0_out 10 O pr2_pru0_gpi4 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo4 13 O gpio8_7 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O uart6_rxd 2 I vin2a_d8 vin1a_d8 3 I vin1a_d8 4 I pr2_edc_sync1_out 10 O pr2_pru0_gpi5 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo5 13 O gpio8_8 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O uart6_txd 2 O vin2a_d9 vin1a_d9 3 I vin1a_d9 4 I pr2_edio_latch_in 10 I pr2_pru0_gpi6 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo6 13 O gpio8_9 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d8 vout1_d9 Yes / No MUXMODE [5] Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 71 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] D7 ADVANCE INFORMATION D8 A5 72 BALL NAME [2] vout1_d10 vout1_d11 vout1_d12 SIGNAL NAME [3] vout1_d10 18 / 16 [4] TYPE [6] 0 O emu3 2 O vin2a_d10 vin1a_d10 3 I vin1a_d10 4 I obs5 5 O obs21 6 O obs_irq2 7 O pr2_edio_sof 10 O pr2_pru0_gpi7 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo7 13 O gpio8_10 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O emu10 2 O vin2a_d11 vin1a_d11 3 I vin1a_d11 4 I obs6 5 O obs22 6 O obs_dmarq2 7 O pr2_uart0_cts_n 10 I pr2_pru0_gpi8 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo8 13 O gpio8_11 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O emu11 2 O vin2a_d12 vin1a_d12 3 I vin1a_d12 4 I obs7 5 O obs23 6 O pr2_uart0_rts_n 10 O pr2_pru0_gpi9 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo9 13 O gpio8_12 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d11 vout1_d12 Yes / No MUXMODE [5] Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) C6 C8 C7 BALL NAME [2] vout1_d13 vout1_d14 vout1_d15 SIGNAL NAME [3] vout1_d13 18 / 16 [4] TYPE [6] 0 O emu12 2 O vin2a_d13 vin1a_d13 3 I vin1a_d13 4 I obs8 5 O obs24 6 O pr2_uart0_rxd 10 I pr2_pru0_gpi10 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo10 13 O gpio8_13 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O emu13 2 O vin2a_d14 vin1a_d14 3 I vin1a_d14 4 I obs9 5 O obs25 6 O pr2_uart0_txd 10 O pr2_pru0_gpi11 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo11 13 O gpio8_14 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O emu14 2 O vin2a_d15 vin1a_d15 3 I vin1a_d15 4 I obs10 5 O obs26 6 O pr2_ecap0_ecap_capin_apwm_o 10 IO pr2_pru0_gpi12 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo12 13 O gpio8_15 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d14 vout1_d15 Yes / No MUXMODE [5] Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 73 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] B7 ADVANCE INFORMATION B8 A7 74 BALL NAME [2] vout1_d16 vout1_d17 vout1_d18 SIGNAL NAME [3] vout1_d16 18 / 16 [4] TYPE [6] 0 O uart7_rxd 2 I vin2a_d0 vin1a_d0 3 I vin1a_d0 4 I pr2_edio_data_in0 10 I pr2_edio_data_out0 11 O pr2_pru0_gpi13 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo13 13 O gpio8_16 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O uart7_txd 2 O vin2a_d1 vin1a_d1 3 I vin1a_d1 4 I pr2_edio_data_in1 10 I pr2_edio_data_out1 11 O pr2_pru0_gpi14 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo14 13 O gpio8_17 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O emu4 2 O vin2a_d2 vin1a_d2 3 I vin1a_d2 4 I obs11 5 O obs27 6 O pr2_edio_data_in2 10 I pr2_edio_data_out2 11 O pr2_pru0_gpi15 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo15 13 O gpio8_18 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d17 vout1_d18 Yes / No MUXMODE [5] Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) A8 C9 A9 BALL NAME [2] vout1_d19 vout1_d20 vout1_d21 SIGNAL NAME [3] vout1_d19 18 / 16 [4] TYPE [6] 0 O emu15 2 O vin2a_d3 vin1a_d3 3 I vin1a_d3 4 I obs12 5 O obs28 6 O pr2_edio_data_in3 10 I pr2_edio_data_out3 11 O pr2_pru0_gpi16 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo16 13 O gpio8_19 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O emu16 2 O vin2a_d4 vin1a_d4 3 I vin1a_d4 4 I obs13 5 O obs29 6 O pr2_edio_data_in4 10 I pr2_edio_data_out4 11 O pr2_pru0_gpi17 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo17 13 O gpio8_20 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O emu17 2 O vin2a_d5 vin1a_d5 3 I vin1a_d5 4 I obs14 5 O obs30 6 O pr2_edio_data_in5 10 I pr2_edio_data_out5 11 O pr2_pru0_gpi18 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo18 13 O gpio8_21 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d20 vout1_d21 Yes / No MUXMODE [5] Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 75 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] B9 ADVANCE INFORMATION A10 B10 B11 76 BALL NAME [2] vout1_d22 vout1_d23 vout1_de vout1_fld SIGNAL NAME [3] vout1_d22 18 / 16 [4] TYPE [6] 0 O emu18 2 O vin2a_d6 vin1a_d6 3 I vin1a_d6 4 I obs15 5 O obs31 6 O pr2_edio_data_in6 10 I pr2_edio_data_out6 11 O pr2_pru0_gpi19 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo19 13 O gpio8_22 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O emu19 2 O vin2a_d7 vin2a_d7 3 I vin1a_d7 4 I spi3_cs3 8 IO pr2_edio_data_in7 10 I pr2_edio_data_out7 11 O pr2_pru0_gpi20 12 I pr2_pru0_gpo20 13 O gpio8_23 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O vin2a_de0 vin1a_de0 3 I vin1a_de0 4 I spi3_d1 8 IO gpio4_20 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O vin2a_clk0 vin1a_clk0 3 I vin1a_clk0 4 I spi3_cs1 8 IO gpio4_21 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_d23 vout1_de vout1_fld Yes / No MUXMODE [5] Yes / No Yes / No Yes / No BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) C11 E11 BALL NAME [2] vout1_hsync vout1_vsync SIGNAL NAME [3] vout1_hsync 18 / 16 [4] TYPE [6] 0 O vin2a_hsync0 vin1a_hsync0 3 I vin1a_hsync0 4 I spi3_d0 8 IO gpio4_22 14 IO Driver off 15 I 0 O vin2a_vsync0 vin1a_vsync0 3 I vin1a_vsync0 4 I spi3_sclk 8 IO pr2_pru1_gpi17 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo17 13 O gpio4_23 14 IO Driver off 15 I vout1_vsync Yes / No MUXMODE [5] Yes / No A1, A14, A2, A23, vss A28, A6, AA14, AA15, AA20, AA8, AA9, AB14, AB20, AD1, AD24, AG1, AH1, AH2, AH20, AH28, B1, D13, D19, E13, E19, F1, F7, G7, G8, G9, H12, J12, J15, J28, K1, K15, K24, K25, K4, K5, L13, L14, M19, N14, N15, N19, N24, N25, P28, R1, R12, R13, R21, T10, T11, T12, T14, T15, T17, T18, T21, U14, U15, U17, U20, U21, V15, V17, W1, W15, W24, W25, W28 vss Yes / Yes GND AA10, AH8 vssa_csi vssa_csi Yes / Yes GND AD19, AE19 vssa_hdmi vssa_hdmi Yes / Yes GND AF15 vssa_osc0 vssa_osc0 Yes / Yes GND AC14 vssa_osc1 vssa_osc1 Yes / Yes GND AD13, AE13 vssa_pcie vssa_pcie Yes / Yes GND AE10 vssa_sata vssa_sata Yes / Yes GND AA11, AB11 vssa_usb vssa_usb Yes / Yes GND AD10 vssa_usb3 vssa_usb3 Yes / Yes GND BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv2 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 77 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) BALL NUMBER [1] BALL NAME [2] SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] R15 vssa_video vssa_video AD17 Wakeup0 Wakeup0 0 I dcan1_rx 1 I gpio1_0 sys_nirq2 14 I Driver off 15 I Wakeup3 0 I sys_nirq1 1 I gpio1_3 dcan2_rx 14 I AC16 Wakeup3 Yes / Yes TYPE [6] ADVANCE INFORMATION Driver off BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] GND 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes IHHV1833 PU/PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv5 Yes IHHV1833 PU/PD 15 I AE15 xi_osc0 xi_osc0 Yes / Yes 0 I 1.8 vdda_osc No LVCMOS Analog NA AC15 xi_osc1 xi_osc1 Yes / Yes 0 I 1.8 vdda_osc No LVCMOS Analog NA AD15 xo_osc0 xo_osc0 Yes / Yes 0 O 1.8 vdda_osc No LVCMOS Analog NA AC13 xo_osc1 xo_osc1 Yes / Yes 0 A 1.8 vdda_osc No LVCMOS Analog NA D18 xref_clk0 xref_clk0 Yes / Yes 0 I 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes mcasp2_axr8 Yes / Yes 1 IO Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS mcasp1_axr4 Yes / Yes 2 IO mcasp1_ahclkx Yes / Yes 3 O mcasp5_ahclkx Yes / Yes 4 O vin1a_d0 Yes / Yes 7 I hdq0 Yes / Yes 8 IO clkout2 Yes / Yes 9 O timer13 Yes / Yes 10 IO pr2_mii1_col Yes / Yes 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi5 Yes / Yes 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo5 Yes / Yes 13 O gpio6_17 Yes / Yes 14 IO Driver off Yes / Yes 15 I 78 PD Terminal Configuration and Functions PD 15 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-2. Ball Characteristics(1) (continued) E17 B26 C23 BALL NAME [2] xref_clk1 xref_clk2 xref_clk3 SIGNAL NAME [3] 18 / 16 [4] MUXMODE [5] TYPE [6] xref_clk1 Yes / Yes 0 I mcasp2_axr9 Yes / Yes 1 IO mcasp1_axr5 Yes / Yes 2 IO mcasp2_ahclkx Yes / Yes 3 O mcasp6_ahclkx Yes / Yes 4 O vin1a_clk0 Yes / Yes 7 I timer14 Yes / Yes 10 IO pr2_mii1_crs Yes / Yes 11 I pr2_pru1_gpi6 Yes / Yes 12 I pr2_pru1_gpo6 Yes / Yes 13 O gpio6_18 Yes / Yes 14 IO Driver off Yes / Yes 15 I xref_clk2 Yes / Yes 0 I mcasp2_axr10 Yes / Yes 1 IO mcasp1_axr6 Yes / Yes 2 IO mcasp3_ahclkx Yes / Yes 3 O mcasp7_ahclkx Yes / Yes 4 O vout2_clk Yes / No 6 O vin2a_clk0 vin1a_clk0 Yes / Yes 8 I timer15 Yes / Yes 10 IO gpio6_19 Yes / Yes 14 IO Driver off Yes / Yes 15 I xref_clk3 Yes / Yes 0 I mcasp2_axr11 Yes / Yes 1 IO mcasp1_axr7 Yes / Yes 2 IO mcasp4_ahclkx Yes / Yes 3 O mcasp8_ahclkx Yes / Yes 4 O vout2_de Yes / No 6 O hdq0 Yes / Yes 7 IO vin2a_de0 vin1a_de0 Yes / Yes 8 I clkout3 Yes / Yes 9 O timer16 Yes / Yes 10 IO gpio6_20 Yes / Yes 14 IO Driver off Yes / Yes 15 I BALL RESET STATE [7] BALL BALL I/O RESET REL. RESET REL. VOLTAGE POWER [11] MUXMODE STATE [8] VALUE [10] [9] HYS [12] BUFFER TYPE [13] PULL UP/DOWN TYPE [14] PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS PD PD 15 1.8/3.3 vddshv3 Yes Dual Voltage PU/PD LVCMOS Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL NUMBER [1] 79 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) NA in this table stands for Not Applicable. (2) For more information on recommended operating conditions, see Table 5-4, Recommended Operating Conditions. (3) The pullup or pulldown block strength is equal to: minimum = 50 μA, typical = 100 μA, maximum = 250 μA. (4) The output impedance settings of this IO cell are programmable; by default, the value is DS[1:0] = 10, this means 40 Ω. For more information on DS[1:0] register configuration, see the Device TRM. (5) IO drive strength for usb1_dp, usb1_dm, usb2_dp and usb2_dm: minimum 18.3 mA, maximum 89 mA (for a power supply vdda33v_usb1 and vdda33v_usb2 = 3.46 V). (6) Minimum PU = 900 Ω, maximum PU = 3.090 kΩ and minimum PD = 14.25 kΩ, maximum PD = 24.8 kΩ. For more information, see chapter 7 of the USB2.0 specification, in particular section Signaling / Device Speed Identification. (7) This function will not be supported on some pin-compatible roadmap devices. Pin compatibility can be maintained in the future by not using these GPIO signals. (8) In PUx / PDy, x and y = 60 to 200 μA. The output impedance settings (or drive strengths) of this IO are programmable (34 Ω, 40 Ω, 48 Ω, 60 Ω, 80 Ω) depending on the values of the I[2:0] registers. ADVANCE INFORMATION 4.3 Multiplexing Characteristics Table 4-3 describes the device multiplexing (no characteristics are available in this table). NOTE This table doesn't take into account subsystem multiplexing signals. Subsystem multiplexing signals are described in Section 4.4, Signal Descriptions. NOTE For more information, see the Control Module / Control Module Functional Description / PAD Functional Multiplexing and Configuration section of the Device TRM. NOTE Configuring two pins to the same input signal is not supported as it can yield unexpected results. This can be easily prevented with the proper software configuration (Hi-Z mode is not an input signal). NOTE When a pad is set into a multiplexing mode which is not defined by pin multiplexing, that pad’s behavior is undefined. This should be avoided. 80 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 NOTE In some cases Table 4-3 may present more than one signal per muxmode for the same ball. First signal in the list is the dominant function as selected via CTRL_CORE_PAD_* register. All other signals are virtual functions that present alternate multiplexing options. This virtual functions are controlled via CTRL_CORE_ALT_SELECT_MUX or CTRL_CORE_VIP_MUX_SELECT register. For more information on how to use this options, please refer to Device TRM, Chapter Control Module, Section Pad Configuration Registers. NOTE ADVANCE INFORMATION Dual rank support is not available on this device, but signal names are retained for consistency with the AM57xx family of devices. CAUTION The I/O timings provided in Section 7, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are valid only if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in the corresponding tables. Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 Y23 ddr1_d26 Y19 ddr1_d21 AE15 xi_osc0 AH24 ddr1_nck AG15 ljcb_clkp AF24 ddr1_d4 V25 ddr1_ecc_d 6 AB16 ddr1_csn1 AG19 hdmi1_data 2x AF21 ddr1_a4 AG5 csi2_1_dx0 W23 ddr1_ecc_d 3 Y27 ddr1_dqsn3 AC24 ddr1_d14 AF28 ddr1_d11 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* 9 10 11 12 13 14* Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 15 81 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME ADVANCE INFORMATION 82 BALL NUMBER MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 AA23 ddr1_d24 AD18 ddr1_a15 AH16 hdmi1_cloc ky AH5 csi2_1_dy0 AC20 ddr1_a2 AA24 ddr1_d27 W19 ddr1_ecc_d 2 AG21 ddr1_rst AE28 ddr1_dqsn1 AC11 usb_txn0 AG25 ddr1_dqsn0 AC17 ddr1_odt1 AG4 csi2_0_dy3 W20 ddr1_d17 AF14 rtc_iso AA27 ddr1_dqm3 AF25 ddr1_d0 AF2 csi2_0_dx2 AF23 ddr1_d6 AG18 hdmi1_data 1x AH6 csi2_1_dy1 AG10 sata1_txn0 AF20 ddr1_rasn V26 ddr1_dqm_ ecc V20 ddr1_d16 AH13 pcie_rxp0 AC18 ddr1_casn AG9 sata1_rxp0 AH23 ddr1_csn0 AE11 usb2_dp Y24 ddr1_d28 AH15 ljcb_clkn AD20 ddr1_a0 AA25 ddr1_d30 AA1 mlbp_dat_p AD14 rtc_osc_xo 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* 9 10 11 12 13 14* 15 pcie_txn1 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 AC25 ddr1_d13 AB23 ddr1_dqm1 AE1 csi2_0_dx0 AH19 hdmi1_data 2y AB27 ddr1_d22 AG14 pcie_txn0 Y28 ddr1_dqs3 AB19 ddr1_a3 AH10 sata1_txp0 AG24 ddr1_ck AE24 ddr1_d5 AC15 xi_osc1 AC21 ddr1_a12 AB1 mlbp_clk_p AF12 usb_rxn0 AH9 sata1_rxn0 AC26 ddr1_dqm2 AA28 ddr1_d31 AD23 ddr1_dqm0 AE27 ddr1_dqs1 AF27 ddr1_d9 V24 ddr1_ecc_d 5 AG27 ddr1_d10 AF22 ddr1_a8 AA2 mlbp_dat_n AH21 ddr1_wen AE21 ddr1_a7 AC12 usb1_dm Y20 ddr1_d23 AC27 ddr1_d20 AE23 ddr1_d7 AG22 ddr1_cke AD27 ddr1_dqs2 AH14 pcie_txp0 AH26 ddr1_d3 AD21 ddr1_a10 Y25 ddr1_ecc_d 4 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* 9 10 11 12 13 14* 15 ADVANCE INFORMATION ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER pcie_rxn1 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 83 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME ADVANCE INFORMATION 84 BALL NUMBER MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 AE17 ddr1_a14 AG7 csi2_1_dy2 AH18 hdmi1_data 1y AH22 ddr1_a5 W22 ddr1_ecc_d 0 V23 ddr1_ecc_d 1 AE12 usb_rxp0 AE14 rtc_osc_xi_ clkin32 AF3 csi2_0_dy2 AB2 mlbp_clk_n AG23 ddr1_a6 AG6 csi2_1_dx1 AB18 ddr1_ba2 AG17 hdmi1_data 0x AF26 ddr1_d1 AD11 usb_txp0 AC1 mlbp_sig_p V27 ddr1_dqs_e cc AF17 ddr1_ba0 AE26 ddr1_d12 AC19 ddr1_a1 AG13 pcie_rxn0 AB28 ddr1_d18 Y26 ddr1_ecc_d 7 AH3 csi2_0_dx4 AD22 ddr1_a11 AD28 ddr1_dqsn2 AD2 csi2_0_dy0 AE18 ddr1_ba1 AE20 ddr1_odt0 AF11 usb2_dm AD15 xo_osc0 AH7 csi2_1_dx2 AE22 ddr1_a9 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* 9 10 11 12 13 14* 15 pcie_rxp1 pcie_txp1 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 Y18 ddr1_vref0 AC13 xo_osc1 AC2 mlbp_sig_n AD12 usb1_dp Y22 ddr1_d25 AH17 hdmi1_data 0y AH4 csi2_0_dx3 AE2 csi2_0_dy1 AG26 ddr1_d2 AH25 ddr1_dqs0 AF18 ddr1_a13 AC28 ddr1_d19 AG3 csi2_0_dy4 V28 ddr1_dqsn_ ecc AC23 ddr1_d8 F22 porz AG16 hdmi1_cloc kx AF1 csi2_0_dx1 AA26 ddr1_d29 AD25 ddr1_d15 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* 9 10 11 12 13 14* 15 0x1400 CTRL_CORE_PAD M6 _GPMC_AD0 gpmc_ad0 vin1a_d0 vout3_d0 gpio1_6 sysboot0 0x1404 CTRL_CORE_PAD M2 _GPMC_AD1 gpmc_ad1 vin1a_d1 vout3_d1 gpio1_7 sysboot1 0x1408 CTRL_CORE_PAD L5 _GPMC_AD2 gpmc_ad2 vin1a_d2 vout3_d2 gpio1_8 sysboot2 0x140C CTRL_CORE_PAD M1 _GPMC_AD3 gpmc_ad3 vin1a_d3 vout3_d3 gpio1_9 sysboot3 0x1410 CTRL_CORE_PAD L6 _GPMC_AD4 gpmc_ad4 vin1a_d4 vout3_d4 gpio1_10 sysboot4 0x1414 CTRL_CORE_PAD L4 _GPMC_AD5 gpmc_ad5 vin1a_d5 vout3_d5 gpio1_11 sysboot5 0x1418 CTRL_CORE_PAD L3 _GPMC_AD6 gpmc_ad6 vin1a_d6 vout3_d6 gpio1_12 sysboot6 0x141C CTRL_CORE_PAD L2 _GPMC_AD7 gpmc_ad7 vin1a_d7 vout3_d7 gpio1_13 sysboot7 0x1420 CTRL_CORE_PAD L1 _GPMC_AD8 gpmc_ad8 vin1a_d8 vout3_d8 gpio7_18 sysboot8 0x1424 CTRL_CORE_PAD K2 _GPMC_AD9 gpmc_ad9 vin1a_d9 vout3_d9 gpio7_19 sysboot9 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER 85 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* 9 10 11 12 13 14* 15 ADVANCE INFORMATION 0x1428 CTRL_CORE_PAD J1 _GPMC_AD10 gpmc_ad10 vin1a_d10 vout3_d10 gpio7_28 sysboot10 0x142C CTRL_CORE_PAD J2 _GPMC_AD11 gpmc_ad11 vin1a_d11 vout3_d11 gpio7_29 sysboot11 0x1430 CTRL_CORE_PAD H1 _GPMC_AD12 gpmc_ad12 vin1a_d12 vout3_d12 gpio1_18 sysboot12 0x1434 CTRL_CORE_PAD J3 _GPMC_AD13 gpmc_ad13 vin1a_d13 vout3_d13 gpio1_19 sysboot13 0x1438 CTRL_CORE_PAD H2 _GPMC_AD14 gpmc_ad14 vin1a_d14 vout3_d14 gpio1_20 sysboot14 0x143C CTRL_CORE_PAD H3 _GPMC_AD15 gpmc_ad15 vin1a_d15 vout3_d15 gpio1_21 sysboot15 0x1440 CTRL_CORE_PAD R6 _GPMC_A0 gpmc_a0 vin1a_d16 vout3_d16 vin2a_d0 vin1a_d0 vin1b_d0 i2c4_scl uart5_rxd gpio7_3 gpmc_a26 gpmc_a16 Driver off 0x1444 CTRL_CORE_PAD T9 _GPMC_A1 gpmc_a1 vin1a_d17 vout3_d17 vin2a_d1 vin1a_d1 vin1b_d1 i2c4_sda uart5_txd gpio7_4 Driver off 0x1448 CTRL_CORE_PAD T6 _GPMC_A2 gpmc_a2 vin1a_d18 vout3_d18 vin2a_d2 vin1a_d2 vin1b_d2 uart7_rxd uart5_ctsn gpio7_5 Driver off 0x144C CTRL_CORE_PAD T7 _GPMC_A3 gpmc_a3 qspi1_cs2 vin1a_d19 vout3_d19 vin2a_d3 vin1a_d3 vin1b_d3 uart7_txd uart5_rtsn gpio7_6 Driver off 0x1450 CTRL_CORE_PAD P6 _GPMC_A4 gpmc_a4 qspi1_cs3 vin1a_d20 vout3_d20 vin2a_d4 vin1a_d4 vin1b_d4 i2c5_scl uart6_rxd gpio1_26 Driver off 0x1454 CTRL_CORE_PAD R9 _GPMC_A5 gpmc_a5 vin1a_d21 vout3_d21 vin2a_d5 vin1a_d5 vin1b_d5 i2c5_sda uart6_txd gpio1_27 Driver off 0x1458 CTRL_CORE_PAD R5 _GPMC_A6 gpmc_a6 vin1a_d22 vout3_d22 vin2a_d6 vin1a_d6 vin1b_d6 uart8_rxd uart6_ctsn gpio1_28 Driver off 0x145C CTRL_CORE_PAD P5 _GPMC_A7 gpmc_a7 vin1a_d23 vout3_d23 vin2a_d7 vin1a_d7 vin1b_d7 uart8_txd uart6_rtsn gpio1_29 Driver off 0x1460 CTRL_CORE_PAD N7 _GPMC_A8 gpmc_a8 vin1a_hsyn vout3_hsyn c0 c vin1b_hsyn timer12 c1 spi4_sclk gpio1_30 Driver off 0x1464 CTRL_CORE_PAD R4 _GPMC_A9 gpmc_a9 vin1a_vsyn vout3_vsyn c0 c vin1b_vsyn timer11 c1 spi4_d1 gpio1_31 Driver off 0x1468 CTRL_CORE_PAD N9 _GPMC_A10 gpmc_a10 vin1a_de0 vout3_de vin1b_clk1 timer10 spi4_d0 gpio2_0 Driver off 0x146C CTRL_CORE_PAD P9 _GPMC_A11 gpmc_a11 vin1a_fld0 vout3_fld vin1b_de1 timer9 spi4_cs0 gpio2_1 Driver off 0x1470 CTRL_CORE_PAD P4 _GPMC_A12 gpmc_a12 vin1b_fld1 timer8 spi4_cs1 dma_evt1 gpio2_2 Driver off 0x1474 CTRL_CORE_PAD R3 _GPMC_A13 gpmc_a13 qspi1_rtclk vin2a_hsyn c0 vin1a_hsyn c0 timer7 spi4_cs2 dma_evt2 gpio2_3 Driver off 0x1478 CTRL_CORE_PAD T2 _GPMC_A14 gpmc_a14 qspi1_d3 vin2a_vsyn c0 vin1a_vsyn c0 timer6 spi4_cs3 gpio2_4 Driver off 0x147C CTRL_CORE_PAD U2 _GPMC_A15 gpmc_a15 qspi1_d2 vin2a_d8 vin1a_d8 timer5 gpio2_5 Driver off 86 vin2a_fld0 vin1a_fld0 vin2a_clk0 vin1a_clk0 gpmc_a0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* 9 10 11 12 13 14* 15 0x1480 CTRL_CORE_PAD U1 _GPMC_A16 gpmc_a16 qspi1_d0 vin2a_d9 vin1a_d9 gpio2_6 Driver off 0x1484 CTRL_CORE_PAD P3 _GPMC_A17 gpmc_a17 qspi1_d1 vin2a_d10 vin1a_d10 gpio2_7 Driver off 0x1488 CTRL_CORE_PAD R2 _GPMC_A18 gpmc_a18 qspi1_sclk vin2a_d11 vin1a_d11 gpio2_8 Driver off 0x148C CTRL_CORE_PAD K7 _GPMC_A19 gpmc_a19 mmc2_dat4 gpmc_a13 vin2a_d12 vin1a_d12 vin2b_d0 vin1b_d0 gpio2_9 Driver off 0x1490 CTRL_CORE_PAD M7 _GPMC_A20 gpmc_a20 mmc2_dat5 gpmc_a14 vin2a_d13 vin1a_d13 vin2b_d1 vin1b_d1 gpio2_10 Driver off 0x1494 CTRL_CORE_PAD J5 _GPMC_A21 gpmc_a21 mmc2_dat6 gpmc_a15 vin2a_d14 vin1a_d14 vin2b_d2 vin1b_d2 gpio2_11 Driver off 0x1498 CTRL_CORE_PAD K6 _GPMC_A22 gpmc_a22 mmc2_dat7 gpmc_a16 vin2a_d15 vin1a_d15 vin2b_d3 vin1b_d3 gpio2_12 Driver off 0x149C CTRL_CORE_PAD J7 _GPMC_A23 gpmc_a23 mmc2_clk vin2a_fld0 vin1a_fld0 vin2b_d4 vin1b_d4 gpio2_13 Driver off 0x14A0 CTRL_CORE_PAD J4 _GPMC_A24 gpmc_a24 mmc2_dat0 gpmc_a18 vin2a_d8 vin1a_d8 vin2b_d5 vin1b_d5 gpio2_14 Driver off 0x14A4 CTRL_CORE_PAD J6 _GPMC_A25 gpmc_a25 mmc2_dat1 gpmc_a19 vin2a_d9 vin1a_d9 vin2b_d6 vin1b_d6 gpio2_15 Driver off 0x14A8 CTRL_CORE_PAD H4 _GPMC_A26 gpmc_a26 mmc2_dat2 gpmc_a20 vin2a_d10 vin1a_d10 vin2b_d7 vin1b_d7 gpio2_16 Driver off 0x14AC CTRL_CORE_PAD H5 _GPMC_A27 gpmc_a27 mmc2_dat3 gpmc_a21 vin2a_d11 vin1a_d11 vin2b_hsyn c1 vin1b_hsyn c1 gpio2_17 Driver off 0x14B0 CTRL_CORE_PAD H6 _GPMC_CS1 gpmc_cs1 mmc2_cmd gpmc_a22 vin2a_de0 vin1a_de0 vin2b_vsyn c1 vin1b_vsyn c1 gpio2_18 Driver off 0x14B4 CTRL_CORE_PAD T1 _GPMC_CS0 gpmc_cs0 gpio2_19 Driver off 0x14B8 CTRL_CORE_PAD P2 _GPMC_CS2 gpmc_cs2 qspi1_cs0 gpio2_20 gpmc_a23 gpmc_a13 Driver off 0x14BC CTRL_CORE_PAD P1 _GPMC_CS3 gpmc_cs3 qspi1_cs1 vin1a_clk0 vout3_clk gpio2_21 gpmc_a24 gpmc_a14 Driver off 0x14C0 CTRL_CORE_PAD P7 _GPMC_CLK gpmc_clk gpmc_cs7 clkout1 gpmc_wait1 vin2a_hsyn vin2a_de0 c0 vin1a_de0 vin1a_hsyn c0 vin2b_clk1 vin1b_clk1 timer4 i2c3_scl dma_evt1 gpio2_22 gpmc_a20 Driver off 0x14C4 CTRL_CORE_PAD N1 _GPMC_ADVN_AL E gpmc_advn gpmc_cs6 _ale clkout2 gpmc_wait1 vin2a_vsyn gpmc_a2 c0 vin1a_vsyn c0 gpmc_a23 timer3 i2c3_sda dma_evt2 gpio2_23 gpmc_a19 Driver off 0x14C8 CTRL_CORE_PAD M5 _GPMC_OEN_RE N gpmc_oen_ ren gpio2_24 Driver off gpmc_a17 gpmc_a1 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER 87 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* ADVANCE INFORMATION 0x14CC CTRL_CORE_PAD M3 _GPMC_WEN gpmc_wen 0x14D0 CTRL_CORE_PAD N6 _GPMC_BEN0 gpmc_ben0 gpmc_cs4 0x14D4 CTRL_CORE_PAD M4 _GPMC_BEN1 gpmc_ben1 gpmc_cs5 0x14D8 CTRL_CORE_PAD N2 _GPMC_WAIT0 gpmc_wait0 0x1554 CTRL_CORE_PAD E1 _VIN2A_CLK0 vin2a_clk0 0x1558 CTRL_CORE_PAD G2 _VIN2A_DE0 vin2a_de0 0x155C CTRL_CORE_PAD H7 _VIN2A_FLD0 vin2a_fld0 0x1560 CTRL_CORE_PAD G1 _VIN2A_HSYNC0 vin2a_hsyn c0 vin2b_hsyn vout2_hsyn emu8 c1 c uart9_rxd spi4_sclk 0x1564 CTRL_CORE_PAD G6 _VIN2A_VSYNC0 vin2a_vsyn c0 vin2b_vsyn vout2_vsyn emu9 c1 c uart9_txd 0x1568 CTRL_CORE_PAD F2 _VIN2A_D0 vin2a_d0 vout2_d23 emu10 0x156C CTRL_CORE_PAD F3 _VIN2A_D1 vin2a_d1 vout2_d22 emu11 0x1570 CTRL_CORE_PAD D1 _VIN2A_D2 vin2a_d2 vout2_d21 0x1574 CTRL_CORE_PAD E2 _VIN2A_D3 vin2a_d3 0x1578 CTRL_CORE_PAD D2 _VIN2A_D4 0x157C vin2b_clk1 vin1b_clk1 gpmc_a3 9 10 11 12 13 14* 15 gpio2_25 Driver off vin2b_de1 vin1b_de1 timer2 dma_evt3 gpio2_26 gpmc_a21 Driver off vin2b_fld1 vin1b_fld1 timer1 dma_evt4 gpio2_27 gpmc_a22 Driver off gpio2_28 gpmc_a25 gpmc_a15 Driver off vout2_fld emu5 kbd_row0 eQEP1A_in pr1_edio_d pr1_edio_d gpio3_28 ata_in0 ata_out0 gpmc_a27 gpmc_a17 Driver off vout2_de emu6 kbd_row1 eQEP1B_in pr1_edio_d pr1_edio_d gpio3_29 ata_in1 ata_out1 Driver off vout2_clk emu7 eQEP1_ind ex pr1_edio_d pr1_edio_d gpio3_30 ata_in2 ata_out2 gpmc_a27 gpmc_a18 Driver off kbd_row2 eQEP1_str pr1_uart0_c pr1_edio_d pr1_edio_d gpio3_31 obe ts_n ata_in3 ata_out3 gpmc_a27 Driver off spi4_d1 kbd_row3 ehrpwm1A pr1_uart0_r pr1_edio_d pr1_edio_d gpio4_0 ts_n ata_in4 ata_out4 Driver off uart9_ctsn spi4_d0 kbd_row4 ehrpwm1B pr1_uart0_r pr1_edio_d pr1_edio_d gpio4_1 xd ata_in5 ata_out5 Driver off uart9_rtsn spi4_cs0 kbd_row5 ehrpwm1_tr pr1_uart0_t pr1_edio_d pr1_edio_d gpio4_2 ipzone_inpu xd ata_in6 ata_out6 t Driver off emu12 uart10_rxd kbd_row6 eCAP1_in_ pr1_ecap0_ pr1_edio_d pr1_edio_d gpio4_3 PWM1_out ecap_capin ata_in7 ata_out7 _apwm_o Driver off vout2_d20 emu13 uart10_txd kbd_col0 ehrpwm1_s pr1_edc_lat pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_4 ynci ch0_in pi0 po0 Driver off vin2a_d4 vout2_d19 emu14 uart10_ctsn kbd_col1 ehrpwm1_s pr1_edc_sy pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_5 ynco nc0_out pi1 po1 Driver off CTRL_CORE_PAD F4 _VIN2A_D5 vin2a_d5 vout2_d18 emu15 uart10_rtsn kbd_col2 eQEP2A_in pr1_edio_s pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_6 of pi2 po2 Driver off 0x1580 CTRL_CORE_PAD C1 _VIN2A_D6 vin2a_d6 vout2_d17 emu16 mii1_rxd1 kbd_col3 eQEP2B_in pr1_mii_mt pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_7 1_clk pi3 po3 Driver off 0x1584 CTRL_CORE_PAD E4 _VIN2A_D7 vin2a_d7 vout2_d16 emu17 mii1_rxd2 kbd_col4 eQEP2_ind pr1_mii1_tx pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_8 ex en pi4 po4 Driver off 0x1588 CTRL_CORE_PAD F5 _VIN2A_D8 vin2a_d8 vout2_d15 emu18 mii1_rxd3 kbd_col5 eQEP2_str pr1_mii1_tx pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_9 obe d3 pi5 po5 gpmc_a26 Driver off 0x158C CTRL_CORE_PAD E6 _VIN2A_D9 vin2a_d9 vout2_d14 emu19 mii1_rxd0 kbd_col6 ehrpwm2A pr1_mii1_tx pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_10 d2 pi6 po6 gpmc_a25 Driver off 0x1590 CTRL_CORE_PAD D3 _VIN2A_D10 vin2a_d10 mdio_mclk vout2_d13 kbd_col7 ehrpwm2B pr1_mdio_ mdclk pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_11 pi7 po7 gpmc_a24 Driver off 0x1594 CTRL_CORE_PAD F6 _VIN2A_D11 vin2a_d11 mdio_d vout2_d12 kbd_row7 ehrpwm2_tr pr1_mdio_d pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_12 ipzone_inpu ata pi8 po8 gpmc_a23 t Driver off 88 vin2a_fld0 vin2b_fld1 vin2b_de1 vin2b_clk1 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* 9 10 11 12 13 14* 15 0x1598 CTRL_CORE_PAD D5 _VIN2A_D12 vin2a_d12 rgmii1_txc vout2_d11 mii1_rxclk kbd_col8 eCAP2_in_ pr1_mii1_tx pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_13 PWM2_out d1 pi9 po9 Driver off 0x159C CTRL_CORE_PAD C2 _VIN2A_D13 vin2a_d13 rgmii1_txctl vout2_d10 mii1_rxdv kbd_row8 eQEP3A_in pr1_mii1_tx pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_14 d0 pi10 po10 Driver off 0x15A0 CTRL_CORE_PAD C3 _VIN2A_D14 vin2a_d14 rgmii1_txd3 vout2_d9 mii1_txclk eQEP3B_in pr1_mii_mr pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_15 1_clk pi11 po11 Driver off 0x15A4 CTRL_CORE_PAD C4 _VIN2A_D15 vin2a_d15 rgmii1_txd2 vout2_d8 mii1_txd0 eQEP3_ind pr1_mii1_rx pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_16 ex dv pi12 po12 Driver off 0x15A8 CTRL_CORE_PAD B2 _VIN2A_D16 vin2a_d16 vin2b_d7 rgmii1_txd1 vout2_d7 mii1_txd1 eQEP3_str pr1_mii1_rx pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_24 obe d3 pi13 po13 Driver off 0x15AC CTRL_CORE_PAD D6 _VIN2A_D17 vin2a_d17 vin2b_d6 rgmii1_txd0 vout2_d6 mii1_txd2 ehrpwm3A pr1_mii1_rx pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_25 d2 pi14 po14 Driver off 0x15B0 CTRL_CORE_PAD C5 _VIN2A_D18 vin2a_d18 vin2b_d5 rgmii1_rxc vout2_d5 mii1_txd3 ehrpwm3B pr1_mii1_rx pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_26 d1 pi15 po15 Driver off 0x15B4 CTRL_CORE_PAD A3 _VIN2A_D19 vin2a_d19 vin2b_d4 rgmii1_rxctl vout2_d4 mii1_txer ehrpwm3_tr pr1_mii1_rx pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_27 ipzone_inpu d0 pi16 po16 t Driver off 0x15B8 CTRL_CORE_PAD B3 _VIN2A_D20 vin2a_d20 vin2b_d3 rgmii1_rxd3 vout2_d3 mii1_rxer eCAP3_in_ pr1_mii1_rx pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_28 PWM3_out er pi17 po17 Driver off 0x15BC CTRL_CORE_PAD B4 _VIN2A_D21 vin2a_d21 vin2b_d2 rgmii1_rxd2 vout2_d2 mii1_col pr1_mii1_rx pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_29 link pi18 po18 Driver off 0x15C0 CTRL_CORE_PAD B5 _VIN2A_D22 vin2a_d22 vin2b_d1 rgmii1_rxd1 vout2_d1 mii1_crs pr1_mii1_c pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_30 ol pi19 po19 Driver off 0x15C4 CTRL_CORE_PAD A4 _VIN2A_D23 vin2a_d23 vin2b_d0 rgmii1_rxd0 vout2_d0 mii1_txen pr1_mii1_cr pr1_pru1_g pr1_pru1_g gpio4_31 s pi20 po20 Driver off 0x15C8 CTRL_CORE_PAD D11 _VOUT1_CLK vout1_clk vin2a_fld0 vin1a_fld0 vin1a_fld0 spi3_cs0 gpio4_19 Driver off 0x15CC CTRL_CORE_PAD B10 _VOUT1_DE vout1_de vin2a_de0 vin1a_de0 vin1a_de0 spi3_d1 gpio4_20 Driver off 0x15D0 CTRL_CORE_PAD B11 _VOUT1_FLD vout1_fld vin2a_clk0 vin1a_clk0 vin1a_clk0 spi3_cs1 gpio4_21 Driver off 0x15D4 CTRL_CORE_PAD C11 _VOUT1_HSYNC vout1_hsyn c vin2a_hsyn vin1a_hsyn c0 c0 vin1a_hsyn c0 spi3_d0 gpio4_22 Driver off 0x15D8 CTRL_CORE_PAD E11 _VOUT1_VSYNC vout1_vsyn c vin2a_vsyn vin1a_vsyn c0 c0 vin1a_vsyn c0 spi3_sclk pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio4_23 pi17 po17 Driver off 0x15DC CTRL_CORE_PAD F11 _VOUT1_D0 vout1_d0 uart5_rxd vin2a_d16 vin1a_d16 vin1a_d16 spi3_cs2 pr1_uart0_c ts_n pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio8_0 pi18 po18 Driver off 0x15E0 CTRL_CORE_PAD G10 _VOUT1_D1 vout1_d1 uart5_txd vin2a_d17 vin1a_d17 vin1a_d17 pr1_uart0_r ts_n pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio8_1 pi19 po19 Driver off 0x15E4 CTRL_CORE_PAD F10 _VOUT1_D2 vout1_d2 emu2 vin2a_d18 vin1a_d18 vin1a_d18 obs0 obs16 obs_irq1 pr1_uart0_r xd pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio8_2 pi20 po20 Driver off 0x15E8 CTRL_CORE_PAD G11 _VOUT1_D3 vout1_d3 emu5 vin2a_d19 vin1a_d19 vin1a_d19 obs1 obs17 obs_dmarq 1 pr1_uart0_t xd pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_3 pi0 po0 Driver off Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER 89 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* 9 10 11 12 13 14* 15 ADVANCE INFORMATION 0x15EC CTRL_CORE_PAD E9 _VOUT1_D4 vout1_d4 emu6 vin2a_d20 vin1a_d20 vin1a_d20 obs2 obs18 pr1_ecap0_ ecap_capin _apwm_o pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_4 pi1 po1 Driver off 0x15F0 CTRL_CORE_PAD F9 _VOUT1_D5 vout1_d5 emu7 vin2a_d21 vin1a_d21 vin1a_d21 obs3 obs19 pr2_edc_lat ch0_in pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_5 pi2 po2 Driver off 0x15F4 CTRL_CORE_PAD F8 _VOUT1_D6 vout1_d6 emu8 vin2a_d22 vin1a_d22 vin1a_d22 obs4 obs20 pr2_edc_lat ch1_in pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_6 pi3 po3 Driver off 0x15F8 CTRL_CORE_PAD E7 _VOUT1_D7 vout1_d7 emu9 vin2a_d23 vin1a_d23 vin1a_d23 pr2_edc_sy nc0_out pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_7 pi4 po4 Driver off 0x15FC CTRL_CORE_PAD E8 _VOUT1_D8 vout1_d8 uart6_rxd vin2a_d8 vin1a_d8 vin1a_d8 pr2_edc_sy nc1_out pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_8 pi5 po5 Driver off 0x1600 CTRL_CORE_PAD D9 _VOUT1_D9 vout1_d9 uart6_txd vin2a_d9 vin1a_d9 vin1a_d9 pr2_edio_la tch_in pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_9 pi6 po6 Driver off 0x1604 CTRL_CORE_PAD D7 _VOUT1_D10 vout1_d10 emu3 vin2a_d10 vin1a_d10 vin1a_d10 obs5 obs21 obs_irq2 pr2_edio_s of pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_10 pi7 po7 Driver off 0x1608 CTRL_CORE_PAD D8 _VOUT1_D11 vout1_d11 emu10 vin2a_d11 vin1a_d11 vin1a_d11 obs6 obs22 obs_dmarq 2 pr2_uart0_c ts_n pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_11 pi8 po8 Driver off 0x160C CTRL_CORE_PAD A5 _VOUT1_D12 vout1_d12 emu11 vin2a_d12 vin1a_d12 vin1a_d12 obs7 obs23 pr2_uart0_r ts_n pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_12 pi9 po9 Driver off 0x1610 CTRL_CORE_PAD C6 _VOUT1_D13 vout1_d13 emu12 vin2a_d13 vin1a_d13 vin1a_d13 obs8 obs24 pr2_uart0_r xd pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_13 pi10 po10 Driver off 0x1614 CTRL_CORE_PAD C8 _VOUT1_D14 vout1_d14 emu13 vin2a_d14 vin1a_d14 vin1a_d14 obs9 obs25 pr2_uart0_t xd pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_14 pi11 po11 Driver off 0x1618 CTRL_CORE_PAD C7 _VOUT1_D15 vout1_d15 emu14 vin2a_d15 vin1a_d15 vin1a_d15 obs10 obs26 pr2_ecap0_ ecap_capin _apwm_o pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_15 pi12 po12 Driver off 0x161C CTRL_CORE_PAD B7 _VOUT1_D16 vout1_d16 uart7_rxd vin2a_d0 vin1a_d0 vin1a_d0 pr2_edio_d pr2_edio_d pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_16 ata_in0 ata_out0 pi13 po13 Driver off 0x1620 CTRL_CORE_PAD B8 _VOUT1_D17 vout1_d17 uart7_txd vin2a_d1 vin1a_d1 vin1a_d1 pr2_edio_d pr2_edio_d pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_17 ata_in1 ata_out1 pi14 po14 Driver off 0x1624 CTRL_CORE_PAD A7 _VOUT1_D18 vout1_d18 emu4 vin2a_d2 vin1a_d2 vin1a_d2 obs11 obs27 pr2_edio_d pr2_edio_d pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_18 ata_in2 ata_out2 pi15 po15 Driver off 0x1628 CTRL_CORE_PAD A8 _VOUT1_D19 vout1_d19 emu15 vin2a_d3 vin1a_d3 vin1a_d3 obs12 obs28 pr2_edio_d pr2_edio_d pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_19 ata_in3 ata_out3 pi16 po16 Driver off 0x162C CTRL_CORE_PAD C9 _VOUT1_D20 vout1_d20 emu16 vin2a_d4 vin1a_d4 vin1a_d4 obs13 obs29 pr2_edio_d pr2_edio_d pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_20 ata_in4 ata_out4 pi17 po17 Driver off 0x1630 CTRL_CORE_PAD A9 _VOUT1_D21 vout1_d21 emu17 vin2a_d5 vin1a_d5 vin1a_d5 obs14 obs30 pr2_edio_d pr2_edio_d pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_21 ata_in5 ata_out5 pi18 po18 Driver off 0x1634 CTRL_CORE_PAD B9 _VOUT1_D22 vout1_d22 emu18 vin2a_d6 vin1a_d6 vin1a_d6 obs15 obs31 pr2_edio_d pr2_edio_d pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_22 ata_in6 ata_out6 pi19 po19 Driver off 0x1638 CTRL_CORE_PAD A10 _VOUT1_D23 vout1_d23 emu19 vin2a_d7 vin2a_d7 vin1a_d7 pr2_edio_d pr2_edio_d pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio8_23 ata_in7 ata_out7 pi20 po20 Driver off 0x163C CTRL_CORE_PAD V1 _MDIO_MCLK mdio_mclk uart3_rtsn mii0_col vin2a_clk0 vin1b_clk1 pr1_mii0_c pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_15 ol pi0 po0 Driver off 0x1640 CTRL_CORE_PAD U4 _MDIO_D mdio_d uart3_ctsn mii0_txer vin2a_d0 vin1b_d0 pr1_mii0_rx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_16 link pi1 po1 Driver off 90 spi3_cs3 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 0x1644 CTRL_CORE_PAD U3 _RMII_MHZ_50_CL K RMII_MHZ_ 50_CLK 0x1648 CTRL_CORE_PAD V2 _UART3_RXD uart3_rxd rmii1_crs mii0_rxdv vin2a_d1 vin1b_d1 spi3_sclk 0x164C CTRL_CORE_PAD Y1 _UART3_TXD uart3_txd rmii1_rxer mii0_rxclk vin2a_d2 vin1b_d2 spi3_d1 0x1650 CTRL_CORE_PAD W9 _RGMII0_TXC rgmii0_txc uart3_ctsn rmii1_rxd1 mii0_rxd3 vin2a_d3 vin1b_d3 0x1654 CTRL_CORE_PAD V9 _RGMII0_TXCTL rgmii0_txctl uart3_rtsn rmii1_rxd0 mii0_rxd2 vin2a_d4 0x1658 CTRL_CORE_PAD V7 _RGMII0_TXD3 rgmii0_txd3 rmii0_crs mii0_crs vin2a_de0 0x165C CTRL_CORE_PAD U7 _RGMII0_TXD2 rgmii0_txd2 rmii0_rxer mii0_rxer 0x1660 CTRL_CORE_PAD V6 _RGMII0_TXD1 rgmii0_txd1 rmii0_rxd1 0x1664 CTRL_CORE_PAD U6 _RGMII0_TXD0 rgmii0_txd0 rmii0_rxd0 0x1668 CTRL_CORE_PAD U5 _RGMII0_RXC rgmii0_rxc 0x166C CTRL_CORE_PAD V5 _RGMII0_RXCTL 0x1670 8* 9 10 vin2a_d11 11 12 13 14* 15 pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_17 pi2 po2 Driver off pr1_mii0_rx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_18 dv pi3 po3 Driver off spi4_cs1 pr1_mii_mr pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_19 0_clk pi4 po4 Driver off spi3_d0 spi4_cs2 pr1_mii0_rx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_20 d3 pi5 po5 Driver off vin1b_d4 spi3_cs0 spi4_cs3 pr1_mii0_rx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_21 d2 pi6 po6 Driver off vin1b_de1 spi4_sclk uart4_rxd pr1_mii0_cr pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_22 s pi7 po7 Driver off vin2a_hsyn vin1b_hsyn c0 c1 spi4_d1 uart4_txd pr1_mii0_rx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_23 er pi8 po8 Driver off mii0_rxd1 vin2a_vsyn vin1b_vsyn c0 c1 spi4_d0 uart4_ctsn pr1_mii0_rx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_24 d1 pi9 po9 Driver off mii0_rxd0 vin2a_d10 spi4_cs0 uart4_rtsn pr1_mii0_rx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_25 d0 pi10 po10 Driver off rmii1_txen mii0_txclk vin2a_d5 vin1b_d5 pr1_mii_mt pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_26 0_clk pi11 po11 Driver off rgmii0_rxctl rmii1_txd1 mii0_txd3 vin2a_d6 vin1b_d6 pr1_mii0_tx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_27 d3 pi12 po12 Driver off CTRL_CORE_PAD V4 _RGMII0_RXD3 rgmii0_rxd3 rmii1_txd0 mii0_txd2 vin2a_d7 vin1b_d7 pr1_mii0_tx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_28 d2 pi13 po13 Driver off 0x1674 CTRL_CORE_PAD V3 _RGMII0_RXD2 rgmii0_rxd2 rmii0_txen mii0_txen vin2a_d8 pr1_mii0_tx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_29 en pi14 po14 Driver off 0x1678 CTRL_CORE_PAD Y2 _RGMII0_RXD1 rgmii0_rxd1 rmii0_txd1 mii0_txd1 vin2a_d9 pr1_mii0_tx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_30 d1 pi15 po15 Driver off 0x167C CTRL_CORE_PAD W2 _RGMII0_RXD0 rgmii0_rxd0 rmii0_txd0 mii0_txd0 vin2a_fld0 pr1_mii0_tx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_31 d0 pi16 po16 Driver off 0x1680 CTRL_CORE_PAD AB10 _USB1_DRVVBUS usb1_drvvb us timer16 gpio6_12 Driver off 0x1684 CTRL_CORE_PAD AC10 _USB2_DRVVBUS usb2_drvvb us timer15 gpio6_13 Driver off 0x1688 CTRL_CORE_PAD E21 _GPIO6_14 gpio6_14 mcasp1_ax dcan2_tx r8 uart10_rxd vout2_hsyn c vin2a_hsyn i2c3_sda c0 vin1a_hsyn c0 timer1 gpio6_14 Driver off 0x168C CTRL_CORE_PAD F20 _GPIO6_15 gpio6_15 mcasp1_ax dcan2_rx r9 uart10_txd vout2_vsyn c vin2a_vsyn i2c3_scl c0 vin1a_vsyn c0 timer2 gpio6_15 Driver off 0x1690 CTRL_CORE_PAD F21 _GPIO6_16 gpio6_16 mcasp1_ax r10 vout2_fld vin2a_fld0 vin1a_fld0 clkout1 timer3 gpio6_16 Driver off 0x1694 CTRL_CORE_PAD D18 _XREF_CLK0 xref_clk0 mcasp2_ax mcasp1_ax mcasp1_ah mcasp5_ah r8 r4 clkx clkx vin1a_d0 hdq0 clkout2 timer13 pr2_mii1_c pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio6_17 ol pi5 po5 Driver off 0x1698 CTRL_CORE_PAD E17 _XREF_CLK1 xref_clk1 mcasp2_ax mcasp1_ax mcasp2_ah mcasp6_ah r9 r5 clkx clkx vin1a_clk0 timer14 pr2_mii1_cr pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio6_18 s pi6 po6 Driver off vin1b_fld1 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER 91 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* 9 11 ADVANCE INFORMATION CTRL_CORE_PAD B26 _XREF_CLK2 xref_clk2 mcasp2_ax mcasp1_ax mcasp3_ah mcasp7_ah r10 r6 clkx clkx vout2_clk 0x16A0 CTRL_CORE_PAD C23 _XREF_CLK3 xref_clk3 mcasp2_ax mcasp1_ax mcasp4_ah mcasp8_ah r11 r7 clkx clkx vout2_de 0x16A4 CTRL_CORE_PAD C14 _MCASP1_ACLKX mcasp1_acl kx vin1a_fld0 i2c3_sda pr2_mdio_ mdclk 0x16A8 CTRL_CORE_PAD D14 _MCASP1_FSX mcasp1_fsx vin1a_de0 i2c3_scl pr2_mdio_d ata 0x16AC CTRL_CORE_PAD B14 _MCASP1_ACLKR mcasp1_acl mcasp7_ax kr r2 vout2_d0 vin2a_d0 vin1a_d0 0x16B0 CTRL_CORE_PAD J14 _MCASP1_FSR mcasp1_fsr mcasp7_ax r3 vout2_d1 vin2a_d1 vin1a_d1 0x16B4 CTRL_CORE_PAD G12 _MCASP1_AXR0 mcasp1_ax r0 uart6_rxd vin1a_vsyn c0 0x16B8 CTRL_CORE_PAD F12 _MCASP1_AXR1 mcasp1_ax r1 uart6_txd vin1a_hsyn c0 0x16BC CTRL_CORE_PAD G13 _MCASP1_AXR2 mcasp1_ax mcasp6_ax r2 r2 uart6_ctsn vout2_d2 0x16C0 CTRL_CORE_PAD J11 _MCASP1_AXR3 mcasp1_ax mcasp6_ax r3 r3 uart6_rtsn 0x16C4 CTRL_CORE_PAD E12 _MCASP1_AXR4 0x16C8 12 13 14* 15 timer15 gpio6_19 Driver off timer16 gpio6_20 Driver off pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio7_31 pi7 po7 Driver off gpio7_30 Driver off i2c4_sda gpio5_0 Driver off i2c4_scl gpio5_1 Driver off i2c5_sda pr2_mii0_rx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_2 er pi8 po8 Driver off i2c5_scl pr2_mii_mt pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_3 0_clk pi9 po9 Driver off vin2a_d2 vin1a_d2 gpio5_4 Driver off vout2_d3 vin2a_d3 vin1a_d3 gpio5_5 Driver off mcasp1_ax mcasp4_ax r4 r2 vout2_d4 vin2a_d4 vin1a_d4 gpio5_6 Driver off CTRL_CORE_PAD F13 _MCASP1_AXR5 mcasp1_ax mcasp4_ax r5 r3 vout2_d5 vin2a_d5 vin1a_d5 gpio5_7 Driver off 0x16CC CTRL_CORE_PAD C12 _MCASP1_AXR6 mcasp1_ax mcasp5_ax r6 r2 vout2_d6 vin2a_d6 vin1a_d6 gpio5_8 Driver off 0x16D0 CTRL_CORE_PAD D12 _MCASP1_AXR7 mcasp1_ax mcasp5_ax r7 r3 vout2_d7 vin2a_d7 vin1a_d7 gpio5_9 Driver off 0x16D4 CTRL_CORE_PAD B12 _MCASP1_AXR8 mcasp1_ax mcasp6_ax r8 r0 spi3_sclk vin1a_d15 timer5 pr2_mii0_tx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_10 en pi10 po10 Driver off 0x16D8 CTRL_CORE_PAD A11 _MCASP1_AXR9 mcasp1_ax mcasp6_ax r9 r1 spi3_d1 vin1a_d14 timer6 pr2_mii0_tx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_11 d3 pi11 po11 Driver off 0x16DC CTRL_CORE_PAD B13 _MCASP1_AXR10 mcasp1_ax mcasp6_acl mcasp6_acl spi3_d0 r10 kx kr vin1a_d13 timer7 pr2_mii0_tx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio5_12 d2 pi12 po12 Driver off 0x16E0 CTRL_CORE_PAD A12 _MCASP1_AXR11 mcasp1_ax mcasp6_fsx mcasp6_fsr spi3_cs0 r11 vin1a_d12 timer8 pr2_mii0_tx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio4_17 d1 pi13 po13 Driver off 0x16E4 CTRL_CORE_PAD E14 _MCASP1_AXR12 mcasp1_ax mcasp7_ax r12 r0 vin1a_d11 timer9 pr2_mii0_tx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio4_18 d0 pi14 po14 Driver off 0x16E8 CTRL_CORE_PAD A13 _MCASP1_AXR13 mcasp1_ax mcasp7_ax r13 r1 vin1a_d10 timer10 pr2_mii_mr pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio6_4 0_clk pi15 po15 Driver off 0x16EC CTRL_CORE_PAD G14 _MCASP1_AXR14 mcasp1_ax mcasp7_acl mcasp7_acl r14 kx kr vin1a_d9 timer11 pr2_mii0_rx pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g gpio6_5 dv pi16 po16 Driver off 0x16F0 CTRL_CORE_PAD F14 _MCASP1_AXR15 mcasp1_ax mcasp7_fsx mcasp7_fsr r15 vin1a_d8 timer12 pr2_mii0_rx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio6_6 d3 pi20 po20 Driver off 0x16F4 CTRL_CORE_PAD A19 _MCASP2_ACLKX mcasp2_acl kx vin1a_d7 pr2_mii0_rx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g d2 pi18 po18 Driver off 0x16F8 CTRL_CORE_PAD A18 _MCASP2_FSX mcasp2_fsx vin1a_d6 pr2_mii0_rx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g d1 pi19 po19 Driver off 92 spi3_cs1 vin2a_clk0 vin1a_clk0 10 0x169C hdq0 Terminal Configuration and Functions vin2a_de0 vin1a_de0 clkout3 timer4 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* 9 10 11 12 13 14* 15 0x16FC CTRL_CORE_PAD E15 _MCASP2_ACLKR mcasp2_acl mcasp8_ax kr r2 vout2_d8 vin2a_d8 vin1a_d8 Driver off 0x1700 CTRL_CORE_PAD A20 _MCASP2_FSR mcasp2_fsr mcasp8_ax r3 vout2_d9 vin2a_d9 vin1a_d9 Driver off 0x1704 CTRL_CORE_PAD B15 _MCASP2_AXR0 mcasp2_ax r0 vout2_d10 vin2a_d10 vin1a_d10 Driver off 0x1708 CTRL_CORE_PAD A15 _MCASP2_AXR1 mcasp2_ax r1 vout2_d11 vin2a_d11 vin1a_d11 Driver off 0x170C CTRL_CORE_PAD C15 _MCASP2_AXR2 mcasp2_ax mcasp3_ax r2 r2 vin1a_d5 pr2_mii0_rx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio6_8 d0 pi16 po16 Driver off 0x1710 CTRL_CORE_PAD A16 _MCASP2_AXR3 mcasp2_ax mcasp3_ax r3 r3 vin1a_d4 pr2_mii0_rx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio6_9 link pi17 po17 Driver off 0x1714 CTRL_CORE_PAD D15 _MCASP2_AXR4 mcasp2_ax mcasp8_ax r4 r0 vout2_d12 vin2a_d12 vin1a_d12 gpio1_4 Driver off 0x1718 CTRL_CORE_PAD B16 _MCASP2_AXR5 mcasp2_ax mcasp8_ax r5 r1 vout2_d13 vin2a_d13 vin1a_d13 gpio6_7 Driver off 0x171C CTRL_CORE_PAD B17 _MCASP2_AXR6 mcasp2_ax mcasp8_acl mcasp8_acl r6 kx kr vout2_d14 vin2a_d14 vin1a_d14 gpio2_29 Driver off 0x1720 CTRL_CORE_PAD A17 _MCASP2_AXR7 mcasp2_ax mcasp8_fsx mcasp8_fsr r7 vout2_d15 vin2a_d15 vin1a_d15 gpio1_5 Driver off 0x1724 CTRL_CORE_PAD B18 _MCASP3_ACLKX mcasp3_acl mcasp3_acl mcasp2_ax uart7_rxd kx kr r12 vin1a_d3 pr2_mii0_cr pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio5_13 s pi12 po12 Driver off 0x1728 CTRL_CORE_PAD F15 _MCASP3_FSX mcasp3_fsx mcasp3_fsr mcasp2_ax uart7_txd r13 vin1a_d2 pr2_mii0_c pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio5_14 ol pi13 po13 Driver off 0x172C CTRL_CORE_PAD B19 _MCASP3_AXR0 mcasp3_ax r0 mcasp2_ax uart7_ctsn r14 uart5_rxd vin1a_d1 pr2_mii1_rx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g er pi14 po14 Driver off 0x1730 CTRL_CORE_PAD C17 _MCASP3_AXR1 mcasp3_ax r1 mcasp2_ax uart7_rtsn r15 uart5_txd vin1a_d0 pr2_mii1_rx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g link pi15 po15 Driver off 0x1734 CTRL_CORE_PAD C18 _MCASP4_ACLKX mcasp4_acl mcasp4_acl spi3_sclk kx kr uart8_rxd i2c4_sda vout2_d16 vin2a_d16 vin1a_d16 vin1a_d15 Driver off 0x1738 CTRL_CORE_PAD A21 _MCASP4_FSX mcasp4_fsx mcasp4_fsr spi3_d1 uart8_txd i2c4_scl vout2_d17 vin2a_d17 vin1a_d17 vin1a_d14 Driver off 0x173C CTRL_CORE_PAD G16 _MCASP4_AXR0 mcasp4_ax r0 spi3_d0 uart8_ctsn uart4_rxd vout2_d18 vin2a_d18 vin1a_d18 vin1a_d13 Driver off 0x1740 CTRL_CORE_PAD D17 _MCASP4_AXR1 mcasp4_ax r1 spi3_cs0 uart8_rtsn uart4_txd vout2_d19 vin2a_d19 vin1a_d19 vin1a_d12 pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g pi0 po0 Driver off 0x1744 CTRL_CORE_PAD AA3 _MCASP5_ACLKX mcasp5_acl mcasp5_acl spi4_sclk kx kr uart9_rxd i2c5_sda vout2_d20 vin2a_d20 vin1a_d20 vin1a_d11 pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g pi1 po1 Driver off 0x1748 CTRL_CORE_PAD AB9 _MCASP5_FSX mcasp5_fsx mcasp5_fsr spi4_d1 uart9_txd i2c5_scl vout2_d21 vin2a_d21 vin1a_d21 vin1a_d10 pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g pi2 po2 Driver off 0x174C CTRL_CORE_PAD AB3 _MCASP5_AXR0 mcasp5_ax r0 spi4_d0 uart9_ctsn uart3_rxd vout2_d22 vin2a_d22 vin1a_d22 vin1a_d9 pr2_mdio_ mdclk pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g pi3 po3 Driver off 0x1750 CTRL_CORE_PAD AA4 _MCASP5_AXR1 mcasp5_ax r1 spi4_cs0 uart9_rtsn uart3_txd vout2_d23 vin2a_d23 vin1a_d23 vin1a_d8 pr2_mdio_d pr2_pru1_g pr2_pru1_g ata pi4 po4 Driver off 0x1754 CTRL_CORE_PAD W6 _MMC1_CLK mmc1_clk gpio6_21 Driver off 0x1758 CTRL_CORE_PAD Y6 _MMC1_CMD mmc1_cmd gpio6_22 Driver off vin1a_fld0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER 93 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* 9 10 11 12 13 14* 15 ADVANCE INFORMATION 0x175C CTRL_CORE_PAD AA6 _MMC1_DAT0 mmc1_dat0 gpio6_23 Driver off 0x1760 CTRL_CORE_PAD Y4 _MMC1_DAT1 mmc1_dat1 gpio6_24 Driver off 0x1764 CTRL_CORE_PAD AA5 _MMC1_DAT2 mmc1_dat2 gpio6_25 Driver off 0x1768 CTRL_CORE_PAD Y3 _MMC1_DAT3 mmc1_dat3 gpio6_26 Driver off 0x176C CTRL_CORE_PAD W7 _MMC1_SDCD mmc1_sdcd uart6_rxd i2c4_sda gpio6_27 Driver off 0x1770 CTRL_CORE_PAD Y9 _MMC1_SDWP mmc1_sdw p uart6_txd i2c4_scl gpio6_28 Driver off 0x1774 CTRL_CORE_PAD AC5 _GPIO6_10 gpio6_10 mdio_mclk i2c3_sda vin2b_hsyn c1 vin1a_clk0 ehrpwm2A pr2_mii_mt pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio6_10 1_clk pi0 po0 Driver off 0x1778 CTRL_CORE_PAD AB4 _GPIO6_11 gpio6_11 mdio_d i2c3_scl vin2b_vsyn c1 vin1a_de0 ehrpwm2B pr2_mii1_tx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio6_11 en pi1 po1 Driver off 0x177C CTRL_CORE_PAD AD4 _MMC3_CLK mmc3_clk vin2b_d7 vin1a_d7 ehrpwm2_tr pr2_mii1_tx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio6_29 ipzone_inpu d3 pi2 po2 t Driver off 0x1780 CTRL_CORE_PAD AC4 _MMC3_CMD mmc3_cmd spi3_sclk vin2b_d6 vin1a_d6 eCAP2_in_ pr2_mii1_tx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio6_30 PWM2_out d2 pi3 po3 Driver off 0x1784 CTRL_CORE_PAD AC7 _MMC3_DAT0 mmc3_dat0 spi3_d1 uart5_rxd vin2b_d5 vin1a_d5 eQEP3A_in pr2_mii1_tx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio6_31 d1 pi4 po4 Driver off 0x1788 CTRL_CORE_PAD AC6 _MMC3_DAT1 mmc3_dat1 spi3_d0 uart5_txd vin2b_d4 vin1a_d4 eQEP3B_in pr2_mii1_tx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio7_0 d0 pi5 po5 Driver off 0x178C CTRL_CORE_PAD AC9 _MMC3_DAT2 mmc3_dat2 spi3_cs0 uart5_ctsn vin2b_d3 vin1a_d3 eQEP3_ind pr2_mii_mr pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio7_1 ex 1_clk pi6 po6 Driver off 0x1790 CTRL_CORE_PAD AC3 _MMC3_DAT3 mmc3_dat3 spi3_cs1 uart5_rtsn vin2b_d2 vin1a_d2 eQEP3_str pr2_mii1_rx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio7_2 obe dv pi7 po7 Driver off 0x1794 CTRL_CORE_PAD AC8 _MMC3_DAT4 mmc3_dat4 spi4_sclk uart10_rxd vin2b_d1 vin1a_d1 ehrpwm3A pr2_mii1_rx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio1_22 d3 pi8 po8 Driver off 0x1798 CTRL_CORE_PAD AD6 _MMC3_DAT5 mmc3_dat5 spi4_d1 uart10_txd vin2b_d0 vin1a_d0 ehrpwm3B pr2_mii1_rx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio1_23 d2 pi9 po9 Driver off 0x179C CTRL_CORE_PAD AB8 _MMC3_DAT6 mmc3_dat6 spi4_d0 uart10_ctsn vin2b_de1 vin1a_hsyn ehrpwm3_tr pr2_mii1_rx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio1_24 c0 ipzone_inpu d1 pi10 po10 t Driver off 0x17A0 CTRL_CORE_PAD AB5 _MMC3_DAT7 mmc3_dat7 spi4_cs0 uart10_rtsn vin2b_clk1 vin1a_vsyn eCAP3_in_ pr2_mii1_rx pr2_pru0_g pr2_pru0_g gpio1_25 c0 PWM3_out d0 pi11 po11 Driver off 0x17A4 CTRL_CORE_PAD A25 _SPI1_SCLK spi1_sclk gpio7_7 Driver off 0x17A8 CTRL_CORE_PAD F16 _SPI1_D1 spi1_d1 gpio7_8 Driver off 0x17AC CTRL_CORE_PAD B25 _SPI1_D0 spi1_d0 gpio7_9 Driver off 0x17B0 CTRL_CORE_PAD A24 _SPI1_CS0 spi1_cs0 gpio7_10 Driver off 0x17B4 CTRL_CORE_PAD A22 _SPI1_CS1 spi1_cs1 gpio7_11 Driver off 94 sata1_led spi2_cs1 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) 0 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* 9 10 11 12 13 14* 15 0x17B8 CTRL_CORE_PAD B21 _SPI1_CS2 spi1_cs2 uart4_rxd mmc3_sdcd spi2_cs2 dcan2_tx mdio_mclk hdmi1_hpd gpio7_12 Driver off 0x17BC CTRL_CORE_PAD B20 _SPI1_CS3 spi1_cs3 uart4_txd mmc3_sdw spi2_cs3 p dcan2_rx mdio_d hdmi1_cec gpio7_13 Driver off 0x17C0 CTRL_CORE_PAD A26 _SPI2_SCLK spi2_sclk uart3_rxd gpio7_14 Driver off 0x17C4 CTRL_CORE_PAD B22 _SPI2_D1 spi2_d1 uart3_txd gpio7_15 Driver off 0x17C8 CTRL_CORE_PAD G17 _SPI2_D0 spi2_d0 uart3_ctsn uart5_rxd gpio7_16 Driver off 0x17CC CTRL_CORE_PAD B24 _SPI2_CS0 spi2_cs0 uart3_rtsn uart5_txd gpio7_17 Driver off 0x17D0 CTRL_CORE_PAD G20 _DCAN1_TX dcan1_tx uart8_rxd mmc2_sdcd hdmi1_hpd gpio1_14 Driver off 0x17D4 CTRL_CORE_PAD G19 _DCAN1_RX dcan1_rx uart8_txd mmc2_sdw sata1_led p hdmi1_cec gpio1_15 Driver off 0x17E0 CTRL_CORE_PAD B27 _UART1_RXD uart1_rxd mmc4_sdcd gpio7_22 Driver off 0x17E4 CTRL_CORE_PAD C26 _UART1_TXD uart1_txd mmc4_sdw p gpio7_23 Driver off 0x17E8 CTRL_CORE_PAD E25 _UART1_CTSN uart1_ctsn uart9_rxd mmc4_clk gpio7_24 Driver off 0x17EC CTRL_CORE_PAD C27 _UART1_RTSN uart1_rtsn uart9_txd mmc4_cmd gpio7_25 Driver off 0x17F0 CTRL_CORE_PAD D28 _UART2_RXD uart2_rxd uart3_ctsn uart3_rctx mmc4_dat0 uart2_rxd uart1_dcdn gpio7_26 Driver off 0x17F4 CTRL_CORE_PAD D26 _UART2_TXD uart2_txd uart3_rtsn uart3_sd mmc4_dat1 uart2_txd uart1_dsrn gpio7_27 Driver off 0x17F8 CTRL_CORE_PAD D27 _UART2_CTSN uart2_ctsn uart3_rxd mmc4_dat2 uart10_rxd uart1_dtrn gpio1_16 Driver off 0x17FC CTRL_CORE_PAD C28 _UART2_RTSN uart2_rtsn uart3_irtx mmc4_dat3 uart10_txd uart1_rin gpio1_17 Driver off 0x1800 CTRL_CORE_PAD C21 _I2C1_SDA i2c1_sda Driver off 0x1804 CTRL_CORE_PAD C20 _I2C1_SCL i2c1_scl Driver off 0x1808 CTRL_CORE_PAD C25 _I2C2_SDA i2c2_sda hdmi1_ddc _scl Driver off 0x180C CTRL_CORE_PAD F17 _I2C2_SCL i2c2_scl hdmi1_ddc _sda Driver off 0x1818 CTRL_CORE_PAD AD17 _WAKEUP0 Wakeup0 dcan1_rx gpio1_0 sys_nirq2 Driver off 0x1824 CTRL_CORE_PAD AC16 _WAKEUP3 Wakeup3 sys_nirq1 gpio1_3 dcan2_rx Driver off 0x1828 CTRL_CORE_PAD Y11 _ON_OFF on_off 0x182C CTRL_CORE_PAD AB17 _RTC_PORZ rtc_porz uart3_txd Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION ADDRESS REGISTER NAME BALL NUMBER 95 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-3. Multiplexing Characteristics (continued) ADDRESS REGISTER NAME MUXMODE FIELD SETTINGS (CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[3:0]) BALL NUMBER 0 1 2 3* 4* 5* 6* 7 8* 9 10 11 12 13 14* ADVANCE INFORMATION 0x1830 CTRL_CORE_PAD F18 _TMS tms 0x1834 CTRL_CORE_PAD D23 _TDI tdi gpio8_27 0x1838 CTRL_CORE_PAD F19 _TDO tdo gpio8_28 0x183C CTRL_CORE_PAD E20 _TCLK tclk 0x1840 CTRL_CORE_PAD D20 _TRSTN trstn 0x1844 CTRL_CORE_PAD E18 _RTCK rtck gpio8_29 0x1848 CTRL_CORE_PAD G21 _EMU0 emu0 gpio8_30 0x184C CTRL_CORE_PAD D24 _EMU1 emu1 gpio8_31 0x185C CTRL_CORE_PAD E23 _RESETN resetn 0x1860 CTRL_CORE_PAD D21 _NMIN_DSP nmin_dsp 0x1864 CTRL_CORE_PAD F23 _RSTOUTN rstoutn 15 1. NA in table stands for Not Applicable. 96 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com 4.4 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Signal Descriptions Many signals are available on multiple pins, according to the software configuration of the pin multiplexing options. Texas Instruments has developed an application called Pin Mux Utility that helps a system designer select the appropriate pin-multiplexing configuration for their device-based product design. The Pin Mux Utility provides a way to select valid IO Sets of specific peripheral interfaces to ensure the pinmultiplexing configuration selected for a design only uses valid IO Sets supported by the device. 1. SIGNAL NAME: The name of the signal passing through the pin. NOTE The subsystem multiplexing signals are not described in Table 4-2 and Table 4-3. ADVANCE INFORMATION 2. DESCRIPTION: Description of the signal 3. TYPE: Signal direction and type: – I = Input – O = Output – IO = Input or output – D = Open Drain – DS = Differential – A = Analog – PWR = Power – GND = Ground 4. BALL: Associated ball(s) bottom NOTE For more information, see the Control Module / Control Module Register Manual section of the device TRM. 4.4.1 Video Input Ports (VIP) CAUTION The I/O timings provided in Section 7, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are valid only for VIN1 and VIN2 if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 7-4. NOTE For more information, see the Video Input Port (VIP) section of the device TRM. Table 4-4. VIP Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL Video Input 1 Port A Clock input.Input clock for 8-bit 16-bit or 24-bit Port A video capture. Input data is sampled on the CLK0 edge. I AC5 / B11 / E17 / P1 / P4 / B26 vin1a_d0 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I AD6 / B7 / C17 / D18 / M6 / R6 / P7 / B14 vin1a_d1 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I AC8 / B19 / B8 / M2 / T9 / J14 Video Input 1 vin1a_clk0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 97 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-4. VIP Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME ADVANCE INFORMATION 98 TYPE BALL vin1a_d2 DESCRIPTION Video Input 1 Port A Data input I A7 / AC3 / F15 / L5 / T6 / G13 vin1a_d3 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I A8 / AC9 / B18 / M1 / T7 / J11 vin1a_d4 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I A16 / AC6 / C9 / L6 / P6 / E12 vin1a_d5 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I A9 / AC7 / C15 / L4 / R9 / F13 vin1a_d6 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I A18 / AC4 / B9 / L3 / R5 / C12 vin1a_d7 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I A10 / A19 / AD4 / L2 / P5 / D12 vin1a_d8 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I AA4 / E8 / F14 / L1 / U2 / J4 / E15 vin1a_d9 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I AB3 / D9 / G14 / K2 / U1 / J6 / A20 vin1a_d10 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I A13 / AB9 / D7 / J1 / P3 / H4 / B15 vin1a_d11 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I AA3 / D8 / E14 / J2 / R2 / H5 / A15 vin1a_d12 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I A12 / A5 / D17 / H1 / K7 / D15 vin1a_d13 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I B13 / C6 / G16 / J3 / M7 / B16 vin1a_d14 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I A11 / A21 / C8 / H2 / J5 / B17 vin1a_d15 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I B12 / C18 / C7 / H3 / K6 / A17 vin1a_d16 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I F11 / R6 / C18 vin1a_d17 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I G10 / T9 / A21 vin1a_d18 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I F10 / T6 / G16 vin1a_d19 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I G11 / T7 / D17 vin1a_d20 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I E9 / P6 / AA3 vin1a_d21 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I F9 / R9 / AB9 vin1a_d22 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I F8 / R5 / AB3 vin1a_d23 Video Input 1 Port A Data input I E7 / P5 / AA4 vin1a_de0 Video Input 1 Port A Field ID input I AB4 / B10 / D14 / N9 / H6 / C23 vin1a_fld0 Video Input 1 Port A Field ID input I C14 / C17 / D11 / P9 / J7 / F21 vin1a_hsync0 Video Input 1 Port A Horizontal Sync input I AB8 / C11 / F12 / N7 / R3 / P7 / E21 vin1a_vsync0 Video Input 1 Port A Vertical Sync input I AB5 / E11 / G12 / R4 / T2 / N1 / F20 vin1b_clk1 Video Input 1 Port B Clock input I N9 / V1 / M4 / P7 vin1b_d0 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I R6 / U4 / K7 vin1b_d1 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I T9 / V2 / M7 vin1b_d2 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I T6 / Y1 / J5 vin1b_d3 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I T7 / W9 / K6 vin1b_d4 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I P6 / V9 / J7 vin1b_d5 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I R9 / U5 / J4 vin1b_d6 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I R5 / V5 / J6 vin1b_d7 Video Input 1 Port B Data input I P5 / V4 / H4 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-4. VIP Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL vin1b_de1 DESCRIPTION Video Input 1 Port B Field ID input I P9 / V7 / N6 vin1b_fld1 Video Input 1 Port B Field ID input I P4 / W2 / M4 vin1b_hsync1 Video Input 1 Port B Horizontal Sync input I N7 / U7 / H5 vin1b_vsync1 Video Input 1 Port B Vertical Sync input I R4 / V6 / H6 Video Input 2 Port A Clock input. I B11 / B26 / E1 / P4 / V1 vin2a_d0 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I B14 / B7 / F2 / R6 / U4 vin2a_d1 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I B8 / F3 / J14 / T9 / V2 vin2a_d2 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I A7 / D1 / G13 / T6 / Y1 vin2a_d3 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I A8 / E2 / J11 / T7 / W9 vin2a_d4 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I C9 / D2 / E12 / P6 / V9 vin2a_d5 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I A9 / F13 / F4 / R9 / U5 vin2a_d6 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I B9 / C1 / C12 / R5 / V5 vin2a_d7 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I A10 / D12 / E4 / P5 / V4 vin2a_d8 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I E15 / E8 / F5 / J4 / U2 / V3 vin2a_d9 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I A20 / D9 / E6 / J6 / U1 / Y2 vin2a_d10 Video Input 2 Port A Data input IO B15 / D3 / D7 / H4 / P3 / U6 vin2a_d11 Video Input 2 Port A Data input IO A15 / D8 / F6 / H5 / R2 / U3 vin2a_d12 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I A5 / D15 / D5 / K7 vin2a_d13 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I B16 / C2 / C6 / M7 vin2a_d14 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I B17 / C3 / C8 / J5 vin2a_d15 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I A17 / C4 / C7 / K6 vin2a_d16 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I B2 / C18 / F11 vin2a_d17 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I A21 / D6 / G10 vin2a_d18 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I C5 / F10 / G16 vin2a_d19 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I A3 / D17 / G11 vin2a_d20 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I AA3 / B3 / E9 vin2a_d21 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I AB9 / B4 / F9 vin2a_d22 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I AB3 / B5 / F8 vin2a_d23 Video Input 2 Port A Data input I A4 / AA4 / E7 vin2a_de0 Video Input 2 Port A Field ID input I B10 / C23 / G2 / H6 / P7 / V7 vin2a_fld0 Video Input 2 Port A Field ID input I D11 / F21 / G2 / H7 / J7 / P9 / W2 vin2a_hsync0 Video Input 2 Port A Horizontal Sync input I C11 / E21 / G1 / P7 / R3 / U7 vin2a_vsync0 Video Input 2 Port A Vertical Sync input I E11 / F20 / G6 / N1 / T2 / V6 vin2b_clk1 Video Input 2 Port B Clock input I AB5 / H7 / M4 / P7 vin2b_d0 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I A4 / AD6 / K7 vin2a_clk0 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 99 ADVANCE INFORMATION Video Input 2 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-4. VIP Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL vin2b_d1 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I AC8 / B5 / M7 vin2b_d2 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I AC3 / B4 / J5 vin2b_d3 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I AC9 / B3 / K6 vin2b_d4 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I A3 / AC6 / J7 vin2b_d5 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I AC7 / C5 / J4 vin2b_d6 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I AC4 / D6 / J6 vin2b_d7 Video Input 2 Port B Data input I AD4 / B2 / H4 vin2b_de1 Video Input 2 Port B Field ID input I AB8 / G2 / N6 vin2b_fld1 Video Input 2 Port B Field ID input I G2 / M4 vin2b_hsync1 Video Input 2 Port B Horizontal Sync input I AC5 / G1 / H5 vin2b_vsync1 Video Input 2 Port B Vertical Sync input I AB4 / G6 / H6 4.4.2 DESCRIPTION Display Subsystem – Video Output Ports ADVANCE INFORMATION CAUTION The I/O timings provided in Section 7 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are valid only if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 7-16 and . Table 4-5. DSS Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL DPI Video Output 1 100 vout1_clk Video Output 1 Clock output O D11 vout1_de Video Output 1 Data Enable output O B10 vout1_fld Video Output 1 Field ID output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O B11 vout1_hsync Video Output 1 Horizontal Sync output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O C11 vout1_vsync E11 Video Output 1 Vertical Sync output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O vout1_d0 Video Output 1 Data output O F11 vout1_d1 Video Output 1 Data output O G10 vout1_d2 Video Output 1 Data output O F10 vout1_d3 Video Output 1 Data output O G11 vout1_d4 Video Output 1 Data output O E9 vout1_d5 Video Output 1 Data output O F9 vout1_d6 Video Output 1 Data output O F8 vout1_d7 Video Output 1 Data output O E7 vout1_d8 Video Output 1 Data output O E8 vout1_d9 Video Output 1 Data output O D9 vout1_d10 Video Output 1 Data output O D7 vout1_d11 Video Output 1 Data output O D8 vout1_d12 Video Output 1 Data output O A5 vout1_d13 Video Output 1 Data output O C6 vout1_d14 Video Output 1 Data output O C8 vout1_d15 Video Output 1 Data output O C7 vout1_d16 Video Output 1 Data output O B7 vout1_d17 Video Output 1 Data output O B8 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-5. DSS Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL vout1_d18 DESCRIPTION Video Output 1 Data output O A7 vout1_d19 Video Output 1 Data output O A8 vout1_d20 Video Output 1 Data output O C9 vout1_d21 Video Output 1 Data output O A9 vout1_d22 Video Output 1 Data output O B9 vout1_d23 Video Output 1 Data output O A10 vout2_clk Video Output 2 Clock output O H7 / B26 vout2_de Video Output 2 Data Enable output O G2 / C23 vout2_fld Video Output 2 Field ID output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O E1 / F21 vout2_hsync Video Output 2 Horizontal Sync output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O G1 / E21 vout2_vsync Video Output 2 Vertical Sync output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O G6 / F20 vout2_d0 Video Output 2 Data output O A4 / B14 vout2_d1 Video Output 2 Data output O B5 / J14 vout2_d2 Video Output 2 Data output O B4 / G13 vout2_d3 Video Output 2 Data output O B3 / J11 vout2_d4 Video Output 2 Data output O A3 / E12 vout2_d5 Video Output 2 Data output O C5 / F13 vout2_d6 Video Output 2 Data output O D6 / C12 vout2_d7 Video Output 2 Data output O B2 / D12 vout2_d8 Video Output 2 Data output O C4 / E15 vout2_d9 Video Output 2 Data output O C3 / A20 vout2_d10 Video Output 2 Data output O C2 / B15 vout2_d11 Video Output 2 Data output O D5 / A15 vout2_d12 Video Output 2 Data output O F6 / D15 vout2_d13 Video Output 2 Data output O D3 / B16 vout2_d14 Video Output 2 Data output O E6 / B17 vout2_d15 Video Output 2 Data output O F5 / A17 vout2_d16 Video Output 2 Data output O E4 / C18 vout2_d17 Video Output 2 Data output O C1 / A21 vout2_d18 Video Output 2 Data output O F4 / G16 vout2_d19 Video Output 2 Data output O D2 / D17 vout2_d20 Video Output 2 Data output O E2 / AA3 vout2_d21 Video Output 2 Data output O D1 / AB9 vout2_d22 Video Output 2 Data output O F3 / AB3 vout2_d23 Video Output 2 Data output O F2 / AA4 vout3_clk Video Output 3 Clock output O P1 vout3_d0 Video Output 3 Data output O M6 vout3_d1 Video Output 3 Data output O M2 vout3_d2 Video Output 3 Data output O L5 vout3_d3 Video Output 3 Data output O M1 vout3_d4 Video Output 3 Data output O L6 vout3_d5 Video Output 3 Data output O L4 vout3_d6 Video Output 3 Data output O L3 vout3_d7 Video Output 3 Data output O L2 vout3_d8 Video Output 3 Data output O L1 ADVANCE INFORMATION DPI Video Output 2 DPI Video Output 3 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 101 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-5. DSS Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME ADVANCE INFORMATION TYPE BALL vout3_d9 Video Output 3 Data output O K2 vout3_d10 Video Output 3 Data output O J1 vout3_d11 Video Output 3 Data output O J2 vout3_d12 Video Output 3 Data output O H1 vout3_d13 Video Output 3 Data output O J3 vout3_d14 Video Output 3 Data output O H2 vout3_d15 Video Output 3 Data output O H3 vout3_d16 Video Output 3 Data output O R6 vout3_d17 Video Output 3 Data output O T9 vout3_d18 Video Output 3 Data output O T6 vout3_d19 Video Output 3 Data output O T7 vout3_d20 Video Output 3 Data output O P6 vout3_d21 Video Output 3 Data output O R9 vout3_d22 Video Output 3 Data output O R5 vout3_d23 Video Output 3 Data output O P5 vout3_de Video Output 3 Data Enable output O N9 vout3_fld Video Output 3 Field ID output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O P9 vout3_hsync Video Output 3 Horizontal Sync output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O N7 vout3_vsync Video Output 3 Vertical Sync output. This signal is not used for embedded sync modes. O R4 4.4.3 DESCRIPTION Display Subsystem – High-Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI) NOTE For more information, see the Display Subsystem / Display Subsystem Overview of the device TRM. Table 4-6. HDMI Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL hdmi1_cec HDMI consumer electronic control IOD B20/ G19 hdmi1_hpd HDMI display hot plug detect I/O B21/ G20 hdmi1_ddc_scl HDMI display data channel clock IOD C25 hdmi1_ddc_sda HDMI display data channel data IOD F17 hdmi1_clockx HDMI clock differential positive or negative ODS AG16 hdmi1_clocky HDMI clock differential positive or negative ODS AH16 hdmi1_data2x HDMI data 2 differential positive or negative ODS AG19 hdmi1_data2y HDMI data 2 differential positive or negative ODS AH19 hdmi1_data1x HDMI data 1 differential positive or negative ODS AG18 hdmi1_data1y HDMI data 1 differential positive or negative ODS AH18 hdmi1_data0x HDMI data 0 differential positive or negative ODS AG17 hdmi1_data0y HDMI data 0 differential positive or negative ODS AH17 4.4.4 DESCRIPTION Camera Serial Interface 2 CAL bridge (CSI2) NOTE For more information, see the CAL Subsystem / CAL Subsystem Overview of the device TRM. 102 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-7. CSI 2 Signal Descriptions DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL csi2_0_dx0 Serial data/clock input - line 0 (position 1) I AE1 csi2_0_dy0 Serial data/clock input - line 0 (position 1) I AD2 csi2_0_dx1 Serial data/clock input - line 1 (position 2) I AF1 csi2_0_dy1 Serial data/clock input - line 1 (position 2) I AE2 csi2_0_dx2 Serial data/clock input - line 2 (position 3) I AF2 csi2_0_dy2 Serial data/clock input - line 2 (position 3) I AF3 csi2_0_dx3 Serial data/clock input - line 3 (position 4) I AH4 csi2_0_dy3 Serial data/clock input - line 3 (position 4) I AG4 csi2_0_dx4 Serial data input only - line 4 (position 5) (1) I AH3 csi2_0_dy4 Serial data input only - line 4 (position 5) (1) I AG3 csi2_1_dx0 Serial data/clock input - line 0 (position 1) I AG5 csi2_1_dy0 Serial data/clock input - line 0 (position 1) I AH5 csi2_1_dx1 Serial data/clock input - line 1 (position 2) I AG6 csi2_1_dy1 Serial data/clock input - line 1 (position 2) I AH6 csi2_1_dx2 Serial data/clock input - line 2 (position 3) I AH7 csi2_1_dy2 Serial data/clock input - line 2 (position 3) I AG7 ADVANCE INFORMATION SIGNAL NAME (1) Line 4 (position 5) supports only data. For more information see CAL Subsystem of the device TRM. 4.4.5 External Memory Interface (EMIF) NOTE For more information, see the Memory Subsystem / EMIF Controller section of the device TRM. NOTE Dual rank support is not available on this device, but signal names are retained for consistency with the AM57xx family of devices. NOTE The index number 1 which is part of the EMIF1 signal prefixes (ddr1_*) listed in Table 4-8, EMIF Signal Descriptions, not to be confused with DDR1 type of SDRAM memories. Table 4-8. EMIF Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL AH23 ddr1_csn0 EMIF1 Chip Select 0 O ddr1_csn1 EMIF1 Chip Select 1 O AB16 ddr1_cke EMIF1 Clock Enable O AG22 ddr1_ck EMIF1 Clock O AG24 ddr1_nck EMIF1 Negative Clock O AH24 ddr1_odt0 EMIF1 On-Die Termination for Chip Select 0 O AE20 ddr1_odt1 EMIF1 On-Die Termination for Chip Select 1 O AC17 ddr1_casn EMIF1 Column Address Strobe output O AC18 ddr1_rasn EMIF1 Row Address Strobe output O AF20 ddr1_wen EMIF1 Write Enable O AH21 ddr1_rst EMIF1 Reset output (DDR3-SDRAM only) O AG21 ddr1_ba0 EMIF1 Bank Address outputs O AF17 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 103 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-8. EMIF Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME ADVANCE INFORMATION 104 TYPE BALL ddr1_ba1 DESCRIPTION EMIF1 Bank Address outputs O AE18 ddr1_ba2 EMIF1 Bank Address outputs O AB18 ddr1_a0 EMIF1 Address Bus O AD20 ddr1_a1 EMIF1 Address Bus O AC19 ddr1_a2 EMIF1 Address Bus O AC20 ddr1_a3 EMIF1 Address Bus O AB19 ddr1_a4 EMIF1 Address Bus O AF21 ddr1_a5 EMIF1 Address Bus O AH22 ddr1_a6 EMIF1 Address Bus O AG23 ddr1_a7 EMIF1 Address Bus O AE21 ddr1_a8 EMIF1 Address Bus O AF22 ddr1_a9 EMIF1 Address Bus O AE22 ddr1_a10 EMIF1 Address Bus O AD21 ddr1_a11 EMIF1 Address Bus O AD22 ddr1_a12 EMIF1 Address Bus O AC21 ddr1_a13 EMIF1 Address Bus O AF18 ddr1_a14 EMIF1 Address Bus O AE17 ddr1_a15 EMIF1 Address Bus O AD18 ddr1_d0 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AF25 ddr1_d1 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AF26 ddr1_d2 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AG26 ddr1_d3 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AH26 ddr1_d4 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AF24 ddr1_d5 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AE24 ddr1_d6 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AF23 ddr1_d7 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AE23 ddr1_d8 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AC23 ddr1_d9 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AF27 ddr1_d10 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AG27 ddr1_d11 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AF28 ddr1_d12 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AE26 ddr1_d13 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AC25 ddr1_d14 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AC24 ddr1_d15 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AD25 ddr1_d16 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O V20 ddr1_d17 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O W20 ddr1_d18 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AB28 ddr1_d19 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AC28 ddr1_d20 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AC27 ddr1_d21 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O Y19 ddr1_d22 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AB27 ddr1_d23 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O Y20 ddr1_d24 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AA23 ddr1_d25 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O Y22 ddr1_d26 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O Y23 ddr1_d27 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AA24 ddr1_d28 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O Y24 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL ddr1_d29 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AA26 ddr1_d30 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AA25 ddr1_d31 EMIF1 Data Bus I/O AA28 ddr1_ecc_d0 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus I/O W22 ddr1_ecc_d1 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus I/O V23 ddr1_ecc_d2 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus I/O W19 ddr1_ecc_d3 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus I/O W23 ddr1_ecc_d4 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus I/O Y25 ddr1_ecc_d5 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus I/O V24 ddr1_ecc_d6 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus I/O V25 ddr1_ecc_d7 EMIF1 ECC Data Bus I/O Y26 ddr1_dqm0 EMIF1 Data Mask outputs O AD23 ddr1_dqm1 EMIF1 Data Mask outputs O AB23 ddr1_dqm2 EMIF1 Data Mask outputs O AC26 ddr1_dqm3 EMIF1 Data Mask outputs O AA27 EMIF1 ECC Data Mask outputs O V26 ddr1_dqs0 Data strobe 0 input/outputs for byte 0 of the 32-bit data bus. These signals are outputs to the EMIF1 memory when writing and inputs when reading. I/O AH25 ddr1_dqsn0 Data strobe 0 invert I/O AG25 ddr1_dqs1 Data strobe 1 input/outputs for byte 1 of the 32-bit data bus. These signals are outputs to the EMIF1 memory when writing and inputs when reading. I/O AE27 ddr1_dqsn1 Data strobe 1 invert I/O AE28 ddr1_dqs2 Data strobe 2 input/outputs for byte 2 of the 32-bit data bus. These signals are outputs to the EMIF1 memory when writing and inputs when reading. I/O AD27 ddr1_dqsn2 Data strobe 2 invert I/O AD28 ddr1_dqs3 Data strobe 3 input/outputs for byte 3 of the 32-bit data bus. These signals are outputs to the EMIF1 memory when writing and inputs when reading. I/O Y28 ddr1_dqsn3 Data strobe 3 invert I/O Y27 ddr1_dqs_ecc EMIF1 ECC Data strobe input/output. These signals are outputs to the EMIF1 memory when writing and inputs when reading. I/O V27 ddr1_dqsn_ecc EMIF1 ECC Complementary Data strobe I/O V28 A Y18 ddr1_dqm_ecc ddr1_vref0 4.4.6 Reference Power Supply EMIF1 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 4-8. EMIF Signal Descriptions (continued) General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) NOTE For more information, see the Memory Subsystem / General-Purpose Memory Controller section of the device TRM. Table 4-9. GPMC Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL gpmc_ad0 DESCRIPTION GPMC Data 0 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 1 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O M6 gpmc_ad1 GPMC Data 1 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 2 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O M2 gpmc_ad2 GPMC Data 2 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 3 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O L5 gpmc_ad3 GPMC Data 3 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 4 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O M1 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 105 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-9. GPMC Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME ADVANCE INFORMATION 106 TYPE BALL gpmc_ad4 DESCRIPTION GPMC Data 4 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 5 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O L6 gpmc_ad5 GPMC Data 5 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 6 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O L4 gpmc_ad6 GPMC Data 6 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 7 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O L3 gpmc_ad7 GPMC Data 7 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 8 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O L2 gpmc_ad8 GPMC Data 8 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 9 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O L1 gpmc_ad9 GPMC Data 9 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 10 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O K2 gpmc_ad10 GPMC Data 10 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 11 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O J1 gpmc_ad11 GPMC Data 11 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 12 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O J2 gpmc_ad12 GPMC Data 12 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 13 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O H1 gpmc_ad13 GPMC Data 13 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 14 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O J3 gpmc_ad14 GPMC Data 14 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 15 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O H2 gpmc_ad15 GPMC Data 15 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and additionally Address 16 in A/D multiplexed mode I/O H3 gpmc_a0 GPMC Address 0. Only used to effectively address 8-bit data nonmultiplexed memories O R6 / P4 gpmc_a1 GPMC address 1 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 17 in A/D multiplexed mode O T9 / P1 gpmc_a2 GPMC address 2 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 18 in A/D multiplexed mode O T6 / N1 gpmc_a3 GPMC address 3 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 19 in A/D multiplexed mode O T7 / M4 gpmc_a4 GPMC address 4 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 20 in A/D multiplexed mode O P6 gpmc_a5 GPMC address 5 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 21 in A/D multiplexed mode O R9 gpmc_a6 GPMC address 6 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 22 in A/D multiplexed mode O R5 gpmc_a7 GPMC address 7 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 23 in A/D multiplexed mode O P5 gpmc_a8 GPMC address 8 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 24 in A/D multiplexed mode O N7 gpmc_a9 GPMC address 9 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 25 in A/D multiplexed mode O R4 gpmc_a10 GPMC address 10 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 26 in A/D multiplexed mode O N9 gpmc_a11 GPMC address 11 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O P9 gpmc_a12 GPMC address 12 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O P4 gpmc_a13 GPMC address 13 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O R3 / K7 / P2 gpmc_a14 GPMC address 14 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O T2 / M7 / P1 gpmc_a15 GPMC address 15 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O U2 / J5 / N2 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL gpmc_a16 GPMC address 16 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O U1 / K6 / R6 gpmc_a17 GPMC address 17 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O P3 / J7 / E1 gpmc_a18 GPMC address 18 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O R2 / J4 / H7 gpmc_a19 GPMC address 19 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O K7 / J6 gpmc_a20 GPMC address 20 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O M7 / H4 gpmc_a21 GPMC address 21 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O J5 / H5 gpmc_a22 GPMC address 22 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O K6 / H6 gpmc_a23 GPMC address 23 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O F6 / J7 / N1 / P2 gpmc_a24 GPMC address 24 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O D3 / J4 / P1 gpmc_a25 GPMC address 25 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O E6 / J6 / N2 gpmc_a26 GPMC address 26 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and unused in A/D multiplexed mode O F5 / H4 / R6 gpmc_a27 GPMC address 27 in A/D nonmultiplexed mode and Address 27 in A/D multiplexed mode O G1 / H5 / E1 / H7 gpmc_cs0 GPMC Chip Select 0 (active low) O T1 gpmc_cs1 GPMC Chip Select 1 (active low) O H6 gpmc_cs2 GPMC Chip Select 2 (active low) O P2 gpmc_cs3 GPMC Chip Select 3 (active low) O P1 gpmc_cs4 GPMC Chip Select 4 (active low) O N6 gpmc_cs5 GPMC Chip Select 5 (active low) O M4 gpmc_cs6 GPMC Chip Select 6 (active low) O N1 gpmc_cs7 GPMC Chip Select 7 (active low) O P7 GPMC Clock output I/O P7 gpmc_advn_ale GPMC address valid active low or address latch enable O N1 gpmc_oen_ren GPMC output enable active low or read enable O M5 gpmc_wen GPMC write enable active low O M3 gpmc_ben0 GPMC lower-byte enable active low O N6 gpmc_ben1 GPMC upper-byte enable active low O M4 gpmc_wait0 GPMC external indication of wait 0 I N2 gpmc_wait1 GPMC external indication of wait 1 I P7 / N1 gpmc_clk(1)(2) DESCRIPTION ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 4-9. GPMC Signal Descriptions (continued) (1) This clock signal is implemented as 'pad loopback' inside the device - the output signal is looped back through the input buffer to serve as the internal reference signal. Series termination is recommended (as close to device pin as possible) to improve signal integrity of the clock input. Any nonmonotonicity in voltage that occurs at the pad loopback clock pin between VIH and VIL must be less than VHYS. (2) The gpio6_16.clkout1 signal can be used as an “always-on” alternative to gpmc_clk provided that the external device can support the associated timing. See Table 7-22 GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Switching Characteristics - Synchronous Mode - 1 Load and Table 7-24 GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Switching Characteristics - Synchronous Mode - 5 Loads for timing information. 4.4.7 Timers NOTE For more information, see the Timers section of the device TRM. Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 107 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-10. Timers Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME ADVANCE INFORMATION TYPE BALL timer1 PWM output/event trigger input I/O M4 / E21 timer2 PWM output/event trigger input I/O N6 / F20 timer3 PWM output/event trigger input I/O N1 / F21 timer4 PWM output/event trigger input I/O P7 / D12 timer5 PWM output/event trigger input I/O U2 / B12 timer6 PWM output/event trigger input I/O T2 / A11 timer7 PWM output/event trigger input I/O R3 / B13 timer8 PWM output/event trigger input I/O P4 / A12 timer9 PWM output/event trigger input I/O P9 / E14 timer10 PWM output/event trigger input I/O N9 / A13 timer11 PWM output/event trigger input I/O R4 / G14 timer12 PWM output/event trigger input I/O N7 / F14 timer13 PWM output/event trigger input I/O D18 timer14 PWM output/event trigger input I/O E17 timer15 PWM output/event trigger input I/O AC10 / B26 timer16 PWM output/event trigger input I/O AB10 / C23 4.4.8 DESCRIPTION Inter-Integrated Circuit Interface (I2C) NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interface / Multimaster High-Speed I2C Controller / HS I2C Environment / HS I2C in I2C Mode section of the device TRM. NOTE I2C1 and I2C2 do NOT support HS-mode. Table 4-11. I2C Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL Inter-Integrated Circuit Interface 1 (I2C1) i2c1_scl I2C1 Clock I/O IOD C20 i2c1_sda I2C1 Data I/O IOD C21 Inter-Integrated Circuit Interface 2 (I2C2) i2c2_scl I2C2 Clock I/O IOD F17 i2c2_sda I2C2 Data I/O IOD C25 Inter-Integrated Circuit Interface 3 (I2C3) i2c3_scl I2C3 Clock I/O IOD P7/ D14/ AB4/ F20 i2c3_sda I2C3 Data I/O IOD N1/ C14/ AC5/ E21 Inter-Integrated Circuit Interface 4 (I2C4) i2c4_scl I2C4 Clock I/O IOD R6/ J14/ A21/ Y9 i2c4_sda I2C4 Data I/O IOD T9/ B14/ C18/ W7 Inter-Integrated Circuit Interface 5 (I2C5) 108 i2c5_scl I2C5 Clock I/O IOD AB9/ P6/ F12 i2c5_sda I2C5 Data I/O IOD AA3/ R9/ G12 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com 4.4.9 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 HDQ / 1-Wire Interface (HDQ1W) NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interface / HDQ/1-Wire section of the device TRM. Table 4-12. HDQ / 1-Wire Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME hdq0 DESCRIPTION HDQ or 1-wire protocol single interface pin TYPE BALL IOD D18/ C23 4.4.10 Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART) NOTE ADVANCE INFORMATION For more information see the Serial Communication Interface / UART/IrDA/CIR section of the device TRM. Table 4-13. UART Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter 1 (UART1) uart1_dcdn UART1 Data Carrier Detect active low I D28 uart1_dsrn UART1 Data Set Ready Active Low I D26 uart1_dtrn UART1 Data Terminal Ready Active Low O D27 C28 uart1_rin UART1 Ring Indicator Input I uart1_rxd UART1 Receive Data Input I B27 uart1_txd UART1 Transmit Data Output O C26 uart1_ctsn UART1 clear to send active low I E25 uart1_rtsn UART1 request to send active low O C27 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter 2 (UART2) uart2_rxd UART2 Receive Data Input I D28 uart2_txd UART2 Transmit Data Output O D26 uart2_ctsn UART2 clear to send active low I D27 uart2_rtsn UART2 request to send active low O C28 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter 3 (UART3)/IrDA uart3_rxd UART3 Receive Data Input I V2/ AB3/ A26 uart3_txd UART3 Transmit Data Output O Y1/ AA4/ B22/ C28 uart3_ctsn UART3 clear to send active low I U4/ W9/ G17/ D28 uart3_rtsn UART3 request to send active low O V1/ V9/ D28/ B24 uart3_rctx Remote control data output O D28 uart3_sd Infrared transceiver configure/shutdown O D26 uart3_irrx Infrared data input. Also functions as uart3_rxd Receive Data Input when IrDA mode is not used. I D27 uart3_irtx Infrared data output O C28 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter 4 (UART4) uart4_rxd UART4 Receive Data Input I V7/ G16/ B21 uart4_txd UART4 Transmit Data Output O U7/ D17/ B20 uart4_ctsn UART4 clear to send active low I V6 uart4_rtsn UART4 request to send active low O U6 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter 5 (UART5) Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 109 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-13. UART Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL uart5_rxd DESCRIPTION UART5 Receive Data Input I R6/ F11/ B19/ AC7/ G17 uart5_txd UART5 Transmit Data Output O T9/ G10/ C17/ AC6/ B24 uart5_ctsn UART5 clear to send active low I T6 / AC9 uart5_rtsn UART5 request to send active low O T7 / AC3 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter 6 (UART6) uart6_rxd UART6 Receive Data Input I P6/ E8/ G12/ W7 uart6_txd UART6 Transmit Data Output O R9/ D9/ F12/ Y9 uart6_ctsn UART6 clear to send active low I R5 / G13 uart6_rtsn UART6 request to send active low O P5 / J11 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter 7 (UART7) ADVANCE INFORMATION uart7_rxd UART7 Receive Data Input I B18 / B7 / T6 uart7_txd UART7 Transmit Data Output O B8 / F15 / T7 uart7_ctsn UART7 clear to send active low I B19 uart7_rtsn UART7 request to send active low O C17 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter 8 (UART8) uart8_rxd UART8 Receive Data Input I C18 / G20 / R5 uart8_txd UART8 Transmit Data Output O A21 / G19 / P5 uart8_ctsn UART8 clear to send active low I G16 uart8_rtsn UART8 request to send active low O D17 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter 9 (UART9) uart9_rxd UART9 Receive Data Input I G1/ AA3/ E25 uart9_txd UART9 Transmit Data Output O G6/ AB9/ C27 uart9_ctsn UART9 clear to send active low I F2 / AB3 uart9_rtsn UART9 request to send active low O F3/ AA4 Universal Asynchronous Receiver/Transmitter 10 (UART10) uart10_rxd UART10 Receive Data Input I D1/ E21/ AC8/ D27 uart10_txd UART10 Transmit Data Output O E2/ F20/ AD6/ C28 uart10_ctsn UART10 clear to send active low I D2 / AB8 uart10_rtsn UART10 request to send active low O F4 / AB5 4.4.11 Multichannel Serial Peripheral Interface (McSPI) CAUTION The I/O timings provided in Section 7, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are applicable for all combinations of signals for SPI1 and SPI2. However, the timings are valid only for SPI3 and SPI4 if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETS are defined in Table 7-41. NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interface / Multichannel Serial Peripheral Interface (MCSPI) section of the device TRM. 110 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-14. SPI Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL Serial Peripheral Interface 1 spi1_sclk(1) SPI1 Clock I/O I/O A25 spi1_d1 SPI1 Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. I/O F16 spi1_d0 SPI1 Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. I/O B25 spi1_cs0 SPI1 Chip Select I/O I/O A24 spi1_cs1 SPI1 Chip Select I/O I/O A22 spi1_cs2 SPI1 Chip Select I/O I/O B21 spi1_cs3 SPI1 Chip Select I/O I/O B20 A26 spi2_sclk(1) SPI2 Clock I/O I/O spi2_d1 SPI2 Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. I/O B22 spi2_d0 SPI2 Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. I/O G17 spi2_cs0 SPI2 Chip Select I/O I/O B24 spi2_cs1 SPI2 Chip Select I/O I/O A22 spi2_cs2 SPI2 Chip Select I/O I/O B21 spi2_cs3 SPI2 Chip Select I/O I/O B20 SPI3 Clock I/O IO AC4 / B12 / C18 / E11 / V2 spi3_d1 SPI3 Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. IO A11 / A21 / AC7 / B10 / Y1 spi3_d0 SPI3 Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. IO AC6 / B13 / C11 / G16 / W9 spi3_cs0 SPI3 Chip Select I/O IO A12 / AC9 / D11 / D17 / V9 spi3_cs1 SPI3 Chip Select I/O IO AC3 / B11 / E14 spi3_cs2 SPI3 Chip Select I/O IO F11 spi3_cs3 SPI3 Chip Select I/O IO A10 SPI4 Clock I/O IO N7/ G1/ AA3/ V7/ AC8 spi4_d1 SPI4 Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. IO R4/ G6/ AB9/ U7/ AD6 spi4_d0 SPI4 Data I/O. Can be configured as either MISO or MOSI. IO N9/ F2/ AB3/ V6/ AB8 spi4_cs0 SPI4 Chip Select I/O IO P9/ F3/ AA4/ U6/ AB5 spi4_cs1 SPI4 Chip Select I/O IO P4 / Y1 spi4_cs2 SPI4 Chip Select I/O IO R3 / W9 spi4_cs3 SPI4 Chip Select I/O IO T2 / V9 Serial Peripheral Interface 3 spi3_sclk(1) Serial Peripheral Interface 4 spi4_sclk(1) (1) This clock signal is implemented as 'pad loopback' inside the device - the output signal is looped back through the input buffer to serve as the internal reference signal. Series termination is recommended (as close to device pin as possible) to improve signal integrity of the clock input. Any nonmonotonicity in voltage that occurs at the pad loopback clock pin between VIH and VIL must be less than VHYS. 4.4.12 Quad Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI) NOTE For more information see the Serial Communication Interface / Quad Serial Peripheral Interface section of the device TRM. Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 111 ADVANCE INFORMATION Serial Peripheral Interface 2 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-15. QSPI Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION qspi1_sclk QSPI1 Serial Clock Output qspi1_rtclk QSPI1 Return Clock Input. Must be connected from QSPI1_SCLK on PCB. Refer to PCB Guidelines for QSPI1 TYPE BALL IO R2 I R3 qspi1_d0 QSPI1 Data[0].This pin is output data for all commands/writes and for dual read and quad read modes it becomes input data pin during read phase. IO U1 qspi1_d1 QSPI1 Data[1].Input read data in all modes. IO P3 qspi1_d2 QSPI1 Data[2].This pin is used only in quad read mode as input data pin during read phase IO U2 qspi1_d3 QSPI1 Data[3].This pin is used only in quad read mode as input data pin during read phase IO T2 qspi1_cs0 QSPI1 Chip Select[0].This pin is Used for QSPI1 boot modes. O P2 qspi1_cs1 QSPI1 Chip Select[1] O P1 qspi1_cs2 QSPI1 Chip Select[2] O T7 qspi1_cs3 QSPI1 Chip Select[3] O P6 ADVANCE INFORMATION 4.4.13 Multichannel Audio Serial Port (McASP) NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interface / Multichannel Audio Serial Port (MCASP) section of the device TRM. Table 4-16. MCASP Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL G12 Multichannel Audio Serial Port 1 mcasp1_axr0 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O mcasp1_axr1 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O F12 mcasp1_axr2 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O G13 mcasp1_axr3 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O J11 mcasp1_axr4 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O D18/ E12 mcasp1_axr5 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O E17 / F13 mcasp1_axr6 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O B26 / C12 mcasp1_axr7 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O C23 / D12 mcasp1_axr8 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O E21 / B12 mcasp1_axr9 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O F20/ A11 mcasp1_axr10 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O F21 / B13 mcasp1_axr11 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O A12 mcasp1_axr12 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O E14 mcasp1_axr13 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O A13 mcasp1_axr14 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O G14 mcasp1_axr15 MCASP1 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O F14 mcasp1_fsx MCASP1 Transmit Frame Sync I/O I/O D14 MCASP1 Receive Bit Clock I/O I/O B14 MCASP1 Receive Frame Sync I/O I/O J14 mcasp1_ahclkx MCASP1 Transmit High-Frequency Master Clock I/O O D18 mcasp1_aclkx(1) MCASP1 Transmit Bit Clock I/O I/O C14 mcasp1_aclkr(1) mcasp1_fsr Multichannel Audio Serial Port 2 112 mcasp2_axr0 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O B15 mcasp2_axr1 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O A15 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL mcasp2_axr2 DESCRIPTION MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O C15 mcasp2_axr3 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O A16 mcasp2_axr4 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O D15 mcasp2_axr5 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O B16 mcasp2_axr6 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O B17 mcasp2_axr7 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O A17 mcasp2_axr8 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O D18 E17 mcasp2_axr9 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O mcasp2_axr10 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O B26 mcasp2_axr11 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O C23 mcasp2_axr12 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O B18 mcasp2_axr13 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O F15 mcasp2_axr14 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O B19 mcasp2_axr15 MCASP2 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O C17 mcasp2_fsx MCASP2 Transmit Frame Sync I/O I/O A18 MCASP2 Receive Bit Clock I/O I/O E15 MCASP2 Receive Frame Sync I/O I/O A20 mcasp2_aclkr(1) mcasp2_fsr mcasp2_ahclkx MCASP2 Transmit High-Frequency Master Clock I/O O E17 mcasp2_aclkx(1) MCASP2 Transmit Bit Clock I/O I/O A19 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 4-16. MCASP Signal Descriptions (continued) Multichannel Audio Serial Port 3 mcasp3_axr0 MCASP3 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O B19 mcasp3_axr1 MCASP3 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O C17 mcasp3_axr2 MCASP3 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O C15 mcasp3_axr3 MCASP3 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O A16 mcasp3_fsx MCASP3 Transmit Frame Sync I/O I/O F15 mcasp3_ahclkx MCASP3 Transmit High-Frequency Master Clock I/O O B26 mcasp3_aclkx(1) MCASP3 Transmit Bit Clock I/O I/O B18 MCASP3 Receive Bit Clock I/O I/O B18 MCASP3 Receive Frame Sync I/O I/O F15 (1) mcasp3_aclkr mcasp3_fsr Multichannel Audio Serial Port 4 mcasp4_axr0 MCASP4 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O G16 mcasp4_axr1 MCASP4 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O D17 mcasp4_axr2 MCASP4 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O E12 mcasp4_axr3 MCASP4 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O F13 mcasp4_fsx MCASP4 Transmit Frame Sync I/O I/O A21 mcasp4_ahclkx MCASP4 Transmit High-Frequency Master Clock I/O O C23 mcasp4_aclkx(1) MCASP4 Transmit Bit Clock I/O I/O C18 MCASP4 Receive Bit Clock I/O I/O C18 MCASP4 Receive Frame Sync I/O I/O A21 (1) mcasp4_aclkr mcasp4_fsr Multichannel Audio Serial Port 5 mcasp5_axr0 MCASP5 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O AB3 mcasp5_axr1 MCASP5 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O AA4 mcasp5_axr2 MCASP5 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O C12 mcasp5_axr3 MCASP5 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O D12 mcasp5_fsx AB9 MCASP5 Transmit Frame Sync I/O I/O mcasp5_ahclkx MCASP5 Transmit High-Frequency Master Clock I/O O D18 mcasp5_aclkx(1) MCASP5 Transmit Bit Clock I/O I/O AA3 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 113 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-16. MCASP Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL mcasp5_aclkr(1) MCASP5 Receive Bit Clock I/O I/O AA3 MCASP5 Receive Frame Sync I/O I/O AB9 B12 mcasp5_fsr Multichannel Audio Serial Port 6 mcasp6_axr0 MCASP6 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O mcasp6_axr1 MCASP6 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O A11 mcasp6_axr2 MCASP6 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O G13 mcasp6_axr3 MCASP6 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O J11 mcasp6_ahclkx MCASP6 Transmit High-Frequency Master Clock I/O O E17 mcasp6_aclkx(1) MCASP6 Transmit Bit Clock I/O I/O B13 MCASP6 Transmit Frame Sync I/O I/O A12 MCASP6 Receive Bit Clock I/O I/O B13 MCASP6 Receive Frame Sync I/O I/O A12 mcasp6_fsx mcasp6_aclkr(1) mcasp6_fsr Multichannel Audio Serial Port 7 ADVANCE INFORMATION mcasp7_axr0 MCASP7 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O E14 mcasp7_axr1 MCASP7 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O A13 mcasp7_axr2 MCASP7 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O B14 mcasp7_axr3 MCASP7 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O J14 mcasp7_ahclkx MCASP7 Transmit High-Frequency Master Clock I/O O B26 mcasp7_aclkx(1) MCASP7 Transmit Bit Clock I/O I/O G14 MCASP7 Transmit Frame Sync I/O I/O F14 MCASP7 Receive Bit Clock I/O I/O G14 MCASP7 Receive Frame Sync I/O I/O F14 mcasp7_fsx mcasp7_aclkr(1) mcasp7_fsr Multichannel Audio Serial Port 8 mcasp8_axr0 MCASP8 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O D15 mcasp8_axr1 MCASP8 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O B16 mcasp8_axr2 MCASP8 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O E15 mcasp8_axr3 MCASP8 Transmit/Receive Data I/O I/O A20 mcasp8_ahclkx MCASP8 Transmit High-Frequency Master Clock I/O O C23 mcasp8_aclkx(1) MCASP8 Transmit Bit Clock I/O I/O B17 MCASP8 Transmit Frame Sync I/O I/O A17 MCASP8 Receive Bit Clock I/O I/O B17 MCASP8 Receive Frame Sync I/O I/O A17 mcasp8_fsx mcasp8_aclkr(1) mcasp8_fsr (1) This clock signal is implemented as 'pad loopback' inside the device - the output signal is looped back through the input buffer to serve as the internal reference signal. Series termination is recommended (as close to device pin as possible) to improve signal integrity of the clock input. Any nonmonotonicity in voltage that occurs at the pad loopback clock pin between VIH and VIL must be less than VHYS. 4.4.14 Universal Serial Bus (USB) NOTE For more information, see: Serial Communication Interface / SuperSpeed USB DRD Subsystem section of the device TRM. Table 4-17. Universal Serial Bus Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL usb1_dp USB1 USB2.0 differential signal pair (positive) IODS AD12 usb1_dm USB1 USB2.0 differential signal pair (negative) IODS AC12 O AB10 Universal Serial Bus 1 usb1_drvvbus 114 USB1 Drive VBUS signal Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-17. Universal Serial Bus Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION usb_rxn0(1) USB1 USB3.0 receiver negative lane (1) TYPE BALL IDS AF12 usb_rxp0 USB1 USB3.0 receiver positive lane IDS AE12 usb_txn0(1) USB1 USB3.0 transmitter negative lane ODS AC11 usb_txp0(1) USB1 USB3.0 transmitter positive lane ODS AD11 usb2_dp USB2 USB2.0 differential signal pair (positive) IODS AE11 usb2_dm USB2 USB2.0 differential signal pair (negative) IODS AF11 O AC10 Universal Serial Bus 2 usb2_drvvbus USB2 Drive VBUS signal (1) Signals are enabled by selecting the correct field in the PCIE_B1C0_MODE_SEL register. There are no CTRL_CORE_PAD* register involved. 4.4.15 SATA NOTE ADVANCE INFORMATION For more information, see the Serial Communication Interfaces / SATA section of the device TRM. Table 4-18. SATA Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL sata1_rxn0 SATA differential negative receiver lane 0 IDS AH9 sata1_rxp0 SATA differential positive receiver lane 0 IDS AG9 sata1_txn0 SATA differential negative transmitter lane 0 ODS AG10 sata1_txp0 SATA differential positive transmitter lane 0 ODS AH10 sata1_led SATA channel activity indicator O A22 / G19 4.4.16 Peripheral Component Interconnect Express (PCIe) NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interfaces / PCIe Controllers and the Shared PHY Component Subsystems / PCIe Shared PHY Susbsytem sections of the device TRM. Table 4-19. PCIe Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL pcie_rxn0 DESCRIPTION PCIe1_PHY_RX Receive Data Lane 0 (negative) - mapped to PCIe_SS1 only. IOS AG13 pcie_rxp0 PCIe1_PHY_RX Receive Data Lane 0 (positive) - mapped to PCIe_SS1 only. IOS AH13 pcie_txn0 PCIe1_PHY_TX Transmit Data Lane 0 (negative) - mapped to PCIe_SS1 only. ODS AG14 pcie_txp0 PCIe1_PHY_TX Transmit Data Lane 0 (positive) - mapped to PCIe_SS1 only. ODS AH14 pcie_rxn1 PCIe2_PHY_RX Receive Data Lane 1 (negative) - mapped to either PCIe_SS1 (dual lane- mode) or PCIe_SS2 (single lane- mode) IOS AF12 pcie_rxp1 PCIe2_PHY_RX Receive Data Lane 1 (positive) - mapped to either PCIe_SS1 (dual lane- mode) or PCIe_SS2 (single lane- mode) IOS AE12 pcie_txn1 PCIe2_PHY_TX Transmit Data Lane 1 (negative) - mapped to either PCIe_SS1 (dual lane- mode) or PCIe_SS2 (single lane- mode) ODS AC11 pcie_txp1 PCIe2_PHY_TX Transmit Data Lane 1 (positive) - mapped to either PCIe_SS1 (dual lane- mode) or PCIe_SS2 (single lane- mode) ODS AH14 ljcb_clkp PCIe1_PHY / PCIe2_PHY shared Reference Clock Input / Output Differential Pair (positive) IODS AG15 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 115 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-19. PCIe Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME ljcb_clkn DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL PCIe1_PHY / PCIe2_PHY shared Reference Clock Input / Output Differential Pair (negative) IODS AH15 4.4.17 Controller Area Network Interface (DCAN) NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interface / DCAN section of the device TRM. Table 4-20. DCAN Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL DCAN 1 ADVANCE INFORMATION dcan1_tx DCAN1 transmit data pin I/O G20 dcan1_rx DCAN1 receive data pin I/O G19 / AD17 dcan2_tx DCAN2 transmit data pin I/O E21/ B21 dcan2_rx DCAN2 receive data pin I/O F20/ B20/ AC16 DCAN 2 4.4.18 Ethernet Interface (GMAC_SW) CAUTION The I/O timings provided in Section 7, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are valid only if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 7-68, Table 7-71, Table 7-76 and Table 7-83. NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interfaces / Ethernet Controller section of the device TRM. Table 4-21. GMAC Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL rgmii0_txc RGMII0 Transmit Clock O W9 rgmii0_txctl RGMII0 Transmit Enable O V9 rgmii0_txd3 RGMII0 Transmit Data O V7 rgmii0_txd2 RGMII0 Transmit Data O U7 rgmii0_txd1 RGMII0 Transmit Data O V6 rgmii0_txd0 RGMII0 Transmit Data O U6 rgmii0_rxc RGMII0 Receive Clock I U5 rgmii0_rxctl RGMII0 Receive Control I V5 rgmii0_rxd3 RGMII0 Receive Data I V4 rgmii0_rxd2 RGMII0 Receive Data I V3 rgmii0_rxd1 RGMII0 Receive Data I Y2 rgmii0_rxd0 RGMII0 Receive Data I W2 RGMII1 Transmit Clock O D5 rgmii1_txc 116 DESCRIPTION Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL rgmii1_txctl DESCRIPTION RGMII1 Transmit Enable O C2 rgmii1_txd3 RGMII1 Transmit Data O C3 rgmii1_txd2 RGMII1 Transmit Data O C4 rgmii1_txd1 RGMII1 Transmit Data O B2 rgmii1_txd0 RGMII1 Transmit Data O D6 rgmii1_rxc RGMII1 Receive Clock I C5 rgmii1_rxctl RGMII1 Receive Control I A3 rgmii1_rxd3 RGMII1Receive Data I B3 rgmii1_rxd2 RGMII1 Receive Data I B4 rgmii1_rxd1 RGMII1 Receive Data I B5 rgmii1_rxd0 RGMII1 Receive Data I A4 mii1_rxd1 MII1 Receive Data I C1 mii1_rxd2 MII1 Receive Data I E4 mii1_rxd3 MII1 Receive Data I F5 mii1_rxd0 MII1 Receive Data I E6 mii1_rxclk MII1 Receive Clock I D5 mii1_rxdv MII1 Receive Data Valid input I C2 mii1_txclk MII1 Transmit Clock I C3 mii1_txd0 MII1 Transmit Data O C4 mii1_txd1 MII1 Transmit Data O B2 mii1_txd2 MII1 Transmit Data O D6 mii1_txd3 MII1 Transmit Data O C5 mii1_txer MII1 Transmit Error I A3 mii1_rxer MII1 Receive Data Error input I B3 mii1_col MII1 Collision Detect (Sense) input I B4 mii1_crs MII1 Carrier Sense input I B5 mii1_txen MII1 Transmit Data Enable Output O A4 mii0_rxd1 MII0 Receive Data I V6 mii0_rxd2 MII0 Receive Data I V9 mii0_rxd3 MII0 Receive Data I W9 mii0_rxd0 MII0 Receive Data I U6 mii0_rxclk MII0 Receive Clock I Y1 mii0_rxdv MII0 Receive Data Valid input I V2 mii0_txclk MII0 Transmit Clock I U5 mii0_txd0 MII0 Transmit Data O W2 mii0_txd1 MII0 Transmit Data O Y2 mii0_txd2 MII0 Transmit Data O V4 mii0_txd3 MII0 Transmit Data O V5 mii0_txer MII0 Transmit Error I U4 mii0_rxer MII0 Receive Data Error input I U7 mii0_col MII0 Collision Detect (Sense) input I V1 mii0_crs MII0 Carrier Sense input I V7 mii0_txen MII0 Transmit Data Enable Output O V3 rmii1_crs RMII1 Carrier Sense input I V2 rmii1_rxer RMII1 Receive Data Error input I Y1 rmii1_rxd1 RMII1 Receive Data I W9 rmii1_rxd0 RMII1 Receive Data I V9 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 4-21. GMAC Signal Descriptions (continued) 117 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-21. GMAC Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL rmii1_txen DESCRIPTION RMII1 Transmit Data Enable output O U5 rmii1_txd1 RMII1 Transmit Data O V5 rmii1_txd0 RMII1 Transmit Data O V4 rmii0_crs RMII0 Carrier Sense input I V7 U7 rmii0_rxer RMII0 Receive Data Error input I rmii0_rxd1 RMII0 Receive Data I V6 rmii0_rxd0 RMII0 Receive Data I U6 rmii0_txen RMII0 Transmit Data Enable output O V3 rmii0_txd1 RMII0 Transmit Data O Y2 rmii0_txd0 RMII0 Transmit Data O W2 mdio_mclk Management Data Serial Clock output O AC5 / V1 / B21 / D3 Management Data I/O IO AB4 / U4 / B20 / F6 mdio_d 4.4.19 Media Local Bus (MLB) Interface ADVANCE INFORMATION NOTE Media Local Bus (MLB) is not available on this device, and must be left unconnected. Table 4-22. MLB Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL mlbp_sig_p Media Local Bus Subsystem (MLBSS) signal input and output differential pair (positive) IODS AC1 mlbp_sig_n Media Local Bus Subsystem (MLBSS) signal input and output differential pair (negative) IODS AC2 mlbp_dat_p Media Local Bus Subsystem (MLBSS) data input and output differential pair (positive) IODS AA1 mlbp_dat_n Media Local Bus Subsystem (MLBSS) data input and output differential pair (negative) IODS AA2 mlbp_clk_p Media Local Bus Subsystem (MLBSS) clock input differential pair (positive) IOS AB1 mlbp_clk_n Media Local Bus Subsystem (MLBSS) clock input differential pair (negative) IOS AB2 TYPE BALL W6 4.4.20 eMMC/SD/SDIO NOTE For more information, see the HS MMC/SDIO section of the device TRM. Table 4-23. eMMC/SD/SDIO Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION Multi Media Card 1 118 mmc1_clk(1) MMC1 clock I/O mmc1_cmd MMC1 command I/O Y6 mmc1_sdcd MMC1 Card Detect I W7 mmc1_sdwp MMC1 Write Protect I Y9 mmc1_dat0 MMC1 data bit 0 I/O AA6 mmc1_dat1 MMC1 data bit 1 I/O Y4 mmc1_dat2 MMC1 data bit 2 I/O AA5 mmc1_dat3 MMC1 data bit 3 I/O Y3 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-23. eMMC/SD/SDIO Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL Multi Media Card 2 mmc2_clk(1) MMC2 clock I/O J7 mmc2_cmd MMC2 command I/O H6 mmc2_sdcd MMC2 Card Detect I G20 mmc2_sdwp MMC2 Write Protect I G19 mmc2_dat0 MMC2 data bit 0 I/O J4 mmc2_dat1 MMC2 data bit 1 I/O J6 mmc2_dat2 MMC2 data bit 2 I/O H4 mmc2_dat3 MMC2 data bit 3 I/O H5 mmc2_dat4 MMC2 data bit 4 I/O K7 mmc2_dat5 MMC2 data bit 5 I/O M7 mmc2_dat6 MMC2 data bit 6 I/O J5 mmc2_dat7 MMC2 data bit 7 I/O K6 mmc3_clk(1) MMC3 clock I/O AD4 mmc3_cmd MMC3 command I/O AC4 mmc3_sdcd MMC3 Card Detect I B21 mmc3_sdwp MMC3 Write Protect I B20 mmc3_dat0 MMC3 data bit 0 I/O AC7 mmc3_dat1 MMC3 data bit 1 I/O AC6 mmc3_dat2 MMC3 data bit 2 I/O AC9 mmc3_dat3 MMC3 data bit 3 I/O AC3 mmc3_dat4 MMC3 data bit 4 I/O AC8 mmc3_dat5 MMC3 data bit 5 I/O AD6 mmc3_dat6 MMC3 data bit 6 I/O AB8 mmc3_dat7 MMC3 data bit 7 I/O AB5 mmc4_clk(1) MMC4 clock I/O E25 mmc4_cmd MMC4 command I/O C27 ADVANCE INFORMATION Multi Media Card 3 Multi Media Card 4 mmc4_sdcd MMC4 Card Detect I B27 mmc4_sdwp MMC4 Write Protect I C26 mmc4_dat0 MMC4 data bit 0 I/O D28 mmc4_dat1 MMC4 data bit 1 I/O D26 mmc4_dat2 MMC4 data bit 2 I/O D27 mmc4_dat3 MMC4 data bit 3 I/O C28 (1) By default, this clock signal is implemented as 'pad loopback' inside the device - the output signal is looped back through the input buffer to serve as the internal reference signal. mmc1_clk and mmc2_clk have an optional software programmable setting to use an 'internal loopback clock' instead of the default 'pad loopback clock'. If the 'pad loopback clock' is used, series termination is recommended (as close to device pin as possible) to improve signal integrity of the clock input. Any nonmonotonicity in voltage that occurs at the pad loopback clock pin between VIH and VIL must be less than VHYS. 4.4.21 General-Purpose Interface (GPIO) NOTE For more information, see the General-Purpose Interface section of the device TRM. Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 119 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-24. GPIOs Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL GPIO 1 ADVANCE INFORMATION gpio1_0 General-Purpose Input I AD17 gpio1_3 General-Purpose Input I AC16 gpio1_4 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D15 gpio1_5 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A17 gpio1_6 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O M6 gpio1_7 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O M2 gpio1_8 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O L5 gpio1_9 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O M1 gpio1_10 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O L6 gpio1_11 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O L4 gpio1_12 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O L3 gpio1_13 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O L2 gpio1_14 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G20 gpio1_15 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G19 gpio1_16 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D27 gpio1_17 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C28 gpio1_18 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H1 gpio1_19 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J3 gpio1_20 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H2 gpio1_21 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H3 gpio1_22 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC8 gpio1_23 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AD6 gpio1_24 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AB8 gpio1_25 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AB5 gpio1_26 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O P6 gpio1_27 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O R9 gpio1_28 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O R5 gpio1_29 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O P5 gpio1_30 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O N7 gpio1_31 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O R4 gpio2_0 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O N9 gpio2_1 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O P9 gpio2_2 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O P4 gpio2_3 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O R3 gpio2_4 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O T2 gpio2_5 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O U2 gpio2_6 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O U1 gpio2_7 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O P3 gpio2_8 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O R2 GPIO 2 120 gpio2_9 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O K7 gpio2_10 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O M7 gpio2_11 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J5 gpio2_12 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O K6 gpio2_13 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J7 gpio2_14 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J4 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL gpio2_15 DESCRIPTION General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J6 gpio2_16 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H4 gpio2_17 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H5 gpio2_18 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H6 gpio2_19 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O T1 gpio2_20 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O P2 gpio2_21 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O P1 gpio2_22 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O P7 gpio2_23 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O N1 gpio2_24 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O M5 gpio2_25 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O M3 gpio2_26 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O N6 gpio2_27 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O M4 gpio2_28 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O N2 gpio2_29 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B17 gpio3_28 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E1 gpio3_29 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G2 gpio3_30 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O H7 gpio3_31 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G1 gpio4_0 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G6 gpio4_1 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F2 gpio4_2 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F3 gpio4_3 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D1 gpio4_4 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E2 gpio4_5 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D2 gpio4_6 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F4 gpio4_7 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C1 gpio4_8 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E4 gpio4_9 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F5 gpio4_10 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E6 gpio4_11 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D3 gpio4_12 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F6 gpio4_13 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D5 gpio4_14 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C2 gpio4_15 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C3 gpio4_16 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C4 gpio4_17 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A12 gpio4_18 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E14 gpio4_19 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D11 gpio4_20 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B10 gpio4_21 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B11 gpio4_22 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C11 gpio4_23 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E11 gpio4_24 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B2 gpio4_25 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D6 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 4-24. GPIOs Signal Descriptions (continued) GPIO 3 GPIO 4 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 121 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-24. GPIOs Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL gpio4_26 DESCRIPTION General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C5 gpio4_27 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A3 gpio4_28 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B3 gpio4_29 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B4 gpio4_30 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B5 gpio4_31 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A4 gpio5_0 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B14 gpio5_1 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J14 gpio5_2 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G12 gpio5_3 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F12 gpio5_4 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G13 gpio5_5 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J11 gpio5_6 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E12 gpio5_7 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F13 gpio5_8 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C12 gpio5_9 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D12 gpio5_10 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B12 gpio5_11 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A11 gpio5_12 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B13 gpio5_13 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B18 gpio5_14 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F15 gpio5_15 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O V1 gpio5_16 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O U4 gpio5_17 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O U3 gpio5_18 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O V2 gpio5_19 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O Y1 gpio5_20 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O W9 gpio5_21 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O V9 gpio5_22 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O V7 gpio5_23 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O U7 gpio5_24 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O V6 gpio5_25 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O U6 gpio5_26 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O U5 gpio5_27 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O V5 gpio5_28 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O V4 gpio5_29 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O V3 gpio5_30 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O Y2 gpio5_31 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O W2 gpio6_4 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A13 gpio6_5 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G14 gpio6_6 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F14 gpio6_7 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B16 gpio6_8 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C15 gpio6_9 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A16 gpio6_10 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC5 GPIO 5 ADVANCE INFORMATION GPIO 6 122 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL gpio6_11 DESCRIPTION General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AB4 gpio6_12 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AB10 gpio6_13 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC10 gpio6_14 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E21 gpio6_15 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F20 gpio6_16 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F21 gpio6_17 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D18 gpio6_18 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E17 gpio6_19 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B26 gpio6_20 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C23 gpio6_21 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O W6 gpio6_22 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O Y6 gpio6_23 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AA6 gpio6_24 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O Y4 gpio6_25 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AA5 gpio6_26 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O Y3 gpio6_27 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O W7 gpio6_28 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O Y9 gpio6_29 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AD4 gpio6_30 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC4 gpio6_31 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC7 gpio7_0 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC6 gpio7_1 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC9 gpio7_2 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O AC3 gpio7_3 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O R6 gpio7_4 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O T9 gpio7_5 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O T6 gpio7_6 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O T7 gpio7_7 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A25 gpio7_8 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F16 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 4-24. GPIOs Signal Descriptions (continued) GPIO 7 gpio7_9 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B25 gpio7_10 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A24 gpio7_11 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A22 gpio7_12 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B21 gpio7_13 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B20 gpio7_14 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A26 gpio7_15 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B22 gpio7_16 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G17 gpio7_17 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B24 gpio7_18 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O L1 gpio7_19 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O K2 gpio7_22 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B27 gpio7_23 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C26 gpio7_24 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E25 gpio7_25 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C27 gpio7_26 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D28 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 123 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-24. GPIOs Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL gpio7_27 DESCRIPTION General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D26 gpio7_28 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J1 gpio7_29 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O J2 gpio7_30 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D14 gpio7_31 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C14 gpio8_0 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F11 gpio8_1 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G10 gpio8_2 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F10 gpio8_3 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G11 gpio8_4 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E9 gpio8_5 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F9 gpio8_6 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F8 gpio8_7 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E7 gpio8_8 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E8 gpio8_9 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D9 gpio8_10 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D7 gpio8_11 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D8 gpio8_12 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A5 gpio8_13 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C6 gpio8_14 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C8 gpio8_15 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C7 gpio8_16 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B7 gpio8_17 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B8 gpio8_18 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A7 gpio8_19 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A8 gpio8_20 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O C9 gpio8_21 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A9 gpio8_22 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O B9 gpio8_23 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O A10 gpio8_27 General-Purpose Input I D23 gpio8_28 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O F19 gpio8_29 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O E18 gpio8_30 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O G21 gpio8_31 General-Purpose Input/Output (I/O) I/O D24 GPIO 8 ADVANCE INFORMATION 4.4.22 Keyboard controller (KBD) NOTE For more information, see Keyboard Controller section of the device TRM. Table 4-25. Keyboard Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME 124 DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL kbd_row0 Keypad row 0 I E1 kbd_row1 Keypad row 1 I G2 kbd_row2 Keypad row 2 I G1 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL kbd_row3 DESCRIPTION Keypad row 3 I G6 kbd_row4 Keypad row 4 I F2 kbd_row5 Keypad row 5 I F3 kbd_row6 Keypad row 6 I D1 kbd_row7 Keypad row 7 I F6 kbd_row8 Keypad row 8 I C2 kbd_col0 Keypad column 0 O E2 kbd_col1 Keypad column 1 O D2 kbd_col2 Keypad column 2 O F4 kbd_col3 Keypad column 3 O C1 kbd_col4 Keypad column 4 O E4 kbd_col5 Keypad column 5 O F5 kbd_col6 Keypad column 6 O E6 kbd_col7 Keypad column 7 O D3 kbd_col8 Keypad column 8 O D5 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 4-25. Keyboard Signal Descriptions (continued) 4.4.23 Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) Interface NOTE For more information, see the Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) SS section of the device TRM. Table 4-26. PWM Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL PWMSS1 eQEP1A_in EQEP1 Quadrature Input A I E1 eQEP1B_in EQEP1 Quadrature Input B I G2 eQEP1_index EQEP1 Index Input IO H7 eQEP1_strobe EQEP1 Strobe Input IO G1 ehrpwm1A EHRPWM1 Output A O G6 ehrpwm1B EHRPWM1 Output B O F2 EHRPWM1 Trip Zone Input IO F3 IO D1 ehrpwm1_tripzone_in put eCAP1_in_PWM1_out ECAP1 Capture Iniput / PWM Output ehrpwm1_synci EHRPWM1 Sync Input I E2 ehrpwm1_synco EHRPWM1 Sync Output O D2 eQEP2A_in EQEP2 Quadrature Input A I F4 eQEP2B_in EQEP2 Quadrature Input B I C1 E4 PWMSS2 eQEP2_index EQEP2 Index Input IO eQEP2_strobe EQEP2 Strobe Input IO F5 ehrpwm2A EHRPWM2 Output A O AC5 / E6 ehrpwm2B EHRPWM2 Output B O AB4 / D3 EHRPWM2 Trip Zone Input IO AD4 / F6 IO AC4 / D5 I AC7 / C2 ehrpwm2_tripzone_in put eCAP2_in_PWM2_out ECAP2 Capture Iniput / PWM Output PWMSS3 eQEP3A_in EQEP3 Quadrature Input A Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 125 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-26. PWM Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION eQEP3B_in EQEP3 Quadrature Input B TYPE BALL I AC6 / C3 AC9 / C4 eQEP3_index EQEP3 Index Input IO eQEP3_strobe EQEP3 Strobe Input IO AC3 / B2 ehrpwm3A EHRPWM3 Output A O AC8 / D6 ehrpwm3B EHRPWM3 Output B O AD6 / C5 EHRPWM3 Trip Zone Input IO AB8 / A3 IO AB5 / B3 ehrpwm3_tripzone_in put eCAP3_in_PWM3_out ECAP3 Capture Iniput / PWM Output 4.4.24 Programmable Real-Time Unit Subsystem and Industrial Communication Subsystem (PRU-ICSS) CAUTION ADVANCE INFORMATION The I/O timings provided in Section 7, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are valid only if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in the Table 7-150 and Table 7-151. NOTE For more information see the Programmable Real-Time Unit Subsystem and Industrial Communication Subsystem section of the device TRM. Table 4-27. PRU-ICSS Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL BOTTOM PRU-ICSS 1 126 pr1_pru1_gpi0 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I E2 pr1_pru1_gpi1 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I D2 pr1_pru1_gpi10 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I C2 pr1_pru1_gpi11 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I C3 pr1_pru1_gpi12 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I C4 pr1_pru1_gpi13 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I B2 pr1_pru1_gpi14 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I D6 pr1_pru1_gpi15 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I C5 pr1_pru1_gpi16 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I A3 pr1_pru1_gpi17 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I B3 pr1_pru1_gpi18 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I B4 pr1_pru1_gpi19 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I B5 pr1_pru1_gpi2 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I F4 pr1_pru1_gpi20 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I A4 pr1_pru1_gpi3 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I C1 pr1_pru1_gpi4 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I E4 pr1_pru1_gpi5 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I F5 pr1_pru1_gpi6 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I E6 pr1_pru1_gpi7 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I D3 pr1_pru1_gpi8 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I F6 pr1_pru1_gpi9 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I D5 pr1_pru1_gpo0 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O E2 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-27. PRU-ICSS Signal Descriptions (continued) DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL BOTTOM pr1_pru1_gpo1 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O D2 pr1_pru1_gpo10 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O C2 pr1_pru1_gpo11 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O C3 pr1_pru1_gpo12 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O C4 pr1_pru1_gpo13 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O B2 pr1_pru1_gpo14 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O D6 pr1_pru1_gpo15 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O C5 pr1_pru1_gpo16 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O A3 pr1_pru1_gpo17 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O B3 pr1_pru1_gpo18 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O B4 pr1_pru1_gpo19 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O B5 pr1_pru1_gpo2 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O F4 pr1_pru1_gpo20 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O A4 pr1_pru1_gpo3 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O C1 pr1_pru1_gpo4 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O E4 pr1_pru1_gpo5 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O F5 pr1_pru1_gpo6 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O E6 pr1_pru1_gpo7 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O D3 pr1_pru1_gpo8 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O F6 pr1_pru1_gpo9 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O D5 pr1_edc_latch0_in Latch Input 0 I E2 pr1_edc_sync0_out SYNC 0 Output O D2 pr1_edio_data_in0 Ethernet Digital Input I E1 pr1_edio_data_in1 Ethernet Digital Input I G2 pr1_edio_data_in2 Ethernet Digital Input I H7 pr1_edio_data_in3 Ethernet Digital Input I G1 pr1_edio_data_in4 Ethernet Digital Input I G6 pr1_edio_data_in5 Ethernet Digital Input I F2 pr1_edio_data_in6 Ethernet Digital Input I F3 pr1_edio_data_in7 Ethernet Digital Input I D1 pr1_edio_data_out0 Ethernet Digital Output O E1 pr1_edio_data_out1 Ethernet Digital Output O G2 pr1_edio_data_out2 Ethernet Digital Output O H7 pr1_edio_data_out3 Ethernet Digital Output O G1 pr1_edio_data_out4 Ethernet Digital Output O G6 pr1_edio_data_out5 Ethernet Digital Output O F2 pr1_edio_data_out6 Ethernet Digital Output O F3 pr1_edio_data_out7 Ethernet Digital Output O D1 Start Of Frame O F4 pr1_mdio_data MDIO Data IO F6 pr1_mdio_mdclk MDIO Clock O D3 V1 pr1_edio_sof pr1_mii0_col MII0 Collision Detect I pr1_mii0_crs MII0 Carrier Sense I V7 pr1_mii0_rxd0 MII0 Receive Data I U6 pr1_mii0_rxd1 MII0 Receive Data I V6 pr1_mii0_rxd2 MII0 Receive Data I V9 pr1_mii0_rxd3 MII0 Receive Data I W9 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION SIGNAL NAME 127 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-27. PRU-ICSS Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL BOTTOM pr1_mii0_rxdv MII0 Data Valid I V2 U7 pr1_mii0_rxer MII0 Receive Error I pr1_mii0_rxlink MII0 Receive Link I U4 pr1_mii0_txd0 MII0 Transmit Data O W2 pr1_mii0_txd1 MII0 Transmit Data O Y2 pr1_mii0_txd2 MII0 Transmit Data O V4 pr1_mii0_txd3 MII0 Transmit Data O V5 pr1_mii0_txen V3 MII0 Transmit Enable O pr1_mii_mr0_clk MII0 Receive Clock I Y1 pr1_mii_mt0_clk MII0 Transmit Clock I U5 pr1_mii1_col MII1 Collision Detect I B5 A4 ADVANCE INFORMATION pr1_mii1_crs MII1 Carrier Sense I pr1_mii1_rxd0 MII1 Receive Data I A3 pr1_mii1_rxd1 MII1 Receive Data I C5 pr1_mii1_rxd2 MII1 Receive Data I D6 pr1_mii1_rxd3 MII1 Receive Data I B2 pr1_mii1_rxdv MII1 Data Valid I C4 B3 pr1_mii1_rxer MII1 Receive Error I pr1_mii1_rxlink MII1 Receive Link I B4 pr1_mii1_txd0 MII1 Transmit Data O C2 pr1_mii1_txd1 MII1 Transmit Data O D5 pr1_mii1_txd2 MII1 Transmit Data O E6 pr1_mii1_txd3 MII1 Transmit Data O F5 pr1_mii1_txen MII1 Transmit Enable O E4 pr1_mii_mr1_clk MII1 Receive Clock I C3 pr1_mii_mt1_clk MII1 Transmit Clock I C1 pr1_uart0_cts_n UART Clear-To-Send I F11, G1 pr1_uart0_rts_n G10, G6 UART Ready-To-Send O pr1_uart0_rxd UART Receive Data I F10, F2 pr1_uart0_txd UART Transmit Data O F3, G11 IO D1, E9 AC5, G11 pr1_ecap0_ecap_capin_apwm_ Capture Input / PWM output o PRU-ICSS 2 128 pr2_pru0_gpi0 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I pr2_pru0_gpi1 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I AB4, E9 pr2_pru0_gpi10 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I AB8, C6 pr2_pru0_gpi11 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I AB5, C8 pr2_pru0_gpi12 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I B18, C7 pr2_pru0_gpi13 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I B7, F15 pr2_pru0_gpi14 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I B19, B8 pr2_pru0_gpi15 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I A7, C17 pr2_pru0_gpi16 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I A8, C15 pr2_pru0_gpi17 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I A16, C9 pr2_pru0_gpi18 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I A19, A9 pr2_pru0_gpi19 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I A18, B9 pr2_pru0_gpi2 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I AD4, F9 pr2_pru0_gpi20 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I A10, F14 pr2_pru0_gpi3 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I AC4, F8 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-27. PRU-ICSS Signal Descriptions (continued) DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL BOTTOM pr2_pru0_gpi4 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I AC7, E7 pr2_pru0_gpi5 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I AC6, E8 pr2_pru0_gpi6 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I AC9, D9 pr2_pru0_gpi7 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I AC3, D7 pr2_pru0_gpi8 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I AC8, D8 pr2_pru0_gpi9 PRU0 General-Purpose Input I A5, AD6 pr2_pru1_gpi0 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I D17, V1 pr2_pru1_gpi1 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I AA3, U4 pr2_pru1_gpi10 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I B12, U6 pr2_pru1_gpi11 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I A11, U5 pr2_pru1_gpi12 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I B13, V5 pr2_pru1_gpi13 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I A12, V4 pr2_pru1_gpi14 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I E14, V3 pr2_pru1_gpi15 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I A13, Y2 pr2_pru1_gpi16 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I G14, W2 pr2_pru1_gpi17 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I E11 pr2_pru1_gpi18 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I F11 pr2_pru1_gpi19 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I G10 pr2_pru1_gpi2 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I AB9, U3 pr2_pru1_gpi20 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I F10 pr2_pru1_gpi3 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I AB3, V2 pr2_pru1_gpi4 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I AA4, Y1 pr2_pru1_gpi5 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I D18, W9 pr2_pru1_gpi6 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I E17, V9 pr2_pru1_gpi7 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I C14, V7 pr2_pru1_gpi8 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I G12, U7 pr2_pru1_gpi9 PRU1 General-Purpose Input I F12, V6 pr2_pru0_gpo0 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O AC5, G11 pr2_pru0_gpo1 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O AB4, E9 pr2_pru0_gpo10 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O AB8, C6 pr2_pru0_gpo11 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O AB5, C8 pr2_pru0_gpo12 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O B18, C7 pr2_pru0_gpo13 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O B7, F15 pr2_pru0_gpo14 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O B19, B8 pr2_pru0_gpo15 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O A7, C17 pr2_pru0_gpo16 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O A8, C15 pr2_pru0_gpo17 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O A16, C9 pr2_pru0_gpo18 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O A19, A9 pr2_pru0_gpo19 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O A18, B9 pr2_pru0_gpo2 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O AD4, F9 pr2_pru0_gpo20 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O A10, F14 pr2_pru0_gpo3 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O AC4, F8 pr2_pru0_gpo4 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O AC7, E7 pr2_pru0_gpo5 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O AC6, E8 pr2_pru0_gpo6 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O AC9, D9 pr2_pru0_gpo7 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O AC3, D7 pr2_pru0_gpo8 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O AC8, D8 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION SIGNAL NAME 129 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-27. PRU-ICSS Signal Descriptions (continued) ADVANCE INFORMATION SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL BOTTOM pr2_pru0_gpo9 PRU0 General-Purpose Output O A5, AD6 pr2_pru1_gpo0 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O D17, V1 pr2_pru1_gpo1 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O AA3, U4 pr2_pru1_gpo10 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O B12, U6 pr2_pru1_gpo11 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O A11, U5 pr2_pru1_gpo12 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O B13, V5 pr2_pru1_gpo13 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O A12, V4 pr2_pru1_gpo14 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O E14, V3 pr2_pru1_gpo15 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O A13, Y2 pr2_pru1_gpo16 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O G14, W2 pr2_pru1_gpo17 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O E11 pr2_pru1_gpo18 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O F11 pr2_pru1_gpo19 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O G10 pr2_pru1_gpo2 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O AB9, U3 pr2_pru1_gpo20 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O F10 pr2_pru1_gpo3 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O AB3, V2 pr2_pru1_gpo4 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O AA4, Y1 pr2_pru1_gpo5 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O D18, W9 pr2_pru1_gpo6 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O E17, V9 pr2_pru1_gpo7 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O C14, V7 pr2_pru1_gpo8 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O G12, U7 pr2_pru1_gpo9 PRU1 General-Purpose Output O F12, V6 pr2_edc_latch0_in Latch Input 0 I F9 pr2_edc_latch1_in Latch Input 1 I F8 pr2_edc_sync0_out SYNC 0 Output O E7 pr2_edc_sync1_out SYNC 1 Output O E8 pr2_edio_data_in0 Ethernet Digital Input I B7 pr2_edio_data_in1 Ethernet Digital Input I B8 pr2_edio_data_in2 Ethernet Digital Input I A7 pr2_edio_data_in3 Ethernet Digital Input I A8 pr2_edio_data_in4 Ethernet Digital Input I C9 pr2_edio_data_in5 Ethernet Digital Input I A9 pr2_edio_data_in6 Ethernet Digital Input I B9 pr2_edio_data_in7 Ethernet Digital Input I A10 pr2_edio_data_out0 Ethernet Digital Output O B7 pr2_edio_data_out1 Ethernet Digital Output O B8 pr2_edio_data_out2 Ethernet Digital Output O A7 pr2_edio_data_out3 Ethernet Digital Output O A8 pr2_edio_data_out4 Ethernet Digital Output O C9 pr2_edio_data_out5 Ethernet Digital Output O A9 pr2_edio_data_out6 Ethernet Digital Output O B9 pr2_edio_data_out7 Ethernet Digital Output O A10 Latch Input I D9 Start Of Frame O D7 pr2_mdio_data MDIO Data IO AA4, D14 pr2_mdio_mdclk MDIO Clock O AB3, C14 MII0 Collision Detect I F15 pr2_edio_latch_in pr2_edio_sof pr2_mii0_col 130 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-27. PRU-ICSS Signal Descriptions (continued) TYPE BALL BOTTOM pr2_mii0_crs DESCRIPTION MII0 Carrier Sense I B18 pr2_mii0_rxd0 MII0 Receive Data I C15 pr2_mii0_rxd1 MII0 Receive Data I A18 pr2_mii0_rxd2 MII0 Receive Data I A19 pr2_mii0_rxd3 MII0 Receive Data I F14 pr2_mii0_rxdv MII0 Data Valid I G14 pr2_mii0_rxer MII0 Receive Error I G12 pr2_mii0_rxlink MII0 Receive Link I A16 pr2_mii0_txd0 MII0 Transmit Data O E14 pr2_mii0_txd1 MII0 Transmit Data O A12 pr2_mii0_txd2 MII0 Transmit Data O B13 pr2_mii0_txd3 MII0 Transmit Data O A11 pr2_mii0_txen MII0 Transmit Enable O B12 pr2_mii_mr0_clk MII0 Receive Clock I A13 pr2_mii_mt0_clk MII0 Transmit Clock I F12 pr2_mii1_col MII1 Collision Detect I D18 pr2_mii1_crs MII1 Carrier Sense I E17 pr2_mii1_rxd0 MII1 Receive Data I AB5 pr2_mii1_rxd1 MII1 Receive Data I AB8 pr2_mii1_rxd2 MII1 Receive Data I AD6 pr2_mii1_rxd3 MII1 Receive Data I AC8 pr2_mii1_rxdv MII1 Data Valid I AC3 pr2_mii1_rxer MII1 Receive Error I B19 pr2_mii1_rxlink MII1 Receive Link I C17 pr2_mii1_txd0 MII1 Transmit Data O AC6 pr2_mii1_txd1 MII1 Transmit Data O AC7 pr2_mii1_txd2 MII1 Transmit Data O AC4 pr2_mii1_txd3 MII1 Transmit Data O AD4 pr2_mii1_txen MII1 Transmit Enable O AB4 pr2_mii_mr1_clk MII1 Receive Clock I AC9 pr2_mii_mt1_clk MII1 Transmit Clock I AC5 pr2_uart0_cts_n UART Clear-To-Send I D8 pr2_uart0_rts_n UART Ready-To-Send O A5 pr2_uart0_rxd UART Receive Data I C6 pr2_uart0_txd UART Transmit Data O C8 IO C7 pr2_ecap0_ecap_capin_apwm_ Capture Input / PWM output o ADVANCE INFORMATION SIGNAL NAME NOTE PRU-ICSS has internal multiplexing capability of pin functions. See PRU-ICSS EGPIO Internal Pinmux in device TRM. Besides, EGPIO module can be configured to export additional functions to EGPIO pins in place of simple GPIO. See Enhanced GeneralPurpose Module/Serial Capture Unit in device TRM. Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 131 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 4.4.25 Test Interfaces CAUTION The I/O timings provided in Section 7, Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics are valid only if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 7-171. NOTE For more information, see the On-Chip Debug Support / Debug Ports section of the device TRM. Table 4-28. Debug Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION tms JTAG test port mode select. An external pullup resistor should be used on this ball. ADVANCE INFORMATION TYPE BALL IO F18 D23 tdi JTAG test data input I tdo JTAG test port data output O F19 tclk JTAG test clock input I E20 trstn JTAG test reset I D20 rtck JTAG return clock output O E18 emu0 Emulator pin 0 IO G21 emu1 Emulator pin 1 IO D24 emu2 Emulator pin 2 O F10 emu3 Emulator pin 3 O D7 emu4 Emulator pin 4 O A7 emu5 Emulator pin 5 O E1 / G11 emu6 Emulator pin 6 O G2 / E9 emu7 Emulator pin 7 O H7 / F9 emu8 Emulator pin 8 O G1 / F8 emu9 Emulator pin 9 O G6 / E7 emu10 Emulator pin 10 O F2 / D8 emu11 Emulator pin 11 O F3 / A5 emu12 Emulator pin 12 O D1 / C6 emu13 Emulator pin 13 O E2 / C8 emu14 Emulator pin 14 O D2 / C7 emu15 Emulator pin 15 O F4 / A8 emu16 Emulator pin 16 O C1 / C9 emu17 Emulator pin 17 O E4 / A9 emu18 Emulator pin 18 O F5 / B9 emu19 Emulator pin 19 O E6 / A10 4.4.26 System and Miscellaneous 4.4.26.1 Sysboot NOTE For more information, see the Initialization (ROM Code) section of the device TRM. 132 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL sysboot0 DESCRIPTION Boot Mode Configuration 0. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I M6 sysboot1 Boot Mode Configuration 1. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I M2 sysboot2 Boot Mode Configuration 2. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I L5 sysboot3 Boot Mode Configuration 3. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I M1 sysboot4 Boot Mode Configuration 4. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I L6 sysboot5 Boot Mode Configuration 5. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I L4 sysboot6 Boot Mode Configuration 6. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I L3 sysboot7 Boot Mode Configuration 7. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I L2 sysboot8 Boot Mode Configuration 8. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I L1 sysboot9 Boot Mode Configuration 9. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I K2 sysboot10 Boot Mode Configuration 10. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I J1 sysboot11 Boot Mode Configuration 11. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I J2 sysboot12 Boot Mode Configuration 12. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I H1 sysboot13 Boot Mode Configuration 13. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I J3 sysboot14 Boot Mode Configuration 14. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I H2 sysboot15 Boot Mode Configuration 15. The value latched on this pin upon porz reset release will determine the boot mode configuration of the device. I H3 TYPE BALL ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 4-29. Sysboot Signal Descriptions 4.4.26.2 Power, Reset, and Clock Management (PRCM) NOTE For more information, see PRCM section of the device TRM. Table 4-30. PRCM Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION clkout1 Device Clock output 1. Can be used externally for devices with non-critical timing requirements, or for debug, or as a reference clock on GPMC as described in Table 7-22 GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Switching Characteristics - Synchronous Mode - 1 Load and Table 7-24 GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Switching Characteristics - Synchronous Mode - 5 Loads. O F21 / P7 clkout2 Device Clock output 2. Can be used externally for devices with non-critical timing requirements, or for debug. O D18 / N1 clkout3 Device Clock output 3. Can be used externally for devices with non-critical timing requirements, or for debug. O C23 rstoutn Reset out (Active low).This pin asserts low in response to any global reset condition on the device. O F23 resetn Device Reset Input I E23 Power on Reset (active low).This pin must be asserted low until all device supplies are valid (see reset sequence/requirements) I F22 porz Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 133 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-30. PRCM Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL xref_clk0 DESCRIPTION External Reference Clock 0. For Audio and other Peripherals. I D18 xref_clk1 External Reference Clock 1. For Audio and other Peripherals. I E17 xref_clk2 External Reference Clock 2. For Audio and other Peripherals. I B26 xref_clk3 External Reference Clock 3. For Audio and other Peripherals. I C23 xi_osc0 System Oscillator OSC0 Crystal input / LVCMOS clock input.Functions as the input connection to a crystal when the internal oscillator OSC0 is used. Functions as an LVCMOS-compatible input clock when an external oscillator is used. I AE15 xo_osc0 System Oscillator OSC0 Crystal output O AD15 xi_osc1 Auxiliary Oscillator OSC1 Crystal input / LVCMOS clock input.Functions as the input connection to a crystal when the internal oscillator OSC1 is used. Functions as an LVCMOS-compatible input clock when an external oscillator is used I AC15 xo_osc1 Auxiliary Oscillator OSC1 Crystal output O AC13 I/O U3 RMII_MHZ_50_CL RMII Reference Clock (50MHz).This pin is an input when external reference is K(1) used or output when internal reference is used. ADVANCE INFORMATION (1) This clock signal is implemented as 'pad loopback' inside the device - the output signal is looped back through the input buffer to serve as the internal reference signal. Series termination is recommended (as close to device pin as possible) to improve signal integrity of the clock input. Any nonmonotonicity in voltage that occurs at the pad loopback clock pin between VIH and VIL must be less than VHYS. 4.4.26.3 Real-Time Clock (RTC) Interface NOTE For more information, see the Real-Time Clock (RTC) chapter of the device TRM. NOTE RTC only mode is not supported feature. Table 4-31. RTC Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL Wakeup0 RTC External Wakeup Input 0 I AD17 Wakeup3 RTC External Wakeup Input 3 I AC16 rtc_porz RTC Power Domain Power-On Reset Input I AB17 RTC Oscillator Input. Crystal connection to internal RTC oscillator. Functions as an RTC clock input when an external oscillator is used. I AE14 rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 rtc_osc_xo DESCRIPTION RTC Oscillator Output O AD14 rtc_iso(1) RTC Domain Isolation Signal I AF14 on_off RTC Power Enable output pin O Y11 (1) This signal must be kept 0 if device power supplies are not valid during RTC mode and 1 during normal operation. This can typically be achieved by connecting rtc_iso to the same signal driving porz (not rtc_porz) with appropriate voltage level translation if necessary. 4.4.26.4 System Direct Memory Access (SDMA) NOTE For more information, see the DMA Controllers / System DMA section of the device TRM. Table 4-32. SDMA Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME 134 TYPE BALL dma_evt1 DESCRIPTION System DMA Event Input 1 I P7 / P4 dma_evt2 System DMA Event Input 2 I N1 / R3 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 4-32. SDMA Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME TYPE BALL dma_evt3 DESCRIPTION System DMA Event Input 3 I N6 dma_evt4 System DMA Event Input 4 I M4 TYPE BALL 4.4.26.5 Interrupt Controllers (INTC) NOTE For more information, see the Interrupt Controllers section of the device TRM. SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION nmin_dsp Non maskable interrupt input, active-low. This pin can be optionally routed to the DSP NMI input or as generic input to the ARM cores. Note that by default this pin has an internal pulldown resistor enabled. This internal pulldown should be disabled or countered by a stronger external pullup resistor before routing to the DSP or ARM processors. I D21 sys_nirq2 External interrupt event to any device INTC I AD17 sys_nirq1 External interrupt event to any device INTC I AC16 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 4-33. INTC Signal Descriptions 4.4.26.6 Observability NOTE For more information, see the Control Module section of the device TRM. Table 4-34. Observability Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL obs0 Observation Output 0 O F10 obs1 Observation Output 1 O G11 obs2 Observation Output 2 O E9 obs3 Observation Output 3 O F9 obs4 Observation Output 4 O F8 obs5 Observation Output 5 O D7 obs6 Observation Output 6 O D8 obs7 Observation Output 7 O A5 obs8 Observation Output 8 O C6 obs9 Observation Output 9 O C8 obs10 Observation Output 10 O C7 obs11 Observation Output 11 O A7 obs12 Observation Output 12 O A8 obs13 Observation Output 13 O C9 obs14 Observation Output 14 O A9 obs15 Observation Output 15 O B9 obs16 Observation Output 16 O F10 obs17 Observation Output 17 O G11 obs18 Observation Output 18 O E9 obs19 Observation Output 19 O F9 obs20 Observation Output 20 O F8 obs21 Observation Output 21 O D7 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 135 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-34. Observability Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL obs22 Observation Output 22 O D8 obs23 Observation Output 23 O A5 obs24 Observation Output 24 O C6 obs25 Observation Output 25 O C8 obs26 Observation Output 26 O C7 obs27 Observation Output 27 O A7 obs28 Observation Output 28 O A8 obs29 Observation Output 29 O C9 obs30 Observation Output 30 O A9 obs31 Observation Output 31 O B9 obs_dmarq1 DMA Request External Observation Output 1 O G11 obs_dmarq2 DMA Request External Observation Output 2 O D8 obs_irq1 IRQ External Observation Output 1 O F10 obs_irq2 IRQ External Observation Output 2 O D7 ADVANCE INFORMATION 4.4.27 Power Supplies NOTE For more information, see Power, Reset and Clock Management / PRCM Subsystem Environment / External Voltage Inputs section of the device TRM. Table 4-35. Power Supply Signal Descriptions SIGNAL NAME vdd TYPE BALL PWR H13 / H14 / J17 / J18 / L7 / L8 / N10 / N13 / P11 / P12 / P13 / R11 / R16 / R19 / T13 / T16 / T19 / U13 / U16 / U8 / U9 / V16 / V8 GND A1 / A14 / A2 / A23 / A28 / A6 / AA14 / AA15 / AA20 / AA8 / AA9 / AB14 / AB20 / AD1 / AD24 / AG1 / AH1 / AH2 / AH20 / AH28 / B1 / D13 / D19 / E13 / E19 / F1 / F7 / G7 / G8 / G9 / H12 / J12 / J15 / J28 / K1 / K15 / K24 / K25 / K4 / K5 / L13 / L14 / M19 / N14 / N15 / N19 / N24 / N25 / P28 / R1 / R12 / R13 / R21 / T10 / T11 / T12 / T14 / T15 / T17 / T18 / T21 / U14 / U15 / U17 / U20 / U21 / V15 / V17 / W1 / W15 / W24 / W25 / W28 Core voltage domain supply vss Ground cap_vbbldo_gpu(1) External capacitor connection for the GPU vbb ldo output CAP Y14 cap_vbbldo_iva(1) External capacitor connection for the IVA vbb ldo output CAP J10 (1) cap_vbbldo_mpu External capacitor connection for the MPU vbb ldo output CAP J16 cap_vbbldo_dsp(1) External capacitor connection for the DSP vbb ldo output CAP K9 External capacitor connection for the Core SRAM array ldo1 output CAP T20 cap_vddram_core1(1) 136 DESCRIPTION Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL cap_vddram_core3(1) SIGNAL NAME External capacitor connection for the Core SRAM array ldo3 output CAP L9 (1) cap_vddram_core4 External capacitor connection for the Core SRAM array ldo4 output CAP J19 cap_vddram_mpu(1) External capacitor connection for the MPU SRAM array ldo output CAP K19 cap_vddram_gpu(1) External capacitor connection for the GPU SRAM array ldo output CAP Y13 External capacitor connection for the IVA SRAM array ldo output CAP K16 External capacitor connection for the DSP CAP J9 DSP PLL and IVA PLL analog power supply PWR N12 DPLL_CORE and CORE HSDIVIDER analog power supply PWR P14 DPLL_SPARE analog power supply PWR P15 DPLL_ABE, DPLL_PER, and PER HSDIVIDER analog power supply PWR M14 vdda_mpu_abe MPU_ABE PLL analog power supply PWR N16 vdda33v_usb1 HS USB1 3.3V analog power supply. If USB1 is not used, this pin can alternatively be connected to VSS if the following requirements are met: - The usb1_dm/usb1_dp pins are left unconnected - The USB1 PHY is kept powered down PWR AA12 vdda33v_usb2 HS USB2 3.3V analog power supply. If USB2 is not used, this pin can alternatively be connected to VSS if the following requirements are met: - The usb2_dm/usb2_dp pins are left unconnected - The USB2 PHY is kept powered down PWR Y12 DPLL_DDR and DDR HSDIVIDER analog power supply PWR R17 DPLL_DEBUG analog power supply PWR N11 vdda_gpu DPLL_GPU analog power supply PWR R14 vdda_hdmi cap_vddram_iva (1) cap_vddram_dsp(1) vdda_dsp_iva vdda_core_gmac vdda_pll_spare vdda_per vdda_ddr vdda_debug ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 4-35. Power Supply Signal Descriptions (continued) PLL_HDMI and HDMI analog power supply PWR Y17 vdda_osc HFOSC analog power supply PWR AD16 / AE16 vdda_pcie DPLL_PCIe_REF and PCIe analog power supply PWR AA17 vdda_pcie0 PCIe ch0 RX/TX analog power supply PWR AA16 RTC bias and RTC LFOSC analog power supply PWR AB13 vdda_sata DPLL_SATA and SATA RX/TX analog power supply PWR V13 vdda_usb1 DPLL_USB and HS USB1 1.8V analog power supply PWR AA13 vdda_usb2 HS USB2 1.8V analog power supply PWR AB12 vdda_usb3 DPLL_USB_OTG_SS and USB3.0 RX/TX analog power supply PWR W14 CSI Interface 1.8v Supply PWR W12 VIDEO1 and VIDEO2 PLL analog power supply PWR P16 1.8V power supply PWR G18 / H17 / M8 / M9 / N8 / P8 / R8 / T8 / V21 / V22 / W17 / W18 EMIF1 bias power supply PWR AA18 / AA19 / N21 / P20 / P21 / W21 / Y21 vddshv1 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the VIN2 Power Group pins PWR E3 / E5 / G4 / G5 / H8 / H9 vddshv2 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the VOUT Power Group pins PWR B6 / D10 / E10 / H10 / H11 vddshv3 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the GENERAL Power Group pins PWR B23 / D16 / D22 / E16 / E22 / G15 / H15 / H16 / H18 / H19 vddshv4 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the MMC4 Power Group pins PWR C24 vddshv5 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the RTC Power Group pins PWR V12 vddshv6 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the VIN1 Power Group pins PWR AD5 / AD7 / AE7 / AF5 vdda_rtc vdda_csi vdda_video vdds18v vdds18v_ddr1 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 137 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 4-35. Power Supply Signal Descriptions (continued) SIGNAL NAME ADVANCE INFORMATION DESCRIPTION TYPE BALL vddshv7 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the WIFI Power Group pins PWR AB6 / AB7 vddshv8 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the MMC1 Power Group pins PWR W8 / Y8 vddshv9 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the RGMII Power Group pins PWR U10 / W4 / W5 vddshv10 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the GPMC Power Group pins PWR N4 / N5 / P10 / R10 / R7 / T4 / T5 vddshv11 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 3.3V) power supply for the MMC2 Power Group pins PWR J8 / K8 vdds_ddr1 EMIF1 power supply (1.5V for DDR3 mode / 1.35V DDR3L mode) PWR AA21 / AA22 / AB21 / AB22 / AB24 / AB25 / AC22 / AD26 / AG20 / AG28 / AH27 / T24 / T25 / W16 / W27 vdds_mlbp MLBP IO power supply PWR AA7 / Y7 vdd_dsp DSP voltage domain supply PWR K10 / K11 / L10 / L11 / M10 / M11 vdd_gpu GPU voltage domain supply PWR U11 / U12 / V10 / V11 / V14 / W10 / W11 / W13 vdd_iva IVA voltage domain supply PWR J13 / K12 / K13 / L12 / M12 / M13 vdd_mpu MPU voltage domain supply PWR K17 / K18 / L15 / L16 / L17 / L18 / L19 / M15 / M16 / M17 / M18 / N17 / N18 / P17 / P18 / R18 vdd_rtc RTC voltage domain supply PWR AB15 vssa_hdmi DPLL_HDMI and HDMI PHY analog ground GND AD19 / AE19 vssa_osc0 OSC0 analog ground GND AF15 vssa_osc1 OSC1 analog ground GND AC14 vssa_pcie PCIe analog ground GND AD13 / AE13 vssa_sata SATA analog ground GND AE10 vssa_usb HS USB1 and HS USB2 analog ground GND AA11 / AB11 vssa_usb3 DPLL_USB and USB3.0 RX/TX analog ground GND AD10 CSI Interface 0v Supply GND AA10 / AH8 DPLL_VIDEO1 analog ground GND R15 vssa_csi vssa_video (1) This pin must always be connected via a 1-µF capacitor to vss. 138 Terminal Configuration and Functions Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 5 Specifications NOTE For more information, see Power, Reset, and Clock Management / PRCM Subsystem Environment / External Voltage Inputs or Initialization / Preinitialization / Power Requirements section of the Device TRM. NOTE The index numbers 1 which is part of the EMIF1 signal prefixes (ddr1_*) listed in Table 4-8, EMIF Signal Descriptions, column "SIGNAL NAME" not to be confused with DDR1 type of SDRAM memories. NOTE CAUTION All IO Cells are NOT Fail-safe compliant and should not be externally driven in absence of their IO supply. 5.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings Stresses beyond those listed as absolute maximum ratings may cause permanent damage to the device. These are stress ratings only, and functional operation of the device at these or any other conditions beyond those listed under Section 5.4, Recommended Operating Conditions, is not implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rated conditions for extended periods may affect device reliability. Table 5-1. Absolute Maximum Rating Over Junction Temperature Range PARAMETER(1) VSUPPLY (Steady-State) Supply Voltage Ranges (SteadyState) MIN MAX UNIT Core (vdd, vdd_mpu, vdd_gpu, vdd_dsp, vdd_iva, vdd_rtc) -0.3 1.5 V Analog (vdda_usb1, vdda_usb2, vdda_per, vdda_ddr, vdda_debug, vdda_mpu_abe, vdda_usb3, vdda_csi, vdda_core_gmac, vdda_pll_spare, vdda_dsp_iva, vdda_gpu, dda_hdmi, vdda_pcie, vdda_pcie0, vdda_sata, vdda_video, vdda_osc, vdda_rtc) -0.3 2.0 V Analog 3.3V (vdda33v_usb1, vdda33v_usb2) -0.3 3.8 V vdds18v, vdds18v_ddr1, vdds_mlbp, vdds_ddr1 -0.3 2.1 V vddshv1-11 (1.8V mode) -0.3 2.1 V vddshv1-7 (3.3V mode), vddshv9-11 (3.3V mode) -0.3 3.8 V vddshv8 (3.3V mode) -0.3 3.6 V Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 139 ADVANCE INFORMATION Audio Back End (ABE) module is not supported for this family of devices, but “ABE” name is still present in some clock or DPLL names. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 5-1. Absolute Maximum Rating Over Junction Temperature Range (continued) PARAMETER(1) VIO (Steady-State) Input and Output Voltage Ranges (Steady-State) MIN MAX UNIT Core I/Os -0.3 1.5 V Analog I/Os (except HDMI) -0.3 2.0 V HDMI I/Os -0.3 3.5 V I/O 1.35V -0.3 1.65 V I/O 1.5V -0.3 1.8 V 1.8V I/Os -0.3 2.1 V 3.3V I/Os (except those powered by vddshv8) -0.3 3.8 V 3.3V I/Os (powered by vddshv8) -0.3 3.6 V 105 V/s 0.2*VDD V ADVANCE INFORMATION SR Maximum slew rate, all supplies VIO (Transient Overshoot / Undershoot) Input and Output Voltage Ranges (Transient Overshoot/Undershoot) Note: valid for up to 20% of the signal period TSTG Storage temperature range after soldered onto PC Board -55 +150 °C Latch-up I-Test I-test(3), All I/Os (if different levels then one line per level) -100 100 mA Latch-up OV-Test Over-voltage Test(4), All supplies (if different levels then one line per level) N/A 1.5*Vsup ply max V (2) (1) See I/Os supplied by this power pin in Table 4-2 Ball Characteristics (2) VDD is the voltage on the corresponding power-supply pin(s) for the IO. (3) Per JEDEC JESD78 at 125°C with specified I/O pin injection current and clamp voltage of 1.5 times maximum recommended I/O voltage and negative 0.5 times maximum recommended I/O voltage. (4) Per JEDEC JESD78 at 125°C. 5.2 ESD Ratings Table 5-2 presents the Device ESD Ratings requirements. Table 5-2. ESD Ratings VALUE VESD Electrostatic discharge Human-body model (HBM), per ANSI/ESDA/JEDEC JS-001(1) ±1000 Charged-device model (CDM), per JEDEC specification JESD22-C101 (2) ±250 UNIT V (1) JEDEC document JEP155 states that 500-V HBM allows safe manufacturing with a standard ESD control process. (2) JEDEC document JEP157 states that 250-V CDM allows safe manufacturing with a standard ESD control process. 5.3 Power on Hours (POH) Limits The information in the section below is provided solely for your convenience and does not extend or modify the warranty provided under TI’s standard terms and conditions for TI semiconductor products. NOTE POH is a function of voltage, temperature and time. Usage at higher voltages and temperatures will result in a reduction in POH. 140 Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 5-3. Power on Hour (POH) Limits(1) OPERATING CONDITION OPP COMMERCIAL JUNCTION TEMP RANGE 0°C ~ 90°C EXTENDED JUNCTION TEMP RANGE -40°C ~ 105°C HDMI JUNCTION TEMP (Tj) LIFETIME (POH) JUNCTION TEMP (Tj) LIFETIME (POH) JUNCTION TEMP (Tj) LIFETIME (POH) OPP_NOM or OPP_OD Not Used 90°C 100k 100°C 100k 105°C 100k (3) 90°C 100k 100°C 63k 105°C 45k OPP_HIGH Not Used 90°C 65k 100°C 55k 105°C 50k 90°C 65k 100°C 55k 105°C 45k (2) Used (2) Used (1) Unless specified in Table 5-3, all voltage domains and operating conditions are supported in the device at the noted temperatures. (2) Power-on hours (POH) assume HDMI is used at the maximum supported bit rate continuously and/or operating the device continuously at the VD_MPU operating point (OPP) noted. (3) 90k POH only if SuperSpeed USB 3.0 Dual-Role-Device (at 5 Gbps) or PCIe in Gen-II mode (at 5 Gbps) are used. 5.4 Recommended Operating Conditions NOTE Logic functions and parameter values are not assured out of the range specified in the recommended operating conditions. Table 5-4. Recommended Operating Conditions PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN (2) NOM MAX DC (3) MAX (2) UNIT Input Power Supply Voltage Range vdd Core voltage domain supply See Section 5.5 V vdd_mpu Supply voltage range for MPU domain See Section 5.5 V vdd_gpu GPU voltage domain supply See Section 5.5 V vdd_dsp DSP voltage domain supply See Section 5.5 V vdd_iva IVA voltage domain supply See Section 5.5 V vdd_rtc RTC voltage domain supply See Section 5.5 vdda_usb1 DPLL_USB and HS USB1 1.8V analog power supply 1.71 1.80 1.71 1.80 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_usb2 HS USB2 1.8V analog power supply HS USB1 3.3V analog power supply.If USB1 is not used, this pin can alternatively be connected to VSS if the following requirements are met: - The usb1_dm/usb1_dp pins are left unconnected - The USB1 PHY is kept powered down HS USB2 3.3V analog power supply. If USB2 is not used, this pin can alternatively be connected to VSS if the following requirements are met: - The usb2_dm/usb2_dp pins are left unconnected - The USB2 PHY is kept powered down 3.135 3.3 3.135 3.3 PER PLL and PER HSDIVIDER analog power supply 1.89 1.71 1.80 50 V mVPPmax 3.366 3.465 3.366 3.465 1.836 1.89 V mVPPmax 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) V mVPPmax 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_per 1.836 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda33v_usb2 1.89 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda33v_usb1 V 1.836 V mVPPmax V mVPPmax Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 141 ADVANCE INFORMATION The device is used under the recommended operating conditions described in Table 5-4. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 5-4. Recommended Operating Conditions (continued) PARAMETER vdda_ddr DESCRIPTION DPLL_DDR and DDR HSDIVIDER analog power supply MIN (2) NOM MAX DC (3) MAX (2) 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_debug DPLL_DEBUG analog power supply 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_dsp_iva DPLL_DSP and DPLL_IVA analog power supply vdda_core_gmac DPLL_CORE and CORE HSDIVIDER analog power supply Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_pll_spare DPLL_SPARE analog power supply 1.71 DPLL_GPU analog power supply ADVANCE INFORMATION PLL_HDMI and HDMI analog power supply 1.71 DPLL_PCIe_REF and PCIe analog power supply 1.71 PCIe ch0 RX/TX analog power supply DPLL_SATA and SATA RX/TX analog power supply 1.80 1.71 1.80 DPLL_USB_OTG_SS and USB3.0 RX/TX analog power supply 1.71 1.80 DPLL_VIDEO1 analog power supply 1.71 1.80 MLBP IO power supply DPLL_MPU analog power supply HFOSC analog power supply 1.80 1.71 1.80 RTC bias and RTC LFOSC analog power supply CSI Interface 1.8v Supply 1.80 1.71 1.80 1.8V power supply vdds18v_ddr1 1.80 1.71 Specifications 1.80 50 V mVPPmax 1.89 V mVPPmax 1.836 1.89 1.836 1.89 V mVPPmax V mVPPmax 1.836 1.89 V mVPPmax 1.89 V mVPPmax 1.836 1.89 V mVPPmax 1.89 V mVPPmax 1.89 V mVPPmax 1.836 1.89 V mVPPmax 1.836 1.89 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) 142 1.89 50 1.71 EMIF1 bias power supply 1.836 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) V mVPPmax 1.80 1.71 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdds18v 1.89 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_csi 1.836 50 1.71 V mVPPmax 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_rtc 1.80 1.71 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_osc 1.89 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_mpu_abe 1.836 50 1.71 V mVPPmax 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdds_mlbp 1.89 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_video 1.836 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_usb3 1.80 1.71 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_sata 1.80 V mVPPmax 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_pcie0 1.89 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_pcie 1.836 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_hdmi 1.80 V mVPPmax 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) vdda_gpu 1.80 V mVPPmax 50 1.71 V mVPPmax 50 Maximum noise (peak-peak) UNIT V mVPPmax 1.836 1.89 V mVPPmax Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 5-4. Recommended Operating Conditions (continued) PARAMETER vdds_ddr1 DESCRIPTION EMIF1 power supply (1.5V 1.35-V for DDR3 mode / 1.35V Mode DDR3L mode) 1.5-V Mode Maximum noise (peakpeak) MIN (2) NOM MAX DC (3) MAX (2) 1.28 1.35 1.377 1.42 1.43 1.50 1.53 1.57 1.35-V Mode 50 UNIT V mVPPmax 1.5-V Mode Dual Voltage (1.8V or 1.8-V Mode 3.3V) power supply for the 3.3-V Mode RTC Power Group pins Maximum noise (peakpeak) vddshv1 vddshv10 vddshv11 vddshv2 vddshv3 vddshv4 vddshv6 vddshv7 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.30 3.366 3.465 50 V mVPPmax 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 50 V mVPPmax 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 50 V mVPPmax 3.3-V Mode 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 1.8-V Mode 50 V mVPPmax 3.3-V Mode 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 1.8-V Mode 50 V mVPPmax 3.3-V Mode 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 1.8-V Mode 50 V mVPPmax 3.3-V Mode 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 1.8-V Mode 50 V mVPPmax 3.3-V Mode Dual Voltage (1.8V or 1.8-V Mode 3.3V) power supply for the 3.3-V Mode WIFI Power Group pins Maximum noise (peakpeak) mVPPmax 3.135 1.8-V Mode Dual Voltage (1.8V or 1.8-V Mode 3.3V) power supply for the 3.3-V Mode VIN1 Power Group pins Maximum noise (peakpeak) V 3.3-V Mode Dual Voltage (1.8V or 1.8-V Mode 3.3V) power supply for the 3.3-V Mode MMC4 Power Group pins Maximum noise (peakpeak) 50 1.8-V Mode Dual Voltage (1.8V or 1.8-V Mode 3.3V) power supply for the 3.3-V Mode GENERAL Power Group pins Maximum noise (peakpeak) 3.465 3.3-V Mode Dual Voltage (1.8V or 1.8-V Mode 3.3V) power supply for the 3.3-V Mode VOUT Power Group pins Maximum noise (peakpeak) 1.89 3.366 1.8-V Mode Dual Voltage (1.8V or 1.8-V Mode 3.3V) power supply for the 3.3-V Mode MMC2 Power Group pins Maximum noise (peakpeak) 1.836 3.30 3.3-V Mode Dual Voltage (1.8V or 1.8-V Mode 3.3V) power supply for the 3.3-V Mode GPMC Power Group pins Maximum noise (peakpeak) 1.80 1.8-V Mode Dual Voltage (1.8V or 1.8-V Mode 3.3V) power supply for the 3.3-V Mode VIN2 Power Group pins Maximum noise (peakpeak) 1.71 3.135 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 1.8-V Mode 50 V mVPPmax 3.3-V Mode Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 143 ADVANCE INFORMATION vddshv5 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 5-4. Recommended Operating Conditions (continued) PARAMETER vddshv8 DESCRIPTION NOM MAX DC (3) MAX (2) 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 Dual Voltage (1.8V or 1.8-V Mode 3.3V) power supply for the 3.3-V Mode MMC1 Power Group pins Maximum noise (peakpeak) vddshv9 MIN (2) 1.8-V Mode 50 V mVPPmax 3.3-V Mode Dual Voltage (1.8V or 1.8-V Mode 3.3V) power supply for the 3.3-V Mode RGMII Power Group pins Maximum noise (peakpeak) UNIT 1.71 1.80 1.836 1.89 3.135 3.30 3.366 3.465 1.8-V Mode 50 V mVPPmax 3.3-V Mode ADVANCE INFORMATION vss Ground supply 0 V vssa_hdmi DPLL_HDMI and HDMI PHY analog ground 0 V vssa_pcie PCIe analog ground 0 V vssa_usb HS USB1 and HS USB2 analog ground 0 V vssa_usb3 DPLL_USB and USB3.0 RX/TX analog ground 0 V vssa_csi CSI Interface 0v Supply 0 V vssa_sata SATA TX ground 0 V vssa_video DPLL_VIDEO1 analog ground 0 V vssa_osc0 OSC0 analog ground 0 V vssa_osc1 OSC1 analog ground 0 V (1) TJ Operating junction temperature range Commercial Extended 0 90 -40 105 °C Output Power Supply Voltage Range ddr1_vref0 Reference Power Supply EMIF1 0.5*vdds_d dr1 V (1) Refer to Power on Hours table for limitations. (2) The voltage at the device ball should never be below the MIN voltage or above the MAX voltage for any amount of time. This requirement includes dynamic voltage events such as AC ripple, voltage transients, voltage dips, etc. (3) The DC voltage at the device ball should never be above the MAX DC voltage to avoid impact on device reliability and lifetime POH (Power-On-Hours). The MAX DC voltage is defined as the highest allowed DC regulated voltage, without transients, seen at the ball. 5.5 Operating Performance Points This section describes the operating conditions of the device. This section also contains the description of each OPP (operating performance point) for processor clocks and device core clocks. CAUTION The OPP voltage and frequency values may change following the silicon characterization result. Table 5-5 describes the maximum supported frequency per speed grade for AM571x devices. Table 5-5. Speed Grade Maximum Frequency DEVICE SPEED 144 MAXIMUM FREQUENCY (MHz) MPU DSP IVA GPU IPU L3 DDR3/DDR3L AM5718xxX 1500 750 532 532 212.8 266 667 (DDR3-1333) AM5716xxX 1500 750 N/A(1) N/A(1) 212.8 266 667 (DDR3-1333) AM5716xxD 500(2) 500 N/A(1) N/A(1) 212.8 266 533 (DDR3-1066) Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 (1) N/A in this table stands for Not Applicable. (2) Device will boot up initially at 588MHz. An intermediate boot program must immediately reprogram the PLL to a frequency not over 500MHz. 5.5.1 AVS and ABB Requirements Adaptive Voltage Scaling (AVS) and Adaptive Body Biasing (ABB) are required on most of the vdd_* supplies as defined in Table 5-6. Table 5-6. AVS and ABB Requirements per vdd_* Supply AVS REQUIRED? ABB REQUIRED? vdd_core Yes, for all OPPs No vdd_mpu Yes, for all OPPs Yes, for all OPPs vdd_iva Yes, for all OPPs Yes, for all OPPs vdd_dsp Yes, for all OPPs Yes, for all OPPs vdd_gpu Yes, for all OPPs Yes, for all OPPs vdd_rtc No No Voltage And Core Clock Specifications Table 5-7 shows the recommended OPP per voltage domain. Table 5-7. Voltage Domains Operating Performance Points (1) DOMAIN CONDITION OPP_NOM OPP_OD NOM (2) MAX (3) BOOT (Before AVS is enabled) 1.11 1.15 1.2 Not Applicable Not Applicable After AVS is enabled (5) AVS Voltage (6) – 3.5% AVS Voltage 1.16 Not Applicable Not Applicable BOOT (Before AVS is enabled) 1.11 1.15 1.2 Not Applicable Not Applicable After AVS is enabled (5) AVS Voltage (6) – 3.5% AVS Voltage 1.16 VD_RTC (7) (V) - 0.84 0.88 to 1.06 1.16 Not Applicable Not Applicable Others (V) BOOT (Before AVS is enabled) 1.02 1.06 1.16 Not Applicable Not Applicable After AVS is enabled (5) AVS Voltage (6) – 3.5% AVS Voltage 1.16 VD_CORE (V) VD_MPU (V) MIN (3) NOM (2) OPP_HIGH MIN (3) MAX (3) MIN (3) NOM (2) MAX DC (4) MAX (3) (5) (6) (5) (6) AVS Voltage (6) – 3.5% AVS Voltage (6) AVS Voltage + 5% (6) AVS Voltage (6) – 3.5% AVS Voltage (6) AVS Voltage (6) +2% AVS Voltage + 5% (6) (5) (6) AVS Voltage (6) – 3.5% AVS Voltage (6) AVS Voltage (6) + 5% AVS Voltage (6) – 3.5% AVS Voltage (6) AVS Voltage (6) +2% AVS Voltage (6) + 5% (1) The voltage ranges in this table are preliminary, and final voltage ranges may be different than shown. Systems should be designed with the ability to modify the voltage to comply with future recommendations. (2) In a typical implementation, the power supply should target the NOM voltage. (3) The voltage at the device ball should never be below the MIN voltage or above the MAX voltage for any amount of time. This requirement includes dynamic voltage events such as AC ripple, voltage transients, voltage dips, etc. (4) The DC voltage at the device ball should never be above the MAX DC voltage to avoid impact on device reliability and lifetime POH (Power-On-Hours). The MAX DC voltage is defined as the highest allowed DC regulated voltage, without transients, seen at the ball. (5) For all OPPs, AVS must be enabled to avoid impact on device reliability, lifetime POH (Power-On-Hours), and device power. (6) The AVS voltages are device-dependent, voltage domain-dependent, and OPP-dependent. They must be read from the Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 145 ADVANCE INFORMATION 5.5.2 SUPPLY AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com STD_FUSE_OPP Registers in the Control Module Section of the TRM. The power supply should be adjustable over the following ranges for each required OPP: – OPP_NOM for MPU: 0.85 V – 1.15 V – OPP_NOM for CORE and Others: 0.85 V - 1.15 V – OPP_OD: 0.94 V - 1.15 V – OPP_HIGH: 1.05 V - 1.25 V The AVS voltages will be within the above specified ranges. (7) VD_RTC can optionally be tied to VD_CORE and operate at the VD_CORE AVS voltages. (8) The power supply must be programmed with the AVS voltages for the MPU and the CORE voltage domain, either just after the ROM boot or at the earliest possible time in the secondary boot loader before there is significant activity seen on these domains. Table 5-8 describes the standard processor clocks speed characteristics vs OPP of the device. Table 5-8. Supported OPP vs Max Frequency (2) DESCRIPTION OPP_NOM OPP_OD OPP_HIGH Max Freq. (MHz) Max Freq. (MHz) Max Freq. (MHz) MPU_CLK 1000 1176 1500 DSP_CLK 600 700 750 IVA_GCLK 388.3 430 532 GPU_CLK 425.6 500 532 CORE_IPUx_CLK 212.8 N/A N/A L3_CLK 266 N/A N/A DDR3 / DDR3L 667 (DDR3-1333) N/A N/A RTC_FCLK 0.034 N/A N/A VD_MPU ADVANCE INFORMATION VD_DSP VD_IVA VD_GPU VD_CORE VD_RTC (1) N/A in this table stands for Not Applicable. (2) Maximum supported frequency is limited according to the Device Speed Grade (see Table 5-5). 5.5.3 Maximum Supported Frequency Device modules either receive their clock directly from an external clock input, directly from a PLL, or from a PRCM. Table 5-9 lists the clock source options for each module on this device, along with the maximum frequency that module can accept. To ensure proper module functionality, the device PLLs and dividers must be programmed not to exceed the maximum frequencies listed in this table. Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency MODULE CLOCK SOURCES Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name AES1 AES1_L3_CLK Int 266 L4SEC_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE AES2 AES2_L3_CLK Int 266 L4SEC_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE BB2D BB2D_FCLK Func 354.6 BB2D_GFCLK BB2D_GFCLK DPLL_CORE BB2D_ICLK Int 266 DSS_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE COUNTER_32K COUNTER_32K_F CLK Func 0.032 FUNC_32K_CLK SYS_32K RTC Oscillator COUNTER_32K_IC LK Int 38.4 WKUPAON_GICLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE 146 Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) CLOCK SOURCES Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name L3INSTR_TS_GCL K Int 4.8 L3INSTR_TS_GCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE CTRL_MODULE_C ORE L4CFG_L4_GICLK Int 133 L4CFG_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE CTRL_MODULE_ WKUP WKUPAON_GICLK Int 38.4 WKUPAON_GICLK DCAN1 DCAN1_FCLK Func 38.4 DCAN1_SYS_CLK DCAN1_ICLK Int 266 WKUPAON_GICLK Instance Name Input Clock Name CTRL_MODULE_B ANDGAP DCAN2 SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE SYS_CLK1 OSC1 SYS_CLK2 OSC2 SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE DCAN2_FCLK Func 38.4 DCAN2_SYS_CLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DCAN2_ICLK Int 266 L4PER2_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE DES3DES DES_CLK_L3 Int 266 L4SEC_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE DLL EMIF_DLL_FCLK Func EMIF_DLL_FC LK EMIF_DLL_GCLK EMIF_DLL_GCLK DPLL_DDR DLL_AGING FCLK Int 38.4 L3INSTR_DLL_AGING _GCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE DMM DMM_CLK Int 266 EMIF_L3_GICLK DPLL_DEBUG SYSCLK Int 38.4 EMU_SYS_CLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DSP1 DSP1_FICLK Int & Func DSP_CLK DSP1_GFCLK DSP_GFCLK DPLL_DSP DSS DSS_HDMI_CEC_ CLK Func 0.032 HDMI_CEC_GFCLK SYS_32K RTC Oscillator DSS_HDMI_PHY_ CLK Func 48 HDMI_PHY_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER DSS_CLK Func 192 DSS_GFCLK DSS_CLK DPLL_PER HDMI_CLKINP Func 38.4 HDMI_DPLL_CLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 SYS_CLK2 OSC2 DSS_L3_ICLK Int 266 DSS_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE VIDEO1_CLKINP Func 38.4 VIDEO1_DPLL_CLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 SYS_CLK2 OSC2 SYS_CLK1 OSC1 VIDEO2_CLKINP Func 38.4 VIDEO2_DPLL_CLK DPLL_DSI1_A_CL K1 Func 209.3 N/A DPLL_DSI1_B_CL K1 Func 209.3 N/A DPLL_DSI1_C_CL K1 Func DPLL_HDMI_CLK1 Func 209.3 185.6 N/A N/A SYS_CLK2 OSC2 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI VIDEO1_CLKOUT1 DPLL_VIDEO1 VIDEO1_CLKOUT3 DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI VIDEO1_CLKOUT3 DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 147 ADVANCE INFORMATION MODULE AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) MODULE CLOCK SOURCES PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name N/A DPLL_DSI1_A_CL K1 See DSS data in the rows above 209.3 N/A DPLL_DSI1_B_CL K1 209.3 N/A DPLL_DSI1_C_CL K1 Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name DSS DISPC LCD1_CLK Func 209.3 LCD2_CLK Func LCD3_CLK Func DSS_CLK DSS_CLK DSS_CLK F_CLK Func 209.3 N/A DPLL_DSI1_A_CL K1 DPLL_DSI1_B_CL K1 ADVANCE INFORMATION DPLL_DSI1_C_CL K1 DSS_CLK DPLL_HDMI_CLK1 EFUSE_CTRL_CU ST ocp_clk Int 133 CUSTEFUSE_L4_GICL K CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE sys_clk Func 38.4 CUSTEFUSE_SYS_GF CLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 ELM ELM_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE EMIF_OCP_FW L3_CLK Int 266 EMIF_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE EMIF_PHY1 EMIF_PHY1_FCLK Func DDR EMIF_PHY_GCLK EMIF_PHY_GCLK DPLL_DDR EMIF1 EMIF1_ICLK Int 266 EMIF_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE GMAC_SW CPTS_RFT_CLK Func 266 GMAC_RFT_CLK PER_ABE_X1_GF CLK DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 GPIO1 DPLL_HDMI CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MAIN_CLK Int 125 GMAC_MAIN_CLK GMAC_250M_CLK DPLL_GMAC MHZ_250_CLK Func 250 GMII_250MHZ_CLK GMII_250MHZ_CL K DPLL_GMAC MHZ_5_CLK Func 5 RGMII_5MHZ_CLK GMAC_RMII_HS_C LK DPLL_GMAC MHZ_50_CLK Func 50 RMII_50MHZ_CLK GMAC_RMII_HS_C LK DPLL_GMAC RMII1_MHZ_50_CL K Func 50 RMII_50MHZ_CLK GMAC_RMII_HS_C LK DPLL_GMAC RMII2_MHZ_50_CL K Func 50 RMII_50MHZ_CLK GMAC_RMII_HS_C LK DPLL_GMAC GPIO1_ICLK Int 38.4 WKUPAON_GICLK GPIO1_DBCLK GPIO2 HDMI_CLK Func 0.032 SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE WKUPAON_SYS_GFC LK WKUPAON_32K_G FCLK GPIO2_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK GPIO2_DBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator DPLL_CORE OSC1 RTC Oscillator 148 Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) MODULE CLOCK SOURCES Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name GPIO3 GPIO3_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE GPIO3_DBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator GPIO5 GPIO6 GPIO7 GPIO8 GPIO4_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE GPIO4_DBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 PIDBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK GPIO5_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK RTC Oscillator DPLL_CORE GPIO5_DBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 PIDBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK GPIO6_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK RTC Oscillator DPLL_CORE GPIO6_DBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 PIDBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK GPIO7_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK RTC Oscillator GPIO7_DBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK PIDBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK DPLL_CORE OSC1 RTC Oscillator GPIO8_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK GPIO8_DBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK PIDBCLK Func 0.032 GPIO_GFCLK DPLL_CORE OSC1 RTC Oscillator GPMC GPMC_FCLK Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE GPU GPU_FCLK1 Func GPU_CLK GPU_CORE_GCLK CORE_GPU_CLK DPLL_CORE PER_GPU_CLK DPLL_PER GPU_FCLK2 Func GPU_CLK GPU_HYD_GCLK GPU_GCLK DPLL_GPU CORE_GPU_CLK DPLL_CORE PER_GPU_CLK DPLL_PER GPU_GCLK DPLL_GPU GPU_ICLK Int 266 GPU_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE HDMI PHY DSS_HDMI_PHY_ CLK Func 38.4 HDMI_PHY_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER HDQ1W HDQ1W_ICLK Int & Func 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE HDQ1W_FCLK Func 12 PER_12M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER I2C1_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE I2C1_FCLK Func 96 PER_96M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER I2C2_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE I2C2_FCLK Func 96 PER_96M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER DPLL_CORE I2C1 I2C2 I2C3 I2C4 I2C5 IEEE1500_2_OCP I2C3_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK I2C3_FCLK Func 96 PER_96M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER I2C4_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE I2C4_FCLK Func 96 PER_96M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER I2C5_ICLK Int 266 IPU_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE I2C5_FCLK Func 96 IPU_96M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER PI_L3CLK Int & Func 266 L3INIT_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 149 ADVANCE INFORMATION GPIO4 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) MODULE Instance Name Input Clock Name IPU1 IPU1_GFCLK IPU2 ADVANCE INFORMATION 150 IPU2_GFCLK CLOCK SOURCES Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name Int & Func 425.6 IPU1_GFCLK Int & Func 425.6 IPU2_GFCLK PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE CORE_IPU_ISS_B OOST_CLK DPLL_CORE CORE_IPU_ISS_B OOST_CLK DPLL_CORE IVA IVA_GCLK Int IVA_GCLK IVA_GCLK IVA_GFCLK DPLL_IVA KBD KBD_FCLK Func 0.032 WKUPAON_SYS_GFC LK WKUPAON_32K_G FCLK OSC1 PICLKKBD Func 0.032 WKUPAON_SYS_GFC LK KBD_ICLK Int 38.4 WKUPAON_GICLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 PICLKOCP Int 38.4 WKUPAON_GICLK DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE L3_INSTR L3_CLK Int L3_CLK L3INSTR_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE L3_MAIN L3_CLK1 Int L3_CLK L3MAIN1_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE L3_CLK2 Int L3_CLK L3INSTR_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE L4_CFG L4_CFG_CLK Int 133 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE L4_PER1 L4_PER1_CLK Int 133 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE L4_PER2 L4_PER2_CLK Int 133 L4PER2_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE L4_PER3 L4_PER3_CLK Int 133 L4PER3_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE L4_WKUP L4_WKUP_CLK Int 38.4 WKUPAON_GICLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE RTC Oscillator MAILBOX1 MAILBOX1_FLCK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MAILBOX2 MAILBOX2_FLCK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MAILBOX3 MAILBOX3_FLCK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MAILBOX4 MAILBOX4_FLCK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MAILBOX5 MAILBOX5_FLCK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MAILBOX6 MAILBOX6_FLCK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MAILBOX7 MAILBOX7_FLCK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MAILBOX8 MAILBOX8_FLCK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MAILBOX9 MAILBOX9_FLCK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MAILBOX10 MAILBOX10_FLCK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MAILBOX11 MAILBOX11_FLCK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MAILBOX12 MAILBOX12_FLCK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MAILBOX13 MAILBOX13_FLCK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) CLOCK SOURCES Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name MCASP1 MCASP1_AHCLKR Func 100 MCASP1_AHCLKR MCASP1_AHCLKX MCASP1_FCLK MCASP1_ICLK Func Func Int 100 192 266 MCASP1_AHCLKX MCASP1_AUX_GFCLK IPU_L3_GICLK PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K PLL / OSC / Source Name DPLL_ABE SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_96M_AON_ CLK DPLL_PER SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_96M_AON_ CLK DPLL_PER SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 PER_ABE_X1_GF CLK DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 151 ADVANCE INFORMATION MODULE AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) MODULE CLOCK SOURCES Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name MCASP2 MCASP2_AHCLKR Func 100 MCASP2_AHCLKR MCASP2_AHCLKX ADVANCE INFORMATION MCASP2_FCLK MCASP3 Func 100 192 MCASP2_AHCLKX MCASP2_AUX_GFCLK DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K PLL / OSC / Source Name DPLL_ABE SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_96M_AON_ CLK DPLL_PER SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_96M_AON_ CLK DPLL_PER SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 PER_ABE_X1_GF CLK DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI MCASP2_ICLK Int 266 L4PER2_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MCASP3_AHCLKX Func 100 MCASP3_AHCLKX DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE MCASP3_FCLK MCASP3_ICLK 152 Func PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name Func Int 192 266 MCASP3_AUX_GFCLK L4PER2_L3_GICLK Specifications SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_96M_AON_ CLK DPLL_PER SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 PER_ABE_X1_GF CLK DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_ABE HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) CLOCK SOURCES Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name MCASP4 MCASP4_AHCLKX Func 100 MCASP4_AHCLKX MCASP4_FCLK MCASP5 192 MCASP4_AUX_GFCLK DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K PLL / OSC / Source Name DPLL_ABE SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_96M_AON_ CLK DPLL_PER SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 PER_ABE_X1_GF CLK DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_ABE HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI MCASP4_ICLK Int 266 L4PER2_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MCASP5_AHCLKX Func 100 MCASP5_AHCLKX DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE MCASP5_FCLK MCASP6 Func PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name Func 192 MCASP5_AUX_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_96M_AON_ CLK DPLL_PER SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 PER_ABE_X1_GF CLK DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_ABE HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI MCASP5_ICLK Int 266 L4PER2_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MCASP6_AHCLKX Func 100 MCASP6_AHCLKX DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE FUNC_96M_AON_ CLK DPLL_PER SYS_CLK1 OSC1 SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 MCASP6_FCLK MCASP6_ICLK Func Int 192 266 MCASP6_AUX_GFCLK L4PER2_L3_GICLK XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 PER_ABE_X1_GF CLK DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_ABE HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION MODULE 153 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) MODULE CLOCK SOURCES Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name MCASP7 MCASP7_AHCLKX Func 100 MCASP7_AHCLKX MCASP7_FCLK ADVANCE INFORMATION MCASP8 MCSPI2 MCSPI3 MCSPI4 CSI2_0 CSI2_1 154 192 MCASP7_AUX_GFCLK DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K PLL / OSC / Source Name DPLL_ABE SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_96M_AON_ CLK DPLL_PER SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 PER_ABE_X1_GF CLK DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_ABE HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI MCASP7_ICLK Int 266 L4PER2_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MCASP8_AHCLKX Func 100 MCASP8_AHCLKX DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE MCASP8_FCLK MCSPI1 Func PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name Func 192 MCASP8_AUX_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_96M_AON_ CLK DPLL_PER SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 PER_ABE_X1_GF CLK DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_ABE HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI MCASP8_ICLK Int 266 L4PER2_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SPI1_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SPI1_FCLK Func 48 PER_48M_GFCLK PER_48M_GFCLK DPLL_PER DPLL_CORE SPI2_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK SPI2_FCLK Func 48 PER_48M_GFCLK PER_48M_GFCLK DPLL_PER SPI3_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SPI3_FCLK Func 48 PER_48M_GFCLK PER_48M_GFCLK DPLL_PER SPI4_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SPI4_FCLK Func 48 PER_48M_GFCLK PER_48M_GFCLK DPLL_PER CTRLCLK Int & Func 96 LVDSRX_96M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER CAL_FCLK Int & Func 266 CAL_GICLK CORE_ISS_MAIN_ CLK DPLL_CORE L3_ICLK CM_CORE_AON CTRLCLK Int & Func 96 LVDSRX_96M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER CAL_FCLK Int & Func 266 CAL_GICLK CORE_ISS_MAIN_ CLK DPLL_CORE L3_ICLK CM_CORE_AON Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) MODULE CLOCK SOURCES Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name MMC1 MMC1_CLK_32K Func 0.032 L3INIT_32K_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 MMC1_FCLK Func 192 MMC1_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER 128 MMC2 DPLL_PER MMC1_ICLK1 Int 266 L3INIT_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MMC1_ICLK2 Int 133 L3INIT_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MMC2_CLK_32K Func 0.032 L3INIT_32K_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 MMC2_FCLK Func 192 MMC2_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER FUNC_256M_CLK DPLL_PER 128 MMC3 FUNC_256M_CLK MMC2_ICLK1 Int 266 L3INIT_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MMC2_ICLK2 Int 133 L3INIT_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MMC3_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MMC3_CLK_32K Func 0.032 L4PER_32K_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 MMC3_FCLK Func 48 MMC3_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER MMC4_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MMC4_CLK_32K Func 0.032 L4PER_32K_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 MMC4_FCLK Func 48 MMC4_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER ADVANCE INFORMATION Instance Name 192 MMC4 192 MMU_EDMA MMU1_CLK Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MMU_PCIESS MMU2_CLK Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE MPU MPU_CLK Int & Func MPU_CLK MPU_GCLK MPU_GCLK DPLL_MPU MPU_EMU_DBG FCLK Int 38.4 EMU_SYS_CLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 MPU_GCLK DPLL_MPU OCMC_RAM1 OCMC1_L3_CLK Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE OCMC_ROM OCMC_L3_CLK Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE OCP_WP_NOC PICLKOCPL3 Int 266 L3INSTR_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE OCP2SCP1 L4CFG1_ADAPTE R_CLKIN Int 133 L3INIT_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE OCP2SCP2 L4CFG2_ADAPTE R_CLKIN Int 133 L4CFG_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE OCP2SCP3 L4CFG3_ADAPTE R_CLKIN Int 133 L3INIT_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE PCIESS1 PCIE1_PHY_WKU P_CLK Func 0.032 PCIE_32K_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK RTC Oscillator PCIe_SS1_FICLK Int 266 PCIE_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE PCIEPHY_CLK Func 2500 PCIE_PHY_GCLK PCIE_PHY_GCLK APLL_PCIE PCIEPHY_CLK_DI V Func 1250 PCIE_PHY_DIV_GCLK PCIE_PHY_DIV_G CLK APLL_PCIE PCIE1_REF_CLKI N Func 34.3 PCIE_REF_GFCLK CORE_USB_OTG_ SS_LFPS_TX_CLK DPLL_CORE PCIE1_PWR_CLK Func 38.4 PCIE_SYS_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 155 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) MODULE Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name PCIE2_PHY_WKU P_CLK Func 0.032 PCIE_32K_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK RTC Oscillator PCIe_SS2_FICLK Func 266 PCIE_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE PCIEPHY_CLK Func 2500 PCIE_PHY_GCLK PCIE_PHY_GCLK APLL_PCIE PCIEPHY_CLK_DI V Func 1250 PCIE_PHY_DIV_GCLK PCIE_PHY_DIV_G CLK APLL_PCIE PCIE2_REF_CLKI N Func 34.3 PCIE_REF_GFCLK CORE_USB_OTG_ SS_LFPS_TX_CLK DPLL_CORE PCIE2_PWR_CLK Func 38.4 PCIE_SYS_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 32K_CLK Func 0.032 FUNC_32K_CLK SYS_32K RTC Oscillator SYS_CLK Func 38.4 WKUPAON_ICLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE Instance Name Input Clock Name PCIESS2 PRCM_MPU ADVANCE INFORMATION PWMSS1 PWMSS1_GICLK Int & Func 266 L4PER2_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE PWMSS2 PWMSS2_GICLK Int & Func 266 L4PER2_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE PWMSS3 PWMSS3_GICLK Int & Func 266 L4PER2_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE QSPI_ICLK Int 266 L4PER2_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE QSPI_FCLK Func 128 QSPI_GFCLK FUNC_256M_CLK DPLL_PER QSPI RNG RTC_SS SAR_ROM SATA RNG_ICLK Int 266 L4SEC_L3_GICLK PER_QSPI_CLK DPLL_PER CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE RTC_ICLK Int 133 RTC_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE RTC_FCLK Func RTC_FCLK RTC_AUX_CLK FUNC_32K_CLK RTC Oscillator PRCM_ROM_CLO CK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SATA_FICLK Int 266 L3INIT_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SATA_PMALIVE_F CLK Func 48 L3INIT_48M_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER REF_CLK Func 38 SATA_REF_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 SDMA SDMA_FCLK Int & Func 266 DMA_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SHA2MD51 SHAM_1_CLK Int 266 L4SEC_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SHA2MD52 SHAM_2_CLK Int 266 L4SEC_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SL2 IVA_GCLK Int IVA_GCLK IVA_GCLK IVA_GFCLK DPLL_IVA DPLL_CORE SMARTREFLEX_C ORE SMARTREFLEX_D SP SMARTREFLEX_G PU 156 CLOCK SOURCES MCLK Int 133 COREAON_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK SYSCLK Func 38.4 WKUPAON_ICLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE DPLL_CORE MCLK Int 133 COREAON_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK SYSCLK Func 38.4 WKUPAON_ICLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE DPLL_CORE MCLK Int 133 COREAON_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK SYSCLK Func 38.4 WKUPAON_ICLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) CLOCK SOURCES Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name SMARTREFLEX_IV AHD MCLK Int 133 COREAON_L4_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SYSCLK Func 38.4 WKUPAON_ICLK SMARTREFLEX_M PU MCLK Int 133 COREAON_L4_GICLK SYSCLK Func 38.4 WKUPAON_ICLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE DPLL_CORE SPINLOCK SPINLOCK_ICLK Int 266 L4CFG_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK TIMER1 TIMER1_ICLK Int 38.4 WKUPAON_GICLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE SYS_CLK1 OSC1 TIMER1_FCLK Func 100 TIMER1_GFCLK FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator TIMER2 TIMER2_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK TIMER2_FCLK Func 100 TIMER2_GFCLK SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 157 ADVANCE INFORMATION MODULE AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) MODULE CLOCK SOURCES Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name TIMER3 TIMER3_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER3_FCLK Func 100 TIMER3_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator ADVANCE INFORMATION TIMER4 SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI TIMER4_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER4_FCLK Func 100 TIMER4_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator TIMER5 SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI TIMER5_ICLK Int 266 IPU_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER5_FCLK Func 100 TIMER5_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator 158 Specifications SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI CLKOUTMUX[0] CLKOUTMUX[0] Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) MODULE CLOCK SOURCES Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name TIMER6 TIMER6_ICLK Int 266 IPU_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER6_FCLK Func 100 TIMER6_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 TIMER7 TIMER7_ICLK Int 266 IPU_L3_GICLK TIMER7_FCLK Func 100 TIMER7_GFCLK SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI CLKOUTMUX[0] CLKOUTMUX[0] CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator TIMER8 SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI CLKOUTMUX[0] CLKOUTMUX[0] TIMER8_ICLK Int 266 IPU_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER8_FCLK Func 100 TIMER8_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI CLKOUTMUX[0] CLKOUTMUX[0] Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 159 ADVANCE INFORMATION RTC Oscillator AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) MODULE CLOCK SOURCES Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name TIMER9 TIMER9_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER9_FCLK Func 100 TIMER9_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator ADVANCE INFORMATION TIMER10 SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI TIMER10_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER10_FCLK Func 100 TIMER10_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator TIMER11 SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI TIMER11_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER11_FCLK Func 100 TIMER11_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator TIMER12 TIMER12_ICLK TIMER12_FCLK 160 Int Func 38.4 0.032 WKUPAON_GICLK OSC_32K_CLK Specifications SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE RC_CLK RC oscillator Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) MODULE CLOCK SOURCES Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name TIMER13 TIMER13_ICLK Int 266 L4PER3_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER13_FCLK Func 100 TIMER13_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 TIMER14 SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI TIMER14_ICLK Int 266 L4PER3_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER14_FCLK Func 100 TIMER14_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator TIMER15 SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI TIMER15_ICLK Int 266 L4PER3_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER15_FCLK Func 100 TIMER15_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator SYS_CLK2 OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 161 ADVANCE INFORMATION RTC Oscillator AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) MODULE CLOCK SOURCES Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name TIMER16 TIMER16_ICLK Int 266 L4PER3_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TIMER16_FCLK Func 100 TIMER16_GFCLK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 FUNC_32K_CLK OSC1 RTC Oscillator OSC2 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK0 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK1 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK2 XREF_CLK3 XREF_CLK3 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE VIDEO1_CLK DPLL_VIDEO1 ADVANCE INFORMATION HDMI_CLK DPLL_HDMI TPCC TPCC_GCLK Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TPTC1 TPTC0_GCLK Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE TPTC2 TPTC1_GCLK Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE UART1 UART1_FCLK Func 48 UART1_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER UART1_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE UART2_FCLK Func 48 UART2_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER UART2_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE UART3_FCLK Func 48 UART3_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER UART3_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE UART4_FCLK Func 48 UART4_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER UART4_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE UART5 UART5_FCLK Func 48 UART5_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER UART5_ICLK Int 266 L4PER_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE UART6 UART6_FCLK Func 48 UART6_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER UART6_ICLK Int 266 IPU_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE UART7_FCLK Func 48 UART7_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER UART7_ICLK Int 266 L4PER2_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE UART8_FCLK Func 48 UART8_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER UART8_ICLK Int 266 L4PER2_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE UART9_FCLK Func 48 UART9_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER UART9_ICLK Int 266 L4PER2_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE UART10_FCLK Func 48 UART10_GFCLK FUNC_192M_CLK DPLL_PER UART10_ICLK Int 38.4 WKUPAON_GICLK UART2 UART3 UART4 UART7 UART8 UART9 UART10 USB1 162 SYS_CLK2 SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE USB1_MICLK Int 266 L3INIT_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE USB3PHY_REF_C LK Func 34.3 USB_LFPS_TX_GFCL K CORE_USB_OTG_ SS_LFPS_TX_CLK DPLL_CORE USB2PHY1_TREF _CLK Func 38.4 USB_OTG_SS_REF_C LK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 USB2PHY1_REF_ CLK Func 960 L3INIT_960M_GFCLK L3INIT_960_GFCL K DPLL_USB Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 5-9. Maximum Supported Frequency (continued) CLOCK SOURCES Instance Name Input Clock Name Clock Type Max. Clock Allowed (MHz) PRCM Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Clock Name PLL / OSC / Source Name USB2 USB2_MICLK Int 266 L3INIT_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE USB2PHY2_TREF _CLK Func 38.4 USB_OTG_SS_REF_C LK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 USB2PHY2_REF_ CLK Func 960 L3INIT_960M_GFCLK L3INIT_960_GFCL K DPLL_USB USB_PHY1_CORE USB2PHY1_WKUP _CLK Func 0.032 COREAON_32K_GFCL K SYS_32K RTC Oscillator USB_PHY2_CORE USB2PHY2_WKUP _CLK Func 0.032 COREAON_32K_GFCL K SYS_32K RTC Oscillator USB_PHY3_CORE USB3PHY_WKUP_ CLK Func 0.032 COREAON_32K_GFCL K SYS_32K RTC Oscillator Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE VCP1 VCP1_CLK VCP2 VCP2_CLK Int 266 L3MAIN1_L3_GICLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE VIP1 L3_CLK_PROC_CL K Int & Func 266 VIP1_GCLK CORE_X2_CLK DPLL_CORE CORE_ISS_MAIN_ CLK DPLL_CORE L3_CLK_PROC_CL K Int & Func 300 CORE_ISS_MAIN_ CLK DPLL_CORE VIDEO1_CLKOUT4 DPLL_VIDEO1 VPE WD_TIMER1 WD_TIMER2 PIOCPCLK 38.4 WKUPAON_GICLK PITIMERCLK Func 0.032 OSC_32K_CLK WD_TIMER2_ICLK Int 38.4 WKUPAON_GICLK WD_TIMER2_FCL K 5.6 Int VPE_GCLK Func 0.032 WKUPAON_SYS_GFC LK SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE RC_CLK RC oscillator SYS_CLK1 OSC1 DPLL_ABE_X2_CL K DPLL_ABE WKUPAON_32K_G FCLK RTC Oscillator Electrical Characteristics NOTE The data specified in Section 5.6.1 through Section 5.6.14 are subject to change. NOTE The interfaces or signals described in Section 5.6.1 through Section 5.6.14 correspond to the interfaces or signals available in multiplexing mode 0 (Function 1). All interfaces or signals multiplexed on the balls described in these tables have the same DC electrical characteristics, unless multiplexing involves a PHY/GPIO combination in which case different DC electrical characteristics are specified for the different multiplexing modes (Functions). 5.6.1 LVCMOS DDR DC Electrical Characteristics Table 5-10 summarizes the DC electrical characteristics for LVCMOS DDR Buffers. Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 163 ADVANCE INFORMATION MODULE AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com NOTE For more information on the I/O cell configurations (i[2:0], sr[1:0]), see the Chapter Control Module of the Device TRM. Table 5-10. LVCMOS DDR DC Electrical Characteristics PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT Signal Names in MUXMODE 0 (Single-Ended Signals): ddr1_d[31:0], ddr1_a[15:0], ddr1_dqm[3:0], ddr1_ba[2:0], ddr1_csn[1:0], ddr1_cke, ddr1_odt[1:0], ddr1_casn, ddr1_rasn, ddr1_wen, ddr1_rst, ddr1_ecc_d[7:0], ddr1_dqm_ecc; Balls: AH23 / AB16 / AG22 / AE20 / AC17 / AC18 / AF20 /AH21 / AG21 / AF17 / AE18 / AB18 / AD20 / AC19 / AC20 / AB19 / AF21 / AH22 / AG23 / AE21 / AF22 / AE22 / AD21 / AD22 / AC21 / AF18 / AE17 / AD18 / AF25 / AF26 / AG26 / AH26 / AF24 / AE24 / AF23 / AE23 / AC23 / AF27 / AG27 / AF28 / AE26 / AC25 / AC24 / AD25 / V20 / W20 / AB28 / AC28 / AC27 / Y19 / AB27 / Y20 / AA23 / Y22 / Y23 / AA24 / Y24 / AA26 / AA25 / AA28 / W22 / V23 / W19 / W23 / Y25 / V24 / V25 / Y26 / AD23 / AB23 / AC26 / AA27 / V26; Driver Mode VOH High-level output threshold (IOH = 0.1 mA) VOL Low-level output threshold (IOL = 0.1 mA) CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) ADVANCE INFORMATION ZO Output impedance (drive strength) 0.9*VDDS V l[2:0] = 000 (Imp80) 80 l[2:0] = 001 (Imp60) 60 l[2:0] = 010 (Imp48) 48 l[2:0] = 011 (Imp40) 40 l[2:0] = 100 (Imp34) 34 0.1*VDDS V 3 pF Ω Single-Ended Receiver Mode VIH High-level input threshold DDR3/DDR3L DDR3/DDR3L VIL Low-level input threshold VCM Input common-mode voltage CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) VREF+0.1 VDDS+0.2 V -0.2 VREF-0.1 V VREF 10%vdds VREF+ 10%vdds V 3 pF Signal Names in MUXMODE 0 (Differential Signals): ddr1_dqs[3:0], ddr1_dqsn[3:0], ddr1_ck, ddr1_nck, ddr1_dqs_ecc, ddr1_dqsn_ecc Bottom Balls: AH25 / AG25 / AE27 / AE28 / AD27 / AD28 / Y28 / Y27 / V27 / V28 / AG24 / AH24 Driver Mode VOH High-level output threshold (IOH = 0.1 mA) VOL Low-level output threshold (IOL = 0.1 mA) CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) ZO Output impedance (drive strength) 0.9*VDDS V l[2:0] = 000 (Imp80) 80 l[2:0] = 001 (Imp60) 60 l[2:0] = 010 (Imp48) 48 l[2:0] = 011 (Imp40) 40 l[2:0] = 100 (Imp34) 34 0.1*VDDS V 3 pF Ω Single-Ended Receiver Mode 164 VIH High-level input threshold DDR3/DDR3L VREF+0.1 VDDS+0.2 V VIL Low-level input threshold DDR3/DDR3L -0.2 VREF-0.1 V VCM Input common-mode voltage VREF 10%vdds VREF+ 10%vdds V Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 5-10. LVCMOS DDR DC Electrical Characteristics (continued) PARAMETER CPAD MIN NOM MAX Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) UNIT 3 pF 0.2 vdds+0.4 V VREF 10%vdds VREF+ 10%vdds V 3 pF Differential Receiver Mode VSWING Input voltage swing DDR3/DDR3L VCM Input common-mode voltage CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) (1) VDDS in this table stands for corresponding power supply (i.e. vdds_ddr1). For more information on the power supply name and the corresponding ball, see Table 4-2, POWER [10] column. (2) VREF in this table stands for corresponding Reference Power Supply (i.e. ddr1_vref0). For more information on the power supply name and the corresponding ball, see Table 4-2, POWER [10] column. 5.6.2 HDMIPHY DC Electrical Characteristics The HDMIPHY DC Electrical Characteristics are compliant with the HDMI 1.4a specification and are not reproduced here. ADVANCE INFORMATION Dual Voltage LVCMOS I2C DC Electrical Characteristics 5.6.3 Table 5-11 summarizes the DC electrical characteristics for Dual Voltage LVCMOS I2C Buffers. NOTE For more information on the I/O cell configurations, see the Control Module section of the Device TRM. Table 5-11. Dual Voltage LVCMOS I2C DC Electrical Characteristics PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT Signal Names in MUXMODE 0: i2c2_scl; i2c1_scl; i2c1_sda; i2c2_sda; Balls: F17 / C20 / C21 / C25 I2C Standard Mode – 1.8 V VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold Vhys Hysteresis 0.7*VDDS V 0.3*VDDS 0.1*VDDS V V IIN Input current at each I/O pin with an input voltage between 0.1*VDDS to 0.9*VDDS 12 µA IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) for BIDI cell. This current is contributed by the tristated driver leakage + input current of the Rx + weak pullup/pulldown leakage. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ 12 µA CIN Input capacitance 10 pF 0.2*VDDS V VOL3 Output low-level threshold open-drain at 3-mA sink current IOLmin Low-level output current @VOL=0.2*VDDS tOF 3 Output fall time from VIHmin to VILmax with a bus capacitance CB from 5 pF to 400 pF mA 250 ns I2C Fast Mode – 1.8 V VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold Vhys Hysteresis IIN 0.7*VDDS V 0.3*VDDS V 12 µA 0.1*VDDS Input current at each I/O pin with an input voltage between 0.1*VDDS to 0.9*VDDS V Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 165 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 5-11. Dual Voltage LVCMOS I2C DC Electrical Characteristics (continued) PARAMETER MIN IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) for BIDI cell. This current is contributed by the tristated driver leakage + input current of the Rx + weak pullup/pulldown leakage. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ CIN Input capacitance VOL3 Output low-level threshold open-drain at 3-mA sink current IOLmin Low-level output current @VOL=0.2*VDDS tOF Output fall time from VIHmin to VILmax with a bus capacitance CB from 10 pF to 400 pF NOM MAX µA 10 pF 0.2*VDDS V 3 20+0.1*Cb UNIT 12 mA 250 ns I2C Standard Mode – 3.3 V VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold Vhys Hysteresis 0.7*VDDS V 0.3*VDDS 0.05*VDDS V V ADVANCE INFORMATION IIN Input current at each I/O pin with an input voltage between 0.1*VDDS to 0.9*VDDS 31 80 µA IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) for BIDI cell. This current is contributed by the tristated driver leakage + input current of the Rx + weak pullup/pulldown leakage. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ 31 80 µA CIN Input capacitance 10 pF VOL3 Output low-level threshold open-drain at 3-mA sink current 0.4 V IOLmin Low-level output current @VOL=0.4V 3 mA IOLmin Low-level output current @VOL=0.6V for full drive load (400pF/400KHz) 6 mA tOF Output fall time from VIHmin to VILmax with a bus capacitance CB from 5 pF to 400 pF 250 ns I2C Fast Mode – 3.3 V VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold Vhys Hysteresis V 0.3*VDDS V 0.05*VDDS V IIN Input current at each I/O pin with an input voltage between 0.1*VDDS to 0.9*VDDSS 31 80 µA IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) for BIDI cell. This current is contributed by the tristated driver leakage + input current of the Rx + weak pullup/pulldown leakage. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ 31 80 µA CIN Input capacitance 10 pF VOL3 Output low-level threshold open-drain at 3-mA sink current 0.4 V IOLmin Low-level output current @VOL=0.4V 3 mA IOLmin Low-level output current @VOL=0.6V for full drive load (400pF/400KHz) 6 mA tOF 166 0.7*VDDS Output fall time from VIHmin to VILmax with a bus capacitance CB from 10 pF to 200 pF (Proper External Resistor Value should be used as per I2C spec) 20+0.1*Cb 250 Output fall time from VIHmin to VILmax with a bus capacitance CB from 300 pF to 400 pF (Proper External Resistor Value should be used as per I2C spec) 40 290 Specifications ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 (1) VDDS in this table stands for corresponding power supply (i.e. vddshv3). For more information on the power supply name and the corresponding ball, see Table 4-2, POWER [10] column. 5.6.4 IQ1833 Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics Table 5-12 summarizes the DC electrical characteristics for IQ1833 Buffers. Table 5-12. IQ1833 Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT Signal Names in MUXMODE 0: tclk; Balls: E20; 1.8-V Mode VIH Input high-level threshold (Does not meet JEDEC VIH) 0.75 * VDDS V VIL Input low-level threshold (Does not meet JEDEC VIL) VHYS Input hysteresis voltage IIN Input current at each I/O pin 2 µA CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) 1 pF 0.25 * VDDS V mV ADVANCE INFORMATION 100 3.3-V Mode VIH Input high-level threshold (Does not meet JEDEC VIH) VIL Input low-level threshold (Does not meet JEDEC VIL) VHYS Input hysteresis voltage IIN Input current at each I/O pin 5 µA CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) 1 pF 5.6.5 2.0 V 0.6 V 400 mV IHHV1833 Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics Table 5-13 summarizes the DC electrical characteristics for IHHV1833 Buffers. Table 5-13. IHHV1833 Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT Signal Names in MUXMODE 0: porz / rtc_iso / rtc_porz / wakeup [3:0]; Balls: F22 / AF14 / AB17 / AD17 / AC17 / AB16 / AC16; 1.8-V Mode VIH Input high-level threshold 1.2 VIL Input low-level threshold VHYS Input hysteresis voltage IIN Input current at each I/O pin CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) V 0.4 40 0.02 V mV 1 µA 1 pF 3.3-V Mode VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold VHYS Input hysteresis voltage IIN Input current at each I/O pin CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) 5.6.6 1.2 V 0.4 40 5 V mV 8 µA 1 pF LVCMOS OSC Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics Table 5-14 summarizes the DC electrical characteristics for LVCMOS OSC Buffers. Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 167 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 5-14. LVCMOS OSC Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT Signal Names in MUXMODE 0: rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 / rtc_osc_xo; Balls: AE14 / AD14; 1.8-V Mode 5.6.7 VIH Input high-level threshold 0.65 * VDDS VIL Input low-level threshold VHYS Input hysteresis voltage CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) V 0.35 * VDDS 150 V mV 3 pF LVCMOS CSI2 DC Electrical Characteristics Table 5-15 summarizes the DC electrical characteristics for LVSMOS CSI2 Buffers. Table 5-15. LVCMOS CSI2 DC Electrical Characteristics ADVANCE INFORMATION PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT 1350 mV Signals MUXMODE0 : csi2_0_dx[4:0]; csi2_0_dy[4:0]; csi2_1_dx[2:0]; csi2_1_dy[2:0]; Bottom Balls: AE1 / AD2 / AF1 / AE2 / AF2 / AF3 / AH4 / AG4 / AH3 / AG3 / AG5 / AH5 / AG6 / AH6 / AH7 / AG7 MIPI D-PHY Mode Low-Power Receiver (LP-RX) VIH Input high-level voltage 880 VIL Input low-level voltage 550 mV VITH Input high-level threshold 880 mV VITL Input low-level threshold VHYS Input hysteresis 550 mV 25 mV 880 mV MIPI D-PHY Mode Ultralow Power Receiver (ULP-RX) VIH Input high-level voltage VIL Input low-level voltage 300 mV VITH Input high-level threshold 880 mV VITL Input low-level threshold VHYS Input hysteresis 300 mV 25 mV MIPI D-PHY Mode High-Speed Receiver (HS-RX) VIDTH Differential input high-level threshold VIDTL Differential input low-level threshold –70 mV VIDMAX Maximum differential input voltage 270 mV VIHHS Single-ended input high voltage 460 mV VILHS Single-ended input low voltage VCMRXDC ZID 70 mV –40 Differential input common-mode voltage 70 Differential input impedance 80 mV 100 330 mV 125 Ω (1) VITH is the voltage at which the receiver is required to detect a high state in the input signal. (2) VITL is the voltage at which the receiver is required to detect a low state in the input signal. VITL is larger than the maximum single-ended line high voltage during HS transmission. Therefore, both low-power (LP) receivers will detect low during HS signaling. (3) To reduce noise sensitivity on the received signal, the LP receiver is required to incorporate a hysteresis, VHYST. VHYST is the difference between the VITH threshold and the VITL threshold. (4) VITL is the voltage at which the receiver is required to detect a low state in the input signal. Specification is relaxed for detecting 0 during ultralow power (ULP) state. The LP receiver is not required to detect HS single-ended voltage as 0 in this state. (5) Excluding possible additional RF interference of 200 mVPP beyond 450 MHz. (6) This value includes a ground difference of 50 mV between the transmitter and the receiver, the static common-mode level tolerance and variations below 450 MHz. (7) This number corresponds to the VODMAX transmitter. (8) Common mode is defined as the average voltage level of X and Y: VCMRX = (VX + VY) / 2. 168 Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 (9) Common mode ripple may be due to tR or tF and transmission line impairments in the PCB. (10) For more information regarding the pin name (or ball name) and corresponding signal name, see Table 4-7, CSI 2 Signal Descriptions. 5.6.8 BMLB18 Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics Table 5-16 summarizes the DC electrical characteristics for BMLB18 Buffers. Table 5-16. BMLB18 Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT Signal Names in MUXMODE 0: mlbp_dat_n / mlbp_dat_p / mlbp_sig_n / mlbp_sig_p / mlbp_clk_n / mlbp_clk_p; Balls: AB2 / AB1 / AA2 / AA1 / AC2 / AC1; 1.8-V Mode Input high-level threshold VHYS Input hysteresis voltage VOD Differential output voltage (measured with 50ohm resistor between PAD and PADN) VCM Common mode output voltage CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) 5.6.9 VCM ± 50mV V NONE mV 300 500 mV 1 1.5 V 4 pF ADVANCE INFORMATION VIH/VIL BC1833IHHV Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics Table 5-17 summarizes the DC electrical characteristics for BC1833IHHV Buffers. Table 5-17. BC1833IHHV Buffers DC Electrical Characteristics PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT Signal Names in MUXMODE 0: on_off; Balls: Y11; 1.8-V Mode VOH Output high-level threshold (IOH = 2 mA) VDDS0.45 VOL Output low-level threshold (IOL = 2 mA) IDRIVE Pin Drive strength at PAD Voltage = 0.45V or VDDS-0.45V 6 IIN Input current at each I/O pin 6 IOZ CPAD V 0.45 V mA 12 µA IOZ(IPAD Current) for BIDI cell. This current is contributed by the tristated driver leakage + input current of the Rx + weak pullup/pulldown leakage. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ 6 µA Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) 4 pF 3.3-V Mode VOH Output high-level threshold (IOH =100µA) VDDS-0.2 V VOL Output low-level threshold (IOL = 100µA) IDRIVE Pin Drive strength at PAD Voltage = 0.45V or VDDS-0.45V IIN Input current at each I/O pin 60 µA IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) for BIDI cell. This current is contributed by the tristated driver leakage + input current of the Rx + weak pullup/pulldown leakage. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ 60 µA CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) 4 pF 0.2 6 Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback V mA 169 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 5.6.10 USBPHY DC Electrical Characteristics NOTE USB1 instance is compliant with the USB3.0 SuperSpeed Transmitter and Receiver Normative Electrical Parameters as defined in the USB3.0 Specification Rev 1.0 dated Jun 6, 2011. NOTE USB1 and USB2 Electrical Characteristics are compliant with USB2.0 Specification Rev 2.0 dated April 27, 2000 including ECNs and Errata as applicable. 5.6.11 Dual Voltage SDIO1833 DC Electrical Characteristics Table 5-18 summarizes the DC electrical characteristics for SDIO1833 Buffers. Table 5-18. Dual Voltage SDIO1833 DC Electrical Characteristics ADVANCE INFORMATION PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT Signal Names in Mode 0: mmc1_clk, mmc1_cmd, mmc1_data[3:0] Bottom Balls: W6 / Y6 / AA6 / Y4 / AA5 / Y3 1.8-V Mode VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold 1.27 V 0.58 V VHYS Input hysteresis voltage IIN Input current at each I/O pin 30 µA IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) for BIDI cell. This current is contributed by the tristated driver leakage + input current of the Rx + weak pullup/pulldown leakage. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ 30 µA IIN with Input current at each I/O pin with weak pulldown enabled measured when PAD = VDDS 50 120 210 µA Input current at each I/O pin with weak pullup enabled measured when PAD = 0 60 120 200 µA 5 pF pulldown enabled IIN with pullup enabled 50 (2) CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) VOH Output high-level threshold (IOH = 2 mA) VOL Output low-level threshold (IOL = 2 mA) mV 1.4 V 0.45 V 3.3-V Mode VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold VHYS Input hysteresis voltage IIN Input current at each I/O pin 110 µA IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) for BIDI cell. This current is contributed by the tristated driver leakage + input current of the Rx + weak pullup/pulldown leakage. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ 110 µA IIN with Input current at each I/O pin with weak pulldown enabled measured when PAD = VDDS 40 100 290 µA Input current at each I/O pin with weak pullup enabled measured when PAD = 0 10 100 290 µA 5 pF pulldown enabled IIN with pullup enabled CPAD 170 0.625 × VDDS V 0.25 × VDDS 40 Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) Specifications (2) V mV Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 5-18. Dual Voltage SDIO1833 DC Electrical Characteristics (continued) PARAMETER VOH Output high-level threshold (IOH = 2 mA) VOL Output low-level threshold (IOL = 2 mA) MIN NOM MAX 0.75 × VDDS UNIT V 0.125 × VDDS V (1) VDDS in this table stands for corresponding power supply. For more information on the power supply name and the corresponding ball, see Table 4-2, POWER [10] column. (2) Hysteresis is enabled/disabled with CTRL_CORE_CONTROL_HYST_1.SDCARD_HYST register. 5.6.12 Dual Voltage LVCMOS DC Electrical Characteristics Table 5-19 summarizes the DC electrical characteristics for Dual Voltage LVCMOS Buffers. Table 5-19. Dual Voltage LVCMOS DC Electrical Characteristics PARAMETER MIN NOM MAX UNIT 1.8-V Mode VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold VHYS Input hysteresis voltage VOH Output high-level threshold (IOH = 2 mA) VOL Output low-level threshold (IOL = 2 mA) IDRIVE Pin Drive strength at PAD Voltage = 0.45V or VDDS-0.45V IIN Input current at each I/O pin 16 µA IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) for BIDI cell. This current is contributed by the tristated driver leakage + input current of the Rx + weak pullup/pulldown leakage. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ 16 µA IIN with pulldown Input current at each I/O pin with weak pulldown enabled measured when PAD = VDDS 50 120 210 µA Input current at each I/O pin with weak pullup enabled measured when PAD = 0 60 120 200 µA enabled CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) 4 pF ZO Output impedance (drive strength) IIN with pullup V 0.35*VDDS 100 V ADVANCE INFORMATION enabled 0.65*VDDS mV VDDS-0.45 V 0.45 6 V mA Ω 40 3.3-V Mode VIH Input high-level threshold VIL Input low-level threshold VHYS Input hysteresis voltage VOH Output high-level threshold (IOH = 100 µA) VOL Output low-level threshold (IOL = 100 µA) IDRIVE Pin Drive strength at PAD Voltage = 0.45V or VDDS-0.45V IIN Input current at each I/O pin 65 µA IOZ IOZ(IPAD Current) for BIDI cell. This current is contributed by the tristated driver leakage + input current of the Rx + weak pullup/pulldown leakage. PAD is swept from 0 to VDDS and the Max(I(PAD)) is measured and is reported as IOZ 65 µA IIN with pulldown Input current at each I/O pin with weak pulldown enabled measured when PAD = VDDS 40 100 200 µA Input current at each I/O pin with weak pullup enabled measured when PAD = 0 10 100 290 µA enabled CPAD Pad capacitance (including package capacitance) 4 pF ZO Output impedance (drive strength) enabled IIN with pullup 2 V 0.8 200 V mV VDDS-0.2 V 0.2 6 V mA 40 Ω Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 171 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) VDDS in this table stands for corresponding power supply. For more information on the power supply name and the corresponding ball, see Table 4-2, POWER [10] column. 5.6.13 SATAPHY DC Electrical Characteristics NOTE The SATA module is compliant with the electrical parameters specified in the SATA-IO SATA Specification, Revision 3.2, August 7, 2013. 5.6.14 SERDES DC Electrical Characteristics NOTE The PCIe interfaces are compliant with the electrical parameters specified in PCI Express® Base Specification Revision 2.0. NOTE ADVANCE INFORMATION USB1 instance is compliant with the USB3.0 SuperSpeed Transmitter and Receiver Normative Electrical Parameters as defined in the USB3.0 Specification Rev 1.0 dated Jun 6, 2011. 5.7 Thermal Characteristics For reliability and operability concerns, the maximum junction temperature of the Device has to be at or below the TJ value identified in Table 5-4, Recommended Operating Conditions. It is recommended to perform thermal simulations at the system level with the worst case device power consumption. 5.7.1 Package Thermal Characteristics Table 5-20 provides the thermal resistance characteristics for the package used on this device. NOTE Power dissipation of 1.5 W and an ambient temperature of 85ºC is assumed for ABC package. Table 5-20. Thermal Resistance Characteristics PARAMETER DESCRIPTION °C/W(1) AIR FLOW (m/s)(2) T1 RΘJC Junction-to-case 0.41 N/A T2 RΘJB Junction-to-board 4.74 N/A Junction-to-free air 11.9 0 8.9 1 8.0 2 T6 7.4 3 T7 0.22 0 0.22 1 0.22 2 0.23 3 NO. T3 T4 T5 T8 T9 RΘJA ΨJT Junction-to-moving air Junction-to-package top T10 172 Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 5-20. Thermal Resistance Characteristics (continued) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION T11 T12 T13 ΨJB Junction-to-board T14 °C/W(1) AIR FLOW (m/s)(2) 4.12 0 3.73 1 3.59 2 3.48 3 (1) These measurements were conducted in a JEDEC defined 2S2P system (with the exception of the Theta JC [RΘJC] measurement, which was conducted in a JEDEC defined 1S0P system) and will change based on environment as well as application. For more information, see these EIA/JEDEC standards: – JESD51-2, Integrated Circuits Thermal Test Method Environment Conditions - Natural Convection (Still Air) – JESD51-3, Low Effective Thermal Conductivity Test Board for Leaded Surface Mount Packages – JESD51-7, High Effective Thermal Conductivity Test Board for Leaded Surface Mount Packages – JESD51-9, Test Boards for Area Array Surface Mount Packages ADVANCE INFORMATION (2) m/s = meters per second Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 173 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 5.8 www.ti.com Power Supply Sequences This section describes the power-up and power-down sequence required to ensure proper device operation. The power supply names described in this section comprise a superset of a family of compatible devices. Some members of this family will not include a subset of these power supplies and their associated device modules. Refer to the Section 4.2, Ball Characteristics of the Section 4, Terminal Configuration and Functions to determine which power supplies are applicable. NOTE RTC only mode is not supported feature. ADVANCE INFORMATION 174 Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Figure 5-1 and Figure 5-2 describe the device Power Sequencing when RTC-mode is NOT used. Note 4 Note 5 vdds18v, vdds_mlbp, vdds18v_ddr1, vdda_rtc(3) vdda_per, vdda_ddr, vdda_debug, vdda_dsp_iva, vdda_core_gmac, vdda_gpu, vdda_video, vdda_mpu, vdda_osc, vdda_csi vdds_ddr1, ddr1_vref0 VD_CORE BOOT voltage vdd, vdd_rtc (3) VD_MPU BOOT voltage vdd_mpu VD_IVA BOOT voltage ADVANCE INFORMATION vdd_iva VD_GPU BOOT voltage vdd_gpu VD_DSP BOOT voltage vdd_dsp vdda_usb1, vdda_usb2, vdda_hdmi, vdda_pcie, vdda_pcie0, vdda_sata, vdda_usb3 vddshv1, vddshv2, vddshv3, vddshv4, (3) vddshv5 , vddshv6, vddshv7, vddshv9, vddshv10, vddshv11 Note 6 vdda33v_usb1, vdda33v_usb2 Note 7 vddshv8 xi_osc0 Note 9 rtc_porz Note 11 resetn/porz Note 12 sysboot[15:0] Note 13 Valid Config Note 14 rstoutn SPRS906_ELCH_04 Figure 5-1. Power-Up Sequencing (1) Grey shaded areas are windows where it is valid to ramp the voltage rail. (2) Blue dashed lines are not valid windows but show alternate ramp possibilities based on the associated note. (3) RTC-only mode is not used and the following combinations are approved: Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 175 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com - vdda_rtc can be combined with vdds18v - vdd_rtc can be combined with vdd - vddshv5 can be combined with other 1.8V or 3.3V vddshvn rails. If combinations listed above are not followed then sequencing for these 3 voltage rails should follow the RTC mode timing requirements. (4) vdd must ramp before or at the same time as vdd_mpu, vdd_gpu, vdd_dsp and vdd_iva. (5) vdd_mpu, vdd_gpu, vdd_dsp, vdd_iva can be ramped at the same time or can be staggered. (6) If any of the vddshv[1-7,9-11] rails (not including vddshv8) are used as 1.8V only, then these rails can be combined with vdds18v. (7) vddshv8 is separated out to show support for dual voltage. If single voltage is used then vddshv8 can be combined with other vddshvn rails but vddshv8 must ramp after vdd. (8) vdds and vdda rails must not be combined together, with the one exception of vdda_rtc when RTC-mode is not supported. (9) Pulse duration: rtc_porz must remain low 1ms after all supplies are ramped and stable. (10) The SYS_32K source must be stable and at a valid frequency 1ms prior to de-asserting rtc_porz high. (11) Pulse duration: resetn/porz must remain low a minimum of 12P(15) after xi_osc0 is stable and at a valid frequency. (12) Setup time: sysboot[15:0] pins must be valid 2P(15) before porz and resetn are de-asserted high. (13) Hold time: sysboot[15:0] pins must be valid 15P(15) after porz and resetn are de-asserted high. (14) resetn to rstoutn delay is 2ms. (15) P = 1/(SYS_CLK1/610) frequency in ns. ADVANCE INFORMATION 176 Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Note 5 Note 6 porz Note 8 vddshv8 vdda33v_usb1, vdda33v_usb2 Note 7 vdda_usb1, vdda_usb2, vdda_hdmi, vdda_pcie, vdda_pcie0, vdda_sata, vdda_usb3 ADVANCE INFORMATION vdd_dsp vdd_gpu vdd_iva vdd_mpu vdd, vdd_rtc (4) vdds_ddr1, ddr1_vref0 vdda_per, vdda_ddr, vdda_debug, vdda_dsp_iva, vdda_core_gmac, vdda_gpu, vdda_video, vdda_mpu, vdda_osc, vdda_csi vdds18v, vdds_mlbp, vdds18v_ddr1, (4) vdda_rtc xi_osc0 SPRS906_ELCH_05 Figure 5-2. Power-Down Sequencing (1) Grey shaded areas are windows where it is valid to ramp the voltage rail. (2) Blue dashed lines are not valid windows but show alternate ramp possibilities based on the associated note. (3) xi_osc0 can be turned off anytime after porz assertion and must be turned off before vdda_osc voltage rail is shutdown. (4) RTC-only mode is not used and the following combinations are approved: - vdda_rtc can be combined with vdds18v - vdd_rtc can be combined with vdd - vddshv5 can be combined with other 1.8V or 3.3V vddshvn rails If combinations listed above are not followed then sequencing for these 3 voltage rails should follow the RTC mode timing requirements. (5) vdd_mpu, vdd_gpu, vdd_dsp, vdd_iva can be ramped at the same time or can be staggered. (6) vdd must ramp after or at the same time as vdd_mpu, vdd_gpu, vdd_dsp and vdd_iva (7) If any of the vddshv[1-7,9-11] rails (not including vddshv8) are used as 1.8V only, then these rails can be combined with vdds18v. vddshv[1-7,9-11] is allowed to ramp down at either of the two points shown in the timing diagram in either 1.8V mode or in 3.3V mode. If vddshv[1-7,9-11] ramps down at the later time in the diagram then the board design must guarantee that the vddshv[1-7,9-11] rail is never higher than 2.0 V above the vdds18v rail. Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 177 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (8) vddshv8 is separated out to show support for dual voltage. If a dedicated LDO/supply source is used for vddshv8, then vddshv8 ramp down should occur at one of the two earliest points in the timing diagram. If vddshv8 is powered by the same supply source as the other vddshv[1-7,9-11] rails, then it is allowed to ramp down at either of the last two points in the timing diagram. Figure 5-3 describes vddshv[1-7,9-11] Supplies Falling Before vdds18v Supplies Delta. vddshv1, vddshv2, vddshv3, vddshv4, vddshv6, vddshv7, vddshv9, vddshv10, vddshv11, (Note 2) vddshv8 vdds18v Vdelta (Note1) ADVANCE INFORMATION SPRS85v_ELCH_06 Figure 5-3. vddshv* Supplies Falling After vdds18v Supplies Delta (1) Vdelta MAX = 2V (2) If vddshv8 is powered by the same supply source as the other vddshv[1-7,9-11] rails. 178 Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 6 Clock Specifications NOTE For more information, see Power, Reset, and Clock Management / PRCM Environment / External Clock Signal and Power Reset / PRCM Functional Description / PRCM Clock Manager Functional Description section of the Device TRM. NOTE The device operation requires the following clocks: • The 32 kHz frequency is used for low frequency operation. It supplies the wake-up domain for operation in lowest power mode. This is an optional clock and will be supplied by on chip divider + mux (FUNC_32K_CLK) incase it is not available on external pin. • The system clocks, SYS_CLKIN1(Mandatory) and SYS_CLKIN2(Optional) are the main clock sources of the device. They supply the reference clock to the DPLLs as well as functional clock to several modules. The Device also embeds an internal free-running 32-kHz oscillator that is always active as long as the the wake-up (WKUP) domain is supplied. Figure 6-1 shows the external input clock sources and the output clocks to peripherals. Clock Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 179 ADVANCE INFORMATION Audio Back End (ABE) module is not supported for this family of devices, but “ABE” name is still present in some clock or DPLL names. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Device rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 rtc_osc_xo From quartz (32 kHz) or from CMOS square clock source (32 kHz). To quartz (from oscillator output). rstoutn Warm reset output. resetn Device reset input. porz xi_osc0 xo_osc0 xi_osc1 xo_osc1 Power ON Reset. From quartz (19.2, 20 or 27 MHz) or from CMOS square clock source (19.2, 20 or 27MHz). To quartz (from oscillator output). From quartz (range from 19.2 to 32 MHz) or from CMOS square clock source(range from 12 to 38.4 MHz). To quartz (from oscillator output). ADVANCE INFORMATION clkout1 clkout2 Output clkout[3:1] clocks come from: • Either the input system clock and alternate clock (xi_osc0 or xi_osc1) • Or a CORE clock (from CORE output) • Or a 192-MHz clock (from PER DPLL output). clkout3 xref_clk0 xref_clk1 External Reference Clock [3:0]. For Audio and other Peripherals xref_clk2 xref_clk3 sysboot[15:0] Boot Mode Configuration Figure 6-1. Clock Interface 6.1 Input Clock Specifications 6.1.1 Input Clock Requirements • • • 180 The source of the internal system clock (SYS_CLK1) could be either: – A CMOS clock that enters on the xi_osc0 ball (with xo_osc0 left unconnected on the CMOS clock case). – A crystal oscillator clock managed by xi_osc0 and xo_osc0. The source of the internal system clock (SYS_CLK2) could be either: – A CMOS clock that enters on the xi_osc1 ball (with xo_osc1 left unconnected on the CMOS clock case). – A crystal oscillator clock managed by xi_osc1 and xo_osc1. The source of the internal system clock (SYS_32K) could be either: – A CMOS clock that enters on the rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 ball and supports external LVCMOS clock generators – A crystal oscillator clock managed by rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 and rtc_osc_xo. Clock Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com 6.1.2 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 System Oscillator OSC0 Input Clock SYS_CLKIN1 is received directly from oscillator OSC0. For more information about SYS_CLKIN1 see Device TRM, Chapter: Power, Reset, and Clock Management. 6.1.2.1 OSC0 External Crystal An external crystal is connected to the device pins. Figure 6-2 describes the crystal implementation. Device xo_osc0 vssa_osc0 Rd (Optional) Crystal Rd (Optional) Cf2 Cf1 Figure 6-2. Crystal Implementation NOTE The load capacitors,Cf1 and Cf2 in Figure 6-2, should be chosen such that the below equation is satisfied. CL in the equation is the load specified by the crystal manufacturer. All discrete components used to implement the oscillator circuit should be placed as close as possible to the associated oscillator xi_osc0, xo_osc0, and vssa_osc0 pins. CL= Cf1Cf2 (Cf1+Cf2) Figure 6-3. Load Capacitance Equation The crystal must be in the fundamental mode of operation and parallel resonant. Table 6-1 summarizes the required electrical constraints. Table 6-1. OSC0 Crystal Electrical Characteristics NAME fp DESCRIPTION Parallel resonance crystal frequency MIN TYP MAX 19.2, 20, 27 UNIT MHz Cf1 Cf1 load capacitance for crystal parallel resonance with Cf1 = Cf2 12 24 pF Cf2 Cf2 load capacitance for crystal parallel resonance with Cf1 = Cf2 12 24 pF 100 Ω ESR(Cf1,Cf2) (1) Crystal ESR Clock Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 181 ADVANCE INFORMATION xi_osc0 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 6-1. OSC0 Crystal Electrical Characteristics (continued) NAME DESCRIPTION ESR = 30 Ω ESR = 40 Ω ESR = 50 Ω CO ESR = 60 Ω Crystal shunt capacitance ESR = 80 Ω ESR = 100 Ω LM Crystal motional inductance for fp = 20 MHz CM Crystal motional capacitance MIN TYP MAX 19.2 MHz, 20 MHz, 27 MHz 7 pF 19.2 MHz, 20 MHz 7 pF 27 MHz 5 pF 7 pF 5 pF 19.2 MHz, 20 MHz 27 MHz Not Supported 19.2 MHz, 20 MHz 27 MHz Frequency accuracy - Not Supported 19.2 MHz, 20 MHz 3 27 MHz pF Not Supported - 10.16 mH 3.42 fF Ethernet not used tj(xiosc0) UNIT (1) , xi_osc0 ±200 ADVANCE INFORMATION Ethernet RGMII and RMII using derived clock ±50 Ethernet MII using derived clock ±100 ppm (1) Crystal characteristics should account for tolerance+stability+aging. When selecting a crystal, the system design must take into account the temperature and aging characteristics of a crystal versus the user environment and expected lifetime of the system. Table 6-2 details the switching characteristics of the oscillator and the requirements of the input clock. Table 6-2. Oscillator Switching Characteristics—Crystal Mode NAME DESCRIPTION fp Oscillation frequency tsX Start-up time 6.1.2.2 MIN TYP MAX 19.2, 20, 27 MHz UNIT MHz 4 ms OSC0 Input Clock A 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible Clock Input can be used instead of the internal oscillator to provide the SYS_CLKIN1 clock input to the system. The external connections to support this are shown in Figure 6-4. The xi_osc0 pin is connected to the 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible clock source. The xi_osc0 pin is left unconnected. The vssa_osc0 pin is connected to board ground (VSS). Device xi_osc0 xo_osc0 vssa_osc0 NC SPRS906_CLK_04 Figure 6-4. 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible Clock Input Table 6-3 summarizes the OSC0 input clock electrical characteristics. 182 Clock Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 6-3. OSC0 Input Clock Electrical Characteristics—Bypass Mode NAME DESCRIPTION f MIN Frequency TYP MAX UNIT 19.2, 20, 27 CIN Input capacitance IIN Input current (3.3V mode) MHz 2.184 2.384 2.584 pF 4 6 10 µA Table 6-4 details the OSC0 input clock timing requirements. Table 6-4. OSC0 Input Clock Timing Requirements DESCRIPTION 1/ CK0 tc(xiosc0) CK1 MIN Frequency, xi_osc0 TYP 19.2, 20, 27 tw(xiosc0) Pulse duration, xi_osc0 low or high tj(xiosc0) Period jitter(1), xi_osc0 tR(xiosc0) Rise time, xi_osc0 tF(xiosc0) Fall time, xi_osc0 0.45 * tc(xiosc0) Ethernet not used tj(xiosc0) MAX Frequency accuracy(2), xi_osc0 UNIT MHz 0.55 * tc(xiosc0) ns 0.01 × tc(xiosc0) ns 5 ns 5 ns ±200 Ethernet RGMII and RMII using derived clock ±50 Ethernet MII using derived clock ±100 ppm (1) Period jitter is meant here as follows: – The maximum value is the difference between the longest measured clock period and the expected clock period – The minimum value is the difference between the shortest measured clock period and the expected clock period (2) Crystal characteristics should account for tolerance+stability+aging. CK0 CK1 CK1 xi_osc0 SPRS906_CLK_05 Figure 6-5. xi_osc0 Input Clock 6.1.3 Auxiliary Oscillator OSC1 Input Clock SYS_CLKIN2 is received directly from oscillator OSC1. For more information about SYS_CLKIN2 see Device TRM, Chapter: Power, Reset, and Clock Management. 6.1.3.1 OSC1 External Crystal An external crystal is connected to the device pins. Figure 6-6 describes the crystal implementation. Clock Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 183 ADVANCE INFORMATION NAME AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Device xo_osc1 xi_osc1 vssa_osc1 Rd (Optional) Crystal Rd (Optional) Cf2 Cf1 Figure 6-6. Crystal Implementation NOTE ADVANCE INFORMATION The load capacitors, Cf1 and Cf2 in Figure 6-6, should be chosen such that the below equation is satisfied. CL in the equation is the load specified by the crystal manufacturer. All discrete components used to implement the oscillator circuit should be placed as close as possible to the associated oscillator xi_osc1, xo_osc1, and vssa_osc1 pins. CL= Cf1Cf2 (Cf1+Cf2) Figure 6-7. Load Capacitance Equation The crystal must be in the fundamental mode of operation and parallel resonant. Table 6-5 summarizes the required electrical constraints. Table 6-5. OSC1 Crystal Electrical Characteristics NAME fp DESCRIPTION MIN Parallel resonance crystal frequency TYP UNIT MHz Cf1 Cf1 load capacitance for crystal parallel resonance with Cf1 = Cf2 12 24 pF Cf2 Cf2 load capacitance for crystal parallel resonance with Cf1 = Cf2 12 24 pF ESR(Cf1,Cf2) Crystal ESR Crystal shunt capacitance Ω 19.2 MHz ≤ fp ≤ 32 MHz 7 pF ESR = 40 Ω 19.2 MHz ≤ fp ≤ 32 MHz 5 pF 19.2 MHz ≤ fp ≤ 25 MHz 7 pF 25 MHz < fp ≤ 27 MHz 5 pF 19.2 MHz ≤ fp ≤ 23 MHz 7 pF 23 MHz < fp ≤ 25 MHz 5 pF 5 pF 3 pF 27 MHz < fp ≤ 32 MHz CO 100 ESR = 30 Ω ESR = 50 Ω ESR = 60 Ω 25 MHz < fp ≤ 32 MHz Not Supported ESR = 80 Ω 23 MHz ≤ fp ≤ 25 MHz 25 MHz < fp ≤ 32 MHz ESR = 100 Ω LM Crystal motional inductance for fp = 20 MHz CM Crystal motional capacitance Clock Specifications - Not Supported 19.2 MHz ≤ fp ≤ 20 MHz 20 MHz < fp ≤ 32 MHz - Not Supported 19.2 MHz ≤ fp ≤ 23 MHz 184 MAX Range from 19.2 to 32 3 Not Supported pF - 10.16 mH 3.42 fF Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 6-5. OSC1 Crystal Electrical Characteristics (continued) NAME DESCRIPTION MIN TYP Ethernet not used tj(xiosc1) Frequency accuracy(1), xi_osc1 MAX UNIT ±200 Ethernet RGMII and RMII using derived clock ±50 Ethernet MII using derived clock ±100 ppm (1) Crystal characteristics should account for tolerance+stability+aging. When selecting a crystal, the system design must take into account the temperature and aging characteristics of a crystal versus the user environment and expected lifetime of the system. Table 6-6 details the switching characteristics of the oscillator and the requirements of the input clock. Table 6-6. Oscillator Switching Characteristics—Crystal Mode DESCRIPTION fp Oscillation frequency tsX Start-up time 6.1.3.2 MIN TYP MAX Range from 19.2 to 32 UNIT MHz 4 ms OSC1 Input Clock A 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible Clock Input can be used instead of the internal oscillator to provide the SYS_CLKIN2 clock input to the system. The external connections to support this are shown in, Figure 6-8. The xi_osc1 pin is connected to the 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible clock sources. The xo_osc1 pin is left unconnected. The vssa_osc1 pin is connected to board ground (vss). Device xi_osc1 xo_osc1 vssa_osc1 NC SPRS906_CLK_07 Figure 6-8. 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible Clock Input Table 6-7 summarizes the OSC1 input clock electrical characteristics. Table 6-7. OSC1 Input Clock Electrical Characteristics—Bypass Mode NAME f DESCRIPTION Frequency CIN Input capacitance IIN Input current (3.3V mode) tsX Start-up time(1) MIN TYP MAX Range from 12 to 38.4 UNIT MHz 2.819 3.019 3.219 pF 4 6 10 µA See(2) ms Clock Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 185 ADVANCE INFORMATION NAME AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) To switch from bypass mode to crystal or from crystal mode to bypass mode, there is a waiting time about 100 μs; however, if the chip comes from bypass mode to crystal mode the crystal will start-up after time mentioned in Table 6-6, tsX parameter. (2) Before the processor boots up and the oscillator is set to bypass mode, there is a waiting time when the internal oscillator is in application mode and receives a wave. The switching time in this case is about 100 μs. Table 6-8 details the OSC1 input clock timing requirements. Table 6-8. OSC1 Input Clock Timing Requirements NAME DESCRIPTION MIN CK0 1/ tc(xiosc1) Frequency, xi_osc1 CK1 tw(xiosc1) Pulse duration, xi_osc1 low or high tj(xiosc1) Period jitter(1), xi_osc1 tR(xiosc1) Rise time, xi_osc1 tF(xiosc1) Fall time, xi_osc1 TYP MAX Range from 12 to 38.4 0.45 * tc(xiosc1) MHz 0.55 * tc(xiosc1) ns 0.01 × tc(xiosc1) ns 5 ns 5 ns (3) Ethernet not used ADVANCE INFORMATION tj(xiosc1) Frequency accuracy(2), xi_osc1 UNIT ±200 Ethernet RGMII and RMII using derived clock ±50 Ethernet MII using derived clock ±100 ppm (1) Period jitter is meant here as follows: – The maximum value is the difference between the longest measured clock period and the expected clock period – The minimum value is the difference between the shortest measured clock period and the expected clock period (2) Crystal characteristics should account for tolerance+stability+aging. (3) The Period jitter requirement for osc1 can be relaxed to 0.02*tc(xiosc1) under the following constraints: a.The osc1/SYS_CLK2 clock bypasses all device PLLs b.The osc1/SYS_CLK2 clock is only used to source the DSS pixel clock outputs CK0 CK1 CK1 xi_osc1 SPRS906_CLK_08 Figure 6-9. xi_osc1 Input Clock 6.1.4 RTC Oscillator Input Clock SYS_32K is received directly from RTC Oscillator. For more information about SYS_32K see the Device TRM, Power, Reset, and Clock Management chapter. NOTE RTC only mode is not supported feature. 6.1.4.1 RTC Oscillator External Crystal An external crystal is connected to the device pins. Figure 6-2 describes the crystal implementation. 186 Clock Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Device rtc_osc_xo rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 Rd (Optional) Crystal Cf2 Cf1 Figure 6-10. Crystal Implementation NOTE The load capacitors, Cf1 and Cf2 in Figure 6-10, should be chosen such that the below equation is satisfied. CL in the equation is the load specified by the crystal manufacturer. All discrete components used to implement the oscillator circuit should be placed as close as possible to the associated oscillator rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 and rtc_osc_xo pins. CL= Cf1Cf2 (Cf1+Cf2) Figure 6-11. Load Capacitance Equation The crystal must be in the fundamental mode of operation and parallel resonant. Table 6-9 summarizes the required electrical constraints. Table 6-9. RTC Crystal Electrical Characteristics NAME DESCRIPTION fp MIN TYP Parallel resonance crystal frequency MAX UNIT 32.768 kHz Cf1 Cf1 load capacitance for crystal parallel resonance with Cf1 = Cf2 12 24 Cf2 Cf2 load capacitance for crystal parallel resonance with Cf1 = Cf2 12 24 pF 80 kΩ 5 pF ESR(Cf1,Cf2) Crystal ESR CO Crystal shunt capacitance LM Crystal motional inductance for fp = 32.768 kHz CM Crystal motional capacitance tj(rtc_osc_xi_clkin32) pF 10.7 mH 2.2 Frequency accuracy, rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 fF ±200 ppm When selecting a crystal, the system design must take into account the temperature and aging characteristics of a crystal versus the user environment and expected lifetime of the system. Table 6-10 details the switching characteristics of the oscillator and the requirements of the input clock. Table 6-10. Oscillator Switching Characteristics—Crystal Mode NAME fp DESCRIPTION Oscillation frequency MIN TYP 32.768 MAX UNIT kHz Clock Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 187 ADVANCE INFORMATION SPRS906_CLK_09 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 6-10. Oscillator Switching Characteristics—Crystal Mode (continued) NAME tsX 6.1.4.2 DESCRIPTION MIN TYP MAX Start-up time UNIT 4 ms RTC Oscillator Input Clock A 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible Clock Input can be used instead of the internal oscillator to provide the SYS_32K clock input to the system. The external connections to support this are shown in Figure 6-12. The rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 pin is connected to the 1.8-V LVCMOS-Compatible clock sources. The rtc_osc_xo pin is left unconnected. Device rtc_osc_xo rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 ADVANCE INFORMATION NC SPRS906_CLK_10 Figure 6-12. LVCMOS-Compatible Clock Input Table 6-11 summarizes the RTC Oscillator input clock electrical characteristics. Table 6-11. RTC Oscillator Input Clock Electrical Characteristics—Bypass Mode NAME CK0 CK1 DESCRIPTION 1/tc(rtc_osc_xi_clkin32) tw(rtc_osc_xi_clkin32) MIN Frequency, rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 Pulse duration, rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 low or high CIN Input capacitance IIN Input current (3.3V mode) tsX Start-up time TYP MAX 32.768 UNIT kHz 0.45 * 0.55 * tc(rtc_osc_xi_clkin32) tc(rtc_osc_xi_clkin32) ns 2.178 2.378 2.578 pF 4 6 10 µA See (1) ms (1) Before the processor boots up and the oscillator is set to bypass mode, there is a waiting time when the internal oscillator is inapplication mode and receives a wave. The switching time in this case is about 100 μs. CK0 CK1 CK1 rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 SPRS906_CLK_11 Figure 6-13. rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 Input Clock 6.2 DPLLs, DLLs Specifications 188 Clock Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 NOTE For more information, see: • Power, Reset, and Clock Management / Clock Management Functional / Internal Clock Sources / Generators / Generic DPLL Overview Section and • Display Subsystem / Display Subsystem Overview section of the Device TRM. To generate high-frequency clocks, the device supports multiple on-chip DPLLs controlled directly by the PRCM module. They are of two types: type A and type B DPLLs. They have their own independent power domain (each one embeds its own switch and can be controlled as an independent functional power domain) • They are fed with ALWAYS ON system clock, with independent control per DPLL. The different DPLLs managed by the PRCM are listed below: • DPLL_MPU: It supplies the MPU subsystem clocking internally. • DPLL_IVA: It feeds the IVA subsystem clocking. • DPLL_CORE: It supplies all interface clocks and also few module functional clocks. • DPLL_PER: It supplies several clock sources: a 192-MHz clock for the display functional clock, a 96-MHz functional clock to subsystems and peripherals. • DPLL_ABE: It provides clocks to various modules within the device. • DPLL_USB: It provides 960M clock for USB modules (USB1/2/3/4). • DPLL_GMAC: It supplies several clocks for the Gigabit Ethernet Switch (GMAC_SW). • DPLL_DSP: It feeds the DSP Subsystem clocking. • DPLL_GPU: It supplies clock for the GPU Subsystem. • DPLL_DDR: It generates clocks for the two External Memory Interface (EMIF) controllers and their associated EMIF PHYs. • DPLL_PCIE_REF: It provides reference clock for the APLL_PCIE in PCIE Subsystem. • APLL_PCIE: It feeds clocks for the device Peripheral Component Interconnect Express (PCIe) controllers. NOTE The following DPLLs are controlled by the clock manager located in the always-on Core power domain (CM_CORE_AON): • DPLL_MPU, DPLL_IVA, DPLL_CORE, DPLL_ABE, DPLL_DDR, DPLL_GMAC, DPLL_PCIE_REF, DPLL_PER, DPLL_USB, DPLL_DSP, DPLL_GPU, APLL_PCIE_REF. For more information on CM_CORE_AON and CM_CORE or PRCM DPLLs, see the Power, Reset, and Clock Management (PRCM) chapter of the Device TRM. The following DPLLs are not managed by the PRCM: • • • • • DPLL_VIDEO1; (It is controlled from DSS) DPLL_HDMI; (It is controlled from DSS) DPLL_SATA; (It is controlled from SATA) DPLL_DEBUG; (It is controlled from DEBUGSS) DPLL_USB_OTG_SS; (It is controlled from OCP2SCP1) NOTE For more information for not controlled from PRCM DPLL’s see the related chapters in TRM. Clock Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 189 ADVANCE INFORMATION • AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 6.2.1 www.ti.com DPLL Characteristics The DPLL has three relevant input clocks. One of them is the reference clock (CLKINP) used to generated the synthesized clock but can also be used as the bypass clock whenever the DPLL enters a bypass mode. It is therefore mandatory. The second one is a fast bypass clock (CLKINPULOW) used when selected as the bypass clock and is optional. The third clock (CLKINPHIF) is explained in the next paragraph. The DPLL has three output clocks (namely CLKOUT, CLKOUTX2, and CLKOUTHIF). CLKOUT and CLKOUTX2 run at the bypass frequency whenever the DPLL enters a bypass mode. Both of them are generated from the lock frequency divided by a post-divider (namely M2 post-divider). The third clock, CLKOUTHIF, has no automatic bypass capability. It is an output of a post-divider (M3 post-divider) with the input clock selectable between the internal lock clock (Fdpll) and CLKINPHIF input of the PLL through an asynchronous multplexing. For more information, see the Power Reset Controller Management chapter of the Device TRM. Table 6-12 summarizes DPLL type described in Section 6.2, DPLLs, DLLs Specifications introduction. Table 6-12. DPLL Control Type ADVANCE INFORMATION DPLL NAME TYPE CONTROLLED BY PRCM DPLL_ABE Table 6-13 (Type A) Yes(1) DPLL_CORE Table 6-13 (Type A) Yes(1) DPLL_DEBUGSS Table 6-13 (Type A) No(2) DPLL_DSP Table 6-13 (Type A) Yes(1) DPLL_GMAC Table 6-13 (Type A) Yes(1) DPLL_HDMI Table 6-14 (Type B) No(2) DPLL_IVA Table 6-13 (Type A) Yes(1) DPLL_MPU Table 6-13 (Type A) Yes(1) DPLL_PER Table 6-13 (Type A) Yes(1) APLL_PCIE Table 6-13 (Type A) Yes(1) DPLL_PCIE_REF Table 6-14 (Type B) Yes(1) DPLL_SATA Table 6-14 (Type B) No(2) DPLL_USB Table 6-14 (Type B) Yes(1) DPLL_USB_OTG_SS Table 6-14 (Type B) No(2) DPLL_VIDEO1 Table 6-13 (Type A) No(2) DPLL_DDR Table 6-13 (Type A) Yes(1) DPLL_GPU Table 6-13 (Type A) Yes(1) (1) DPLL is in the always-on domain. (2) DPLL is not controlled by the PRCM. Table 6-13 and Table 6-14 summarize the DPLL characteristics and assume testing over recommended operating conditions. Table 6-13. DPLL Type A Characteristics NAME finput MIN TYP 0.032 MAX UNIT 52 MHz FINP COMMENTS finternal Internal reference frequency 0.15 52 MHz REFCLK fCLKINPHIF CLKINPHIF input frequency 10 1400 MHz FINPHIF 0.001 600 MHz Bypass mode: fCLKOUT = fCLKINPULOW / (M1 + 1) if ulowclken = 1(6) 20(1) 1400(2) MHz [M / (N + 1)] × FINP × [1 / M2] (in locked condition) fCLKINPULOW fCLKOUT 190 DESCRIPTION CLKINP input frequency CLKINPULOW input frequency CLKOUT output frequency Clock Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 6-13. DPLL Type A Characteristics (continued) fCLKOUTx2 DESCRIPTION MIN CLKOUTx2 output frequency TYP MAX UNIT COMMENTS 40(1) 2200(2) MHz 2 × [M / (N + 1)] × FINP × [1 / M2] (in locked condition) 20 (4) 1400 MHz FINPHIF / M3 if clkinphifsel = 1 40(3) 2200(4) MHz 2 × [M / (N + 1)] × FINP × [1 / M3] if clkinphifsel = 0 40 2800 MHz 2 × [M / (N + 1)] × FINP (in locked condition) (3) fCLKOUTHIF CLKOUTHIF output frequency fCLKDCOLDO DCOCLKLDO output frequency tlock Frequency lock time 6 + 350 × REFCLK µs plock Phase lock time 6 + 500 × REFCLK µs 6 + 70 × REFCLK µs DPLL in LP relock time: lowcurrstdby = 1 6 + 120 × REFCLK µs DPLL in LP relock time: lowcurrstdby = 1 3.55 + 70 × REFCLK µs DPLL in fast relock time: lowcurrstdby = 0 3.55 + 120 × REFCLK µs DPLL in fast relock time: lowcurrstdby = 0 trelock-L Relock time—Frequency lock(5) (LP relock time from bypass) prelock-L Relock time—Phase lock(5) (LP relock time from bypass) trelock-F Relock time—Frequency lock(5) (fast relock time from bypass) prelock-F Relock time—Phase lock(5) (fast relock time from bypass) (1) The minimum frequencies on CLKOUT and CLKOUTX2 are assuming M2 = 1. For M2 > 1, the minimum frequency on these clocks will further scale down by factor of M2. (2) The maximum frequencies on CLKOUT and CLKOUTX2 are assuming M2 = 1. (3) The minimum frequency on CLKOUTHIF is assuming M3 = 1. For M3 > 1, the minimum frequency on this clock will further scale down by factor of M3. (4) The maximum frequency on CLKOUTHIF is assuming M3 = 1. (5) Relock time assumes typical operating conditions, 10°C maximum temperature drift. (6) Bypass mode: fCLKOUT = FINP if ulowclken = 0. For more information, see the Device TRM. Table 6-14. DPLL Type B Characteristics NAME MAX UNIT CLKINP input clock frequency 0.62 60 MHz FINP finternal REFCLK internal reference clock frequency 0.62 2.5 MHz [1 / (N + 1)] × FINP fCLKINPULOW CLKINPULOW bypass input clock frequency 0.001 600 MHz Bypass mode: fCLKOUT = fCLKINPULOW / (M1 + 1) If ulowclken = 1(4) fCLKLDOOUT CLKOUTLDO output clock frequency 20(1)(5) 2500(2)(5) MHz M / (N + 1)] × FINP × [1 / M2] (in locked condition) CLKOUT output clock frequency 20(1)(5) 1450(2)(5) MHz [M / (N + 1)] × FINP × [1 / M2] (in locked condition) 750(5) finput fCLKOUT fCLKDCOLDO DESCRIPTION MIN Internal oscillator (DCO) output clock frequency TYP 1500(5) MHz (5) 2500(5) MHz –2.5% 2.5% 1250 COMMENTS [M / (N + 1)] × FINP (in locked condition) CLKOUTLDO period jitter tJ CLKOUT period jitter The period jitter at the output clocks is ± 2.5% peak to peak CLKDCOLDO period jitter tlock Frequency lock time 350 × REFCLKs µs plock Phase lock time 500 × REFCLKs µs 9 + 30 × REFCLKs µs (3) trelock-L Relock time—Frequency lock (LP relock time from bypass) Clock Specifications Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 191 ADVANCE INFORMATION NAME AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 6-14. DPLL Type B Characteristics (continued) NAME DESCRIPTION prelock-L Relock time—Phase lock(3) (LP relock time from bypass) MIN TYP MAX UNIT 9 + 125 × REFCLKs COMMENTS µs (1) The minimum frequency on CLKOUT is assuming M2 = 1. For M2 > 1, the minimum frequency on this clock will further scale down by factor of M2. (2) The maximum frequency on CLKOUT is assuming M2 = 1. (3) Relock time assumes typical operating conditions, 10°C maximum temperature drift. (4) Bypass mode: fCLKOUT = FINP if ULOWCLKEN = 0. For more information, see the Device TRM. (5) For output clocks, there are two frequency ranges according to the SELFREQDCO setting. For more information, see the Device TRM. 6.2.2 DLL Characteristics Table 6-15 summarizes the DLL characteristics and assumes testing over recommended operating conditions. Table 6-15. DLL Characteristics ADVANCE INFORMATION NAME MAX UNIT finput Input clock frequency (EMIF_DLL_FCLK) 266 MHz tlock Lock time 50k cycles Relock time (a change of the DLL frequency implies that DLL must relock) 50k cycles trelock 192 DESCRIPTION Clock Specifications MIN TYP Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 7 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics 7.1 Timing Test Conditions All timing requirements and switching characteristics are valid over the recommended operating conditions unless otherwise specified. 7.2 7.2.1 Interface Clock Specifications Interface Clock Terminology The interface clock is used at the system level to sequence the data and/or to control transfers accordingly with the interface protocol. 7.2.2 Interface Clock Frequency The interface clock frequency documented in this document is the maximum clock frequency, which corresponds to the maximum frequency programmable on this output clock. This frequency defines the maximum limit supported by the Device IC and does not take into account any system consideration (PCB, peripherals). The system designer will have to consider these system considerations and the Device IC timing characteristics as well to define properly the maximum operating frequency that corresponds to the maximum frequency supported to transfer the data on this interface. 7.3 Timing Parameters and Information The timing parameter symbols used in the timing requirement and switching characteristic tables are created in accordance with JEDEC Standard 100. To shorten the symbols, some of pin names and other related terminologies have been abbreviated as follows: Table 7-1. Timing Parameters SUBSCRIPTS SYMBOL PARAMETER c Cycle time (period) d Delay time dis Disable time en Enable time h Hold time su Setup time START Start bit t Transition time v Valid time w Pulse duration (width) X Unknown, changing, or don't care level F Fall time H High L Low R Rise time V Valid IV Invalid Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 193 ADVANCE INFORMATION The two interface clock characteristics are: • The maximum clock frequency • The maximum operating frequency AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-1. Timing Parameters (continued) SUBSCRIPTS 7.3.1 SYMBOL PARAMETER AE Active Edge FE First Edge LE Last Edge Z High impedance Parameter Information Tester Pin Electronics 42 Ω 3.5 nH Transmission Line ADVANCE INFORMATION Z0 = 50 Ω (see Note) 4.0 pF 1.85 pF Data Sheet Timing Reference Point Output Under Test Device Pin (see Note) pm_tstcirc_prs403 Figure 7-1. Test Load Circuit for AC Timing Measurements The load capacitance value stated is only for characterization and measurement of AC timing signals. This load capacitance value does not indicate the maximum load the device is capable of driving. 7.3.1.1 1.8V and 3.3V Signal Transition Levels All input and output timing parameters are referenced to Vref for both "0" and "1" logic levels. Vref = (VDD I/O)/2. Vref pm_io_volt_prs403 Figure 7-2. Input and Output Voltage Reference Levels for AC Timing Measurements All rise and fall transition timing parameters are referenced to VIL MAX and VIH MIN for input clocks, VOL MAX and VOH MIN for output clocks. Vref = VIH MIN (or VOH MIN) Vref = VIL MAX (or VOL MAX) pm_transvolt_prs403 Figure 7-3. Rise and Fall Transition Time Voltage Reference Levels 7.3.1.2 1.8V and 3.3V Signal Transition Rates The default SLEWCONTROL settings in each pad configuration register must be used to guaranteed timings, unless specific instructions otherwise are given in the individual timing sub-sections of the datasheet. 194 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 All timings are tested with an input edge rate of 4 volts per nanosecond (4 V/ns). 7.3.1.3 Timing Parameters and Board Routing Analysis The timing parameter values specified in this data manual do not include delays by board routes. As a good board design practice, such delays must always be taken into account. Timing values may be adjusted by increasing/decreasing such delays. TI recommends using the available I/O buffer information specification (IBIS) models to analyze the timing characteristics correctly. To properly use IBIS models to attain accurate timing analysis for a given system, see the Using IBIS Models for timing Analysis application report (literature number SPRA839). If needed, external logic hardware such as buffers may be used to compensate any timing differences. 7.4 Recommended Clock and Control Signal Transition Behavior 7.5 Virtual and Manual I/O Timing Modes Some of the timings described in the following sections require the use of Virtual or Manual I/O Timing Modes. Table 7-2 provides a summary of the Virtual and Manual I/O Timing Modes across all device interfaces. The individual interface timing sections found later in this document provide the full description of each applicable Virtual and Manual I/O Timing Mode. Refer to the "Pad Configuration" section of the TRM for the procedure on implementing the Virtual and Manual Timing Modes in a system. Table 7-2. Modes Summary Virtual or Manual IO Mode Name Data Manual Timing Mode DPI Video Output VOUT1_MANUAL1 DPI1 Video Output Alternate Timings VOUT2_IOSET1_MANUAL1 DPI2 Video Output IOSET1 Alternate Timings VOUT2_IOSET1_MANUAL2 DPI2 Video Output IOSET1 Default Timings - Rising-edge Clock Reference VOUT2_IOSET1_MANUAL3 DPI2 Video Output IOSET1 Default Timings - Falling-edge Clock Reference VOUT2_IOSET2_MANUAL1 DPI2 Video Output IOSET2 Alternate Timings VOUT2_IOSET2_MANUAL2 DPI2 Video Output IOSET2 Default Timings - Rising-edge Clock Reference VOUT2_IOSET2_MANUAL3 DPI2 Video Output IOSET2 Default Timings - Falling-edge Clock Reference VOUT3_MANUAL1 DPI3 Video Output Alternate Timings GPMC No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required GPMC Asynchronous Mode Timings and Synchronous Mode - 1 Load Timings GPMC_VIRTUAL1 GPMC Synchronous Mode - 5 Load Timings McASP No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required McASP1 Asynchronous and Synchronous Transmit Timings MCASP1_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX See Table 7-51 MCASP1_VIRTUAL2_ASYNC_RX See Table 7-51 No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required McASP2 Asynchronous and Synchronous Transmit Timings MCASP2_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX_80M See Table 7-52 MCASP2_VIRTUAL2_ASYNC_RX See Table 7-52 MCASP2_VIRTUAL3_SYNC_RX See Table 7-52 MCASP2_VIRTUAL4_ASYNC_RX_80M See Table 7-52 No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required McASP3 Synchronous Transmit Timings MCASP3_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX See Table 7-53 No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required McASP4 Synchronous Transmit Timings Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 195 ADVANCE INFORMATION All clocks and control signals must transition between VIH and VIL (or between VIL and VIH) in a monotonic manner. Monotonic transitions are more easily guaranteed with faster switching signals. Slower input transitions are more susceptible to glitches due to noise and special care should be taken for slow input clocks. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-2. Modes Summary (continued) Virtual or Manual IO Mode Name Data Manual Timing Mode MCASP4_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX See Table 7-54 No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required McASP5 Synchronous Transmit Timings MCASP5_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX See Table 7-55 No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required McASP6 Synchronous Transmit Timings MCASP6_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX See Table 7-56 No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required McASP7 Synchronous Transmit Timings MCASP7_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX See Table 7-57 No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required McASP8 Synchronous Transmit Timings MCASP8_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX See Table 7-58 eMMC/SD/SDIO ADVANCE INFORMATION No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required MMC1 DS (Pad Loopback), HS (Internal Loopback and Pad Loopback), SDR12 (Internal Loopback and Pad Loopback), and SDR25 Timings (Internal Loopback and Pad Loopback) Timings MMC1_VIRTUAL1 MMC1 SDR50 (Pad Loopback) Timings MMC1_VIRTUAL4 MMC1 DS (Internal Loopback) Timings MMC1_VIRTUAL5 MMC1 SDR50 (Internal Loopback) Timings MMC1_VIRTUAL6 MMC1 DDR50 (Internal Loopback) Timings MMC1_MANUAL1 MMC1 DDR50 (Pad Loopback) Timings MMC1_MANUAL2 MMC1 SDR104 Timings MMC2_MANUAL1 MMC2 DDR (Pad Loopback) Timings MMC2_MANUAL2 MMC2 DDR (Internal Loopback) Timings MMC2_MANUAL3 MMC2 HS200 Timings No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required MMC3 DS, SDR12, HS, SDR25 Timings MMC3_MANUAL1 MMC3 SDR50 Timings No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required MMC4 DS, SDR12, HS, SDR25 Timings QSPI No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required QSPI Mode 3 Timings QSPI1_MANUAL1 QSPI Mode 0 Timings GMAC No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required GMAC MII0/1 Timings GMAC_RGMII0_MANUAL1 GMAC RGMII0 with Transmit Clock Internal Delay Enabled GMAC_RGMII1_MANUAL1 GMAC RGMII1 with Transmit Clock Internal Delay Enabled GMAC_RMII0_MANUAL1 GMAC RMII0 Timings GMAC_RMII1_MANUAL1 GMAC RMII1 Timings VIP VIP_MANUAL1 VIN2A (IOSET10) Rise-Edge Capture Mode Timings VIP_MANUAL2 VIN2A (IOSET10) Fall-Edge Capture Mode Timings VIP_MANUAL3 VIN2A (IOSET4/5/6) Rise-Edge Capture Mode Timings VIP_MANUAL4 VIN2B (IOSET1/2/7) Rise-Edge Capture Mode Timings VIP_MANUAL5 VIN2A (IOSET4/5/6) Fall-Edge Capture Mode Timings VIP_MANUAL6 VIN2B (IOSET1/2/7) Fall-Edge Capture Mode Timings VIP_MANUAL7 VIN1A (IOSET2/3) and VIN1B (IOSET4) and VIN2B (IOSET8) Rise-Edge Capture Mode Timings VIP_MANUAL8 VIN1A (IOSET4/5/6) and VIN2A (IOSET7/8/9) Rise-Edge Capture Mode Timings VIP_MANUAL9 VIN1B (IOSET6) Rise-Edge Capture Mode Timings VIP_MANUAL10 VIN1B (IOSET5) and VIN2B (IOSET9) Rise-Edge Capture Mode Timings VIP_MANUAL11 VIN1B (IOSET5) and VIN2B (IOSET9) Fall-Edge Capture Mode Timings 196 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-2. Modes Summary (continued) Virtual or Manual IO Mode Name Data Manual Timing Mode VIP_MANUAL12 VIN1A (IOSET2/3) and VIN1B (IOSET4) and VIN2B (IOSET8) Fall-Edge Capture Mode Timings VIP_MANUAL13 VIN1A (IOSET4/5/6) and VIN2A (IOSET7/8/9) Fall-Edge Capture Mode Timings VIP_MANUAL14 VIN1B (IOSET6) Fall-Edge Capture Mode Timings VIP_MANUAL15 VIN1A (IOSET8/9/10) Rise-Edge Capture Mode Timings VIP_MANUAL16 VIN1A (IOSET8/9/10) Fall-Edge Capture Mode Timings No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required All PRU_ICSS Modes not covered below PR1_PRU1_DIR_IN_MANUAL PRU-ICSS1 PRU1 Direct Input Mode Timings PR1_PRU1_DIR_OUT_MANUAL PRU-ICSS1 PRU1 Direct Output Mode Timings PR2_PRU0_DIR_IN_MANUAL1 PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET1 Direct Input Mode Timings PR2_PRU0_DIR_IN_MANUAL2 PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET2 Direct Input Mode Timings PR2_PRU0_DIR_OUT_MANUAL1 PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET1 Direct Output Mode Timings PR2_PRU0_DIR_OUT_MANUAL2 PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET2 Direct Output Mode Timings PR2_PRU1_DIR_IN_MANUAL1 PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET1 Direct Input Mode Timings PR2_PRU1_DIR_IN_MANUAL2 PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET2 Direct Input Mode Timings PR2_PRU1_DIR_OUT_MANUAL1 PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET1 Direct Output Mode Timings PR2_PRU1_DIR_OUT_MANUAL2 PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET2 Direct Output Mode Timings ADVANCE INFORMATION PRU-ICSS HDMI, EMIF, Timers, I2C, HDQ/1-Wire, UART, McSPI, USB, SATA, PCIe, DCAN, GPIO, KBD, PWM, ATL, JTAG, TPIU, RTC, SDMA, INTC, MLB No Virtual or Manual IO Timing Mode Required 7.6 All Modes Video Input Ports (VIP) The Device includes 1 Video Input Ports (VIP) Table 7-3, Figure 7-4 and Figure 7-5 present timings and switching characteristics of the VIPs. CAUTION The I/O timings provided in this section are valid only for VIN1 and VIN2 if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 7-4. Table 7-3. Timing Requirements for VIP (1)(2) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN V1 tc(CLK) Cycle time, vinx_clki 6.06 MAX UNIT ns V2 tw(CLKH) Pulse duration, vinx_clki high 0.45*P ns V3 tw(CLKL) Pulse duration, vinx_clki low 0.45*P ns V4 tsu(CTL/DATA-CLK) Input setup time, Control (vinx_dei, vinx_vsynci, vinx_fldi, vinx_hsynci) and Data (vinx_dn) valid to vinx_clki transition 3.11 ns V6 th(CLK-CTL/DATA) Input hold time, Control (vinx_dei, vinx_vsynci, vinx_fldi, vinx_hsynci) and Data (vinx_dn) valid from vinx_clki transition -0.05 ns (1) For maximum frequency of 165 MHZ. (2) P = vinx_clki period. (3) x in vinx = 1a, 1b, 2a, 2b. (4) n in dn = 0 to 7 when x = 1b, 2b. n = 0 to 23 when x = 1a, 2a. (5) i in clki, dei, vsynci, hsynci and fldi = 0 or 1. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 197 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com V3 V2 V1 vinx_clki SPRS906_TIMING_VIP_01 Figure 7-4. Video Input Ports clock signal vinx_clki (positive-edge clocking) vinx_clki (negative-edge clocking) V5 V4 vinx_d[23:0]/sig ADVANCE INFORMATION SPRS906_TIMING_VIP_02 Figure 7-5. Video Input Ports timings 198 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 In Table 7-4 and Table 7-5 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with vin1 and vin2. Table 7-4. VIN1 IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET2 BALL IOSET4 (1) IOSET3 MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX IOSET5 (1) BALL MUX IOSET6 (1) BALL IOSET7 (1) IOSET8 IOSET9 IOSET10 MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX vin1a_clk0 P1 2 B11 4 B11 3 P4 4 P4 4 B26 8 AC5 9 E17 7 E17 7 vin1a_hsync0 N7 2 C11 4 C11 3 R3 4 P7 4 E21 8 AB8 9 F12 7 F12 7 vin1a_vsync0 R4 2 E11 4 E11 3 T2 4 N1 4 F20 8 AB5 9 G12 7 G12 7 vin1a_fld0 P9 2 D11 4 D11 3 P9 4 J7 4 F21 8 C17 9 C14 7 C14 7 vin1a_de0 N9 2 B10 4 B10 3 P7 5 H6 4 C23 8 AB4 9 D14 7 D14 7 vin1a_d0 M6 2 B7 4 B7 3 R6 4 R6 4 B14 8 AD6 9 D18 7 C17 7 vin1a_d1 M2 2 B8 4 B8 3 T9 4 T9 4 J14 8 AC8 9 B19 7 B19 7 vin1a_d2 L5 2 A7 4 A7 3 T6 4 T6 4 G13 8 AC3 9 F15 7 F15 7 vin1a_d3 M1 2 A8 4 A8 3 T7 4 T7 4 J11 8 AC9 9 B18 7 B18 7 vin1a_d4 L6 2 C9 4 C9 3 P6 4 P6 4 E12 8 AC6 9 A16 7 A16 7 vin1a_d5 L4 2 A9 4 A9 3 R9 4 R9 4 F13 8 AC7 9 C15 7 C15 7 vin1a_d6 L3 2 B9 4 B9 3 R5 4 R5 4 C12 8 AC4 9 A18 7 A18 7 vin1a_d7 L2 2 A10 4 A10 3 P5 4 P5 4 D12 8 AD4 9 A19 7 A19 7 vin1a_d8 L1 2 E8 4 E8 3 U2 4 U2 4 E15 8 AA4 9 F14 7 F14 7 vin1a_d9 K2 2 D9 4 D9 3 U1 4 U1 4 A20 8 AB3 9 G14 7 G14 7 vin1a_d10 J1 2 D7 4 D7 3 P3 4 P3 4 B15 8 AB9 9 A13 7 A13 7 vin1a_d11 J2 2 D8 4 D8 3 R2 4 R2 4 A15 8 AA3 9 E14 7 E14 7 vin1a_d12 H1 2 A5 4 A5 3 K7 4 K7 4 D15 8 D17 9 A12 7 A12 7 vin1a_d13 J3 2 C6 4 C6 3 M7 4 M7 4 B16 8 G16 9 B13 7 B13 7 vin1a_d14 H2 2 C8 4 C8 3 J5 4 J5 4 B17 8 A21 9 A11 7 A11 7 vin1a_d15 H3 2 C7 4 C7 3 K6 4 K6 4 A17 8 C18 9 B12 7 B12 7 vin1a_d16 R6 2 F11 4 F11 3 C18 8 vin1a_d17 T9 2 G10 4 G10 3 A21 8 vin1a_d18 T6 2 F10 4 F10 3 G16 8 vin1a_d19 T7 2 G11 4 G11 3 D17 8 vin1a_d20 P6 2 E9 4 E9 3 AA3 8 vin1a_d21 R9 2 F9 4 F9 3 AB9 8 vin1a_d22 R5 2 F8 4 F8 3 AB3 8 vin1a_d23 P5 2 E7 4 E7 3 AA4 8 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION vin1a 199 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-4. VIN1 IOSETs (continued) SIGNALS IOSET2 BALL MUX IOSET4 (1) IOSET3 BALL MUX BALL MUX IOSET5 (1) BALL MUX IOSET6 (1) BALL MUX IOSET7 (1) BALL MUX IOSET8 BALL IOSET9 MUX BALL IOSET10 MUX BALL MUX vin1b ADVANCE INFORMATION vin1b_clk1 P7 6 M4 4 V1 5 vin1b_hsync1 H5 6 H5 6 U7 5 vin1b_vsync1 H6 6 H6 6 V6 5 vin1b_fld1 M4 6 W2 5 vin1b_de1 N6 6 N6 6 V7 5 vin1b_d0 K7 6 K7 6 U4 5 vin1b_d1 M7 6 M7 6 V2 5 vin1b_d2 J5 6 J5 6 Y1 5 vin1b_d3 K6 6 K6 6 W9 5 vin1b_d4 J7 6 J7 6 V9 5 vin1b_d5 J4 6 J4 6 U5 5 vin1b_d6 J6 6 J6 6 V5 5 vin1b_d7 H4 6 H4 6 V4 5 (1) The IOSET under this column is only applicable for pins with alternate functionality which allows either VIN1 or VIN2 signals to be mapped to the pins. These alternate functions are controlled via CTRL_CORE_VIP_MUX_SELECT register. For more information on how to use these options, please refer to Device TRM, Chapter Control Module, Section Pad Configuration Registers. Table 7-5. VIN2 IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET1 BALL MUX IOSET2 BALL MUX IOSET4 BALL IOSET5 MUX BALL IOSET7 (1) IOSET6 MUX BALL IOSET8 (1) IOSET9 (1) IOSET10 (1) MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX P4 4 B26 8 vin2a vin2a_clk0 E1 0 E1 0 V1 4 B11 3 P4 4 vin2a_hsync0 G1 0 G1 0 U7 4 C11 3 R3 4 P7 4 E21 8 vin2a_vsync0 G6 0 G6 0 V6 4 E11 3 T2 4 N1 4 F20 8 vin2a_fld0 H7 0 G2 1 W2 4 D11 3 P9 4 J7 4 F21 8 vin2a_de0 G2 0 V7 4 B10 3 P7 5 H6 4 C23 8 vin2a_d0 F2 0 F2 0 U4 4 B7 3 R6 4 R6 4 B14 8 vin2a_d1 F3 0 F3 0 V2 4 B8 3 T9 4 T9 4 J14 8 vin2a_d2 D1 0 D1 0 Y1 4 A7 3 T6 4 T6 4 G13 8 vin2a_d3 E2 0 E2 0 W9 4 A8 3 T7 4 T7 4 J11 8 vin2a_d4 D2 0 D2 0 V9 4 C9 3 P6 4 P6 4 E12 8 vin2a_d5 F4 0 F4 0 U5 4 A9 3 R9 4 R9 4 F13 8 200 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-5. VIN2 IOSETs (continued) SIGNALS IOSET1 MUX BALL IOSET4 MUX IOSET5 IOSET7 (1) IOSET6 IOSET8 (1) IOSET9 (1) IOSET10 (1) BALL MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX vin2a_d6 C1 0 C1 0 V5 4 B9 3 R5 4 R5 4 C12 8 vin2a_d7 E4 0 E4 0 V4 4 A10 3 P5 4 P5 4 D12 8 vin2a_d8 F5 0 F5 0 V3 4 E8 3 U2 4 U2 4 E15 8 vin2a_d9 E6 0 E6 0 Y2 4 D9 3 U1 4 U1 4 A20 8 vin2a_d10 D3 0 D3 0 U6 4 D7 3 P3 4 P3 4 B15 8 vin2a_d11 F6 0 F6 0 U3 4 D8 3 R2 4 R2 4 A15 8 vin2a_d12 D5 0 D5 0 A5 3 K7 4 K7 4 D15 8 vin2a_d13 C2 0 C2 0 C6 3 M7 4 M7 4 B16 8 vin2a_d14 C3 0 C3 0 C8 3 J5 4 J5 4 B17 8 vin2a_d15 C4 0 C4 0 C7 3 K6 4 K6 4 A17 8 vin2a_d16 B2 0 B2 0 F11 3 C18 8 vin2a_d17 D6 0 D6 0 G10 3 A21 8 vin2a_d18 C5 0 C5 0 F10 3 G16 8 vin2a_d19 A3 0 A3 0 G11 3 D17 8 vin2a_d20 B3 0 B3 0 E9 3 AA3 8 vin2a_d21 B4 0 B4 0 F9 3 AB9 8 vin2a_d22 B5 0 B5 0 F8 3 AB3 8 vin2a_d23 A4 0 A4 0 E7 3 AA4 8 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL IOSET2 vin2b vin2b_clk1 P7 6 M4 4 H7 2 H7 2 AB5 4 vin2b_hsync1 H5 6 H5 6 G1 3 G1 3 AC5 4 vin2b_vsync1 H6 6 H6 6 G6 3 G6 3 AB4 4 G2 2 vin2b_fld1 M4 6 vin2b_de1 N6 6 N6 6 G2 3 AB8 4 vin2b_d0 K7 6 K7 6 A4 2 A4 2 AD6 4 vin2b_d1 M7 6 M7 6 B5 2 B5 2 AC8 4 vin2b_d2 J5 6 J5 6 B4 2 B4 2 AC3 4 vin2b_d3 K6 6 K6 6 B3 2 B3 2 AC9 4 vin2b_d4 J7 6 J7 6 A3 2 A3 2 AC6 4 vin2b_d5 J4 6 J4 6 C5 2 C5 2 AC7 4 vin2b_d6 J6 6 J6 6 D6 2 D6 2 AC4 4 vin2b_d7 H4 6 H4 6 B2 2 B2 2 AD4 4 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 201 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) The IOSET under this column is only applicable for pins with alternate functionality which allows either VIN1 or VIN2 signals to be mapped to the pins. These alternate functions are controlled via CTRL_CORE_VIP_MUX_SELECT register. For more information on how to use these options, please refer to Device TRM, Chapter Control Module, Section Pad Configuration Registers. ADVANCE INFORMATION 202 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 NOTE To configure the desired Manual IO Timing Mode the user must follow the steps described in section "Manual IO Timing Modes" of the Device TRM. ADVANCE INFORMATION The associated registers to configure are listed in the CFG REGISTER column. For more information please see the Control Module Chapter in the Device TRM. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 203 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for VIP1. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Manual Functions Mapping for VIP1 2A IOSET10 for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-6 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-6. Manual Functions Mapping for VIP1 2A IOSET10 BALL BALL NAME VIP_MANUAL1 VIP_MANUAL2 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) E21 gpio6_14 1400 240 1767 0 CFG_GPIO6_14_IN vin2a_hsync0 F20 gpio6_15 1170 240 1522 0 CFG_GPIO6_15_IN vin2a_vsync0 8 ADVANCE INFORMATION F21 gpio6_16 1470 0 1600 0 CFG_GPIO6_16_IN vin2a_fld0 B14 mcasp1_aclkr 2145 200 2509 0 CFG_MCASP1_ACLKR_IN vin2a_d0 G13 mcasp1_axr2 2740 900 2680 1180 CFG_MCASP1_AXR2_IN vin2a_d2 J11 mcasp1_axr3 2933 200 2700 600 CFG_MCASP1_AXR3_IN vin2a_d3 E12 mcasp1_axr4 2901 240 2660 700 CFG_MCASP1_AXR4_IN vin2a_d4 F13 mcasp1_axr5 2600 840 2640 920 CFG_MCASP1_AXR5_IN vin2a_d5 C12 mcasp1_axr6 2718 240 3081 0 CFG_MCASP1_AXR6_IN vin2a_d6 D12 mcasp1_axr7 2983 240 2540 800 CFG_MCASP1_AXR7_IN vin2a_d7 J14 mcasp1_fsr 2203 240 2566 0 CFG_MCASP1_FSR_IN vin2a_d1 E15 mcasp2_aclkr 2143 240 2492 0 CFG_MCASP2_ACLKR_IN vin2a_d8 B15 mcasp2_axr0 2543 240 2905 0 CFG_MCASP2_AXR0_IN vin2a_d10 A15 mcasp2_axr1 2664 240 2730 400 CFG_MCASP2_AXR1_IN vin2a_d11 D15 mcasp2_axr4 2792 240 2750 400 CFG_MCASP2_AXR4_IN vin2a_d12 B16 mcasp2_axr5 2621 300 2983 0 CFG_MCASP2_AXR5_IN vin2a_d13 B17 mcasp2_axr6 1903 100 2086 0 CFG_MCASP2_AXR6_IN vin2a_d14 A17 mcasp2_axr7 2928 200 2670 700 CFG_MCASP2_AXR7_IN vin2a_d15 A20 mcasp2_fsr 2291 200 2654 0 CFG_MCASP2_FSR_IN vin2a_d9 C18 mcasp4_aclkx 1433 0 1540 0 CFG_MCASP4_ACLKX_IN vin2a_d16 G16 mcasp4_axr0 2500 0 2560 0 CFG_MCASP4_AXR0_IN vin2a_d18 D17 mcasp4_axr1 2379 100 2599 0 CFG_MCASP4_AXR1_IN vin2a_d19 A21 mcasp4_fsx 1500 1400 1900 1040 CFG_MCASP4_FSX_IN vin2a_d17 AA3 mcasp5_aclkx 3740 1850 3900 1700 CFG_MCASP5_ACLKX_IN vin2a_d20 AB3 mcasp5_axr0 3800 2760 3800 2800 CFG_MCASP5_AXR0_IN vin2a_d22 AA4 mcasp5_axr1 4099 2500 3900 2870 CFG_MCASP5_AXR1_IN vin2a_d23 AB9 mcasp5_fsx 3740 2100 3860 2060 CFG_MCASP5_FSX_IN vin2a_d21 B26 xref_clk2 0 0 0 0 CFG_XREF_CLK2_IN vin2a_clk0 204 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-6. Manual Functions Mapping for VIP1 2A IOSET10 (continued) BALL BALL NAME C23 xref_clk3 VIP_MANUAL1 VIP_MANUAL2 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) 1440 0 1623 0 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE CFG_XREF_CLK3_IN vin2a_de0 8 Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for VIP1. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-7 Manual Functions Mapping for VIN2A (IOSET4/5/6) for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-7 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. BAL L BALL NAME U3 VIP_MANUAL3 VIP_MANUAL5 CFG REGISTER A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) RMII_MHZ_50 _CLK 2616 1379 2798 1294 U4 mdio_d 2558 1105 2790 954 MUXMODE 0 1 2 3 4 CFG_RMII_MHZ_50_CLK_I N - - - - vin2a_d11 CFG_MDIO_D_IN - - - - vin2a_d0 V1 mdio_mclk 998 463 1029 431 CFG_MDIO_MCLK_IN - - - - vin2a_clk0 U5 rgmii0_rxc 2658 862 2896 651 CFG_RGMII0_RXC_IN - - - - vin2a_d5 V5 rgmii0_rxctl 2658 1628 2844 1518 CFG_RGMII0_RXCTL_IN - - - - vin2a_d6 W2 rgmii0_rxd0 2638 1123 2856 888 CFG_RGMII0_RXD0_IN - - - - vin2a_fld0 Y2 rgmii0_rxd1 2641 1737 2804 1702 CFG_RGMII0_RXD1_IN - - - - vin2a_d9 V3 rgmii0_rxd2 2641 1676 2801 1652 CFG_RGMII0_RXD2_IN - - - - vin2a_d8 V4 rgmii0_rxd3 2644 1828 2807 1790 CFG_RGMII0_RXD3_IN - - - - vin2a_d7 W9 rgmii0_txc 2638 1454 2835 1396 CFG_RGMII0_TXC_IN - - - - vin2a_d3 V9 rgmii0_txctl 2672 1663 2831 1640 CFG_RGMII0_TXCTL_IN - - - - vin2a_d4 U6 rgmii0_txd0 2604 1442 2764 1417 CFG_RGMII0_TXD0_IN - - - - vin2a_d10 V6 rgmii0_txd1 2683 1598 2843 1600 CFG_RGMII0_TXD1_IN - - - - vin2a_vsync 0 U7 rgmii0_txd2 2563 1483 2816 1344 CFG_RGMII0_TXD2_IN - - - - vin2a_hsync 0 V7 rgmii0_txd3 2717 1461 2913 1310 CFG_RGMII0_TXD3_IN - - - - vin2a_de0 V2 uart3_rxd 2445 1145 2743 923 CFG_UART3_RXD_IN - - - - vin2a_d1 Y1 uart3_txd 2650 1197 2842 1080 CFG_UART3_TXD_IN - - - - vin2a_d2 E1 vin2a_clk0 0 0 0 0 CFG_VIN2A_CLK0_IN vin2a_clk0 - - - - F2 vin2a_d0 1812 102 1936 0 CFG_VIN2A_D0_IN vin2a_d0 - - - - F3 vin2a_d1 1701 439 2229 10 CFG_VIN2A_D1_IN vin2a_d1 - - - - D3 vin2a_d10 1720 215 2031 0 CFG_VIN2A_D10_IN vin2a_d10 - - - - Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 205 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 7-7. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN2A (IOSET4/5/6) AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-7. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN2A (IOSET4/5/6) (continued) BAL L BALL NAME F6 VIP_MANUAL3 VIP_MANUAL5 CFG REGISTER A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) vin2a_d11 1622 0 1702 0 D5 vin2a_d12 1350 412 1819 C2 vin2a_d13 1613 147 1476 C3 vin2a_d14 1149 516 1701 C4 vin2a_d15 1530 450 MUXMODE 0 1 2 3 4 CFG_VIN2A_D11_IN vin2a_d11 - - - - 0 CFG_VIN2A_D12_IN vin2a_d12 - - - - 260 CFG_VIN2A_D13_IN vin2a_d13 - - - - 0 CFG_VIN2A_D14_IN vin2a_d14 - - - - 2021 0 CFG_VIN2A_D15_IN vin2a_d15 - - - - ADVANCE INFORMATION B2 vin2a_d16 1512 449 2044 11 CFG_VIN2A_D16_IN vin2a_d16 - vin2b_d7 - - D6 vin2a_d17 1293 488 1839 5 CFG_VIN2A_D17_IN vin2a_d17 - vin2b_d6 - - C5 vin2a_d18 2140 371 2494 0 CFG_VIN2A_D18_IN vin2a_d18 - vin2b_d5 - - A3 vin2a_d19 2041 275 1699 611 CFG_VIN2A_D19_IN vin2a_d19 - vin2b_d4 - - D1 vin2a_d2 1675 35 1736 0 CFG_VIN2A_D2_IN vin2a_d2 - - - - B3 vin2a_d20 1972 441 2412 88 CFG_VIN2A_D20_IN vin2a_d20 - vin2b_d3 - - B4 vin2a_d21 1957 556 2391 161 CFG_VIN2A_D21_IN vin2a_d21 - vin2b_d2 - - B5 vin2a_d22 2011 433 2446 102 CFG_VIN2A_D22_IN vin2a_d22 - vin2b_d1 - - A4 vin2a_d23 1962 523 2395 145 CFG_VIN2A_D23_IN vin2a_d23 - vin2b_d0 - - E2 vin2a_d3 1457 361 1943 0 CFG_VIN2A_D3_IN vin2a_d3 - - - - D2 vin2a_d4 1535 0 1601 0 CFG_VIN2A_D4_IN vin2a_d4 - - - - F4 vin2a_d5 1676 271 2052 0 CFG_VIN2A_D5_IN vin2a_d5 - - - - C1 vin2a_d6 1513 0 1571 0 CFG_VIN2A_D6_IN vin2a_d6 - - - - E4 vin2a_d7 1616 141 1855 0 CFG_VIN2A_D7_IN vin2a_d7 - - - - F5 vin2a_d8 1286 437 1224 618 CFG_VIN2A_D8_IN vin2a_d8 - - - - E6 vin2a_d9 1544 265 1373 509 CFG_VIN2A_D9_IN vin2a_d9 - - - - G2 vin2a_de0 1732 208 1949 0 CFG_VIN2A_DE0_IN vin2a_de0 vin2a_fld0 vin2b_fld1 vin2b_de1 - H7 vin2a_fld0 1461 562 1983 151 CFG_VIN2A_FLD0_IN vin2a_fld0 - vin2b_clk1 - - G1 vin2a_hsync0 1877 0 1943 0 CFG_VIN2A_HSYNC0_IN vin2a_hsync 0 - - vin2b_hsync 1 - G6 vin2a_vsync0 1566 0 1612 0 CFG_VIN2A_VSYNC0_IN vin2a_vsync 0 - - vin2b_vsync 1 - Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for VIP1. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-8 Manual Functions Mapping for VIN2B (IOSET1/2/7) for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-8 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. 206 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-8. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN2B (IOSET1/2/7) AC5 BALL NAME VIP_MANUAL4 VIP_MANUAL6 CFG REGISTER A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) gpio6_10 2829 884 3009 892 MUXMODE 2 3 4 CFG_GPIO6_10_IN - - vin2b_hsync1 AB4 gpio6_11 2648 1033 2890 1096 CFG_GPIO6_11_IN - - vin2b_vsync1 AD4 mmc3_clk 2794 1074 2997 1089 CFG_MMC3_CLK_IN - - vin2b_d7 AC4 mmc3_cmd 2789 1162 2959 1210 CFG_MMC3_CMD_IN - - vin2b_d6 AC7 mmc3_dat0 2689 1180 2897 1269 CFG_MMC3_DAT0_IN - - vin2b_d5 AC6 mmc3_dat1 2605 1219 2891 1219 CFG_MMC3_DAT1_IN - - vin2b_d4 AC9 mmc3_dat2 2616 703 2947 590 CFG_MMC3_DAT2_IN - - vin2b_d3 AC3 mmc3_dat3 2760 1235 2931 1342 CFG_MMC3_DAT3_IN - - vin2b_d2 AC8 mmc3_dat4 2757 880 2979 891 CFG_MMC3_DAT4_IN - - vin2b_d1 AD6 mmc3_dat5 2688 1177 2894 1262 CFG_MMC3_DAT5_IN - - vin2b_d0 AB8 mmc3_dat6 2638 1165 2894 1187 CFG_MMC3_DAT6_IN - - vin2b_de1 AB5 mmc3_dat7 995 182 1202 107 CFG_MMC3_DAT7_IN - - vin2b_clk1 B2 vin2a_d16 1623 0 1939 0 CFG_VIN2A_D16_IN vin2b_d7 - - D6 vin2a_d17 1453 0 1768 0 CFG_VIN2A_D17_IN vin2b_d6 - - C5 vin2a_d18 2280 0 2417 0 CFG_VIN2A_D18_IN vin2b_d5 - - A3 vin2a_d19 2049 0 2229 0 CFG_VIN2A_D19_IN vin2b_d4 - - B3 vin2a_d20 2081 50 2402 0 CFG_VIN2A_D20_IN vin2b_d3 - - B4 vin2a_d21 2117 167 2513 0 CFG_VIN2A_D21_IN vin2b_d2 - - B5 vin2a_d22 2155 79 2534 0 CFG_VIN2A_D22_IN vin2b_d1 - - A4 vin2a_d23 2099 145 2488 0 CFG_VIN2A_D23_IN vin2b_d0 - - G2 vin2a_de0 1768 261 2248 0 CFG_VIN2A_DE0_IN vin2b_fld1 vin2b_de1 - H7 vin2a_fld0 0 0 0 0 CFG_VIN2A_FLD0_IN vin2b_clk1 - - G1 vin2a_hsync0 1793 0 2011 0 CFG_VIN2A_HSYNC0_IN - vin2b_hsync1 - G6 vin2a_vsync0 1382 0 1632 0 CFG_VIN2A_VSYNC0_IN - vin2b_vsync1 - Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for VIP1. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-9 Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1A (IOSET2/3) and VIN1B (IOSET4) and VIN2B (IOSET8) for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-9 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 207 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-9. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1A (IOSET2/3) and VIN1B (IOSET4) and VIN2B (IOSET8) BAL L BALL NAME R6 T9 VIP_MANUAL7 VIP_MANUAL12 CFG REGISTER ADVANCE INFORMATION A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) gpmc_a0 3080 1792 3376 1632 gpmc_a1 2958 1890 3249 1749 N9 gpmc_a10 3073 1653 3388 P9 gpmc_a11 3014 1784 K7 gpmc_a19 1385 0 T6 gpmc_a2 3041 M7 gpmc_a20 MUXMODE 2 3 4 5 6 CFG_GPMC_A0_IN vin1a_d16 - vin2a_d0 - vin1b_d0 CFG_GPMC_A1_IN vin1a_d17 - vin2a_d1 - vin1b_d1 1433 CFG_GPMC_A10_IN vin1a_de0 - - - vin1b_clk1 3290 1693 CFG_GPMC_A11_IN vin1a_fld0 - vin2a_fld0 - vin1b_de1 1246 0 CFG_GPMC_A19_IN - - vin2a_d12 - vin2b_d0 1960 3322 1850 CFG_GPMC_A2_IN vin1a_d18 - vin2a_d2 - vin1b_d2 859 0 720 0 CFG_GPMC_A20_IN - - vin2a_d13 - vin2b_d1 J5 gpmc_a21 1465 0 1334 0 CFG_GPMC_A21_IN - - vin2a_d14 - vin2b_d2 K6 gpmc_a22 1210 0 1064 0 CFG_GPMC_A22_IN - - vin2a_d15 - vin2b_d3 J7 gpmc_a23 1111 0 954 0 CFG_GPMC_A23_IN - - vin2a_fld0 - vin2b_d4 J4 gpmc_a24 1137 0 1051 0 CFG_GPMC_A24_IN - - vin2a_d8 - vin2b_d5 J6 gpmc_a25 1402 0 1283 0 CFG_GPMC_A25_IN - - vin2a_d9 - vin2b_d6 H4 gpmc_a26 1298 0 1153 0 CFG_GPMC_A26_IN - - vin2a_d10 - vin2b_d7 H5 gpmc_a27 934 0 870 0 CFG_GPMC_A27_IN - - vin2a_d11 - vin2b_hsync 1 T7 gpmc_a3 3019 2145 3296 2050 CFG_GPMC_A3_IN vin1a_d19 - vin2a_d3 - vin1b_d3 P6 gpmc_a4 3063 1981 3357 1829 CFG_GPMC_A4_IN vin1a_d20 - vin2a_d4 - vin1b_d4 R9 gpmc_a5 3021 1954 3304 1840 CFG_GPMC_A5_IN vin1a_d21 - vin2a_d5 - vin1b_d5 R5 gpmc_a6 3062 1716 3348 1592 CFG_GPMC_A6_IN vin1a_d22 - vin2a_d6 - vin1b_d6 P5 gpmc_a7 3260 1889 3583 1631 CFG_GPMC_A7_IN vin1a_d23 - vin2a_d7 - vin1b_d7 N7 gpmc_a8 3033 1702 3328 1547 CFG_GPMC_A8_IN vin1a_hsync 0 - - - vin1b_hsync 1 R4 gpmc_a9 2991 1905 3281 1766 CFG_GPMC_A9_IN vin1a_vsync 0 - - - vin1b_vsync 1 M6 gpmc_ad0 2907 1342 3181 1255 CFG_GPMC_AD0_IN vin1a_d0 - - - - M2 gpmc_ad1 2858 1321 3132 1234 CFG_GPMC_AD1_IN vin1a_d1 - - - - J1 gpmc_ad10 2920 1384 3223 1204 CFG_GPMC_AD10_IN vin1a_d10 - - - - J2 gpmc_ad11 2719 1310 3019 1198 CFG_GPMC_AD11_IN vin1a_d11 - - - - H1 gpmc_ad12 2845 1135 3160 917 CFG_GPMC_AD12_IN vin1a_d12 - - - - J3 gpmc_ad13 2765 1225 3045 1119 CFG_GPMC_AD13_IN vin1a_d13 - - - - H2 gpmc_ad14 2845 1150 3153 952 CFG_GPMC_AD14_IN vin1a_d14 - - - - H3 gpmc_ad15 2766 1453 3044 1355 CFG_GPMC_AD15_IN vin1a_d15 - - - - L5 gpmc_ad2 2951 1296 3226 1209 CFG_GPMC_AD2_IN vin1a_d2 - - - - 208 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-9. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1A (IOSET2/3) and VIN1B (IOSET4) and VIN2B (IOSET8) (continued) BALL NAME M1 VIP_MANUAL7 VIP_MANUAL12 CFG REGISTER A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) gpmc_ad3 2825 1154 3121 997 L6 gpmc_ad4 2927 1245 3246 L4 gpmc_ad5 2923 1251 3217 L3 gpmc_ad6 2958 1342 L2 gpmc_ad7 2900 MUXMODE 2 3 4 5 6 CFG_GPMC_AD3_IN vin1a_d3 - - - - 1014 CFG_GPMC_AD4_IN vin1a_d4 - - - - 1098 CFG_GPMC_AD5_IN vin1a_d5 - - - - 3238 1239 CFG_GPMC_AD6_IN vin1a_d6 - - - - 1244 3174 1157 CFG_GPMC_AD7_IN vin1a_d7 - - - - L1 gpmc_ad8 2845 1585 3125 1482 CFG_GPMC_AD8_IN vin1a_d8 - - - K2 gpmc_ad9 2779 1343 3086 1223 CFG_GPMC_AD9_IN vin1a_d9 - - - - N6 gpmc_ben0 1555 0 1425 0 CFG_GPMC_BEN0_IN - - - - vin2b_de1 M4 gpmc_ben1 1501 0 1397 0 CFG_GPMC_BEN1_IN - - vin2b_clk1 - vin2b_fld1 P7 gpmc_clk 0 0 0 0 CFG_GPMC_CLK_IN - - vin2a_hsync 0 vin2a_de0 vin2b_clk1 H6 gpmc_cs1 1192 0 1102 0 CFG_GPMC_CS1_IN - - vin2a_de0 - vin2b_vsync 1 P1 gpmc_cs3 1324 374 1466 353 CFG_GPMC_CS3_IN vin1a_clk0 - - - - D11 vout1_clk 1648 885 1762 928 CFG_VOUT1_CLK_IN - vin2a_fld0 vin1a_fld0 - - F11 vout1_d0 2197 565 2734 215 CFG_VOUT1_D0_IN - vin2a_d16 vin1a_d16 - - G10 vout1_d1 2221 576 2750 230 CFG_VOUT1_D1_IN - vin2a_d17 vin1a_d17 - - D7 vout1_d10 1800 863 1910 916 CFG_VOUT1_D10_IN - vin2a_d10 vin1a_d10 - - D8 vout1_d11 1656 931 1780 945 CFG_VOUT1_D11_IN - vin2a_d11 vin1a_d11 - - A5 vout1_d12 1719 1086 1866 1041 CFG_VOUT1_D12_IN - vin2a_d12 vin1a_d12 - - C6 vout1_d13 1757 928 1851 1022 CFG_VOUT1_D13_IN - vin2a_d13 vin1a_d13 - - C8 vout1_d14 2279 345 2788 0 CFG_VOUT1_D14_IN - vin2a_d14 vin1a_d14 - - C7 vout1_d15 1810 874 2786 69 CFG_VOUT1_D15_IN - vin2a_d15 vin1a_d15 - - B7 vout1_d16 1763 774 1880 807 CFG_VOUT1_D16_IN - vin2a_d0 vin1a_d0 - - B8 vout1_d17 1695 788 1805 838 CFG_VOUT1_D17_IN - vin2a_d1 vin1a_d1 - - A7 vout1_d18 1777 590 1871 684 CFG_VOUT1_D18_IN - vin2a_d2 vin1a_d2 - - A8 vout1_d19 2047 22 2196 0 CFG_VOUT1_D19_IN - vin2a_d3 vin1a_d3 - - F10 vout1_d2 1809 941 2759 178 CFG_VOUT1_D2_IN - vin2a_d18 vin1a_d18 - - C9 vout1_d20 1676 944 1795 973 CFG_VOUT1_D20_IN - vin2a_d4 vin1a_d4 - - A9 vout1_d21 1712 688 1848 670 CFG_VOUT1_D21_IN - vin2a_d5 vin1a_d5 - - B9 vout1_d22 1698 557 2443 0 CFG_VOUT1_D22_IN - vin2a_d6 vin1a_d6 - - A10 vout1_d23 1627 1035 1726 1116 CFG_VOUT1_D23_IN - vin2a_d7 vin1a_d7 - - Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 209 ADVANCE INFORMATION BAL L AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-9. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1A (IOSET2/3) and VIN1B (IOSET4) and VIN2B (IOSET8) (continued) BAL L BALL NAME G11 VIP_MANUAL7 VIP_MANUAL12 CFG REGISTER A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) vout1_d3 2427 429 2853 167 E9 vout1_d4 2351 412 2845 F9 vout1_d5 1634 983 1729 F8 vout1_d6 1776 880 2736 E7 vout1_d7 2272 351 MUXMODE 2 3 4 5 6 CFG_VOUT1_D3_IN - vin2a_d19 vin1a_d19 - - 85 CFG_VOUT1_D4_IN - vin2a_d20 vin1a_d20 - - 1076 CFG_VOUT1_D5_IN - vin2a_d21 vin1a_d21 - - 107 CFG_VOUT1_D6_IN - vin2a_d22 vin1a_d22 - - 2757 53 CFG_VOUT1_D7_IN - vin2a_d23 vin1a_d23 - - ADVANCE INFORMATION E8 vout1_d8 1724 898 1819 990 CFG_VOUT1_D8_IN - vin2a_d8 vin1a_d8 - - D9 vout1_d9 2281 566 2804 195 CFG_VOUT1_D9_IN - vin2a_d9 vin1a_d9 - - B10 vout1_de 1734 749 1828 842 CFG_VOUT1_DE_IN - vin2a_de0 vin1a_de0 - - B11 vout1_fld 0 0 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_FLD_IN - vin2a_clk0 vin1a_clk0 - - C11 vout1_hsync 1634 606 2399 0 CFG_VOUT1_HSYNC_IN - vin2a_hsync 0 vin1a_hsync 0 - - E11 vout1_vsync 1887 0 2068 0 CFG_VOUT1_VSYNC_IN - vin2a_vsync 0 vin1a_vsync 0 - - Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for VIP1. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-10 Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1A (IOSET4/5/6) and VIN2A (IOSET7/8/9) for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-10 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-10. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1A (IOSET4/5/6) and VIN2A (IOSET7/8/9) BALL R6 BALL NAME VIP_MANUAL8 VIP_MANUAL13 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) gpmc_a0 1891 427 2176 0 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE 3 4 5 CFG_GPMC_A0_IN - vin2a_d0 - T9 gpmc_a1 1713 513 2109 0 CFG_GPMC_A1_IN - vin2a_d1 - P9 gpmc_a11 1797 317 2036 0 CFG_GPMC_A11_IN - vin2a_fld0 - P4 gpmc_a12 0 0 0 0 CFG_GPMC_A12_IN - vin2a_clk0 - R3 gpmc_a13 1876 391 2144 0 CFG_GPMC_A13_IN - vin2a_hsync0 - T2 gpmc_a14 1720 756 2384 38 CFG_GPMC_A14_IN - vin2a_vsync0 - U2 gpmc_a15 1502 368 1804 0 CFG_GPMC_A15_IN - vin2a_d8 - U1 gpmc_a16 1651 355 1902 0 CFG_GPMC_A16_IN - vin2a_d9 - P3 gpmc_a17 1642 338 1862 0 CFG_GPMC_A17_IN - vin2a_d10 - R2 gpmc_a18 1612 0 1406 0 CFG_GPMC_A18_IN - vin2a_d11 - 210 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-10. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1A (IOSET4/5/6) and VIN2A (IOSET7/8/9) (continued) BALL NAME VIP_MANUAL8 VIP_MANUAL13 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) 3 4 5 K7 gpmc_a19 1463 152 1418 0 CFG_GPMC_A19_IN - vin2a_d12 - T6 gpmc_a2 1789 646 2310 0 CFG_GPMC_A2_IN - vin2a_d2 - M7 gpmc_a20 1124 0 933 0 CFG_GPMC_A20_IN - vin2a_d13 - J5 gpmc_a21 1491 206 1483 0 CFG_GPMC_A21_IN - vin2a_d14 - K6 gpmc_a22 1218 245 1254 0 CFG_GPMC_A22_IN - vin2a_d15 - J7 gpmc_a23 1216 0 1021 0 CFG_GPMC_A23_IN - vin2a_fld0 - T7 gpmc_a3 1789 766 2451 8 CFG_GPMC_A3_IN - vin2a_d3 - P6 gpmc_a4 1842 646 2329 0 CFG_GPMC_A4_IN - vin2a_d4 - R9 gpmc_a5 1778 556 2215 0 CFG_GPMC_A5_IN - vin2a_d5 - R5 gpmc_a6 1783 443 2088 0 CFG_GPMC_A6_IN - vin2a_d6 - P5 gpmc_a7 2207 370 2393 0 CFG_GPMC_A7_IN - vin2a_d7 - N1 gpmc_advn_ale 1755 116 1745 0 CFG_GPMC_ADVN_ALE_IN - vin2a_vsync0 - P7 gpmc_clk 1896 351 2152 0 CFG_GPMC_CLK_IN - vin2a_hsync0 vin2a_de0 H6 gpmc_cs1 1337 74 1288 0 CFG_GPMC_CS1_IN - vin2a_de0 - D11 vout1_clk 1939 332 2486 0 CFG_VOUT1_CLK_IN vin2a_fld0 - - F11 vout1_d0 2140 647 2617 386 CFG_VOUT1_D0_IN vin2a_d16 - - G10 vout1_d1 2104 615 2620 314 CFG_VOUT1_D1_IN vin2a_d17 - - D7 vout1_d10 2139 406 2675 85 CFG_VOUT1_D10_IN vin2a_d10 - - D8 vout1_d11 1944 534 2569 125 CFG_VOUT1_D11_IN vin2a_d11 - - A5 vout1_d12 1966 659 2646 154 CFG_VOUT1_D12_IN vin2a_d12 - - C6 vout1_d13 2048 447 2624 87 CFG_VOUT1_D13_IN vin2a_d13 - - C8 vout1_d14 2222 548 2700 286 CFG_VOUT1_D14_IN vin2a_d14 - - C7 vout1_d15 2072 443 2664 67 CFG_VOUT1_D15_IN vin2a_d15 - - B7 vout1_d16 2044 455 2634 82 CFG_VOUT1_D16_IN vin2a_d0 - - B8 vout1_d17 1971 246 2433 0 CFG_VOUT1_D17_IN vin2a_d1 - - A7 vout1_d18 2104 120 2440 0 CFG_VOUT1_D18_IN vin2a_d2 - - A8 vout1_d19 1888 0 2105 0 CFG_VOUT1_D19_IN vin2a_d3 - - F10 vout1_d2 2170 237 2624 0 CFG_VOUT1_D2_IN vin2a_d18 - - C9 vout1_d20 1942 512 2579 91 CFG_VOUT1_D20_IN vin2a_d4 - - A9 vout1_d21 1997 141 2324 0 CFG_VOUT1_D21_IN vin2a_d5 - - B9 vout1_d22 1949 0 2165 0 CFG_VOUT1_D22_IN vin2a_d6 - - A10 vout1_d23 1871 704 2522 269 CFG_VOUT1_D23_IN vin2a_d7 - - Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 211 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-10. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1A (IOSET4/5/6) and VIN2A (IOSET7/8/9) (continued) BALL BALL NAME VIP_MANUAL8 VIP_MANUAL13 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) 3 4 5 G11 vout1_d3 2319 417 2740 191 CFG_VOUT1_D3_IN vin2a_d19 - - E9 vout1_d4 2300 369 2739 137 CFG_VOUT1_D4_IN vin2a_d20 - - F9 vout1_d5 1923 579 2527 191 CFG_VOUT1_D5_IN vin2a_d21 - - F8 vout1_d6 2148 396 2622 138 CFG_VOUT1_D6_IN vin2a_d22 - - E7 vout1_d7 2212 335 2653 110 CFG_VOUT1_D7_IN vin2a_d23 - - ADVANCE INFORMATION E8 vout1_d8 1962 573 2573 178 CFG_VOUT1_D8_IN vin2a_d8 - - D9 vout1_d9 2312 335 2725 138 CFG_VOUT1_D9_IN vin2a_d9 - - B10 vout1_de 1973 414 2551 52 CFG_VOUT1_DE_IN vin2a_de0 - - B11 vout1_fld 0 0 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_FLD_IN vin2a_clk0 - - C11 vout1_hsync 1813 261 2277 0 CFG_VOUT1_HSYNC_IN vin2a_hsync0 - - E11 vout1_vsync 1665 0 1881 0 CFG_VOUT1_VSYNC_IN vin2a_vsync0 - - Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for VIP1. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-11 Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1B (IOSET6) for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-11 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-11. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1B (IOSET6) BALL BALL NAME VIP_MANUAL9 VIP_MANUAL14 CFG REGISTER A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) MUXMODE 5 6 vin1b_d0 R6 gpmc_a0 1873 702 2202 441 CFG_GPMC_A0_IN - T9 gpmc_a1 1629 772 2057 413 CFG_GPMC_A1_IN - vin1b_d1 N9 gpmc_a10 0 0 0 0 CFG_GPMC_A10_IN - vin1b_clk1 P9 gpmc_a11 1851 1011 2126 856 CFG_GPMC_A11_IN - vin1b_de1 P4 gpmc_a12 2009 601 2289 327 CFG_GPMC_A12_IN - vin1b_fld1 T6 gpmc_a2 1734 898 2131 573 CFG_GPMC_A2_IN - vin1b_d2 T7 gpmc_a3 1757 1076 2106 812 CFG_GPMC_A3_IN - vin1b_d3 P6 gpmc_a4 1794 893 2164 559 CFG_GPMC_A4_IN - vin1b_d4 R9 gpmc_a5 1726 853 2120 523 CFG_GPMC_A5_IN - vin1b_d5 R5 gpmc_a6 1792 612 2153 338 CFG_GPMC_A6_IN - vin1b_d6 P5 gpmc_a7 2117 610 2389 304 CFG_GPMC_A7_IN - vin1b_d7 N7 gpmc_a8 1758 653 2140 308 CFG_GPMC_A8_IN - vin1b_hsync1 R4 gpmc_a9 1705 899 2067 646 CFG_GPMC_A9_IN - vin1b_vsync1 212 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-11. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1B (IOSET6) (continued) BALL NAME VIP_MANUAL9 VIP_MANUAL14 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) 5 6 U4 mdio_d 1945 671 2265 414 CFG_MDIO_D_IN vin1b_d0 - V1 mdio_mclk 255 119 337 0 CFG_MDIO_MCLK_IN vin1b_clk1 - U5 rgmii0_rxc 2057 909 2341 646 CFG_RGMII0_RXC_IN vin1b_d5 - V5 rgmii0_rxctl 2121 1139 2323 988 CFG_RGMII0_RXCTL_IN vin1b_d6 - W2 rgmii0_rxd0 2070 655 2336 340 CFG_RGMII0_RXD0_IN vin1b_fld1 - V4 rgmii0_rxd3 2092 1357 2306 1216 CFG_RGMII0_RXD3_IN vin1b_d7 - W9 rgmii0_txc 2088 1205 2328 1079 CFG_RGMII0_TXC_IN vin1b_d3 - V9 rgmii0_txctl 2143 1383 2312 1311 CFG_RGMII0_TXCTL_IN vin1b_d4 - V6 rgmii0_txd1 2078 1189 2324 1065 CFG_RGMII0_TXD1_IN vin1b_vsync1 - U7 rgmii0_txd2 1928 1125 2306 763 CFG_RGMII0_TXD2_IN vin1b_hsync1 - V7 rgmii0_txd3 2255 971 2401 846 CFG_RGMII0_TXD3_IN vin1b_de1 - V2 uart3_rxd 1829 747 2220 400 CFG_UART3_RXD_IN vin1b_d1 - Y1 uart3_txd 2030 837 2324 568 CFG_UART3_TXD_IN vin1b_d2 - Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for VIP1. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-12 Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1B (IOSET5) and VIN2B (IOSET9) for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-12 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-12. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1B (IOSET5) and VIN2B (IOSET9) BALL BALL NAME VIP_MANUAL10 VIP_MANUAL11 CFG REGISTER A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) MUXMODE 4 6 K7 gpmc_a19 1600 943 2023 477 CFG_GPMC_A19_IN vin2a_d12 vin2b_d0 M7 gpmc_a20 1440 621 1875 136 CFG_GPMC_A20_IN vin2a_d13 vin2b_d1 J5 gpmc_a21 1602 1066 2021 604 CFG_GPMC_A21_IN vin2a_d14 vin2b_d2 K6 gpmc_a22 1395 983 1822 519 CFG_GPMC_A22_IN vin2a_d15 vin2b_d3 J7 gpmc_a23 1571 716 2045 200 CFG_GPMC_A23_IN vin2a_fld0 vin2b_d4 J4 gpmc_a24 1463 832 1893 396 CFG_GPMC_A24_IN vin2a_d8 vin2b_d5 J6 gpmc_a25 1426 1166 1842 732 CFG_GPMC_A25_IN vin2a_d9 vin2b_d6 H4 gpmc_a26 1362 1094 1797 584 CFG_GPMC_A26_IN vin2a_d10 vin2b_d7 H5 gpmc_a27 1283 809 1760 338 CFG_GPMC_A27_IN vin2a_d11 vin2b_hsync1 N6 gpmc_ben0 1978 780 2327 389 CFG_GPMC_BEN0_IN - vin2b_de1 M4 gpmc_ben1 0 0 0 0 CFG_GPMC_BEN1_IN vin2b_clk1 vin2b_fld1 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 213 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-12. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1B (IOSET5) and VIN2B (IOSET9) (continued) BALL BALL NAME H6 gpmc_cs1 VIP_MANUAL10 VIP_MANUAL11 CFG REGISTER A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) 1411 982 1857 536 CFG_GPMC_CS1_IN MUXMODE 4 6 vin2a_de0 vin2b_vsync1 Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for VIP1. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-13 Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1A (IOSET8/9/10) for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-13 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-13. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1A (IOSET8/9/10) ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL BALL NAME VIP_MANUAL15 VIP_MANUAL16 CFG REGISTER A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) MUXMODE 7 9 AC5 gpio6_10 2131 2198 2170 2180 CFG_GPIO6_10_IN - vin1a_clk0 AB4 gpio6_11 3720 2732 4106 2448 CFG_GPIO6_11_IN - vin1a_de0 C14 mcasp1_aclkx 2447 0 3042 0 CFG_MCASP1_ACLKX_IN vin1a_fld0 - G12 mcasp1_axr0 3061 0 3380 292 CFG_MCASP1_AXR0_IN vin1a_vsync0 - F12 mcasp1_axr1 3113 0 3396 304 CFG_MCASP1_AXR1_IN vin1a_hsync0 - B13 mcasp1_axr10 2803 0 3362 0 CFG_MCASP1_AXR10_IN vin1a_d13 - A12 mcasp1_axr11 3292 0 3357 546 CFG_MCASP1_AXR11_IN vin1a_d12 - E14 mcasp1_axr12 2854 0 3145 320 CFG_MCASP1_AXR12_IN vin1a_d11 - A13 mcasp1_axr13 2813 0 3229 196 CFG_MCASP1_AXR13_IN vin1a_d10 - G14 mcasp1_axr14 2471 0 3053 0 CFG_MCASP1_AXR14_IN vin1a_d9 - F14 mcasp1_axr15 2815 0 3225 201 CFG_MCASP1_AXR15_IN vin1a_d8 - B12 mcasp1_axr8 2965 0 3427 83 CFG_MCASP1_AXR8_IN vin1a_d15 - A11 mcasp1_axr9 3082 0 3253 440 CFG_MCASP1_AXR9_IN vin1a_d14 - D14 mcasp1_fsx 2898 0 3368 139 CFG_MCASP1_FSX_IN vin1a_de0 - A19 mcasp2_aclkx 2413 0 2972 0 CFG_MCASP2_ACLKX_IN vin1a_d7 - C15 mcasp2_axr2 2478 0 3062 0 CFG_MCASP2_AXR2_IN vin1a_d5 - A16 mcasp2_axr3 2806 0 3175 242 CFG_MCASP2_AXR3_IN vin1a_d4 - A18 mcasp2_fsx 2861 78 2936 599 CFG_MCASP2_FSX_IN vin1a_d6 - B18 mcasp3_aclkx 1583 0 1878 0 CFG_MCASP3_ACLKX_IN vin1a_d3 - B19 mcasp3_axr0 2873 0 3109 375 CFG_MCASP3_AXR0_IN vin1a_d1 - C17 mcasp3_axr1 1625 1400 2072 1023 CFG_MCASP3_AXR1_IN vin1a_d0 vin1a_fld0 F15 mcasp3_fsx 2792 0 3146 257 CFG_MCASP3_FSX_IN vin1a_d2 - C18 mcasp4_aclkx 1547 268 1776 0 CFG_MCASP4_ACLKX_IN - vin1a_d15 214 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-13. Manual Functions Mapping for VIN1A (IOSET8/9/10) (continued) BALL NAME VIP_MANUAL15 VIP_MANUAL16 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) 7 9 G16 mcasp4_axr0 2362 587 2815 193 CFG_MCASP4_AXR0_IN - vin1a_d13 D17 mcasp4_axr1 2226 667 2669 304 CFG_MCASP4_AXR1_IN - vin1a_d12 A21 mcasp4_fsx 924 2573 1338 2219 CFG_MCASP4_FSX_IN - vin1a_d14 AA3 mcasp5_aclkx 3731 2106 4130 1708 CFG_MCASP5_ACLKX_IN - vin1a_d11 AB3 mcasp5_axr0 3800 3013 4159 2776 CFG_MCASP5_AXR0_IN - vin1a_d9 AA4 mcasp5_axr1 3828 2951 4179 2733 CFG_MCASP5_AXR1_IN - vin1a_d8 AB9 mcasp5_fsx 3675 2447 4074 2142 CFG_MCASP5_FSX_IN - vin1a_d10 AD4 mmc3_clk 3907 2744 4260 2450 CFG_MMC3_CLK_IN - vin1a_d7 AC4 mmc3_cmd 3892 2768 4242 2470 CFG_MMC3_CMD_IN - vin1a_d6 AC7 mmc3_dat0 3786 2765 4156 2522 CFG_MMC3_DAT0_IN - vin1a_d5 AC6 mmc3_dat1 3673 2961 4053 2667 CFG_MMC3_DAT1_IN - vin1a_d4 AC9 mmc3_dat2 3818 2447 4209 2096 CFG_MMC3_DAT2_IN - vin1a_d3 AC3 mmc3_dat3 3902 2903 4259 2672 CFG_MMC3_DAT3_IN - vin1a_d2 AC8 mmc3_dat4 3905 2622 4259 2342 CFG_MMC3_DAT4_IN - vin1a_d1 AD6 mmc3_dat5 3807 2824 4167 2595 CFG_MMC3_DAT5_IN - vin1a_d0 AB8 mmc3_dat6 3724 2818 4123 2491 CFG_MMC3_DAT6_IN - vin1a_hsync0 AB5 mmc3_dat7 3775 2481 4159 2161 CFG_MMC3_DAT7_IN - vin1a_vsync0 D18 xref_clk0 1971 0 2472 0 CFG_XREF_CLK0_IN vin1a_d0 - E17 xref_clk1 0 192 0 603 CFG_XREF_CLK1_IN vin1a_clk0 - Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 215 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 7.7 www.ti.com Display Subsystem – Video Output Ports Three Display Parallel Interfaces (DPI) channels are available in DSS named DPI Video Output 1, DPI Video Output 2 and DPI Video Output 3. NOTE The DPI Video Output i (i = 1 to 3) interface is also referred to as VOUTi. Every VOUT interface consists of: • 24-bit data bus (data[23:0]) • Horizontal synchronization signal (HSYNC) • Vertical synchronization signal (VSYNC) • Data enable (DE) • Field ID (FID) • Pixel clock (CLK) ADVANCE INFORMATION NOTE For more information, see the Display Subsystem chapter of the Device TRM. NOTE VOUT1, VOUT2 and VOUT3 only qualified for use at 1.8V. CAUTION The I/O Timings provided in this section are valid only if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 7-16. CAUTION The I/O Timings provided in this section are valid only for some DSS usage modes when the corresponding Virtual I/O Timings or Manual I/O Timings are configured as described in the tables found in this section. CAUTION All pads/balls configured as vouti_* signals must be programmed to use slow slew rate by setting the corresponding CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[SLEWCONTROL] register field to SLOW (0b1). Table 7-14, Table 7-15 and Figure 7-6 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions. Table 7-14. DPI Video Output i (i = 1..3) Default Switching Characteristics NO. PARAMETE R D1 tc(clk) Cycle time, output pixel clock vouti_clk D2 tw(clkL) Pulse duration, output pixel clock vouti_clk low 216 DESCRIPTION Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback MODE MIN MAX UNIT 11.76 ns P*0.5-1 ns (1) Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-14. DPI Video Output i (i = 1..3) Default Switching Characteristics (continued) NO. PARAMETE R D3 tw(clkH) Pulse duration, output pixel clock vouti_clk high D5 td(clk-ctlV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output data vouti_d[23:0] valid DPI1 -2.5 2.5 ns D6 td(clk-dV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output control signals vouti_vsync, vouti_hsync, vouti_de, and vouti_fld valid DPI1 -2.5 2.5 ns D5 td(clk-ctlV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output data vouti_d[23:0] valid DPI2 (vin2a_fld0 clock reference) -2.5 2.5 ns D6 td(clk-dV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output control signals vouti_vsync, vouti_hsync, vouti_de, and vouti_fld valid DPI2 (vin2a_fld0 clock reference) -2.5 2.5 ns D5 td(clk-ctlV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output data vouti_d[23:0] valid DPI2 (xref_clk2 clock reference) -2.5 2.5 ns D6 td(clk-dV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output control signals vouti_vsync, vouti_hsync, vouti_de, and vouti_fld valid DPI2 (xref_clk2 clock reference) -2.5 2.5 ns D5 td(clk-ctlV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output data vouti_d[23:0] valid DPI3 -2.5 2.5 ns D6 td(clk-dV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output control signals vouti_vsync, vouti_hsync, vouti_de, and vouti_fld valid DPI3 -2.5 2.5 ns MAX UNIT MODE MIN MAX P*0.5-1 UNIT ns (1) (1) P = output vouti_clk period in ns. (2) All pads/balls configured as vouti_* signals must be programmed to use slow slew rate by setting the corresponding CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[SLEWCONTROL] register field to SLOW (0b1). Table 7-15. DPI Video Output i (i = 1..3) Alternate Switching Characteristics NO. PARAMETE R D1 tc(clk) Cycle time, output pixel clock vouti_clk 6.06 ns D2 tw(clkL) Pulse duration, output pixel clock vouti_clk low P*0.5-1 ns D3 tw(clkH) Pulse duration, output pixel clock vouti_clk high P*0.5-1 ns D5 td(clk-ctlV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output data vouti_d[23:0] valid DPI1 1.51 4.55 ns D6 td(clk-dV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output control signals vouti_vsync, vouti_hsync, vouti_de, and vouti_fld valid DPI1 1.51 4.55 ns D5 td(clk-ctlV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output data vouti_d[23:0] valid DPI2 (vin2a_fld0 clock reference) 1.51 4.55 ns D6 td(clk-dV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output control signals vouti_vsync, vouti_hsync, vouti_de, and vouti_fld valid DPI2 (vin2a_fld0 clock reference) 1.51 4.55 ns D5 td(clk-ctlV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output data vouti_d[23:0] valid DPI2 (xref_clk2 clock reference) 1.45 4.77 ns D6 td(clk-dV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output control signals vouti_vsync, vouti_hsync, vouti_de, and vouti_fld valid DPI2 (xref_clk2 clock reference) 1.45 4.77 ns D5 td(clk-ctlV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output data vouti_d[23:0] valid DPI3 1.51 4.55 ns D6 td(clk-dV) Delay time, output pixel clock vouti_clk transition to output control signals vouti_vsync, vouti_hsync, vouti_de, and vouti_fld valid DPI3 1.51 4.55 ns DESCRIPTION Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated MODE MIN (1) (1) Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 217 ADVANCE INFORMATION DESCRIPTION AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) P = output vouti_clk period in ns. (2) All pads/balls configured as vouti_* signals must be programmed to use slow slew rate by setting the corresponding CTRL_CORE_PAD_*[SLEWCONTROL] register field to SLOW (0b1). D2 D1 D3 D4 Falling-edge Clock Reference vouti_clk D6 Rising-edge Clock Reference vouti_clk vouti_vsync D6 vouti_hsync D5 ADVANCE INFORMATION vouti_d[23:0] data_1 data_2 data_n D6 vouti_de D6 vouti_fld even odd SWPS049-018 (1)(2)(3) Figure 7-6. DPI Video Output (1) The configuration of assertion of the data can be programmed on the falling or rising edge of the pixel clock. (2) The polarity and the pulse width of vouti_hsync and vouti_vsync are programmable, refer to the DSS section of the device TRM. (3) The vouti_clk frequency can be configured, refer to the DSS section of the device TRM. In Table 7-16 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with VOUT2. Table 7-16. VOUT2 IOSETs SIGNALS 218 IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL MUX BALL MUX vout2_d23 F2 4 AA4 6 vout2_d22 F3 4 AB3 6 vout2_d21 D1 4 AB9 6 vout2_d20 E2 4 AA3 6 vout2_d19 D2 4 D17 6 vout2_d18 F4 4 G16 6 vout2_d17 C1 4 A21 6 vout2_d16 E4 4 C18 6 vout2_d15 F5 4 A17 6 vout2_d14 E6 4 B17 6 vout2_d13 D3 4 B16 6 vout2_d12 F6 4 D15 6 vout2_d11 D5 4 A15 6 vout2_d10 C2 4 B15 6 vout2_d9 C3 4 A20 6 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-16. VOUT2 IOSETs (continued) IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL MUX BALL MUX vout2_d8 C4 vout2_d7 B2 4 E15 6 4 D12 vout2_d6 6 D6 4 C12 6 vout2_d5 C5 4 F13 6 vout2_d4 A3 4 E12 6 vout2_d3 B3 4 J11 6 vout2_d2 B4 4 G13 6 vout2_d1 B5 4 J14 6 vout2_d0 A4 4 B14 6 vout2_vsync G6 4 F20 6 vout2_hsync G1 4 E21 6 vout2_clk H7 4 B26 6 vout2_fld E1 4 F21 6 vout2_de G2 4 C23 6 NOTE To configure the desired Manual IO Timing Mode the user must follow the steps described in section "Manual IO Timing Modes" of the Device TRM. The associated registers to configure are listed in the CFG REGISTER column. For more information please see the Control Module Chapter in the Device TRM. Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for VOUT1. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-17 Manual Functions Mapping for DSS VOUT1 for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-17 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-17. Manual Functions Mapping for DSS VOUT1 BALL BALL NAME VOUT1_MANUAL1 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) D11 vout1_clk 0 212 CFG_VOUT1_CLK_OUT vout1_clk 0 F11 vout1_d0 2502 0 CFG_VOUT1_D0_OUT vout1_d0 G10 vout1_d1 2402 0 CFG_VOUT1_D1_OUT vout1_d1 D7 vout1_d10 2147 0 CFG_VOUT1_D10_OUT vout1_d10 D8 vout1_d11 2249 0 CFG_VOUT1_D11_OUT vout1_d11 A5 vout1_d12 2410 0 CFG_VOUT1_D12_OUT vout1_d12 C6 vout1_d13 2129 0 CFG_VOUT1_D13_OUT vout1_d13 C8 vout1_d14 2279 0 CFG_VOUT1_D14_OUT vout1_d14 C7 vout1_d15 2266 23 CFG_VOUT1_D15_OUT vout1_d15 B7 vout1_d16 1798 0 CFG_VOUT1_D16_OUT vout1_d16 B8 vout1_d17 2243 0 CFG_VOUT1_D17_OUT vout1_d17 A7 vout1_d18 2127 0 CFG_VOUT1_D18_OUT vout1_d18 A8 vout1_d19 2096 0 CFG_VOUT1_D19_OUT vout1_d19 F10 vout1_d2 2375 0 CFG_VOUT1_D2_OUT vout1_d2 C9 vout1_d20 2105 0 CFG_VOUT1_D20_OUT vout1_d20 A9 vout1_d21 2120 0 CFG_VOUT1_D21_OUT vout1_d21 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 219 ADVANCE INFORMATION SIGNALS AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-17. Manual Functions Mapping for DSS VOUT1 (continued) BALL BALL NAME VOUT1_MANUAL1 CFG REGISTER A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) MUXMODE 0 B9 vout1_d22 2013 65 CFG_VOUT1_D22_OUT vout1_d22 A10 vout1_d23 1887 0 CFG_VOUT1_D23_OUT vout1_d23 G11 vout1_d3 2429 0 CFG_VOUT1_D3_OUT vout1_d3 E9 vout1_d4 2639 0 CFG_VOUT1_D4_OUT vout1_d4 F9 vout1_d5 2319 0 CFG_VOUT1_D5_OUT vout1_d5 F8 vout1_d6 2227 0 CFG_VOUT1_D6_OUT vout1_d6 E7 vout1_d7 2309 0 CFG_VOUT1_D7_OUT vout1_d7 E8 vout1_d8 1999 0 CFG_VOUT1_D8_OUT vout1_d8 D9 vout1_d9 2276 0 CFG_VOUT1_D9_OUT vout1_d9 B10 vout1_de 1933 0 CFG_VOUT1_DE_OUT vout1_de B11 vout1_fld 1825 0 CFG_VOUT1_FLD_OUT vout1_fld C11 vout1_hsync 1741 13 CFG_VOUT1_HSYNC_OUT vout1_hsync E11 vout1_vsync 2338 0 CFG_VOUT1_VSYNC_OUT vout1_vsync ADVANCE INFORMATION Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for VOUT2. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-18 Manual Functions Mapping for DSS VOUT2 IOSET1 for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-18 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. 220 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-18. Manual Functions Mapping for DSS VOUT2 IOSET1 BALL NAME VOUT2_IOSET1_MANUAL1 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) VOUT2_IOSET1_MANUAL2 VOUT2_IOSET1_MANUAL3 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) CFG REGISTER MUXMODE 4 E1 vin2a_clk0 2571 0 1059 0 1025 0 CFG_VIN2A_CLK0_OUT vout2_fld F2 vin2a_d0 2124 0 589 0 577 0 CFG_VIN2A_D0_OUT vout2_d23 F3 vin2a_d1 2103 0 568 0 557 0 CFG_VIN2A_D1_OUT vout2_d22 D3 vin2a_d10 2091 0 557 0 545 0 CFG_VIN2A_D10_OUT vout2_d13 F6 vin2a_d11 2142 0 608 0 596 0 CFG_VIN2A_D11_OUT vout2_d12 D5 vin2a_d12 3220 385 1816 255 1783 276 CFG_VIN2A_D12_OUT vout2_d11 C2 vin2a_d13 3276 322 1872 192 1838 213 CFG_VIN2A_D13_OUT vout2_d10 C3 vin2a_d14 3304 0 1769 0 1757 0 CFG_VIN2A_D14_OUT vout2_d9 C4 vin2a_d15 3070 257 1665 127 1632 148 CFG_VIN2A_D15_OUT vout2_d8 B2 vin2a_d16 3314 155 1908 31 1878 43 CFG_VIN2A_D16_OUT vout2_d7 D6 vin2a_d17 3302 199 1897 69 1865 89 CFG_VIN2A_D17_OUT vout2_d6 C5 vin2a_d18 1893 0 358 0 347 0 CFG_VIN2A_D18_OUT vout2_d5 A3 vin2a_d19 1698 0 163 0 151 0 CFG_VIN2A_D19_OUT vout2_d4 D1 vin2a_d2 2193 0 658 0 646 0 CFG_VIN2A_D2_OUT vout2_d21 B3 vin2a_d20 1736 0 202 0 190 0 CFG_VIN2A_D20_OUT vout2_d3 B4 vin2a_d21 1636 0 101 0 89 0 CFG_VIN2A_D21_OUT vout2_d2 B5 vin2a_d22 1628 0 93 0 81 0 CFG_VIN2A_D22_OUT vout2_d1 A4 vin2a_d23 1538 0 0 0 0 0 CFG_VIN2A_D23_OUT vout2_d0 E2 vin2a_d3 1997 0 462 0 450 0 CFG_VIN2A_D3_OUT vout2_d20 D2 vin2a_d4 2528 0 993 0 982 0 CFG_VIN2A_D4_OUT vout2_d19 F4 vin2a_d5 2038 0 503 0 492 0 CFG_VIN2A_D5_OUT vout2_d18 C1 vin2a_d6 1746 0 211 0 200 0 CFG_VIN2A_D6_OUT vout2_d17 E4 vin2a_d7 2213 0 678 0 666 0 CFG_VIN2A_D7_OUT vout2_d16 F5 vin2a_d8 2268 0 733 0 721 0 CFG_VIN2A_D8_OUT vout2_d15 vout2_d14 E6 vin2a_d9 2170 0 635 0 623 0 CFG_VIN2A_D9_OUT G2 vin2a_de0 2102 0 568 0 556 0 CFG_VIN2A_DE0_OUT vout2_de H7 vin2a_fld0 0 983 1398 1185 1385 1202 CFG_VIN2A_FLD0_OUT vout2_clk G1 vin2a_hsync0 2482 0 974 0 936 0 CFG_VIN2A_HSYNC0_ OUT vout2_hsync G6 vin2a_vsync0 2296 0 784 0 750 0 CFG_VIN2A_VSYNC0_ OUT vout2_vsync Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 221 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for VOUT2. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-19 Manual Functions Mapping for DSS VOUT2 IOSET2 for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-19 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-19. Manual Functions Mapping for DSS VOUT2 IOSET2 BALL BALL NAME VOUT2_IOSET2_MANUAL1 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) E21 gpio6_14 1483 0 79 0 68 F20 gpio6_15 1659 0 158 0 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) ADVANCE INFORMATION 222 VOUT2_IOSET2_MANUAL2 VOUT2_IOSET2_MANUAL3 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE 0 CFG_GPIO6_14_OUT vout2_hsync 148 0 CFG_GPIO6_15_OUT vout2_vsync 6 F21 gpio6_16 1364 0 0 0 0 0 CFG_GPIO6_16_OUT vout2_fld B14 mcasp1_aclkr 2614 0 1255 0 1270 0 CFG_MCASP1_ACLKR _OUT vout2_d0 G13 mcasp1_axr2 2705 0 1350 0 1360 0 CFG_MCASP1_AXR2_ OUT vout2_d2 J11 mcasp1_axr3 2565 0 1210 0 1219 0 CFG_MCASP1_AXR3_ OUT vout2_d3 E12 mcasp1_axr4 2759 0 1404 0 1413 0 CFG_MCASP1_AXR4_ OUT vout2_d4 F13 mcasp1_axr5 2680 0 1325 0 1335 0 CFG_MCASP1_AXR5_ OUT vout2_d5 C12 mcasp1_axr6 2634 0 1275 0 1289 0 CFG_MCASP1_AXR6_ OUT vout2_d6 D12 mcasp1_axr7 2658 0 1302 0 1311 0 CFG_MCASP1_AXR7_ OUT vout2_d7 J14 mcasp1_fsr 2518 0 1163 0 1172 0 CFG_MCASP1_FSR_O UT vout2_d1 E15 mcasp2_aclkr 2728 0 1373 0 1382 0 CFG_MCASP2_ACLKR _OUT vout2_d8 B15 mcasp2_axr0 2213 0 319 534 308 560 CFG_MCASP2_AXR0_ OUT vout2_d10 A15 mcasp2_axr1 2712 0 1357 0 1366 0 CFG_MCASP2_AXR1_ OUT vout2_d11 D15 mcasp2_axr4 2529 0 1169 0 1184 0 CFG_MCASP2_AXR4_ OUT vout2_d12 B16 mcasp2_axr5 2376 0 543 478 1029 0 CFG_MCASP2_AXR5_ OUT vout2_d13 B17 mcasp2_axr6 2620 0 1265 0 1274 0 CFG_MCASP2_AXR6_ OUT vout2_d14 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-19. Manual Functions Mapping for DSS VOUT2 IOSET2 (continued) BALL NAME VOUT2_IOSET2_MANUAL1 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A17 mcasp2_axr7 2192 0 354 483 845 0 CFG_MCASP2_AXR7_ OUT vout2_d15 A20 mcasp2_fsr 1858 0 12 487 513 0 CFG_MCASP2_FSR_O UT vout2_d9 C18 mcasp4_aclkx 2524 0 1165 0 1179 0 CFG_MCASP4_ACLKX_ OUT vout2_d16 G16 mcasp4_axr0 2278 0 797 0 806 0 CFG_MCASP4_AXR0_ OUT vout2_d18 D17 mcasp4_axr1 2253 0 750 0 759 0 CFG_MCASP4_AXR1_ OUT vout2_d19 A21 mcasp4_fsx 2178 0 823 0 832 0 CFG_MCASP4_FSX_O UT vout2_d17 AA3 mcasp5_aclkx 4672 1737 3256 1798 3226 1837 CFG_MCASP5_ACLKX_ OUT vout2_d20 AB3 mcasp5_axr0 4642 1286 3226 1347 3196 1386 CFG_MCASP5_AXR0_ OUT vout2_d22 AA4 mcasp5_axr1 4625 725 3209 786 3179 825 CFG_MCASP5_AXR1_ OUT vout2_d23 AB9 mcasp5_fsx 4565 1062 3149 1123 3119 1162 CFG_MCASP5_FSX_O UT vout2_d21 B26 xref_clk2 0 49 1359 466 1341 512 CFG_XREF_CLK2_OUT vout2_clk C23 xref_clk3 1447 0 36 0 45 0 CFG_XREF_CLK3_OUT vout2_de A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) VOUT2_IOSET2_MANUAL2 VOUT2_IOSET2_MANUAL3 6 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 223 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for VOUT3. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-20 Manual Functions Mapping for DSS VOUT3 for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-20 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-20. Manual Functions Mapping for DSS VOUT3 BALL ADVANCE INFORMATION 7.8 BALL NAME VOUT3_MANUAL1 CFG REGISTER A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) MUXMODE 3 R6 gpmc_a0 2395 0 CFG_GPMC_A0_OUT vout3_d16 T9 gpmc_a1 2412 0 CFG_GPMC_A1_OUT vout3_d17 N9 gpmc_a10 2473 0 CFG_GPMC_A10_OUT vout3_de P9 gpmc_a11 2906 0 CFG_GPMC_A11_OUT vout3_fld T6 gpmc_a2 2360 0 CFG_GPMC_A2_OUT vout3_d18 T7 gpmc_a3 2391 0 CFG_GPMC_A3_OUT vout3_d19 P6 gpmc_a4 2626 0 CFG_GPMC_A4_OUT vout3_d20 R9 gpmc_a5 2338 0 CFG_GPMC_A5_OUT vout3_d21 R5 gpmc_a6 2374 0 CFG_GPMC_A6_OUT vout3_d22 P5 gpmc_a7 2432 0 CFG_GPMC_A7_OUT vout3_d23 N7 gpmc_a8 3155 0 CFG_GPMC_A8_OUT vout3_hsync R4 gpmc_a9 2309 0 CFG_GPMC_A9_OUT vout3_vsync M6 gpmc_ad0 2360 0 CFG_GPMC_AD0_OUT vout3_d0 M2 gpmc_ad1 2420 0 CFG_GPMC_AD1_OUT vout3_d1 J1 gpmc_ad10 2235 0 CFG_GPMC_AD10_OU T vout3_d10 J2 gpmc_ad11 2253 0 CFG_GPMC_AD11_OU T vout3_d11 H1 gpmc_ad12 1949 427 CFG_GPMC_AD12_OU T vout3_d12 J3 gpmc_ad13 2318 0 CFG_GPMC_AD13_OU T vout3_d13 H2 gpmc_ad14 2123 0 CFG_GPMC_AD14_OU T vout3_d14 H3 gpmc_ad15 2195 29 CFG_GPMC_AD15_OU T vout3_d15 L5 gpmc_ad2 2617 0 CFG_GPMC_AD2_OUT vout3_d2 M1 gpmc_ad3 2350 0 CFG_GPMC_AD3_OUT vout3_d3 L6 gpmc_ad4 2324 0 CFG_GPMC_AD4_OUT vout3_d4 L4 gpmc_ad5 2371 0 CFG_GPMC_AD5_OUT vout3_d5 L3 gpmc_ad6 2231 0 CFG_GPMC_AD6_OUT vout3_d6 L2 gpmc_ad7 2440 0 CFG_GPMC_AD7_OUT vout3_d7 L1 gpmc_ad8 2479 0 CFG_GPMC_AD8_OUT vout3_d8 K2 gpmc_ad9 2355 0 CFG_GPMC_AD9_OUT vout3_d9 P1 gpmc_cs3 0 641 CFG_GPMC_CS3_OUT vout3_clk Display Subsystem – High-Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI) The High-Definition Multimedia Interface is provided for transmitting digital television audiovisual signals from DVD players, set-top boxes and other audiovisual sources to television sets, projectors and other video displays. The HDMI interface is aligned with the HDMI TMDS single stream standard v1.4a (720p @60Hz to 1080p @24Hz) and the HDMI v1.3 (1080p @60Hz): 3 data channels, plus 1 clock channel is supported (differential). 224 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 NOTE For more information, see the High-Definition Multimedia Interface chapter of the device TRM 7.9 Camera Serial Interface 2 CAL bridge (CSI2) NOTE For more information, see the Camera Serial Interface 2 CAL Bridge chapter of the device TRM 7.9.1 CSI-2 MIPI D-PHY—1.5 V and 1.8 V The CSI-2 port A is compliant with the MIPI D-PHY RX specification v1.00.00 and the MIPI CSI-2 specification v1.00, with 4 data differential lanes plus 1 clock differential lane in synchronous mode, double data rate: • 1.5 Gbps (750 MHz) @OPP_NOM for each lane. The CSI-2 port B is compliant with the MIPI D-PHY RX specification v1.00.00 and the MIPI CSI-2 specification v1.00, with 2 data lanes plus 1 clock lane (differential) in synchronous mode, double data rate: • 1.5 Gbps (750 MHz) @OPP_NOM for each lane, in synchronous mode. 7.10 External Memory Interface (EMIF) The device has a dedicated interface to DDR3 and DDR3L SDRAM. It supports JEDEC standard compliant DDR3 and DDR3L SDRAM devices with the following features: • 16-bit or 32-bit data path to external SDRAM memory • Memory device capacity: 128Mb, 256Mb, 512Mb, 1Gb, 2Gb, 4Gb and 8Gb devices • One interface with associated DDR3/DDR3L PHYs NOTE For more information, see the EMIF Controller section of the Device TRM. 7.11 General-Purpose Memory Controller (GPMC) The GPMC is the unified memory controller that interfaces external memory devices such as: • Asynchronous SRAM-like memories and ASIC devices • Asynchronous page mode and synchronous burst NOR flash • NAND flash NOTE For more information, see the General-Purpose Memory Controller section of the Device TRM. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 225 ADVANCE INFORMATION The camera adaptation layer (CAL) deals with the processing of the pixel data coming from an external image sensor, data from memory. The CAL is a key component for the following multimedia applications: camera viewfinder, video record, and still image capture. The CAL has two serial camera interfaces (primary and secondary): • The primary serial interface (CSI2 Port A) is compliant with MIPI CSI-2 protocol with four data lanes. • The secondary serial interface (CSI2 Port B) is compliant with MIPI CSI-2 protocol with two data lanes. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 7.11.1 GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Synchronous Timing CAUTION The I/O Timings provided in this section are valid only for some GPMC usage modes when the corresponding Virtual I/O Timings or Manual I/O Timings are configured as described in the tables found in this section. Table 7-21 and Table 7-22 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 7-7, Figure 7-8, Figure 7-9, Figure 7-10, Figure 7-11 and Figure 7-12). Table 7-21. GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Timing Requirements - Synchronous Mode - 1 Load NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION ADVANCE INFORMATION F12 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid before gpmc_clk high F13 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid after gpmc_clk high F21 tsu(waitV-clkH) Setup time, gpmc_wait[1:0] valid before gpmc_clk high F22 th(clkH-waitV) Hold Time, gpmc_wait[1:0] valid after gpmc_clk high MIN MAX UNIT 1.9 ns 1 ns 1.9 ns 1 ns NOTE Wait monitoring support is limited to a WaitMonitoringTime value > 0. For a full description of wait monitoring feature, see the Device TRM. Table 7-22. GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Switching Characteristics - Synchronous Mode - 1 Load NO. PARAMETER F0 tc(clk) 226 DESCRIPTION MIN MAX Cycle time, output clock gpmc_clk period – 1.8V Mode 11.3 Cycle time, output clock gpmc_clk period – 3.3V Mode 15.04 (7) UNIT ns ns F+3.1 (7) ns F2 td(clkH-nCSV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_cs[7:0] transition F-0.8 F3 td(clkH-nCSIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_cs[7:0] invalid E-0.8 (6) E+3.1 (6) ns F4 td(ADDV-clk) Delay time, gpmc_a[27:0] address bus valid to gpmc_clk first edge B-0.8 (3) B+3.1 (3) ns F5 td(clkH-ADDIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_a[27:0] gpmc address bus invalid F6 td(nBEV-clk) Delay time, gpmc_ben[1:0] valid to gpmc_clk rising edge B-3.8 (3) B+3.2 (3) ns F7 td(clkH-nBEIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_ben[1:0] invalid D-0.4 (5) D+3.2 (5) ns (8) (8) ns -0.8 ns F8 td(clkH-nADV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_advn_ale transition G-0.8 F9 td(clkH-nADVIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_advn_ale invalid D-0.8 (5) D+3.1 (5) ns F10 td(clkH-nOE) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_oen_ren transition H-0.8 (9) H+2.1 (9) ns F11 td(clkH-nOEIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_oen_ren invalid E-0.8 (6) E+2.1 (6) ns (10) ns F14 td(clkH-nWE) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_wen transition I-0.8 (10) F15 td(clkH-Data) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_ad[15:0] data bus transition J-1.1 (11) F17 td(clkH-nBE) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_ben[1:0] transition J-1.1 (11) F18 tw(nCSV) Pulse duration, gpmc_cs[7:0] low A F19 tw(nBEV) Pulse duration, gpmc_ben[1:0] low C (4) K (12) tw(nADVV) Pulse duration, gpmc_advn_ale low F23 td(CLK-GPIO) Delay time, gpmc_clk transition to gpio6_16.clkout1 transition Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback I+3.1 J+3.92 (11) (2) F20 G+3.1 1.2 J+3.8 (11) ns ns ns ns ns 6.1 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-23. GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Timing Requirements - Synchronous Mode - 5 Loads(1) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT F12 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid before gpmc_clk high 2.5 ns F13 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid after gpmc_clk high 1.9 ns F21 tsu(waitV-clkH) Setup time, gpmc_wait[1:0] valid before gpmc_clk high 2.5 ns F22 th(clkH-waitV) Hold Time, gpmc_wait[1:0] valid after gpmc_clk high 1.9 ns (1) Total GPMC load on any signal at 3.3V must not exceed 10pF. Table 7-24. GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Switching Characteristics - Synchronous Mode - 5 Loads PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN (13) MAX 15.04 UNIT F0 tc(clk) Cycle time, output clock gpmc_clk period F2 td(clkH-nCSV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_cs[7:0] transition F+0.4 (7) F+6.1 (7) ns ns F3 td(clkH-nCSIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_cs[7:0] invalid E+0.4 (6) E+6.1 (6) ns F4 td(ADDV-clk) Delay time, gpmc_a[27:0] address bus valid to gpmc_clk first edge B+0.7 (3) B+6.1 (3) ns F5 td(clkH-ADDIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_a[27:0] gpmc address bus invalid F6 td(nBEV-clk) Delay time, gpmc_ben[1:0] valid to gpmc_clk rising edge B-4.9 B+0.4 ns F7 td(clkH-nBEIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_ben[1:0] invalid D-0.4 D+4.9 ns F8 td(clkH-nADV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_advn_ale transition G+0.7 (8) G+6.1 (8) ns F9 td(clkH-nADVIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_advn_ale invalid D+0.7 (5) D+6.1 (5) ns F10 td(clkH-nOE) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_oen_ren transition H+0.7 (9) H+5.1 (9) ns F11 td(clkH-nOEIV) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_oen_ren invalid E+0.7 (6) E+5.1 (6) ns F14 td(clkH-nWE) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_wen transition I+0.7 (10) I+6.1 (10) ns F15 td(clkH-Data) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_ad[15:0] data bus transition J-0.4 (11) J+4.9 (11) ns F17 td(clkH-nBE) Delay time, gpmc_clk rising edge to gpmc_ben[1:0] transition J-0.4 (11) J+4.9 (11) ns F18 tw(nCSV) Pulse duration, gpmc_cs[7:0] low F19 tw(nBEV) F20 tw(nADVV) F23 td(CLK-GPIO) Delay time, gpmc_clk transition to gpio6_16.clkout1 transition 0.7 ns A (2) ns Pulse duration, gpmc_ben[1:0] low C (4) ns Pulse duration, gpmc_advn_ale low K (12) (14) 1.2 ns 6.1 ns (1) Total GPMC load on any signal at 3.3V must not exceed 10pF. (2) For single read: A = (CSRdOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK period For burst read: A = (CSRdOffTime - CSOnTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK period For burst write: A = (CSWrOffTime - CSOnTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK period with n the page burst access number. (3) B = ClkActivationTime * GPMC_FCLK (4) For single read: C = RdCycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: C = (RdCycleTime + (n – 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For Burst write: C = (WrCycleTime + (n – 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK with n the page burst access number. (5) For single read: D = (RdCycleTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: D = (RdCycleTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst write: D = (WrCycleTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (6) For single read: E = (CSRdOffTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: E = (CSRdOffTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst write: E = (CSWrOffTime – AccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (7) For nCS falling edge (CS activated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0 : F = 0.5 * CSExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: F = 0.5 * CSExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and CSOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and CSOnTime are even) F = (1 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: F = 0.5 * CSExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) F = (1 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 227 ADVANCE INFORMATION NO. (1) AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com F = (2 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 3: F = 0.5 * CSExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime - ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 4) F = (1 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 1) is a multiple of 4) F = (2 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 2) is a multiple of 4) F = (3 + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((CSOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 3) is a multiple of 4) ADVANCE INFORMATION (8) For ADV falling edge (ADV activated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0 : G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and ADVOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and ADVOnTime are even) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVOnTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) For ADV rising edge (ADV desactivated) in Reading mode: Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and ADVRdOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and ADVRdOffTime are even) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 3: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 4) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 4) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 4) G = (3 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVRdOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 3) is a multiple of 4) For ADV rising edge (ADV desactivated) in Writing mode: Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and ADVWrOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and ADVWrOffTime are even) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 3: G = 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 4) G = (1 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 4) G = (2 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 4) G = (3 + 0.5 * ADVExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((ADVWrOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 3) is a multiple of 4) (9) For OE falling edge (OE activated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and OEOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and OEOnTime are even) - H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) - H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) - H = (2 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 3: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime - ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 4) - H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 1) is a multiple of 4) - H = (2 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 2) is a multiple of 4) - H = (3 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 3) is a multiple of 4) For OE rising edge (OE desactivated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and OEOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and OEOffTime are even) - H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) 228 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 (10) For WE falling edge (WE activated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and WEOnTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and WEOnTime are even) - I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) - I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) - I = (2 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 3: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime - ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 4) - I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 1) is a multiple of 4) - I = (2 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 2) is a multiple of 4) - I = (3 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOnTime - ClkActivationTime - 3) is a multiple of 4) For WE rising edge (WE desactivated): Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 0: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 1: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if (ClkActivationTime and WEOffTime are odd) or (ClkActivationTime and WEOffTime are even) - I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK otherwise Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 2: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 3) - I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) - I = (2 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 3: - I = 0.5 * WEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime - ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 4) - I = (1 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime - ClkActivationTime - 1) is a multiple of 4) - I = (2 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime - ClkActivationTime - 2) is a multiple of 4) - I = (3 + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((WEOffTime - ClkActivationTime - 3) is a multiple of 4) (11) J = GPMC_FCLK period, where GPMC_FCLK is the General Purpose Memory Controller internal functional clock (12) For read: K = (ADVRdOffTime – ADVOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For write: K = (ADVWrOffTime – ADVOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (13) The gpmc_clk output clock maximum and minimum frequency is programmable in the I/F module by setting the GPMC_CONFIG1_CSx configuration register bit fields GpmcFCLKDivider (14) gpio6_16 programmed to MUXMODE=9 (clkout1), CM_CLKSEL_CLKOUTMUX1 programmed to 7 (CORE_DPLL_OUT_DCLK), CM_CLKSEL_CORE_DPLL_OUT_CLK_CLKOUTMUX programmed to 1. (15) CSEXTRADELAY = 0, ADVEXTRADELAY = 0, WEEXTRADELAY = 0, OEEXTRADELAY = 0. Extra half-GPMC_FCLK cycle delay mode is not timed. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 229 ADVANCE INFORMATION - H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 3) - H = (2 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 3) Case GpmcFCLKDivider = 3: - H = 0.5 * OEExtraDelay * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime) is a multiple of 4) - H = (1 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 1) is a multiple of 4) - H = (2 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 2) is a multiple of 4) - H = (3 + 0.5 * OEExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK if ((OEOffTime – ClkActivationTime – 3) is a multiple of 4) AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com F1 F0 F1 gpmc_clk F2 F3 F18 gpmc_csi F4 Address (MSB) gpmc_a[10:1] gpmc_a[27] F6 F7 F19 gpmc_ben1 F6 F7 F19 gpmc_ben0 F8 F8 ADVANCE INFORMATION F20 F9 gpmc_advn_ale F10 F11 gpmc_oen_ren F13 F4 gpmc_ad[15:0] F5 F12 Address (LSB) D0 F22 F21 gpmc_waitj F23 F23 gpio6_16.clkout1 GPMC_01 Figure 7-7. GPMC / Multiplexed 16bits NOR Flash - Synchronous Single Read (GpmcFCLKDivider = 0)(1)(2) (1) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. (2) In gpmc_waitj, j = 0 to 1. 230 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 F1 F0 F1 gpmc_clk F2 F3 F18 gpmc_csi F4 gpmc_a[27:1] Address F6 F7 F19 gpmc_ben1 F6 F7 F19 gpmc_ben0 F8 F9 F20 gpmc_advn_ale F10 F11 gpmc_oen_ren F13 F12 D0 gpmc_ad[15:0] F22 F21 gpmc_waitj F23 F23 gpio6_16.clkout1 GPMC_02 Figure 7-8. GPMC / Nonmultiplexed 16bits NOR Flash - Synchronous Single Read (GpmcFCLKDivider = 0)(1)(2) (1) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. (2) In gpmc_waitj, j = 0 to 1. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 231 ADVANCE INFORMATION F8 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com F1 F1 F0 gpmc_clk F2 F3 F18 gpmc_csi F4 gpmc_a[10:1] gpmc_a[27] Address (MSB) F7 F6 F19 Valid gpmc_ben1 F7 F6 F19 Valid gpmc_ben0 F8 F8 ADVANCE INFORMATION F9 F20 gpmc_advn_ale F10 F11 gpmc_oen_ren F12 F4 gpmc_ad[15:0] F5 F13 D0 Address (LSB) F22 D1 F12 D2 D3 F21 gpmc_waitj F23 F23 gpio6_16.clkout1 GPMC_03 Figure 7-9. GPMC / Multiplexed 16bits NOR Flash - Synchronous Burst Read 4x16 bits (GpmcFCLKDivider = 0)(1)(2) (1) In gpmc_csi, i= 0 to 7. (2) In gpmc_waitj, j = 0 to 1. 232 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 F1 F1 F0 gpmc_clk F2 F3 F18 gpmc_csi F4 gpmc_a[27:1] Address F7 F6 F19 Valid gpmc_ben1 F7 F6 F19 Valid gpmc_ben0 F8 F20 F9 gpmc_advn_ale F10 F11 gpmc_oen_ren F12 F13 gpmc_ad[15:0] D0 D1 F12 D2 D3 F21 F22 gpmc_waitj F23 F23 gpio6_16.clkout1 GPMC_04 Figure 7-10. GPMC / Nonmultiplexed 16bits NOR Flash - Synchronous Burst Read 4x16 bits (GpmcFCLKDivider = 0)(1)(2) (1) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. (2) In gpmc_waitj, j = 0 to 1. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 233 ADVANCE INFORMATION F8 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com F1 F1 F0 gpmc_clk F2 F3 F18 gpmc_csi F4 gpmc_a[10:1] gpmc_a[27] Address (MSB) F17 F6 F17 F6 F17 F17 gpmc_ben1 F17 F17 gpmc_ben0 F8 F8 F20 F9 ADVANCE INFORMATION gpmc_advn_ale F14 F14 gpmc_wen F15 gpmc_ad[15:0] Address (LSB) D0 F22 D1 F15 D2 F15 D3 F21 gpmc_waitj F23 F23 gpio6_16.clkout1 GPMC_05 Figure 7-11. GPMC / Multiplexed 16bits NOR Flash - Synchronous Burst Write 4x16bits (GpmcFCLKDivider = 0)(1)(2) (1) In “gpmc_csi”, i = 0 to 7. (2) In “gpmc_waitj”, j = 0 to 1. 234 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 F1 F1 F0 gpmc_clk F2 F3 F18 gpmc_csi F4 Address gpmc_a[27:1] F17 F6 F17 F17 gpmc_ben1 F17 F6 F17 F17 gpmc_ben0 F8 F20 F9 gpmc_advn_ale F14 F14 gpmc_wen F15 gpmc_ad[15:0] D0 D1 F15 F15 D2 D3 F21 F22 gpmc_waitj F23 F23 gpio6_16.clkout1 GPMC_06 Figure 7-12. GPMC / Nonmultiplexed 16bits NOR Flash - Synchronous Burst Write 4x16bits (GpmcFCLKDivider = 0)(1)(2) (1) In “gpmc_csi”, i = 1 to 7. (2) In “gpmc_waitj”, j = 0 to 1. 7.11.2 GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Asynchronous Timing CAUTION The I/O Timings provided in this section are valid only for some GPMC usage modes when the corresponding Virtual I/O Timings or Manual I/O Timings are configured as described in the tables found in this section. Table 7-25 and Table 7-26 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 7-13, Figure 7-14, Figure 7-15, Figure 7-16, Figure 7-17 and Figure 7-18). Table 7-25. GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Timing Requirements - Asynchronous Mode NO. FA5 PARAMETER tacc(DAT) DESCRIPTION Data Maximum Access Time (GPMC_FCLK cycles) Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated MIN MAX UNIT (1) cycles H Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 235 ADVANCE INFORMATION F8 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-25. GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Timing Requirements - Asynchronous Mode (continued) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN FA20 tacc1-pgmode(DAT) Page Mode Successive Data Maximum Access Time (GPMC_FCLK cycles) FA21 tacc2-pgmode(DAT) Page Mode First Data Maximum Access Time (GPMC_FCLK cycles) - tsu(DV-OEH) Setup time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid before gpmc_oen_ren high - th(OEH-DV) Hold time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid after gpmc_oen_ren high MAX UNIT P (2) cycles H (1) cycles 1.9 ns 1 ns (1) H = Access Time * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) (2) P = PageBurstAccessTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) Table 7-26. GPMC/NOR Flash Interface Switching Characteristics - Asynchronous Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT ADVANCE INFORMATION - tr(DO) Rising time, gpmc_ad[15:0] output data 0.447 4.067 ns - tf(DO) Fallling time, gpmc_ad[15:0] output data 0.43 4.463 ns FA0 tw(nBEV) Pulse duration, gpmc_ben[1:0] valid time N (1) FA1 tw(nCSV) Pulse duration, gpmc_cs[7:0] low A (2) FA3 td(nCSV-nADVIV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_advn_ale invalid FA4 td(nCSV-nOEIV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_oen_ren invalid (Single read) FA9 td(AV-nCSV) ns ns B-2 (3) B+4 (3) C-2 (4) ns C+4 (4) Delay time, address bus valid to gpmc_cs[7:0] valid J-2 ns (5) J+4 (5) ns J-2 (5) J+4 (5) FA10 td(nBEV-nCSV) Delay time, gpmc_ben[1:0] valid to gpmc_cs[7:0] valid FA12 td(nCSV-nADVV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_advn_ale valid ns K-2 (6) K+4 (6) FA13 td(nCSV-nOEV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_oen_ren valid ns L-2 (7) L+4 (7) ns FA16 tw(AIV) Pulse duration, address invalid between 2 successive R/W accesses G FA18 td(nCSV-nOEIV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_oen_ren invalid (Burst read) I-2 (9) I+4 (9) FA20 tw(AV) Pulse duration, address valid : 2nd, 3rd and 4th accesses FA25 td(nCSV-nWEV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_wen valid E-2 (11) E+4 (11) ns FA27 td(nCSV-nWEIV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_wen invalid F-2 (12) F+4 (12) ns FA28 td(nWEV-DV) Delay time, gpmc_ wen valid to data bus valid FA29 td(DV-nCSV) Delay time, data bus valid to gpmc_cs[7:0] valid FA37 td(nOEV-AIV) Delay time, gpmc_oen_ren valid to gpmc_ad[15:0] multiplexed address bus phase end D ns (8) 2 J-2 ns ns (10) (5) J+4 ns (5) 2 ns ns (1) For single read: N = RdCycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For single write: N = WrCycleTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: N = (RdCycleTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst write: N = (WrCycleTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (2) For single read: A = (CSRdOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For single write: A = (CSWrOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst read: A = (CSRdOffTime - CSOnTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK For burst write: A = (CSWrOffTime - CSOnTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (3) For reading: B = ((ADVRdOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK For writing: B = ((ADVWrOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (4) C = ((OEOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (5) J = (CSOnTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * CSExtraDelay) * GPMC_FCLK (6) K = ((ADVOnTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (7) L = ((OEOnTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (8) G = Cycle2CycleDelay * GPMC_FCLK * (TimeParaGranularity +1) (9) I = ((OEOffTime + (n - 1) * PageBurstAccessTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (10) D = PageBurstAccessTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (11) E = ((WEOnTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (12) F = ((WEOffTime - CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay - CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK 236 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 GPMC_FCLK gpmc_clk FA5 FA1 gpmc_csi FA9 Valid Address gpmc_a[27:1] FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben0 Valid gpmc_ben1 Valid FA0 FA10 FA3 FA12 gpmc_advn_ale gpmc_oen_ren gpmc_ad[15:0] Data IN 0 Data IN 0 gpmc_waitj FA15 FA14 DIR OUT IN OUT GPMC_07 Figure 7-13. GPMC / NOR Flash - Asynchronous Read - Single Word Timing(1)(2)(3) (1) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. In gpmc_waitj, j = 0 to 1. (2) FA5 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample input data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after FA5 functional clock cycles, input Data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. FA5 value must be stored inside AccessTime register bits field. (3) GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally. (4) The "DIR" (direction control) output signal is NOT pinned out on any of the device pads. It is an internal signal only representing a signal direction on the GPMC data bus. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 237 ADVANCE INFORMATION FA4 FA13 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com GPMC_FCLK gpmc_clk FA5 FA5 FA1 FA1 gpmc_csi FA16 FA9 FA9 gpmc_a[27:1] Address 0 Address 1 FA0 FA0 FA10 FA10 gpmc_ben0 Valid FA0 FA0 gpmc_ben1 Valid Valid Valid FA10 FA10 ADVANCE INFORMATION FA3 FA3 FA12 FA12 gpmc_advn_ale FA4 FA4 FA13 FA13 gpmc_oen_ren gpmc_ad[15:0] Data Upper gpmc_waitj FA15 FA15 FA14 DIR OUT FA14 IN OUT IN GPMC_08 (1)(2)(3) Figure 7-14. GPMC / NOR Flash - Asynchronous Read - 32-bit Timing (1) In “gpmc_csi”, i = 0 to 7. In “gpmc_waitj”, j = 0 to 1. (2) FA5 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample input Data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after FA5 functional clock cycles, input Data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. FA5 value should be stored inside AccessTime register bits field (3) GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally (4) The "DIR" (direction control) output signal is NOT pinned out on any of the device pads. It is an internal signal only representing a signal direction on the GPMC data bus. 238 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 GPMC_FCLK gpmc_clk FA21 FA20 FA20 FA20 FA1 gpmc_csi FA9 Add0 gpmc_a[27:1] Add1 Add2 Add3 D0 D1 D2 Add4 FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben0 FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben1 FA12 FA18 FA13 gpmc_oen_ren gpmc_ad[15:0] D3 D3 gpmc_waitj FA15 FA14 DIR OUT IN OUT SPRS91v_GPMC_09 Figure 7-15. GPMC / NOR Flash - Asynchronous Read - Page Mode 4x16-bit Timing(1)(2)(3)(4) (1) In “gpmc_csi”, i = 0 to 7. In “gpmc_waitj”, j = 0 to 1 (2) FA21 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample first input Page Data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after FA21 functional clock cycles, First input Page Data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. FA21 calculation is detailled in a separated application note and should be stored inside AccessTime register bits field. (3) FA20 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample successive input Page Data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. After each access to input Page Data, next input Page Data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge after FA20 functional clock cycles. FA20 is also the duration of address phases for successive input Page Data (excluding first input Page Data). FA20 value should be stored in PageBurstAccessTime register bits field. (4) GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally (5) The "DIR" (direction control) output signal is NOT pinned out on any of the device pads. It is an internal signal only representing a signal direction on the GPMC data bus. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 239 ADVANCE INFORMATION gpmc_advn_ale AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com gpmc_fclk gpmc_clk FA1 gpmc_csi FA9 Valid Address gpmc_a[27:1] FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben0 FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben1 FA3 FA12 gpmc_advn_ale FA27 FA25 ADVANCE INFORMATION gpmc_wen FA29 Data OUT gpmc_ad[15:0] gpmc_waitj DIR OUT GPMC_10 Figure 7-16. GPMC / NOR Flash - Asynchronous Write - Single Word Timing(1) (1) In “gpmc_csi”, i = 0 to 7. In “gpmc_waitj”, j = 0 to 1. (2) The "DIR" (direction control) output signal is NOT pinned out on any of the device pads. It is an internal signal only representing a signal direction on the GPMC data bus. 240 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 GPMC_FCLK gpmc_clk FA1 FA5 gpmc_csi FA9 gpmc_a27 gpmc_a[10:1] Address (MSB) FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben0 Valid FA0 FA10 Valid gpmc_ben1 FA3 gpmc_advn_ale FA4 FA13 gpmc_oen_ren FA29 gpmc_ad[15:0] FA37 Address (LSB) Data IN Data IN FA15 FA14 DIR OUT IN OUT gpmc_waitj GPMC_11 Figure 7-17. GPMC / Multiplexed NOR Flash - Asynchronous Read - Single Word Timing(1)(2)(3) (1) In “gpmc_csi”, i = 0 to 7. In “gpmc_waitj”, j = 0 to 1 (2) FA5 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample input Data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after FA5 functional clock cycles, input Data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. FA5 value should be stored inside AccessTime register bits field. (3) GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally (4) The "DIR" (direction control) output signal is NOT pinned out on any of the device pads. It is an internal signal only representing a signal direction on the GPMC data bus. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 241 ADVANCE INFORMATION FA12 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com gpmc_fclk gpmc_clk FA1 gpmc_csi FA9 gpmc_a27 gpmc_a[10:1] Address (MSB) FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben0 FA0 FA10 gpmc_ben1 FA3 FA12 gpmc_advn_ale ADVANCE INFORMATION FA27 FA25 gpmc_wen FA29 FA28 Valid Address (LSB) gpmc_ad[15:0] Data OUT gpmc_waitj OUT DIR GPMC_12 Figure 7-18. GPMC / Multiplexed NOR Flash - Asynchronous Write - Single Word Timing(1) (1) In “gpmc_csi”, i = 0 to 7. In “gpmc_waitj”, j = 0 to 1. (2) The "DIR" (direction control) output signal is NOT pinned out on any of the device pads. It is an internal signal only representing a signal direction on the GPMC data bus. 7.11.3 GPMC/NAND Flash Interface Asynchronous Timing CAUTION The I/O Timings provided in this section are valid only for some GPMC usage modes when the corresponding Virtual I/O Timings or Manual I/O Timings are configured as described in the tables found in this section. Table 7-27 and Table 7-28 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 7-19, Figure 7-20, Figure 7-21 and Figure 7-22). Table 7-27. GPMC/NAND Flash Interface Timing Requirements NO. GNF12 242 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION tacc(DAT) Data maximum access time (GPMC_FCLK Cycles) - tsu(DV-OEH) Setup time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid before gpmc_oen_ren high - th(OEH-DV) Hold time, read gpmc_ad[15:0] valid after gpmc_oen_ren high Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback MIN MAX J (1) UNIT cycles 1.9 ns 1 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 (1) J = AccessTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) Table 7-28. GPMC/NAND Flash Interface Switching Characteristics MIN MAX UNIT - tr(DO) PARAMETER Rising time, gpmc_ad[15:0] output data DESCRIPTION 0.447 4.067 ns - 0.43 4.463 ns tf(DO) Fallling time, gpmc_ad[15:0] output data GNF0 tw(nWEV) Pulse duration, gpmc_wen valid time GNF1 td(nCSV-nWEV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_wen valid A B-2 (2) (1) ns B+4 (2) ns ns GNF2 td(CLEH-nWEV) Delay time, gpmc_ben[1:0] high to gpmc_wen valid C-2 (3) C+4 (3) GNF3 td(nWEV-DV) Delay time, gpmc_ad[15:0] valid to gpmc_wen valid D-2 (4) D+4 (4) ns GNF4 td(nWEIV-DIV) Delay time, gpmc_wen invalid to gpmc_ad[15:0] invalid E-2 (5) E+4 (5) ns GNF5 td(nWEIV-CLEIV) Delay time, gpmc_wen invalid to gpmc_ben[1:0] invalid F-2 (6) F+4 (6) ns ns GNF6 td(nWEIV-nCSIV) Delay time, gpmc_wen invalid to gpmc_cs[7:0] invalid G-2 (7) G+4 (7) GNF7 td(ALEH-nWEV) Delay time, gpmc_advn_ale high to gpmc_wen valid C-2 (3) C+4 (3) ns GNF8 td(nWEIV-ALEIV) Delay time, gpmc_wen invalid to gpmc_advn_ale invalid F-2 (6) F+4 (6) ns GNF9 tc(nWE) Cycle time, write cycle time GNF10 td(nCSV-nOEV) Delay time, gpmc_cs[7:0] valid to gpmc_oen_ren valid GNF13 tw(nOEV) Pulse duration, gpmc_oen_ren valid time GNF14 tc(nOE) Cycle time, read cycle time GNF15 td(nOEIV-nCSIV) Delay time, gpmc_oen_ren invalid to gpmc_cs[7:0] invalid H I-2 M-2 (9) (12) (8) I+4 (9) ns ns K (10) ns L (11) ns M+4 (12) ns (1) A = (WEOffTime – WEOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) * GPMC_FCLK (2) B = ((WEOnTime – CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay – CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (3) C = ((WEOnTime – ADVOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (WEExtraDelay – ADVExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (4) D = (WEOnTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * WEExtraDelay ) * GPMC_FCLK (5) E = (WrCycleTime – WEOffTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) – 0.5 * WEExtraDelay ) * GPMC_FCLK (6) F = (ADVWrOffTime – WEOffTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (ADVExtraDelay – WEExtraDelay ) * GPMC_FCLK (7) G = (CSWrOffTime – WEOffTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (CSExtraDelay – WEExtraDelay ) * GPMC_FCLK (8) H = WrCycleTime * (1 + TimeParaGranularity) * GPMC_FCLK (9) I = ((OEOffTime + (n – 1) * PageBurstAccessTime – CSOnTime) * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (OEExtraDelay – CSExtraDelay)) * GPMC_FCLK (10) K = (OEOffTime – OEOnTime) * (1 + TimeParaGranularity) * GPMC_FCLK (11) L = RdCycleTime * (1 + TimeParaGranularity) * GPMC_FCLK (12) M = (CSRdOffTime – OEOffTime * (TimeParaGranularity + 1) + 0.5 * (CSExtraDelay – OEExtraDelay ) * GPMC_FCLK Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 243 ADVANCE INFORMATION NO. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com GPMC_FCLK GNF1 GNF6 GNF2 GNF5 gpmc_csi gpmc_ben0 gpmc_advn_ale gpmc_oen_ren GNF0 gpmc_wen GNF3 GNF4 Command gpmc_ad[15:0] GPMC_13 (1) Figure 7-19. GPMC / NAND Flash - Command Latch Cycle Timing ADVANCE INFORMATION (1) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. GPMC_FCLK GNF1 GNF6 GNF7 GNF8 gpmc_csi gpmc_ben0 gpmc_advn_ale gpmc_oen_ren GNF9 GNF0 gpmc_wen GNF3 gpmc_ad[15:0] GNF4 Address GPMC_14 Figure 7-20. GPMC / NAND Flash - Address Latch Cycle Timing(1) (1) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. 244 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 GPMC_FCLK GNF12 GNF10 GNF15 gpmc_csi gpmc_ben0 gpmc_advn_ale GNF14 GNF13 gpmc_oen_ren gpmc_ad[15:0] DATA gpmc_waitj Figure 7-21. GPMC / NAND Flash - Data Read Cycle Timing(1)(2)(3) (1) GNF12 parameter illustrates amount of time required to internally sample input Data. It is expressed in number of GPMC functional clock cycles. From start of read cycle and after GNF12 functional clock cycles, input data will be internally sampled by active functional clock edge. GNF12 value must be stored inside AccessTime register bits field. (2) GPMC_FCLK is an internal clock (GPMC functional clock) not provided externally. (3) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. In gpmc_waitj, j = 0 to 1. GPMC_FCLK GNF1 GNF6 gpmc_csi gpmc_ben0 gpmc_advn_ale gpmc_oen_ren GNF9 GNF0 gpmc_wen GNF3 GNF4 gpmc_ad[15:0] DATA GPMC_16 (1) Figure 7-22. GPMC / NAND Flash - Data Write Cycle Timing (1) In gpmc_csi, i = 0 to 7. NOTE To configure the desired virtual mode the user must set MODESELECT bit and DELAYMODE bitfield for each corresponding pad control register. The pad control registers are presented in Table 4-3 and described in Device TRM, Control Module Chapter. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 245 ADVANCE INFORMATION GPMC_15 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Virtual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for GPMC. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Virtual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-29 Virtual Functions Mapping for GPMC for a definition of the Virtual modes. Table 7-29 presents the values for DELAYMODE bitfield. Table 7-29. Virtual Functions Mapping for GPMC ADVANCE INFORMATION 246 BALL BALL NAME Delay Mode Value MUXMODE GPMC_VIRTUAL1 0 1 N1 gpmc_advn_ale 15 gpmc_advn_ale gpmc_cs6 H3 gpmc_ad15 13 gpmc_ad15 L3 gpmc_ad6 13 gpmc_ad6 L5 gpmc_ad2 13 gpmc_ad2 E6 vin2a_d9 9 M3 gpmc_wen 15 gpmc_wen H2 gpmc_ad14 13 gpmc_ad14 R3 gpmc_a13 15 gpmc_a13 N7 gpmc_a8 14 gpmc_a8 T2 gpmc_a14 15 gpmc_a14 L6 gpmc_ad4 13 gpmc_ad4 H4 gpmc_a26 15 gpmc_a26 M6 gpmc_ad0 13 gpmc_ad0 N2 gpmc_wait0 15 gpmc_wait0 F6 vin2a_d11 9 gpmc_ad1 13 gpmc_ad1 gpmc_ad13 J3 gpmc_ad13 13 gpmc_a2 14 gpmc_a2 L4 gpmc_ad5 13 gpmc_ad5 vin2a_d8 9 gpmc_cs0 15 G1 vin2a_hsync0 9 5 6 gpmc_a2 gpmc_a23 14 gpmc_a20 gpio4_12 T6 T1 3 gpmc_wait1 gpio4_10 M2 F5 2 gpio4_9 gpmc_cs0 gpio3_31 P6 gpmc_a4 14 gpmc_a4 N6 gpmc_ben0 15 gpmc_ben0 R5 gpmc_a6 14 gpmc_a6 U2 gpmc_a15 15 gpmc_a15 J2 gpmc_ad11 13 gpmc_ad11 U1 gpmc_a16 15 gpmc_a16 gpmc_cs4 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-29. Virtual Functions Mapping for GPMC (continued) BALL BALL NAME Delay Mode Value MUXMODE GPMC_VIRTUAL1 0 T9 gpmc_a1 14 gpmc_a1 J4 gpmc_a24 15 gpmc_a24 gpmc_a18 gpmc_a17 gpmc_a23 15 gpmc_a23 gpmc_ad8 13 gpmc_ad8 J1 gpmc_ad10 13 gpmc_ad10 H1 gpmc_ad12 13 gpmc_ad12 M7 gpmc_a20 15 gpmc_a20 D3 vin2a_d10 9 P1 gpmc_cs3 14 gpmc_cs3 M5 gpmc_oen_ren 15 gpmc_oen_ren R4 gpmc_a9 14 gpmc_a9 H6 gpmc_cs1 15 gpmc_cs1 M1 gpmc_ad3 13 gpmc_ad3 L2 gpmc_ad7 13 gpmc_ad7 P5 gpmc_a7 14 gpmc_a7 2 3 5 6 14 gpmc_a14 ADVANCE INFORMATION J7 L1 1 gpio4_11 gpmc_a1 gpmc_a22 T7 gpmc_a3 14 gpmc_a3 M4 gpmc_ben1 15 gpmc_ben1 gpmc_cs5 P7 gpmc_clk 15 gpmc_clk gpmc_cs7 K6 gpmc_a22 15 gpmc_a22 gpmc_cs2 P2 gpmc_cs2 15 H7 vin2a_fld0 11 N9 gpmc_a10 14 gpmc_a10 P4 gpmc_a12 15 gpmc_a12 P3 gpmc_a17 15 gpmc_a17 R9 gpmc_a5 14 gpmc_a5 gpmc_a3 gpmc_wait1 gpmc_a16 gpio3_30 gpmc_a0 J5 gpmc_a21 15 gpmc_a21 gpmc_a15 H5 gpmc_a27 15 gpmc_a27 gpmc_a21 K2 gpmc_ad9 13 gpmc_ad9 K7 gpmc_a19 15 gpmc_a19 gpmc_a13 gpmc_a19 J6 gpmc_a25 15 gpmc_a25 R6 gpmc_a0 14 gpmc_a0 E1 vin2a_clk0 11 gpio3_28 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 247 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-29. Virtual Functions Mapping for GPMC (continued) BALL BALL NAME Delay Mode Value MUXMODE GPMC_VIRTUAL1 0 R2 gpmc_a18 15 gpmc_a18 P9 gpmc_a11 14 gpmc_a11 1 2 3 5 6 14 ADVANCE INFORMATION 248 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 7.12 Timers The device has two system watchdog timer (WD_TIMER1 and WD_TIMER2) that have the following features: • Free-running 32-bit upward counter • On-the-fly read/write register (while counting) • Reset upon occurrence of a timer overflow condition The device includes one instance of the 32-bit watchdog timer: WD_TIMER2, also called the MPU watchdog timer. The watchdog timer is used to provide a recovery mechanism for the device in the event of a fault condition, such as a non-exiting code loop. NOTE For additional information on the Timer Module, see the Device TRM. 7.13 Inter-Integrated Circuit Interface (I2C) The device includes 5 inter-integrated circuit (I2C) modules which provide an interface to other devices compliant with Philips Semiconductors Inter-IC bus (I2C-bus™) specification version 2.1. External components attached to this 2-wire serial bus can transmit/receive 8-bit data to/from the device through the I2C module. NOTE Note that, on I2C1 and I2C2, due to characteristics of the open drain IO cells, HS mode is not supported. NOTE Inter-integrated circuit i (i=1 to 5) module is also referred to as I2Ci. NOTE For more information, see the Multimaster High-Speed I2C Controller section of the Device TRM. Table 7-30, Table 7-31 and Figure 7-23 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 249 ADVANCE INFORMATION The device has 16 general-purpose (GP) timers (TIMER1 - TIMER16), two watchdog timers, and a 32-kHz synchronized timer (COUNTER_32K) that have the following features: • Dedicated input trigger for capture mode and dedicated output trigger/pulse width modulation (PWM) signal • Interrupts generated on overflow, compare, and capture • Free-running 32-bit upward counter • Supported modes: – Compare and capture modes – Auto-reload mode – Start-stop mode • On-the-fly read/write register (while counting) AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-30. Timing Requirements for I2C Input Timings(1) NO. 1 PARAMETER STANDARD MODE DESCRIPTION MIN FAST MODE MAX MIN MAX UNIT tc(SCL) Cycle time, SCL 10 2.5 µs 2 tsu(SCLH-SDAL) Setup time, SCL high before SDA low (for a repeated START condition) 4.7 0.6 µs 3 th(SDAL-SCLL) Hold time, SCL low after SDA low (for a START and a repeated START condition) 4 0.6 µs 4 tw(SCLL) Pulse duration, SCL low 4.7 1.3 µs 5 tw(SCLH) Pulse duration, SCL high 4 0.6 µs (2) ADVANCE INFORMATION 6 tsu(SDAV-SCLH) Setup time, SDA valid before SCL high 250 7 th(SCLL-SDAV) Hold time, SDA valid after SCL low 0(3) 8 tw(SDAH) Pulse duration, SDA high between STOP and START conditions 4.7 9 tr(SDA) Rise time, SDA 1000 20 + 0.1Cb 300(3) ns 10 tr(SCL) Rise time, SCL 1000 20 + 0.1Cb 300(3) ns 11 tf(SDA) Fall time, SDA 300 20 + 0.1Cb 300(3) ns 12 tf(SCL) Fall time, SCL 300 20 + 0.1Cb 300(3) ns 13 tsu(SCLH-SDAH) Setup time, SCL high before SDA high (for STOP condition) 14 tw(SP) Pulse duration, spike (must be suppressed) 15 (5) Cb 100 3.45(4) ns 0(3) 0.9(4) 1.3 µs (5) (5) (5) (5) 4 0.6 µs 0 Capacitive load for each bus line µs 400 50 ns 400 pF (1) The I2C pins SDA and SCL do not feature fail-safe I/O buffers. These pins could potentially draw current when the device is powered down. (2) A Fast-mode I2C-bus™ device can be used in a Standard-mode I2C-bus system, but the requirement tsu(SDA-SCLH)≥ 250 ns must then be met. This will automatically be the case if the device does not stretch the LOW period of the SCL signal. If such a device does stretch the LOW period of the SCL signal, it must output the next data bit to the SDA line tr max + tsu(SDA-SCLH)= 1000 + 250 = 1250 ns (according to the Standard-mode I2C-Bus Specification) before the SCL line is released. (3) A device must internally provide a hold time of at least 300 ns for the SDA signal (referred to the VIHmin of the SCL signal) to bridge the undefined region of the falling edge of SCL. (4) The maximum th(SDA-SCLL) has only to be met if the device does not stretch the low period [tw(SCLL)] of the SCL signal. (5) Cb = total capacitance of one bus line in pF. If mixed with HS-mode devices, faster fall-times are allowed. Table 7-31. Timing Requirements for I2C HS-Mode (I2C3/4/5 Only)(1) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION Cb = 400 pF (2) Cb = 100 pF MAX MIN MAX MIN UNIT MAX 1 tc(SCL) Cycle time, SCL 0.294 0.588 µs 2 tsu(SCLH-SDAL) Set-up time, SCL high before SDA low (for a repeated START condition) 160 160 ns 3 th(SDAL-SCLL) Hold time, SCL low after SDA low (for a repeated START condition) 160 160 ns 4 tw(SCLL) LOW period of the SCLH clock 160 320 ns 5 tw(SCLH) HIGH period of the SCLH clock 60 120 ns 6 tsu(SDAV-SCLH) Setup time, SDA valid vefore SCL high 10 10 ns 7 th(SCLL-SDAV) Hold time, SDA valid after SCL low 0 13 tsu(SCLH-SDAH) Setup time, SCL high before SDA high (for a STOP condition) 160 250 (3) Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 70 0 (3) 160 150 ns ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-31. Timing Requirements for I2C HS-Mode (I2C3/4/5 Only)(1) (continued) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION Cb = 400 pF (2) Cb = 100 pF MAX UNIT MIN MAX MIN MAX 0 10 0 10 ns 14 tw(SP) Pulse duration, spike (must be suppressed) 15 Cb (2) Capacitive load for SDAH and SCLH lines 100 400 pF 16 Cb Capacitive load for SDAH + SDA line and SCLH + SCL line 400 400 pF (1) I2C HS-Mode is only supported on I2C3/4/5. I2C HS-Mode is not supported on I2C1/2. (2) For bus line loads Cb between 100 and 400 pF the timing parameters must be linearly interpolated. (3) A device must internally provide a Data hold time to bridge the undefined part between VIH and VIL of the falling edge of the SCLH signal. An input circuit with a threshold as low as possible for the falling edge of the SCLH signal minimizes this hold time. 9 11 I2Ci_SDA 6 14 4 13 5 10 I2Ci_SCL 1 12 3 7 2 3 Stop Start Repeated Start Stop SPRS906_TIMING_I2C_01 Figure 7-23. I2C Receive Timing Table 7-32 and Figure 7-24 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below. Table 7-32. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for I2C Output Timings(2) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION STANDARD MODE MIN MAX FAST MODE MIN MAX UNIT 16 tc(SCL) Cycle time, SCL 10 2.5 µs 17 tsu(SCLH-SDAL) Setup time, SCL high before SDA low (for a repeated START condition) 4.7 0.6 µs 18 th(SDAL-SCLL) Hold time, SCL low after SDA low (for a START and a repeated START condition) 4 0.6 µs 19 tw(SCLL) Pulse duration, SCL low 4.7 1.3 µs 20 tw(SCLH) Pulse duration, SCL high 4 0.6 µs 21 tsu(SDAV-SCLH) Setup time, SDA valid before SCL high 250 100 ns 22 th(SCLL-SDAV) Hold time, SDA valid after SCL low (for I2C bus devices) 23 tw(SDAH) Pulse duration, SDA high between STOP and START conditions 24 tr(SDA) Rise time, SDA 1000 20 + 0.1Cb 300(3) ns 25 tr(SCL) Rise time, SCL 1000 20 + 0.1Cb 300(3) ns 26 tf(SDA) Fall time, SDA 300 20 + 0.1Cb 300(3) ns 27 tf(SCL) Fall time, SCL 300 20 + 0.1Cb 300(3) ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated 0 3.45 4.7 0 0.9 1.3 (1) (3) (1) (3) (1) (3) (1) (3) µs µs Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 251 ADVANCE INFORMATION 8 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-32. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for I2C Output Timings(2) (continued) NO. PARAMETER STANDARD MODE DESCRIPTION MIN 28 tsu(SCLH-SDAH) Setup time, SCL high before SDA high (for STOP condition) 29 Cp Capacitance for each I2C pin MAX 4 FAST MODE MIN MAX 0.6 UNIT µs 10 10 pF (1) Cb = total capacitance of one bus line in pF. If mixed with HS-mode devices, faster fall-times are allowed. (2) Software must properly configure the I2C module registers to achieve the timings shown in this table. See the Device TRM for details. (3) These timings apply only to I2C1 and I2C2. I2C3, I2C4, and I2C5 use standard LVCMOS buffers to emulate open-drain buffers and their rise/fall times should be referenced in the device IBIS model. NOTE I2C emulation is achieved by configuring the LVCMOS buffers to output Hi-Z instead of driving high when transmitting logic-1. 24 26 ADVANCE INFORMATION I2Ci_SDA 21 23 19 28 20 25 I2Ci_SCL 27 16 18 22 17 18 Stop Start Repeated Start Stop SPRS906_TIMING_I2C_02 Figure 7-24. I2C Transmit Timing 7.14 HDQ / 1-Wire Interface (HDQ1W) The module is intended to work with both HDQ and 1-Wire protocols. The protocols use a single wire to communicate between the master and the slave. The protocols employ an asynchronous return to one mechanism where, after any command, the line is pulled high. NOTE For more information, see the HDQ / 1-Wire section of the Device TRM. 7.14.1 HDQ / 1-Wire — HDQ Mode Table 7-33 and Table 7-34 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 7-25, Figure 7-26, Figure 7-27 and Figure 7-28). Table 7-33. HDQ/1-Wire Timing Requirements—HDQ Mode NO. 1 252 PARAMETER tCYCH DESCRIPTION Read bit window timing MIN MAX UNIT 190 250 µs (2) (2) µs 2 tHW1 Read one data valid after HDQ low 32 3 tHW0 Read zero data hold after HDQ low 70(2) 145(2) µs 4 tRSPS Response time from HDQ slave device(1) 190 320 µs Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 66 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 (1) Defined by software. (2) If the HDQ slave device drives a logic-low state after tHW0 maximum, it can be interpreted as a break pulse. For more information see "HDQ / 1-Wire Switching Characteristics - HDQ Mode" and the HDQ/1-Wire chapter of the TRM. Table 7-34. HDQ / 1-Wire Switching Characteristics - HDQ Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT 5 tB Break timing 190 µs 6 tBR Break recovery time 40 µs 7 tCYCD Write bit windows timing 190 µs 8 tDW1 Write one data valid after HDQ low 0.5 50 µs 9 tDW0 Write zero data hold after HDQ low 86 145 µs tB tBR HDQ SPRS906_TIMING_HDQ1W_01 tCYCH tHW0 tHW1 HDQ SPRS906_TIMING_HDQ1W_02 Figure 7-26. Device HDQ Interface Bit Read Timing (Data) tCYCD tDW0 tDW1 HDQ SPRS906_TIMING_HDQ1W_03 Figure 7-27. Device HDQ Interface Bit Write Timing (Command / Address or Data) Command_byte_written Break 1 Data_byte_received tRSPS 0_(LSB) 6 7_(MSB) 1 0_(LSB) 6 HDQ SPRS906_TIMING_HDQ1W_04 Figure 7-28. HDQ Communication Timing 7.14.2 HDQ/1-Wire—1-Wire Mode Table 7-35 and Table 7-36 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below (see Figure 7-29, Figure 7-30 and Figure 7-31). Table 7-35. HDQ / 1-Wire Timing Requirements - 1-Wire Mode NO. MIN MAX UNIT 10 tPDH PARAMETER Presence pulse delay high DESCRIPTION 15 60 µs 11 tPDL Presence pulse delay low 60 240 µs 12 tRDV Read data valid time tLOWR 15 µs Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 253 ADVANCE INFORMATION Figure 7-25. HDQ Break and Break Recovery Timing — HDQ Interface Writing to Slave AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-35. HDQ / 1-Wire Timing Requirements - 1-Wire Mode (continued) NO. 13 PARAMETER tREL DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT 0 45 µs Read data release time Table 7-36. HDQ / 1-Wire Switching Characteristics - 1-Wire Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT 960 µs 14 tRSTL Reset time low 480 15 tRSTH Reset time high 480 16 tSLOT Bit cycle time 60 17 tLOW1 Write bit-one time 18 tLOW0 Write bit-zero time(2) 19 tREC Recovery time 1 20 tLOWR Read bit strobe time(1) 1 µs 120 µs 1 15 µs 60 120 µs µs 15 µs (1) tLOWR (low pulse sent by the master) must be short as possible to maximize the master sampling window. (2) tLOWR must be less than tSLOT. ADVANCE INFORMATION tRSTH tPDH tRTSL tPDL 1-WIRE SPRS906_TIMING_HDQ1W_05 Figure 7-29. 1-Wire—Break (Reset) tSLOT_and_tREC tRDV_and_tREL tLOWR 1-WIRE SPRS906_TIMING_HDQ1W_06 Figure 7-30. 1-Wire—Read Bit (Data) tSLOT_and_tREC tLOW0 tLOW1 1-WIRE SPRS906_TIMING_HDQ1W_07 Figure 7-31. 1-Wire—Write Bit-One Timing (Command / Address or Data) 7.15 Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (UART) The UART performs serial-to-parallel conversions on data received from a peripheral device and parallelto-serial conversion on data received from the CPU. There are 10 UART modules in the device. Only one UART supports IrDA features. Each UART can be used for configuration and data exchange with a number of external peripheral devices or interprocessor communication between devices The UARTi (where i = 1 to 10) include the following features: • 16C750 compatibility • 64-byte FIFO buffer for receiver and 64-byte FIFO for transmitter • Baud generation based on programmable divisors N (where N = 1…16 384) operating from a fixed functional clock of 48 MHz or 192 MHz 254 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com • • • • • SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Break character detection and generation Configurable data format: – Data bit: 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits – Parity bit: Even, odd, none – Stop-bit: 1, 1.5, 2 bit(s) Flow control: Hardware (RTS/CTS) or software (XON/XOFF) Only UART1 module has extended modem control signals (CD, RI, DTR, DSR) Only UART3 supports IrDA NOTE For more information, see the UART section of the Device TRM. Table 7-37, Table 7-38 and Figure 7-32 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN (1) 4 tw(RX) Pulse width, receive data bit, 15/30/100pF high or low 0.96U 5 tw(CTS) Pulse width, receive start bit, 15/30/100pF high or low 0.96U(1) td(RTS-TX) Delay time, transmit start bit to transmit data td(CTS-TX) Delay time, receive start bit to transmit data MAX UNIT (1) ns 1.05U(1) ns 1.05U P(2) ns (2) ns P (1) U = UART baud time = 1/programmed baud rate (2) P = Clock period of the reference clock (FCLK, usually 48 MHz or 192MHz). Table 7-38. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for UART NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX 15 pF 12 30 pF 0.23 UNIT f(baud) Maximum programmable baud rate 2 tw(TX) Pulse width, transmit data bit, 15/30/100 pF high or low U - 2(1) U + 2(1) ns 3 tw(RTS) Pulse width, transmit start bit, 15/30/100 pF high or low U - 2(1) U + 2(1) ns 100 pF MHz 0.115 (1) U = UART baud time = 1/programmed baud rate 3 2 UARTi_TXD Start Bit Data Bits 5 4 UARTi_RXD Start Bit Data Bits SPRS906_TIMING_UART_01 Figure 7-32. UART Timing 7.16 Multichannel Serial Peripheral Interface (MCSPI) Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 255 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 7-37. Timing Requirements for UART NO. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com The MCSPI is a master/slave synchronous serial bus. There are four separate MCSPI modules (SPI1, SPI2, SPI3, and SPI4) in the device. All these four modules support up to four external devices (four chip selects) and are able to work as both master and slave. ADVANCE INFORMATION The MCSPI modules include the following main features: • Serial clock with programmable frequency, polarity, and phase for each channel • Wide selection of SPI word lengths, ranging from 4 to 32 bits • Up to four master channels, or single channel in slave mode • Master multichannel mode: – Full duplex/half duplex – Transmit-only/receive-only/transmit-and-receive modes – Flexible input/output (I/O) port controls per channel – Programmable clock granularity – SPI configuration per channel. This means, clock definition, polarity enabling and word width • Power management through wake-up capabilities • Programmable timing control between chip select and external clock generation • Built-in FIFO available for a single channel. • Each SPI module supports multiply chip select pins spim_cs[i], where i = 1 to 4. NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interface section of the device TRM. NOTE The MCSPIm module (m = 1 to 4) is also referred to as SPIm. CAUTION The I/O timings provided in this section are applicable for all combinations of signals for SPI1 and SPI2. However, the timings are valid only for SPI3 and SPI4 if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETS are defined in Table 7-41. Table 7-39, Figure 7-33 and Figure 7-34 present Timing Requirements for McSPI - Master Mode. Table 7-39. Timing Requirements for SPI - Master Mode (1)(8) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MODE (1) (2) SM1 tc(SPICLK) Cycle time, spi_sclk SPI1/2/3/ 4 SM2 tw(SPICLKL) Typical Pulse duration, spi_sclk low SM3 tw(SPICLKH) Typical Pulse duration, spi_sclk high SM4 tsu(MISO-SPICLK) Setup time, spi_d[x] valid before spi_sclk active edge (1) (1) (1) (1) th(SPICLK-MISO) Hold time, spi_d[x] valid after spi_sclk active edge td(SPICLK-SIMO) Delay time, spi_sclk active edge to spi_d[x] transition 256 0.5*P-1 ns 0.5*P-1 ns 2.29 ns 3.2 (1) Delay time, spi_cs[x] active edge to spi_d[x] transition Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback UNIT ns 20.8 (4) SM6 td(CS-SIMO) MAX (3) (4) SM5 SM7 MIN ns SPI1/2/4 -3.57 3.57 ns SPI3 -3.57 3.57 ns 3.57 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-39. Timing Requirements for SPI - Master Mode (1)(8) (continued) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SM8 td(CS-SPICLK) Delay time, spi_cs[x] active to spi_sclk first edge (1) MODE MIN MASTER _PHA0 B-4.2 (6) MAX UNIT ns MASTER _PHA1 A-4.2 (7) ns MASTER _PHA0 A-4.2 (7) ns MASTER _PHA1 B-4.2 (6) ns (5) (5) SM9 td(SPICLK-CS) Delay time, spi_sclk last edge to spi_cs[x] inactive (1) (5) (5) (1) This timing applies to all configurations regardless of SPI_CLK polarity and which clock edges are used to drive output data and capture input data. (2) Related to the SPI_CLK maximum frequency. (3) 20.8ns cycle time = 48MHz (5) SPI_CLK phase is programmable with the PHA bit of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register. (6) B = (TCS + 0.5) * TSPICLKREF * Fratio, where TCS is a bit field of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register and Fratio = Even ≥2. (7) When P = 20.8 ns, A = (TCS + 1) * TSPICLKREF, where TCS is a bit field of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register. When P > 20.8 ns, A = (TCS + 0.5) * Fratio * TSPICLKREF, where TCS is a bit field of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register. (8) The I/O timings provided in this section are applicable for all combinations of signals for spi1 and spi2. However, the timings are valid only for spi3 and spi4 if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in the following tables. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 257 ADVANCE INFORMATION (4) P = SPICLK period. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com PHA=0 EPOL=1 spim_cs(OUT) SM1 SM3 SM8 spim_sclk(OUT) SM2 SM9 POL=0 SM3 SM1 SM2 POL=1 spim_sclk(OUT) SM7 SM6 Bit n-1 spim_d(OUT) SM6 Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit n-4 Bit 0 ADVANCE INFORMATION PHA=1 EPOL=1 spim_cs(OUT) SM2 SM1 SM8 spim_sclk(OUT) SM3 SM9 POL=0 SM1 SM2 SM3 POL=1 spim_sclk(OUT) SM6 spim_d(OUT) Bit n-1 SM6 Bit n-2 SM6 Bit n-3 SM6 Bit 1 Bit0 SPRS906_TIMING_McSPI_01 Figure 7-33. McSPI - Master Mode Transmit 258 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 PHA=0 EPOL=1 spim_cs(OUT) SM1 SM3 SM8 spim_sclk(OUT) SM2 SM9 POL=0 SM3 SM1 SM2 POL=1 spim_sclk(OUT) SM5 SM5 SM4 spim_d(IN) Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit n-4 Bit 0 ADVANCE INFORMATION SM4 Bit n-1 PHA=1 EPOL=1 spim_cs(OUT) SM2 SM1 SM8 spim_sclk(OUT) SM3 SM9 POL=0 SM1 SM2 SM3 POL=1 spim_sclk(OUT) SM5 SM4 SM4 Bit n-1 spim_d(IN) SM5 Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit 1 Bit 0 SPRS906_TIMING_McSPI_02 Figure 7-34. McSPI - Master Mode Receive Table 7-40, Figure 7-35 and Figure 7-36 present Timing Requirements for McSPI - Slave Mode. Table 7-40. Timing Requirements for SPI - Slave Mode(6) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SS1 (1) NO. tc(SPICLK) (3) Cycle time, spi_sclk SS2 (1) tw(SPICLKL) (4) tw(SPICLKH) (4) (2) SS3 (1) MODE MIN MAX UNIT 62.5 ns Typical Pulse duration, spi_sclk low 0.45*P ns Typical Pulse duration, spi_sclk high 0.45*P ns SS4 (1) tsu(SIMO-SPICLK) Setup time, spi_d[x] valid before spi_sclk active edge 5 ns SS5 (1) th(SPICLK-SIMO) Hold time, spi_d[x] valid after spi_sclk active edge 5 ns (1) td(SPICLK-SOMI) Delay time, spi_sclk active edge to mcspi_somi transition SS6 SS7 (5) SS8 (1) td(CS-SOMI) Delay time, spi_cs[x] active edge to mcspi_somi transition tsu(CS-SPICLK) Setup time, spi_cs[x] valid before spi_sclk first edge Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated SPI1/2/3 2 26.1 ns SPI4 2 26.1 ns 20.95 ns 5 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback ns 259 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-40. Timing Requirements for SPI - Slave Mode(6) (continued) NO. SS9 (1) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION th(SPICLK-CS) Hold time, spi_cs[x] valid after spi_sclk last edge MODE MIN MAX 5 UNIT ns (1) This timing applies to all configurations regardless of SPI_CLK polarity and which clock edges are used to drive output data and capture input data. (2) When operating the SPI interface in RX-only mode, the minimum Cycle time is 26ns (38.4MHz) (3) 62.5ns Cycle time = 16 MHz (4) P = SPICLK period. (5) PHA = 0; SPI_CLK phase is programmable with the PHA bit of the SPI_CH(i)CONF register. (6) The IO timings provided in this section are applicable for all combinations of signals for spi1 and spi2. However, the timings are only valid for spi3 and spi4 if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in the following tables. PHA=0 EPOL=1 spim_cs(IN) SS2 SS1 ADVANCE INFORMATION SS8 spim_sclk(IN) SS3 SS9 POL=0 SS2 SS1 SS3 POL=1 spim_sclk(IN) SS7 SS6 Bit n-1 spim_d(OUT) SS6 Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit n-4 Bit 0 PHA=1 EPOL=1 spim_cs(IN) SS2 SS1 SS8 spim_sclk(IN) SS3 SS9 POL=0 SS3 SS1 SS2 POL=1 spim_sclk(IN) SS6 spim_d(OUT) Bit n-1 SS6 Bit n-2 SS6 SS6 Bit n-3 Bit 1 Bit 0 SPRS906_TIMING_McSPI_03 Figure 7-35. McSPI - Slave Mode Transmit 260 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 PHA=0 EPOL=1 spim_cs(IN) SS2 SS1 SS8 spim_sclk(IN) SS3 SS9 POL=0 SS2 SS1 SS3 POL=1 spim_sclk(IN) SS5 SS4 SS4 SS5 Bit n-1 spim_d(IN) Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit n-4 Bit 0 EPOL=1 spim_cs(IN) SS2 SS1 SS8 spim_sclk(IN) SS3 SS9 POL=0 SS3 SS1 SS2 POL=1 spim_sclk(IN) SS4 SS5 SS4 Bit n-1 spim_d(IN) SS5 Bit n-2 Bit n-3 Bit 1 Bit0 SPRS906_TIMING_McSPI_04 Figure 7-36. McSPI - Slave Mode Receive In Table 7-41 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with SPI3 and SPI4. Table 7-41. McSPI3/4 IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET1 BALL IOSET2 MUX BALL IOSET3 MUX BALL IOSET4 IOSET5 MUX BALL MUX BALL MUX McSPI3 spi3_cs0 D11 8 V9 7 A12 3 D17 2 AC9 1 spi3_cs1 B11 8 AC3 1 E14 3 B11 8 AC3 1 spi3_cs2 F11 8 F11 8 F11 8 spi3_cs3 A10 8 A10 8 A10 8 spi3_d0 C11 8 W9 7 B13 3 G16 2 AC6 1 spi3_d1 B10 8 Y1 7 A11 3 A21 2 AC7 1 spi3_sclk E11 8 V2 7 B12 3 C18 2 AC4 1 7 AA4 2 AB5 1 McSPI4 spi4_cs0 P9 8 F3 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated 8 U6 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 261 ADVANCE INFORMATION PHA=1 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-41. McSPI3/4 IOSETs (continued) SIGNALS IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL MUX spi4_cs1 P4 spi4_cs2 R3 spi4_cs3 IOSET3 BALL MUX 8 P4 8 R3 T2 8 spi4_d0 N9 spi4_d1 R4 spi4_sclk N7 IOSET4 BALL MUX 8 Y1 8 W9 T2 8 8 F2 8 G6 8 G1 IOSET5 BALL MUX BALL MUX 8 Y1 8 W9 8 Y1 8 8 W9 V9 8 8 V9 8 V9 8 8 V6 8 U7 7 AB3 2 AB8 1 7 AB9 2 AD6 8 V7 1 7 AA3 2 AC8 1 7.17 Quad Serial Peripheral Interface (QSPI) ADVANCE INFORMATION The Quad SPI (QSPI) module is a type of SPI module that allows single, dual or quad read access to external SPI devices. This module has a memory mapped register interface, which provides a direct interface for accessing data from external SPI devices and thus simplifying software requirements. It works as a master only. There is one QSPI module in the device and it is primary intended for fast booting from quad-SPI flash memories. General SPI features: • Programmable clock divider • Six pin interface (DCLK, CS_N, DOUT, DIN, QDIN1, QDIN2) • 4 external chip select signals • Support for 3-, 4- or 6-pin SPI interface • Programmable CS_N to DOUT delay from 0 to 3 DCLKs • Programmable signal polarities • Programmable active clock edge • Software controllable interface allowing for any type of SPI transfer NOTE For more information, see the Quad Serial Peripheral Interface section of the Device TRM. CAUTION The I/O Timings provided in this section are valid only for some QSPI usage modes when the corresponding Virtual I/O Timings or Manual I/O Timings are configured as described in the tables found in this section. Table 7-42 and Table 7-43 Present Timing and Switching Characteristics for Quad SPI Interface. Table 7-42. Switching Characteristics for QSPI NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MODE MIN Q1 tc(SCLK) Cycle time, sclk Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 0 13.02 MAX UNIT ns Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 3 20.8 ns Q2 tw(SCLKL) Pulse duration, sclk low Y*P-1 ns Q3 tw(SCLKH) Pulse duration, sclk high Y*P-1 ns Q4 td(CS-SCLK) Delay time, sclk falling edge to cs active edge, CS3:0 262 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback (1) (1) Default Timing Mode -M*P-2 (2) (3) -M*P+2 (2) (3) ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-42. Switching Characteristics for QSPI (continued) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MODE MIN MAX UNIT Q5 td(SCLK-CS) Delay time, sclk falling edge to cs inactive edge, CS3:0 Default Timing Mode N*P-2 N*P+2 ns Q6 td(SCLK-D0) Delay time, sclk falling edge to d[0] transition Default Timing Mode Q7 tena(CS-D0LZ) Enable time, cs active edge to d[0] driven (lo-z) Q8 tdis(CS-D0Z) Disable time, cs active edge to d[0] tri-stated (hi-z) Q9 td(SCLK-D0) Delay time, sclk first falling edge to first d[0] transition (2) (3) PHA=0 Only, Default Timing Mode (2) (3) -2 2 ns -P-3.5 -P+2.5 ns -P-2.5 -P+2.0 ns -2 2 ns (1) The Y parameter is defined as follows: If DCLK_DIV is 0 or ODD then, Y equals 0.5. If DCLK_DIV is EVEN then, Y equals (DCLK_DIV/2) / (DCLK_DIV+1). For best performance, it is recommended to use a DCLK_DIV of 0 or ODD to minimize the duty cycle distortion. The HSDIVIDER on CLKOUTX2_H13 output of DPLL_PER can be used to achieve the desired clock divider ratio. All required details about clock division factor DCLK_DIV can be found in the device-specific Technical Reference Manual. (2) P = SCLK period. ADVANCE INFORMATION (3) M=QSPI_SPI_DC_REG.DDx + 1 when Clock Mode 0. M=QSPI_SPI_DC_REG.DDx when Clock Mode 3. N = 2 when Clock Mode 0. N = 3 when Clock Mode 3. PHA=1 cs Q5 Q1 POL=1 Q4 Q3 Q2 sclk Q15 POL=1 Q14 rtclk Q7 d[0] Q6 Q6 Command Command Bit n-1 Bit n-2 d[3:1] Q12 Q13 Read Data Read Data Bit 1 Bit 0 Q12 Q13 Read Data Read Data Bit 1 Bit 0 SPRS85v_TIMING_OSPI1_01 Figure 7-37. QSPI Read (Clock Mode 3) Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 263 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com PHA=0 cs Q5 Q4 Q1 Q2 POL=0 Q3 sclk POL=0 rtclk Q7 ADVANCE INFORMATION d[0] Q6 Q9 Command Command Bit n-1 Bit n-2 Q12 Q13 Read Data Bit 1 Q12 Q13 Read Data Bit 0 Q12 Q13 Q12 Q13 Read Data Read Data Bit 1 Bit 0 d[3:1] SPRS85v_TIMING_OSPI1_02 Figure 7-38. QSPI Read (Clock Mode 0) CAUTION The I/O Timings provided in this section are valid only for some QSPI usage modes when the corresponding Virtual I/O Timings or Manual I/O Timings are configured as described in the tables found in this section. Table 7-43. Timing Requirements for QSPI NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MODE MIN Q2 tsu(D-RTCLK) Setup time, d[3:0] valid before falling rtclk edge Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 0 5.1 ns tsu(D-SCLK) Setup time, d[3:0] valid before falling sclk edge Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 3 12.3 ns th(RTCLK-D) Hold time, d[3:0] valid after falling rtclk edge Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 0 -0.1 ns th(SCLK-D) Hold time, d[3:0] valid after falling sclk edge Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 3 0.1 ns Q14 tsu(D-SCLK) Setup time, final d[3:0] bit valid before final falling sclk edge Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 3 12.3-P ns Q15 th(SCLK-D) Hold time, final d[3:0] bit valid after final falling sclk edge Default Timing Mode, Clock Mode 3 0.1+P ns Q13 264 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback (1) (1) MAX UNIT Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 (1) P = SCLK period. (2) Clock Modes 1 and 2 are not supported. (3) The Device captures data on the falling clock edge in Clock Mode 0 and 3, as opposed to the traditional rising clock edge. Although non-standard, the falling-edge-based setup and hold time timings have been designed to be compatible with standard SPI devices that launch data on the falling edge in Clock Modes 0 and 3. PHA=1 cs Q5 POL=1 Q1 Q4 Q3 Q2 sclk Q8 d[0] Q6 Command Command Bit n-1 Bit n-2 Q6 Write Data Bit 1 Write Data Bit 0 d[3:1] SPRS85v_TIMING_OSPI1_03 Figure 7-39. QSPI Write (Clock Mode 3) PHA=0 cs Q5 Q4 Q1 Q2 POL=0 Q3 sclk Q8 Q7 d[0] Q9 Q6 Command Command Bit n-1 Bit n-2 Q6 Write Data Bit 1 Write Data Bit 0 d[3:1] SPRS85v_TIMING_OSPI1_04 Figure 7-40. QSPI Write (Clock Mode 0) CAUTION The I/O Timings provided in this section are valid only for some QSPI usage modes when the corresponding Virtual I/O Timings or Manual I/O Timings are configured as described in the tables found in this section. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 265 ADVANCE INFORMATION Q7 Q6 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com NOTE To configure the desired Manual IO Timing Mode the user must follow the steps described in section Manual IO Timing Modes of the Device TRM. The associated registers to configure are listed in the CFG REGISTER column. For more information see the Control Module chapter in the Device TRM. Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for QSPI. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-44 Manual Functions Mapping for QSPI for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-44 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-44. Manual Functions Mapping for QSPI BALL BALL NAME QSPI1_MANUAL1 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) T7 gpmc_a3 0 0 CFG_GPMC_A3_OUT qspi1_cs2 1 ADVANCE INFORMATION P6 gpmc_a4 0 0 CFG_GPMC_A4_OUT qspi1_cs3 R3 gpmc_a13 0 0 CFG_GPMC_A13_IN qspi1_rtclk T2 gpmc_a14 2247 1186 CFG_GPMC_A14_IN qspi1_d3 U2 gpmc_a15 2176 1197 CFG_GPMC_A15_IN qspi1_d2 U1 gpmc_a16 2229 1268 CFG_GPMC_A16_IN qspi1_d0 U1 gpmc_a16 0 0 CFG_GPMC_A16_OUT qspi1_d0 P3 gpmc_a17 2251 1217 CFG_GPMC_A17_IN qspi1_d1 R2 gpmc_a18 0 0 CFG_GPMC_A18_OUT qspi1_sclk P2 gpmc_cs2 0 0 CFG_GPMC_CS2_OUT qspi1_cs0 P1 gpmc_cs3 0 0 CFG_GPMC_CS3_OUT qspi1_cs1 7.18 Multichannel Audio Serial Port (McASP) The multichannel audio serial port (McASP) functions as a general-purpose audio serial port optimized for the needs of multichannel audio applications. The McASP is useful for time-division multiplexed (TDM) stream, Inter-Integrated Sound (I2S) protocols, and intercomponent digital audio interface transmission (DIT). The device have integrated 8 McASP modules (McASP1-McASP8) with: • McASP1 and McASP2 modules supporting 16 channels with independent TX/RX clock/sync domain • McASP3 through McASP8 modules supporting 4 channels with independent TX/RX clock/sync domain • The McASP1 is instantiated in IPU power domain • McASP2 through McASP8 are part of the L4_PER2 peripheral power domain NOTE For more information, see the Serial Communication Interface section of the Device TRM. CAUTION The I/O Timings provided in this section are valid only for some McASP usage modes when the corresponding Virtual I/O Timings or Manual I/O Timings are configured as described in the tables found in this section. 266 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-45, Table 7-46, Table 7-47 and Figure 7-41 present Timing Requirements for McASP1 to McASP8. Table 7-45. Timing Requirements for McASP1 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 1 tc(AHCLKRX) Cycle time, AHCLKR/X 2 tw(AHCLKRX) Pulse duration, AHCLKR/X high or low 3 tc(ACLKRX) Cycle time, ACLKR/X 4 tw(ACLKRX) Pulse duration, ACLKR/X high or low 5 tsu(AFSRX-ACLK) Setup time, AFSR/X input valid before ACLKR/X 6 7 8 th(ACLK-AFSRX) tsu(AXR-ACLK) th(ACLK-AXR) MODE MIN MAX ns 0.35P ns (2) 20 ns 0.5R - 3 ns ACLKR/X int 19.4 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 4 ns (3) Hold time, AFSR/X input valid after ACLKR/X Setup time, AXR input valid before ACLKR/X Hold time, AXR input valid after ACLKR/X UNIT 20 ACLKR/X int -1 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 0.4 ns ACLKR/X int 19.4 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 11.5 ns ACLKR/X int 1.6 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 1.6 ns (1) ACLKR internal: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=1, PDIR.ACLKR = 1 ACLKR external input: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=0 ACLKR external output: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=1 ACLKX internal: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=1, PDIR.ACLKX = 1 ACLKX external input: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=0 ACLKX external output: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=1 (2) P = AHCLKR/X period in ns. (3) R = ACLKR/X period in ns. Table 7-46. Timing Requirements for McASP2(1) NO. 1 PARAMETER tc(AHCLKRX) DESCRIPTION tw(AHCLKRX) Pulse duration, AHCLKR/X high or low 3 tc(ACLKRX) Cycle time, ACLKR/X tw(ACLKRX) 6 7 8 tsu(AFSRX-ACLK) th(ACLK-AFSRX) tsu(AXR-ACLK) th(ACLK-AXR) Pulse duration, ACLKR/X high or low Setup time, AFSR/X input valid before ACLKR/X Hold time, AFSR/X input valid after ACLKR/X Setup time, AXR input valid before ACLKR/X Hold time, AXR input valid after ACLKR/X Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated MAX 0.35P UNIT ns (2) ns Any Other Conditions 20 ns ACLKx, AFSX, and AXR are all inputs 12.5 ns Any Other Conditions ACLKx, AFSX, and AXR are all inputs 5 MIN 20 2 4 MODE Cycle time, AHCLKR/X 0.5R - 3 0.38R (3) (3) ns ns ACLKR/X int 18.5 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 ns ACLKR/X int -1 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 ns ACLKR/X int 18.5 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 ns ACLKR/X int -1 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 ns Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 267 ADVANCE INFORMATION NO. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) ACLKR internal: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=1, PDIR.ACLKR = 1 ACLKR external input: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=0 ACLKR external output: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=1 ACLKX internal: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=1, PDIR.ACLKX = 1 ACLKX external input: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=0 ACLKX external output: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=1 (2) P = AHCLKR/X period in ns. (3) R = ACLKR/X period in ns. Table 7-47. Timing Requirements for McASP3/4/5/6/7/8(1) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 1 tc(AHCLKRX) Cycle time, AHCLKR/X 2 tw(AHCLKRX) Pulse duration, AHCLKR/X high or low 3 tc(ACLKRX) Cycle time, ACLKR/X 4 tw(ACLKRX) Pulse duration, ACLKR/X high or low 5 tsu(AFSRX-ACLK) Setup time, AFSR/X input valid before ACLKR/X ADVANCE INFORMATION 6 th(ACLK-AFSRX) tsu(AXR-ACLK) 8 th(ACLK-AXR) Hold time, AFSR/X input valid after ACLKR/X Setup time, AXR input valid before ACLKX Hold time, AXR input valid after ACLKX MODE MIN MAX UNIT 20 ns 0.35P ns (2) 20 ns 0.5R - 3 ns ACLKR/X int 18.2 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 4 ns (3) ACLKR/X int -1 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2.5 ns ACLKX int (ASYNC=0) 18.2 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 11.5 ns ACLKX int (ASYNC=0) -1 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2.5 ns (1) ACLKR internal: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=1, PDIR.ACLKR = 1 (NOT SUPPORTED) ACLKR external input: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=0 ACLKR external output: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=1 ACLKX internal: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=1, PDIR.ACLKX = 1 ACLKX external input: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=0 ACLKX external output: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=1 (2) P = AHCLKR/X period in ns. (3) R = ACLKR/X period in ns. 268 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 2 1 2 AHCLKR/X (Falling Edge Polarity) AHCLKR/X (Rising Edge Polarity) 4 3 4 ACLKR/X (CLKRP = CLKXP = 0) (A) ACLKR/X (CLKRP = CLKXP = 1) (B) 6 5 AFSR/X (Bit Width, 0 Bit Delay) ADVANCE INFORMATION AFSR/X (Bit Width, 1 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Bit Width, 2 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Slot Width, 0 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Slot Width, 1 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Slot Width, 2 Bit Delay) 8 7 AXR[n] (Data In/Receive) A0 A1 A30 A31 B0 B1 B30 B31 C0 C1 C2 C3 C31 SPRS906_TIMING_McASP_01 A. B. For CLKRP = CLKXP = receiver is configured for For CLKRP = CLKXP = receiver is configured for 0, the McASP transmitter is configured for rising edge (to shift data out) and the McASP falling edge (to shift data in). 1, the McASP transmitter is configured for falling edge (to shift data out) and the McASP rising edge (to shift data in). Figure 7-41. McASP Input Timing CAUTION The I/O Timings provided in this section are valid only for some McASP usage modes when the corresponding Virtual I/O Timings or Manual I/O Timings are configured as described in the tables found in this section. Table 7-48, Table 7-49, Table 7-50 and Figure 7-42 present Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for McASP1 to McASP8. Table 7-48. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for McASP1(1) NO. 9 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION tc(AHCLKRX) Cycle time, AHCLKR/X Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated MODE MIN MAX 20 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback UNIT ns 269 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-48. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for McASP1(1) (continued) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 10 tw(AHCLKRX) Pulse duration, AHCLKR/X high or low 11 tc(ACLKRX) Cycle time, ACLKR/X 12 tw(ACLKRX) Pulse duration, ACLKR/X high or low 13 td(ACLK-AFSXR) Delay time, ACLKR/X transmit edge to AFSX/R output valid 14 td(ACLK-AXR) Delay time, ACLKR/X transmit edge to AXR output valid MODE MIN MAX UNIT 0.5P 2.5 (2) ns 20 ns 0.5P 2.5 (3) ns ACLKR/X int -0.5 6 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 23.1 ns ACLKR/X int -0.5 6 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 23.1 ns ADVANCE INFORMATION (1) ACLKR internal: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=1, PDIR.ACLKR = 1 ACLKR external input: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=0 ACLKR external output: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=1 ACLKX internal: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=1, PDIR.ACLKX = 1 ACLKX external input: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=0 ACLKX external output: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=1 (2) P = AHCLKR/X period in ns. (3) R = ACLKR/X period in ns. Table 7-49. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for McASP2 NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 9 tc(AHCLKRX) Cycle time, AHCLKR/X 10 tw(AHCLKRX) Pulse duration, AHCLKR/X high or low 11 tc(ACLKRX) Cycle time, ACLKR/X 12 tw(ACLKRX) Pulse duration, ACLKR/X high or low 13 td(ACLK-AFSXR) Delay time, ACLKR/X transmit edge to AFSX/R output valid 14 td(ACLK-AXR) Delay time, ACLKR/X transmit edge to AXR output valid MODE MIN MAX (1) UNIT 20 ns 0.5P 2.5 (2) ns 20 ns 0.5P 2.5 (3) ns ACLKR/X int -0.5 6 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 22.2 ns ACLKR/X int -0.5 6 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 22.2 ns (1) ACLKR internal: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=1, PDIR.ACLKR = 1 ACLKR external input: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=0 ACLKR external output: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=1 ACLKX internal: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=1, PDIR.ACLKX = 1 ACLKX external input: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=0 ACLKX external output: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=1 (2) P = AHCLKR/X period in ns. (3) R = ACLKR/X period in ns. Table 7-50. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for McASP3/4/5/6/7/8(1) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 9 tc(AHCLKRX) Cycle time, AHCLKR/X 10 tw(AHCLKRX) Pulse duration, AHCLKR/X high or low 11 tc(ACLKRX) Cycle time, ACLKR/X 270 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback MODE MIN MAX UNIT 20 ns 0.5P 2.5 (2) ns 20 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-50. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for McASP3/4/5/6/7/8(1) (continued) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 12 tw(ACLKRX) Pulse duration, ACLKR/X high or low 13 td(ACLK-AFSXR) Delay time, ACLKR/X transmit edge to AFSX/R output valid 14 td(ACLK-AXR) MODE Delay time, ACLKR/X transmit edge to AXR output valid MIN MAX 0.5P 2.5 (3) UNIT ns ACLKR/X int -0.5 6 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 23.1 ns ACLKR/X int -0.5 6 ns ACLKR/X ext in ACLKR/X ext out 2 23.1 ns (1) ACLKR internal: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=1, PDIR.ACLKR = 1 ACLKR external input: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=0 ACLKR external output: ACLKRCTL.CLKRM=0, PDIR.ACLKR=1 ACLKX internal: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=1, PDIR.ACLKX = 1 ACLKX external input: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=0 ACLKX external output: ACLKXCTL.CLKXM=0, PDIR.ACLKX=1 (2) P = AHCLKR/X period in ns. ADVANCE INFORMATION (3) R = ACLKR/X period in ns. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 271 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 10 10 9 AHCLKR/X (Falling Edge Polarity) AHCLKR/X (Rising Edge Polarity) 12 11 12 ACLKR/X (CLKRP = CLKXP = 1) (A) ACLKR/X (CLKRP = CLKXP = 0) (B) 13 13 13 13 AFSR/X (Bit Width, 0 Bit Delay) ADVANCE INFORMATION AFSR/X (Bit Width, 1 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Bit Width, 2 Bit Delay) 13 13 13 AFSR/X (Slot Width, 0 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Slot Width, 1 Bit Delay) AFSR/X (Slot Width, 2 Bit Delay) 14 15 AXR[n] (Data Out/Transmit) A0 A1 A30 A31 B0 B1 B30 B31 C0 C1 C2 C3 C31 SPRS906_TIMING_McASP_02 A. B. For CLKRP = CLKXP = receiver is configured for For CLKRP = CLKXP = receiver is configured for 1, the McASP transmitter is configured for falling edge (to shift data out) and the McASP rising edge (to shift data in). 0, the McASP transmitter is configured for rising edge (to shift data out) and the McASP falling edge (to shift data in). Figure 7-42. McASP Output Timing Table 7-51 through Table 7-58 explain all cases with Virtual Mode Details for McASP1/2/3/4/5/6/7/8 (see Figure 7-43 through Figure 7-50). Table 7-51. Virtual Mode Case Details for McASP1 No. CASE CASE Description Virtual Mode Settings Signals Notes Virtual Mode Value IP Mode : ASYNC 1 272 COIFOI CLKX / FSX: Output CLKR / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP1_VIRTUAL2_ASYNC_RX Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback See Figure 7-43 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-51. Virtual Mode Case Details for McASP1 (continued) No. CASE CASE Description Virtual Mode Settings Signals 2 COIFIO Notes Virtual Mode Value CLKX / FSR: Output CLKR / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP1_VIRTUAL2_ASYNC_RX MCASP1_VIRTUAL2_ASYNC_RX 3 CIOFIO CLKR / FSR: Output CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR Default (No Virtual Mode) 4 CIOFOI CLKR / FSX: Output CLKX / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP1_VIRTUAL2_ASYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR Default (No Virtual Mode) See Figure 7-44 See Figure 7-45 See Figure 7-46 IP Mode : SYNC (CLKR / FSR internally generated from CLKX / FSX) CO-FO- CLKX / FSX: Output AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) 6 CI-FO- FSX: Output CLKX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP1_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP1_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX 7 CI-FI- CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP1_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP1_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) 8 CO-FI- CLKX: Output FSX: Input See Figure 7-47 See Figure 7-48 See Figure 7-49 See Figure 7-50 Table 7-52. Virtual Mode Case Details for McASP2 No. CASE CASE Description Virtual Mode Settings Signals Virtual Mode Value Notes Virtual Mode Value when ACLKR, AFSR, and AXR are all inputs IP Mode : ASYNC 1 COIFOI CLKX / FSX: Output CLKR / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FS X Default (No Virtual Mode) N/A AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP2_VIRTUAL2_ASYNC_RX MCASP2_VIRTUAL4_AS YNC_RX_80M 2 COIFIO CLKX / FSR: Output CLKR / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FS X Default (No Virtual Mode) N/A AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP2_VIRTUAL2_ASYNC_RX N/A 3 CIOFIO CLKR / FSR: Output CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FS X MCASP2_VIRTUAL2_ASYNC_RX N/A AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR Default (No Virtual Mode) N/A 4 CIOFOI CLKR / FSX: Output CLKX / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FS X MCASP2_VIRTUAL2_ASYNC_RX N/A AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR Default (No Virtual Mode) N/A See Figure 743 See Figure 744 See Figure 745 See Figure 746 IP Mode : SYNC (CLKR / FSR internally generated from CLKX / FSX) 5 CO-FO- CLKX / FSX: Output AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FS X 6 CI-FO- FSX: Output CLKX: Input 7 CI-FI- CLKX / FSX: Input 8 CO-FI- CLKX: Output FSX: Input Default (No Virtual Mode) N/A AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) N/A AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FS X MCASP2_VIRTUAL3_SYNC_RX N/A AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP2_VIRTUAL3_SYNC_RX N/A AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FS X MCASP2_VIRTUAL3_SYNC_RX N/A AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP2_VIRTUAL3_SYNC_RX MCASP2_VIRTUAL1_SY NC_RX_80M AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FS X Default (No Virtual Mode) N/A AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) N/A Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated See Figure 747 See Figure 748 See Figure 749 See Figure 750 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 273 ADVANCE INFORMATION 5 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-53. Virtual Mode Case Details for McASP3 No. CASE CASE Description Virtual Mode Settings Signals Notes Virtual Mode Value IP Mode : ASYNC 1 2 3 4 COIFOI COIFIO CIOFIO CIOFOI CLKX / FSX: Output CLKR / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP3_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX CLKX / FSR: Output CLKR / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP3_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX CLKR / FSR: Output CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP3_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP3_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX CLKR / FSX: Output CLKX / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP3_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP3_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX See Figure 7-43 See Figure 7-44 See Figure 7-45 See Figure 7-46 ADVANCE INFORMATION IP Mode : SYNC (CLKR / FSR internally generated from CLKX / FSX) 5 6 7 8 CO-FOCI-FOCI-FICO-FI- CLKX / FSX: Output AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) FSX: Output CLKX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP3_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP3_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP3_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP3_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX CLKX: Output FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) See Figure 7-47 See Figure 7-48 See Figure 7-49 See Figure 7-50 Table 7-54. Virtual Mode Case Details for McASP4 No. CASE CASE Description Virtual Mode Settings Signals Notes Virtual Mode Value IP Mode : ASYNC 1 2 3 4 COIFOI COIFIO CIOFIO CIOFOI CLKX / FSX: Output CLKR / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP4_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKX / FSR: Output CLKR / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP4_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKR / FSR: Output CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP4_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP4_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKR / FSX: Output CLKX / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP4_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP4_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX See Figure 7-43 See Figure 7-44 See Figure 7-45 See Figure 7-46 IP Mode : SYNC (CLKR / FSR internally generated from CLKX / FSX) 5 CO-FO- CLKX / FSX: Output AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) 6 CI-FO- FSX: Output CLKX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP4_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP4_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP4_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP4_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX 7 274 CI-FI- Default (No Virtual Mode) Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback See Figure 7-47 See Figure 7-48 See Figure 7-49 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-54. Virtual Mode Case Details for McASP4 (continued) No. 8 CASE CO-FI- CASE Description Virtual Mode Settings CLKX: Output FSX: Input Notes Signals Virtual Mode Value AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) See Figure 7-50 Table 7-55. Virtual Mode Case Details for McASP5 No. CASE CASE Description Virtual Mode Settings Signals Notes Virtual Mode Value IP Mode : ASYNC 2 3 4 COIFOI COIFIO CIOFIO CIOFOI CLKX / FSX: Output CLKR / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP5_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKX / FSR: Output CLKR / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP5_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKR / FSR: Output CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP5_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP5_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKR / FSX: Output CLKX / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP5_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP5_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX See Figure 7-43 See Figure 7-44 See Figure 7-45 ADVANCE INFORMATION 1 See Figure 7-46 IP Mode : SYNC (CLKR / FSR internally generated from CLKX / FSX) 5 CO-FO- CLKX / FSX: Output AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) 6 CI-FO- FSX: Output CLKX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP5_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP5_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP5_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP5_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKX: Output FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) 7 8 CI-FICO-FI- Default (No Virtual Mode) See Figure 7-47 See Figure 7-48 See Figure 7-49 See Figure 7-50 Table 7-56. Virtual Mode Case Details for McASP6 No. CASE CASE Description Virtual Mode Settings Signals Notes Virtual Mode Value IP Mode : ASYNC 1 2 3 4 COIFOI COIFIO CIOFIO CIOFOI CLKX / FSX: Output CLKR / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP6_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKX / FSR: Output CLKR / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP6_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKR / FSR: Output CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP6_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP6_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKR / FSX: Output CLKX / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP6_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP6_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX See Figure 7-43 See Figure 7-44 See Figure 7-45 See Figure 7-46 IP Mode : SYNC (CLKR / FSR internally generated from CLKX / FSX) 5 CO-FO- CLKX / FSX: Output Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) See Figure 7-47 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 275 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-56. Virtual Mode Case Details for McASP6 (continued) No. 6 CASE CI-FO- CASE Description Virtual Mode Settings Notes Signals Virtual Mode Value FSX: Output CLKX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP6_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP6_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX 7 CI-FI- CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP6_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP6_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX 8 CO-FI- CLKX: Output FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) See Figure 7-48 See Figure 7-49 See Figure 7-50 Table 7-57. Virtual Mode Case Details for McASP7 No. CASE CASE Description Virtual Mode Settings Signals Notes Virtual Mode Value IP Mode : ASYNC 1 ADVANCE INFORMATION 2 3 4 COIFOI COIFIO CIOFIO CIOFOI CLKX / FSX: Output CLKR / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP7_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX CLKX / FSR: Output CLKR / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP7_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX CLKR / FSR: Output CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP7_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP7_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX CLKR / FSX: Output CLKX / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP7_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP7_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX See Figure 7-43 See Figure 7-44 See Figure 7-45 See Figure 7-46 IP Mode : SYNC (CLKR / FSR internally generated from CLKX / FSX) 5 CO-FO- CLKX / FSX: Output AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) 6 CI-FO- FSX: Output CLKX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP7_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP7_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX 7 CI-FI- CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP7_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP7_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX CLKX: Output FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) 8 CO-FI- See Figure 7-47 See Figure 7-48 See Figure 7-49 See Figure 7-50 Table 7-58. Virtual Mode Case Details for McASP8 No. CASE CASE Description Virtual Mode Settings Signals Notes Virtual Mode Value IP Mode : ASYNC 1 2 3 276 COIFOI COIFIO CIOFIO CLKX / FSX: Output CLKR / FSR: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP8_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKX / FSR: Output CLKR / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP8_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKR / FSR: Output CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP8_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP8_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback See Figure 7-43 See Figure 7-44 See Figure 7-45 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-58. Virtual Mode Case Details for McASP8 (continued) No. 4 CASE CIOFOI CASE Description Virtual Mode Settings CLKR / FSX: Output CLKX / FSR: Input Signals Virtual Mode Value AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP8_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKR/FSR MCASP8_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX Notes See Figure 7-46 IP Mode : SYNC (CLKR / FSR internally generated from CLKX / FSX) CO-FO- CLKX / FSX: Output AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) 6 CI-FO- FSX: Output CLKX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP8_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP8_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX 7 CI-FI- CLKX / FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP8_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX MCASP8_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX CLKX: Output FSX: Input AXR(Outputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) AXR(Inputs)/CLKX/FSX Default (No Virtual Mode) 8 CO-FI- MCASP See Figure 7-47 See Figure 7-48 See Figure 7-49 See Figure 7-50 SoC IOs ADVANCE INFORMATION 5 CLKX FSX TXDATA CLKR FSR RXDATA Figure 7-43. McASP1-8 COIFOI – ASYNC Mode Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 277 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com MCASP SoC IOs CLKX FSX TXDATA CLKR FSR ADVANCE INFORMATION RXDATA Figure 7-44. McASP1-8 COIFIO – ASYNC Mode MCASP SoC IOs CLKX FSX TXDATA CLKR FSR RXDATA Figure 7-45. McASP1-8 CIOFIO – ASYNC Mode 278 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 MCASP SoC IOs CLKX FSX TXDATA CLKR FSR ADVANCE INFORMATION RXDATA Figure 7-46. McASP1-8 CIOFOI – ASYNC Mode MCASP SoC IOs CLKX FSX TXDATA CLKR FSR RXDATA Figure 7-47. McASP1-8 COIFOI – SYNC Mode Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 279 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com MCASP SoC IOs CLKX FSX TXDATA CLKR FSR ADVANCE INFORMATION RXDATA Figure 7-48. McASP1-8 CIOFOI – SYNC Mode MCASP SoC IOs CLKX FSX TXDATA CLKR FSR RXDATA Figure 7-49. McASP1-8 CIOFIO – SYNC Mode 280 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 MCASP SoC IOs CLKX FSX TXDATA CLKR FSR ADVANCE INFORMATION RXDATA Figure 7-50. McASP1-8 COIFIO – SYNC Mode NOTE To configure the desired virtual mode the user must set MODESELECT bit and DELAYMODE bitfield for each corresponding pad control register. The pad control registers are presented in Table 4-3 and described in Device TRM, Control Module Chapter. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 281 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Virtual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for McASP1. See Table 7-2, Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Virtual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-59, Virtual Functions Mapping for McASP1 for a definition of the Virtual modes. Table 7-59 presents the values for DELAYMODE bitfield. Table 7-59. Virtual Functions Mapping for McASP1 BALL NAME MCASP1_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX MCASP1_VIRTUAL2_ASYNC_RX 0 C14 mcasp1_aclkx 15 14 mcasp1_aclkx E21 gpio6_14 14 13 A13 mcasp1_axr13 15 14 mcasp1_axr13 E12 mcasp1_axr4 14 13 mcasp1_axr4 B26 xref_clk2 14 13 A11 mcasp1_axr9 15 14 D12 mcasp1_axr7 14 13 mcasp1_axr7 E14 mcasp1_axr12 15 14 mcasp1_axr12 F21 gpio6_16 14 13 mcasp1_axr10 mcasp1_axr9 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL 282 Delay Mode Value MUXMODE 1 2 3 mcasp1_axr8 mcasp1_axr6 mcasp1_axr9 F20 gpio6_15 14 13 C23 xref_clk3 14 13 C12 mcasp1_axr6 14 13 mcasp1_axr6 B13 mcasp1_axr10 15 14 mcasp1_axr10 J14 mcasp1_fsr N/A 14 mcasp1_fsr B12 mcasp1_axr8 15 14 mcasp1_axr8 A12 mcasp1_axr11 15 14 mcasp1_axr11 G13 mcasp1_axr2 14 13 mcasp1_axr2 D14 mcasp1_fsx 15 14 mcasp1_fsx G14 mcasp1_axr14 15 14 mcasp1_axr14 F14 mcasp1_axr15 15 14 mcasp1_axr15 F12 mcasp1_axr1 15 14 mcasp1_axr1 B14 mcasp1_aclkr N/A 14 mcasp1_aclkr mcasp1_axr5 mcasp1_axr7 F13 mcasp1_axr5 14 13 E17 xref_clk1 15 14 G12 mcasp1_axr0 15 14 mcasp1_axr0 J11 mcasp1_axr3 14 13 mcasp1_axr3 D18 xref_clk0 15 14 mcasp1_axr5 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics mcasp1_axr4 mcasp1_ahclkx Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Virtual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for McASP2. See Table 7-2, Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Virtual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-60, Virtual Functions Mapping for McASP2 for a definition of the Virtual modes. Table 7-60 presents the values for DELAYMODE bitfield. Table 7-60. Virtual Functions Mapping for McASP2 BALL NAME Delay Mode Value MUXMODE MCASP2_VIRTUAL1 _SYNC_RX_80M MCASP2_VIRTUAL2 _ASYNC_RX MCASP2_VIRTUAL3 _SYNC_RX MCASP2_VIRTUAL4 _ASYNC_RX_80M 0 B19 mcasp3_axr0 15 14 10 9 B17 mcasp2_axr6 14 13 12 11 mcasp2_axr6 B16 mcasp2_axr5 14 13 12 11 mcasp2_axr5 A18 mcasp2_fsx 15 14 10 9 mcasp2_fsx B26 xref_clk2 12 11 10 9 1 2 3 mcasp2_axr1 4 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL mcasp2_axr1 0 A16 mcasp2_axr3 15 14 10 9 mcasp2_axr3 E15 mcasp2_aclkr N/A 14 N/A 13 mcasp2_aclkr B18 mcasp3_aclkx 15 14 10 9 A19 mcasp2_aclkx 15 14 10 9 mcasp2_aclkx mcasp2_axr7 mcasp2_axr1 2 A17 mcasp2_axr7 14 13 12 11 C23 xref_clk3 12 11 10 9 C17 mcasp3_axr1 15 14 10 8 mcasp2_axr1 5 F15 mcasp3_fsx 15 14 10 9 mcasp2_axr1 3 C15 mcasp2_axr2 15 14 10 9 mcasp2_axr2 D15 mcasp2_axr4 14 13 12 11 mcasp2_axr4 A20 mcasp2_fsr N/A 14 N/A 13 mcasp2_fsr E17 xref_clk1 10 9 8 6 A15 mcasp2_axr1 14 13 12 11 mcasp2_axr1 B15 mcasp2_axr0 14 13 12 11 mcasp2_axr0 D18 xref_clk0 10 9 8 6 mcasp2_axr1 1 mcasp2_axr9 mcasp2_ahclkx mcasp2_axr8 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 283 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Virtual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for McASP3/4/5/6/7/8. See Table 7-2, Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Virtual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-61, Virtual Functions Mapping for McASP3/4/5/6/7/8 for a definition of the Virtual modes. Table 7-61 presents the values for DELAYMODE bitfield. Table 7-61. Virtual Functions Mapping for McASP3/4/5/6/7/8 BALL BALL NAME Delay Mode Value MUXMODE 0 1 2 MCASP3_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX ADVANCE INFORMATION A16 mcasp2_axr3 8 B18 mcasp3_aclkx 8 mcasp3_aclkx mcasp3_axr3 B19 mcasp3_axr0 8 mcasp3_axr0 C17 mcasp3_axr1 6 mcasp3_axr1 F15 mcasp3_fsx 8 mcasp3_fsx C15 mcasp2_axr2 8 A21 mcasp4_fsx 14 mcasp4_fsx mcasp4_fsr C18 mcasp4_aclkx 14 mcasp4_aclkx mcasp4_aclkr G16 mcasp4_axr0 14 mcasp4_axr0 D17 mcasp4_axr1 14 mcasp4_axr1 F13 mcasp1_axr5 12 mcasp4_axr3 E12 mcasp1_axr4 12 mcasp4_axr2 AA3 mcasp5_aclkx 14 mcasp5_aclkx mcasp5_aclkr AB9 mcasp5_fsx 14 mcasp5_fsx mcasp5_fsr AA4 mcasp5_axr1 14 mcasp5_axr1 C12 mcasp1_axr6 12 AB3 mcasp5_axr0 14 D12 mcasp1_axr7 12 G13 mcasp1_axr2 12 mcasp6_axr2 J11 mcasp1_axr3 12 mcasp6_axr3 B13 mcasp1_axr10 10 mcasp6_aclkx A11 mcasp1_axr9 10 mcasp6_axr1 B12 mcasp1_axr8 10 mcasp6_axr0 A12 mcasp1_axr11 10 mcasp6_fsx mcasp3_aclkr mcasp3_fsr mcasp3_axr2 MCASP4_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX MCASP5_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX mcasp5_axr2 mcasp5_axr0 mcasp5_axr3 MCASP6_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX 284 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics mcasp6_aclkr mcasp6_fsr Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-61. Virtual Functions Mapping for McASP3/4/5/6/7/8 (continued) BALL BALL NAME Delay Mode Value MUXMODE 0 1 2 MCASP7_VIRTUAL2_SYNC_RX mcasp1_axr12 10 mcasp7_axr0 F14 mcasp1_axr15 10 mcasp7_fsx mcasp7_fsr G14 mcasp1_axr14 10 mcasp7_aclkx mcasp7_aclkr A13 mcasp1_axr13 10 mcasp7_axr1 B14 mcasp1_aclkr 13 mcasp7_axr2 J14 mcasp1_fsr 13 mcasp7_axr3 ADVANCE INFORMATION E14 MCASP8_VIRTUAL1_SYNC_RX D15 mcasp2_axr4 10 mcasp8_axr0 A17 mcasp2_axr7 10 mcasp8_fsx mcasp8_fsr B17 mcasp2_axr6 10 mcasp8_aclkx mcasp8_aclkr A20 mcasp2_fsr 12 mcasp8_axr3 B16 mcasp2_axr5 10 mcasp8_axr1 E15 mcasp2_aclkr 12 mcasp8_axr2 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 285 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 7.19 Universal Serial Bus (USB) SuperSpeed USB DRD Subsystem has four instances in the device providing the following functions: • USB1: SuperSpeed (SS) USB 3.0 Dual-Role-Device (DRD) subsystem with integrated SS (USB3.0) PHY and HS/FS (USB2.0) PHY. • USB2: High-Speed (HS) USB 2.0 Dual-Role-Device (DRD) subsystem with integrated HS/FS PHY. NOTE For more information, see the SuperSpeed USB DRD section of the Device TRM. 7.19.1 USB1 DRD PHY ADVANCE INFORMATION The USB1 DRD interface supports the following applications: • USB2.0 High-Speed PHY port (1.8 V and 3.3 V): this asynchronous high-speed interface is compliant with the USB2.0 PHY standard with an internal transceiver (USB2.0 standard v2.0), for a maximum data rate of 480 Mbps. • USB3.0 Super-Speed PHY port (1.8 V): this asynchronous differential super-speed interface is compliant with the USB3.0 RX/TX PHY standard (USB3.0 standard v1.0) for a maximum data bit rate of 5Gbps. 7.19.2 USB2 PHY The USB2 interface supports the following applications: • USB2.0 High-Speed PHY port (1.8 V and 3.3 V): this asynchronous high-speed interface is compliant with the USB2.0 PHY standard with an internal transceiver (USB2.0 standard v2.0), for a maximum data rate of 480 Mbps. 7.20 Serial Advanced Technology Attachment (SATA) The SATA RX/TX PHY interface is compliant with the SATA standard v2.6 for a maximum data rate: • Gen2i, Gen2m, Gen2x: 3Gbps. • Gen1i, Gen1m, Gen1x: 1.5Gbps. NOTE For more information, see the SATA Controller section of the Device TRM. 7.21 Peripheral Component Interconnect Express (PCIe) The device supports connections to PCIe-compliant devices via the integrated PCIe master/slave bus interface. The PCIe module is comprised of a dual-mode PCIe core and a SerDes PHY. Each PCIe subsystem controller has support for PCIe Gen-II mode (5.0 Gbps /lane) and Gen-I mode (2.5 Gbps/lane) (Single Lane and Flexible dual lane configuration). The device PCIe supports the following features: • 16-bit operation @250 MHz on PIPE interface (per 16-bit lane) • Supports 2 ports x 1 lane or 1 port x 2 lanes configuration • Single virtual channel (VC0), single traffic class (TC0) • Single function in end-point mode • Automatic width and speed negotiation • Max payload: 128 byte outbound, 256 byte inbound • Automatic credit management 286 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com • • • • • • SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 ECRC generation and checking Configurable BAR filtering Legacy interrupt reception (RC) and generation (EP) MSI generation and reception PCI Express Active State Power Management (ASPM) state L0s and L1 (with exceptions) All PCI Device Power Management D-states with the exception of D3cold / L2 state The PCIe peripheral on the device conforms to the PCI Express Base 3.0 Specification, revision 1.0 and the PCI Local Bus Specification, revision 3.0. NOTE For more information, see the PCIe Controller section of the Device TRM. The device provides two DCAN interfaces for supporting distributed realtime control with a high level of security. The DCAN interfaces implement the following features: • Supports CAN protocol version 2.0 part A, B • Bit rates up to 1 MBit/s • 64 message objects • Individual identifier mask for each message object • Programmable FIFO mode for message objects • Programmable loop-back modes for self-test operation • Suspend mode for debug support • Software module reset • Automatic bus on after Bus-Off state by a programmable 32-bit timer • Direct access to Message RAM during test mode • CAN Rx/Tx pins are configurable as general-purpose IO pins • Two interrupt lines (plus additional parity-error interrupts line) • RAM initialization • DMA support NOTE For more information, see the DCAN section of the Device TRM. NOTE The Controller Area Network Interface x (x = 1 to 2) is also referred to as DCANx. Table 7-62, Table 7-63 and Figure 7-51 present timing and switching characteristics for DCANx Interface. Table 7-62. Timing Requirements for DCANx Receive(1) NO. 1 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION f(baud) Maximum programmable baud rate tw(DCANRX) Pulse duration, receive data bit (DCANx_RX) Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated MIN H - 15 NOM MAX UNIT 1 Mbps H + 15 ns Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 287 ADVANCE INFORMATION 7.22 Controller Area Network Interface (DCAN) AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) H = period of baud rate, 1/programmed baud rate. Table 7-63. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for DCANx Transmit NO. 2 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION f(baud) Maximum programmable baud rate tw(DCANTX) Pulse duration, transmit data bit (DCANx_TX) (1) MIN MAX UNIT 1 Mbps H - 15 H + 15 ns (1) H = period of baud rate, 1/programmed baud rate. 1 DCANx_RX 2 DCANx_TX SPRS906_TIMING_DCAN_01 ADVANCE INFORMATION Figure 7-51. DCANx Timings 7.23 Ethernet Interface (GMAC_SW) The three-port gigabit ethernet switch subsystem (GMAC_SW) provides ethernet packet communication and can be configured as an ethernet switch. It provides the Gigabit Media Independent Interface (G/MII) in MII mode, Reduced Gigabit Media Independent Interface (RGMII), Reduced Media Independent Interface (RMII), and the Management Data Input/Output (MDIO) for physical layer device (PHY) management. NOTE For more information, see the Ethernet Subsystem section of the Device TRM. NOTE The Gigabit, Reduced and Media Independent Interface n (n = 0 to 1) are also referred to as MIIn, RMIIn and RGMIIn. CAUTION The I/O timings provided in this section are valid only if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 7-68, Table 7-71, Table 776 and Table 7-83. CAUTION The I/O Timings provided in this section are valid only for some GMAC usage modes when the corresponding Virtual I/O Timings or Manual I/O Timings are configured as described in the tables found in this section. Table 7-64 and Figure 7-52 present timing requirements for MIIn in receive operation. 7.23.1 GMAC MII Timings 288 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-64. Timing Requirements for miin_rxclk - MII Operation NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SPEED MIN 1 tc(RX_CLK) Cycle time, miin_rxclk 10 Mbps 400 2 tw(RX_CLKH) Pulse duration, miin_rxclk high 3 tw(RX_CLKL) Pulse duration, miin_rxclk low 4 tt(RX_CLK) Transition time, miin_rxclk MAX UNIT ns 100 Mbps 40 10 Mbps 140 260 ns ns 100 Mbps 14 26 ns 10 Mbps 140 260 ns 100 Mbps 14 26 ns 10 Mbps 3 ns 100 Mbps 3 ns 4 1 3 2 4 SPRS906_TIMING_GMAC_MIIRXCLK_01 Figure 7-52. Clock Timing (GMAC Receive) - MIIn operation Table 7-65 and Figure 7-53 present timing requirements for MIIn in transmit operation. Table 7-65. Timing Requirements for miin_txclk - MII Operation NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SPEED MIN 1 tc(TX_CLK) Cycle time, miin_txclk 10 Mbps 400 100 Mbps 40 10 Mbps 140 2 tw(TX_CLKH) Pulse duration, miin_txclk high 3 tw(TX_CLKL) Pulse duration, miin_txclk low 4 tt(TX_CLK) Transition time, miin_txclk MAX UNIT ns ns 260 ns 100 Mbps 14 26 ns 10 Mbps 140 260 ns 100 Mbps 14 26 ns 10 Mbps 3 ns 100 Mbps 3 ns 4 1 2 3 miin_txclk 4 SPRS906_TIMING_GMAC_MIITXCLK_02 Figure 7-53. Clock Timing (GMAC Transmit) - MIIn operation Table 7-66 and Figure 7-54 present timing requirements for GMAC MIIn Receive 10/100Mbit/s. Table 7-66. Timing Requirements for GMAC MIIn Receive 10/100 Mbit/s NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT tsu(RXD-RX_CLK) 1 tsu(RX_DV-RX_CLK) Setup time, receive selected signals valid before miin_rxclk 8 ns tsu(RX_ER-RX_CLK) Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 289 ADVANCE INFORMATION miin_rxclk AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-66. Timing Requirements for GMAC MIIn Receive 10/100 Mbit/s (continued) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT th(RX_CLK-RXD) 2 th(RX_CLK-RX_DV) Hold time, receive selected signals valid after miin_rxclk 8 ns th(RX_CLK-RX_ER) 1 2 miin_rxclk (Input) miin_rxd3−miin_rxd0, miin_rxdv, miin_rxer (Inputs) SPRS906_TIMING_GMAC_MIIRCV_03 Figure 7-54. GMAC Receive Interface Timing MIIn operation ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 7-67 and Figure 7-55 present timing requirements for GMAC MIIn Transmit 10/100Mbit/s. Table 7-67. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for GMAC MIIn Transmit 10/100 Mbits/s NO. 1 PARAMETER td(TX_CLK-TXD) td(TX_CLK-TX_EN) DESCRIPTION Delay time, miin_txclk to transmit selected signals valid MIN MAX UNIT 0 25 ns 1 miin_txclk (input) miin_txd3 − miin_txd0, miin_txen (outputs) SPRS906_TIMING_GMAC_MIITX_04 Figure 7-55. GMAC Transmit Interface Timing MIIn operation In Table 7-68 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with GMAC MII signals. Table 7-68. GMAC MII IOSETs SIGNALS 290 IOSET5 IOSET6 BALL MUX mii1_txd3 C5 8 mii1_txd2 D6 8 mii1_txd1 B2 8 mii1_txd0 C4 8 mii1_rxd3 F5 8 mii1_rxd2 E4 8 mii1_rxd1 C1 8 mii1_rxd0 E6 8 mii1_col B4 8 mii1_rxer B3 8 mii1_txer A3 8 mii1_txen A4 8 mii1_crs B5 8 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback BALL MUX Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-68. GMAC MII IOSETs (continued) IOSET5 IOSET6 BALL MUX BALL MUX mii1_rxclk D5 8 mii1_txclk C3 8 mii1_rxdv C2 8 mii0_txd3 V5 3 mii0_txd2 V4 3 mii0_txd1 Y2 3 mii0_txd0 W2 3 mii0_rxd3 W9 3 mii0_rxd2 V9 3 mii0_rxd1 V6 3 mii0_rxd0 U6 3 mii0_txclk U5 3 mii0_txer U4 3 mii0_rxer U7 3 mii0_rxdv V2 3 mii0_crs V7 3 mii0_col V1 3 mii0_rxclk Y1 3 mii0_txen V3 3 ADVANCE INFORMATION SIGNALS 7.23.2 GMAC MDIO Interface Timings CAUTION The I/O Timings provided in this section are valid only for some GMAC usage modes when the corresponding Virtual I/O Timings or Manual I/O Timings are configured as described in the tables found in this section. Table 7-69, Table 7-69 and Figure 7-56 present timing requirements for MDIO. Table 7-69. Timing Requirements for MDIO Input NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT MDIO1 tc(MDC) Cycle time, MDC 400 ns MDIO2 tw(MDCH) Pulse Duration, MDC High 160 ns MDIO3 tw(MDCL) Pulse Duration, MDC Low 160 ns MDIO4 tsu(MDIO-MDC) Setup time, MDIO valid before MDC High 90 ns MDIO5 th(MDIO_MDC) Hold time, MDIO valid from MDC High 0 ns Table 7-70. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for MDIO Output NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MDIO6 tt(MDC) Transition time, MDC MDIO7 td(MDC-MDIO) Delay time, MDC High to MDIO valid Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated MIN 10 MAX UNIT 5 ns 390 ns Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 291 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 1 MDIO2 MDIO3 MDCLK MDIO6 MDIO6 MDIO4 MDIO5 MDIO (input) MDIO7 MDIO (output) SPRS906_TIMING_GMAC_MDIO_05 Figure 7-56. GMAC MDIO diagrams ADVANCE INFORMATION In Table 7-71 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with GMAC MDIO signals. Table 7-71. GMAC MDIO IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET7 IOSET8 IOSET9 BALL MUX BALL MUX mdio_d F6 3 U4 mdio_mclk D3 3 V1 IOSET10 BALL MUX BALL MUX 0 AB4 1 B20 5 0 AC5 1 B21 5 7.23.3 GMAC RMII Timings The main reference clock REF_CLK (RMII_50MHZ_CLK) of RMII interface is internally supplied from PRCM. The source of this clock could be either externally sourced from the RMII_MHZ_50_CLK pin of the device or internally generated from DPLL_GMAC output clock GMAC_RMII_HS_CLK. Please see the PRCM chapter of the device TRM for full details about RMII reference clock. CAUTION The I/O Timings provided in this section are valid only for some GMAC usage modes when the corresponding Virtual I/O Timings or Manual I/O Timings are configured as described in the tables found in this section. Table 7-72, Table 7-73 and Figure 7-57 present timing requirements for GMAC RMIIn Receive. Table 7-72. Timing Requirements for GMAC REF_CLK - RMII Operation NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT RMII1 tc(REF_CLK) Cycle time, REF_CLK 20 RMII2 tw(REF_CLKH) Pulse duration, REF_CLK high 7 13 ns RMII3 tw(REF_CLKL) Pulse duration, REF_CLK low 7 13 ns RMII4 ttt(REF_CLK) Transistion time, REF_CLK 3 ns 292 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-73. Timing Requirements for GMAC RMIIn Receive NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION RMII5 tsu(RXD-REF_CLK) Setup time, receive selected signals valid before REF_CLK MIN 4 MAX UNIT ns Hold time, receive selected signals valid after REF_CLK 2 ns tsu(CRS_DV-REF_CLK) tsu(RX_ER-REF_CLK) RMII6 th(REF_CLK-RXD) th(REF_CLK-CRS_DV) th(REF_CLK-RX_ER) RMII1 RMII3 RMII4 RMII2 RMII5 RMII6 rmiin_rxd1−rmiin_rxd0, rmiin_crs, rmin_rxer (inputs) SPRS906_TIMING_GMAC_RGMIITX_09 Figure 7-57. GMAC Receive Interface Timing RMIIn operation Table 7-74, Table 7-74 and Figure 7-58 present switching characteristics for GMAC RMIIn Transmit 10/100Mbit/s. Table 7-74. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for GMAC REF_CLK RMII Operation NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT RMII7 tc(REF_CLK) Cycle time, REF_CLK 20 ns RMII8 tw(REF_CLKH) Pulse duration, REF_CLK high 7 13 ns RMII9 tw(REF_CLKL) Pulse duration, REF_CLK low 7 13 ns RMII10 tt(REF_CLK) Transistion time, REF_CLK 3 ns Table 7-75. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for GMAC RMIIn Transmit 10/100 Mbits/s NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION td(REF_CLK-TXD) RMII11 tdd(REF_CLK-TXEN) td(REF_CLK-TXD) RMIIn MIN MAX UNIT RMII0 2 13.5 ns RMII1 2 13.8 ns Delay time, REF_CLK high to selected transmit signals valid tdd(REF_CLK-TXEN) RMII7 RMII8 RMII11 RMII9 RMII10 REF_CLK (PRCM) rmiin_txd1−rmiin_txd0, rmiin_txen (Outputs) SPRS906_TIMING_GMAC_RMIITX_07 Figure 7-58. GMAC Transmit Interface Timing RMIIn Operation Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 293 ADVANCE INFORMATION REF_CLK (PRCM) AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com In Table 7-76 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with GMAC RMII signals. Table 7-76. GMAC RMII IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET1 IOSET2 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL MUX BALL MUX RMII_MHZ_50_CLK U3 0 U3 0 rmii1_txd1 V5 2 rmii0_txd1 Y2 1 rmii0_txd0 W2 1 rmii0_rxd1 V6 1 rmii0_rxd0 U6 1 rmii0_txen V3 1 rmii0_rxer U7 1 rmii0_crs V7 1 rmii1_txd0 V4 2 rmii1_rxd1 W9 2 rmii1_rxd0 V9 2 rmii1_rxer Y1 2 rmii1_txen U5 2 rmii1_crs V2 2 Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for GMAC. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-77 Manual Functions Mapping for GMAC RMII0 for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-77 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-77. Manual Functions Mapping for GMAC RMII0 BALL BALL NAME GMAC_RMII0_MANUAL1 A_DELAY (ps) CFG REGISTER MUXMODE G_DELAY (ps) 0 1 U3 RMII_MHZ_50_CLK 0 0 CFG_RMII_MHZ_50_CLK_IN U6 rgmii0_txd0 2444 804 CFG_RGMII0_TXD0_IN RMII_MHZ_50_CLK rmii0_rxd0 V6 rgmii0_txd1 2453 981 CFG_RGMII0_TXD1_IN rmii0_rxd1 U7 rgmii0_txd2 2356 847 CFG_RGMII0_TXD2_IN rmii0_rxer V7 rgmii0_txd3 2415 993 CFG_RGMII0_TXD3_IN rmii0_crs Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for GMAC. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-78 Manual Functions Mapping for GMAC RMII1 for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-78 list the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-78. Manual Functions Mapping for GMAC RMII1 BALL BALL NAME GMAC_RMII1_MANUAL1 A_DELAY (ps) 294 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE G_DELAY (ps) 0 2 U3 RMII_MHZ_50_CLK 0 0 CFG_RMII_MHZ_50_CLK_IN V9 rgmii0_txctl 2450 909 CFG_RGMII0_TXCTL_IN rmii1_rxd0 W9 rgmii0_txc 2327 926 CFG_RGMII0_TXC_IN rmii1_rxd1 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback RMII_MHZ_50_CLK Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-78. Manual Functions Mapping for GMAC RMII1 (continued) BALL BALL NAME GMAC_RMII1_MANUAL1 A_DELAY (ps) CFG REGISTER MUXMODE G_DELAY (ps) 0 2 Y1 uart3_txd 2553 443 CFG_UART3_TXD_IN rmii1_rxer V2 uart3_rxd 1943 1110 CFG_UART3_RXD_IN rmii1_crs 7.23.4 GMAC RGMII Timings CAUTION The I/O Timings provided in this section are valid only for some GMAC usage modes when the corresponding Virtual I/O Timings or Manual I/O Timings are configured as described in the tables found in this section. Table 7-79. Timing Requirements for rgmiin_rxc - RGMIIn Operation NO. 1 2 3 4 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SPEED MIN MAX UNIT tc(RXC) Cycle time, rgmiin_rxc 10 Mbps 360 440 ns tw(RXCH) tw(RXCL) tt(RXC) 100 Mbps 36 44 ns 1000 Mbps 7.2 8.8 ns 10 Mbps 160 240 ns Pulse duration, rgmiin_rxc high 100 Mbps 16 24 ns 1000 Mbps 3.6 4.4 ns 10 Mbps 160 240 ns 100 Mbps 16 24 ns 1000 Mbps 3.6 Pulse duration, rgmiin_rxc low 4.4 ns 10 Mbps 0.75 ns 100 Mbps 0.75 ns 1000 Mbps 0.75 ns Transition time, rgmiin_rxc Table 7-80. Timing Requirements for GMAC RGMIIn Input Receive for 10/100/1000 Mbps NO. 5 6 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MODE MIN tsu(RXD-RXCH) Setup time, receive selected signals valid before rgmiin_rxc high/low RGMII0 1 Hold time, receive selected signals valid after rgmiin_rxc high/low RGMII0/1 th(RXCH-RXD) Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated RGMII1 1.15 MAX UNIT ns (2) 1 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback ns 295 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 7-79, Table 7-80 and Figure 7-59 present timing requirements for receive RGMIIn operation. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) For RGMII, receive selected signals include: rgmiin_rxd[3:0] and rgmiin_rxctl. (2) RGMII1 requires that the RGMII1_rxc and RGMII1_rxd[3:0] board propogation delays be matched to < 50pS. 1 4 2 4 3 rgmiin_rxc (A) 5 1st Half-byte 6 2nd Half-byte rgmiin_rxd[3:0](B) RGRXD[3:0] RGRXD[7:4] RXDV RXERR rgmiin_rxctl(B) SPRS906_TIMING_GMAC_RGMIIRX_08 A. B. ADVANCE INFORMATION rgmiin_rxc must be externally delayed relative to the data and control pins. Data and control information is received using both edges of the clocks. rgmiin_rxd[3:0] carries data bits 3-0 on the rising edge of rgmiin_rxc and data bits 7-4 on the falling edge ofrgmiin_rxc. Similarly, rgmiin_rxctl carries RXDV on rising edge of rgmiin_rxc and RXERR on falling edge of rgmiin_rxc. Figure 7-59. GMAC Receive Interface Timing, RGMIIn operation Table 7-81, Table 7-82 and Figure 7-60 present switching characteristics for transmit - RGMIIn for 10/100/1000Mbit/s. Table 7-81. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for rgmiin_txctl - RGMIIn Operation for 10/100/1000 Mbit/s NO. 1 2 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SPEED MIN MAX UNIT tc(TXC) Cycle time, rgmiin_txc 10 Mbps 360 440 ns 100 Mbps 36 44 ns tw(TXCH) 3 tw(TXCL) 4 tt(TXC) Pulse duration, rgmiin_txc high Pulse duration, rgmiin_txc low Transition time, rgmiin_txc 1000 Mbps 7.2 8.8 ns 10 Mbps 160 240 ns 100 Mbps 16 24 ns 1000 Mbps 3.6 4.4 ns 10 Mbps 160 240 ns 100 Mbps 16 24 ns 1000 Mbps 3.6 4.4 ns 10 Mbps 0.75 ns 100 Mbps 0.75 ns 1000 Mbps 0.75 ns Table 7-82. Switching Characteristics for GMAC RGMIIn Output Transmit for 10/100/1000 Mbps NO. 5 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION tosu(TXD-TXC) Output Setup time, transmit selected signals valid to rgmiin_txc high/low MODE MIN RGMII0, Internal Delay Enabled, 1000 Mbps 1.05 ns RGMII0, Internal Delay Enabled, 10/100 Mbps 1.2 ns (3) RGMII1, Internal Delay Enabled, 1000 Mbps RGMII1, Internal Delay Enabled, 10/100 Mbps 296 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback MAX (1) UNIT ns 1.2 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-82. Switching Characteristics for GMAC RGMIIn Output Transmit for 10/100/1000 Mbps (1) (continued) NO. 6 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION toh(TXC-TXD) Output Hold time, transmit selected signals valid after rgmiin_txc high/low MODE MIN RGMII0, Internal Delay Enabled, 1000 Mbps 1.05 MAX UNIT ns RGMII0, Internal Delay Enabled, 10/100 Mbps 1.2 ns (3) RGMII1, Internal Delay Enabled, 1000 Mbps ns RGMII1, Internal Delay Enabled, 10/100 Mbps 1.2 ns (1) For RGMII, transmit selected signals include: rgmiin_txd[3:0] and rgmiin_txctl. (2) RGMII0 1000Mbps operation requires that the RGMII0_txc and RGMII0_txd[3:0] board propogation delays be matched to < 50pS. (3) RGMII1 1000Mbps operation is not supported. 1 4 3 rgmiin_txc [internal delay enabled] 4 (A) 5 (B) rgmiin_txd[3:0] 1st Half-byte 2nd Half-byte 6 rgmiin_txctl(B) TXEN TXERR SPRS906 TIMING GMAC RGMIITX 09 A. B. TXC is delayed internally before being driven to the rgmiin_txc pin. This internal delay is always enabled. Data and control information is transmitted using both edges of the clocks. rgmiin_txd[3:0] carries data bits 3-0 on the rising edge of rgmiin_txc and data bits 7-4 on the falling edge of rgmiin_txc. Similarly, rgmiin_txctl carries TXEN on rising edge of rgmiin_txc and TXERR of falling edge of rgmiin_txc. Figure 7-60. GMAC Transmit Interface Timing RGMIIn operation In Table 7-83 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with GMAC RGMII signals. Table 7-83. GMAC RGMII IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET3 IOSET4 BALL MUX BALL MUX rgmii1_txd3 C3 3 rgmii1_txd2 C4 3 rgmii1_txd1 B2 3 rgmii0_txd3 V7 0 rgmii0_txd2 U7 0 rgmii1_txd0 D6 3 rgmii1_rxd3 B3 3 rgmii1_rxd2 B4 3 rgmii1_rxd1 B5 3 rgmii1_rxd0 A4 3 rgmii1_rxctl A3 3 rgmii1_txc D5 3 rgmii1_txctl C2 3 rgmii1_rxc C5 3 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 297 ADVANCE INFORMATION 2 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-83. GMAC RGMII IOSETs (continued) SIGNALS IOSET3 BALL IOSET4 MUX BALL MUX rgmii0_txd1 V6 0 rgmii0_txd0 U6 0 rgmii0_rxd3 V4 0 rgmii0_rxd2 V3 0 rgmii0_rxd1 Y2 0 rgmii0_rxd0 W2 0 rgmii0_txc W9 0 rgmii0_rxctl V5 0 rgmii0_rxc U5 0 rgmii0_txctl V9 0 NOTE To configure the desired Manual IO Timing Mode the user must follow the steps described in section "Manual IO Timing Modes" of the Device TRM. ADVANCE INFORMATION The associated registers to configure are listed in the CFG REGISTER column. For more information please see the Control Module Chapter in the Device TRM. 298 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for GMAC. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-84 Manual Functions Mapping for GMAC RGMII0 for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-84 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-84. Manual Functions Mapping for GMAC RGMII0 BALL NAME GMAC_RGMII0_MANUAL1 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) U5 rgmii0_rxc 413 0 CFG_RGMII0_RXC_IN rgmii0_rxc V5 rgmii0_rxctl 27 2296 CFG_RGMII0_RXCTL_IN rgmii0_rxctl W2 Y2 rgmii0_rxd0 3 1721 CFG_RGMII0_RXD0_IN rgmii0_rxd0 rgmii0_rxd1 134 1786 CFG_RGMII0_RXD1_IN rgmii0_rxd1 V3 rgmii0_rxd2 40 1966 CFG_RGMII0_RXD2_IN rgmii0_rxd2 V4 rgmii0_rxd3 0 2057 CFG_RGMII0_RXD3_IN rgmii0_rxd3 W9 rgmii0_txc 0 60 CFG_RGMII0_TXC_OUT rgmii0_txc V9 rgmii0_txctl 0 60 CFG_RGMII0_TXCTL_OUT rgmii0_txctl U6 rgmii0_txd0 0 60 CFG_RGMII0_TXD0_OUT rgmii0_txd0 0 V6 rgmii0_txd1 0 0 CFG_RGMII0_TXD1_OUT rgmii0_txd1 U7 rgmii0_txd2 0 60 CFG_RGMII0_TXD2_OUT rgmii0_txd2 V7 rgmii0_txd3 0 120 CFG_RGMII0_TXD3_OUT rgmii0_txd3 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL 299 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for GMAC. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-85 Manual Functions Mapping for GMAC RGMII1 for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-85 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-85. Manual Functions Mapping for GMAC RGMII1 BALL NAME A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) C5 vin2a_d18 530 A3 vin2a_d19 B3 B4 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL 300 GMAC_RGMII1_MANUAL1 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE 0 CFG_VIN2A_D18_IN rgmii1_rxc 71 1099 CFG_VIN2A_D19_IN rgmii1_rxctl vin2a_d20 142 1337 CFG_VIN2A_D20_IN rgmii1_rxd3 vin2a_d21 114 1517 CFG_VIN2A_D21_IN rgmii1_rxd2 B5 vin2a_d22 171 1331 CFG_VIN2A_D22_IN rgmii1_rxd1 A4 vin2a_d23 0 1328 CFG_VIN2A_D23_IN rgmii1_rxd0 D5 vin2a_d12 0 0 CFG_VIN2A_D12_OUT rgmii1_txc C2 vin2a_d13 170 0 CFG_VIN2A_D13_OUT rgmii1_txctl C3 vin2a_d14 150 0 CFG_VIN2A_D14_OUT rgmii1_txd3 C4 vin2a_d15 0 0 CFG_VIN2A_D15_OUT rgmii1_txd2 B2 vin2a_d16 60 0 CFG_VIN2A_D16_OUT rgmii1_txd1 D6 vin2a_d17 60 0 CFG_VIN2A_D17_OUT rgmii1_txd0 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics 3 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 7.24 eMMC/SD/SDIO The Device includes the following external memory interfaces 4 MultiMedia Card/Secure Digital/Secure Digital Input Output Interface (MMC/SD/SDIO) NOTE The eMMC/SD/SDIOi (i = 1 to 4) controller is also referred to as MMCi. MMC1 interface is compliant with the SD Standard v3.01 and it supports the following SD Card applications: • Default speed, 4-bit data, SDR, half-cycle • High speed, 4-bit data, SDR, half-cycle • SDR12, 4-bit data, half-cycle • SDR25, 4-bit data, half-cycle • UHS-I SDR50, 4-bit data, half-cycle • UHS-I SDR104, 4-bit data, half-cycle • UHS-I DDR50, 4-bit data NOTE For more information, see the eMMC/SD/SDIO chapter of the Device TRM. 7.24.1.1 Default speed, 4-bit data, SDR, half-cycle Table 7-86 and Table 7-87 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC1 - Default Speed in receiver and transmitter mode (see Figure 7-61 and Figure 7-62). Table 7-86. Timing Requirements for MMC1 - SD Card Default Speed Mode PARAMETER DESCRIPTION DSSD5 NO. tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc1_cmd valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge 25.83 MIN MAX UNIT ns DSSD6 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc1_cmd valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge 20.9 ns DSSD7 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc1_dat[3:0] valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge 25.83 ns DSSD8 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc1_dat[3:0] valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge 20.9 ns Table 7-87. Switching Characteristics for MMC1 - SD Card Default Speed Mode PARAMETER DESCRIPTION DSSD0 NO. fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc1_clk DSSD1 tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc1_clk high 0.5*P0.185 (1) ns DSSD2 tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc1_clk low 0.5*P0.185 (1) ns DSSD3 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc1_clk falling clock edge to mmc1_cmd transition -14.93 14.93 ns DSSD4 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc1_clk falling clock edge to mmc1_dat[3:0] transition -14.93 14.93 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated MIN MAX UNIT 24 MHz Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 301 ADVANCE INFORMATION 7.24.1 MMC1—SD Card Interface AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) P = output mmc1_clk period in ns DSSD2 DSSD1 DSSD0 mmc1_clk DSSD6 DSSD5 mmc1_cmd DSSD8 DSSD7 mmc1_dat[3:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC1_01 Figure 7-61. MMC/SD/SDIO in - Default Speed - Receiver Mode DSSD2 ADVANCE INFORMATION DSSD1 DSSD0 mmc1_clk DSSD3 mmc1_cmd DSSD4 mmc1_dat[3:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC1_02 Figure 7-62. MMC/SD/SDIO in - Default Speed - Transmitter Mode 7.24.1.2 High speed, 4-bit data, SDR, half-cycle Table 7-88 and Table 7-89 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC1 - High Speed in receiver and transmitter mode (see Figure 7-63 and Figure 7-64). Table 7-88. Timing Requirements for MMC1 - SD Card High Speed NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT HSSD3 tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc1_cmd valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge 6.64 ns HSSD4 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc1_cmd valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge 2.6 ns HSSD7 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc1_dat[3:0] valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge 6.64 ns HSSD8 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc1_dat[3:0] valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge 2.6 ns Table 7-89. Switching Characteristics for MMC1 - SD Card High Speed NO. HSSD1 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc1_clk MIN MAX UNIT 48 MHz HSSD2H tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc1_clk high 0.5*P0.185 (1) ns HSSD2L tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc1_clk low 0.5*P0.185 (1) ns HSSD5 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc1_clk falling clock edge to mmc1_cmd transition -7.6 3.6 ns HSSD6 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc1_clk falling clock edge to mmc1_dat[3:0] transition -7.6 3.6 ns 302 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 (1) P = output mmc1_clk period in ns HSSD1 HSSD2L HSSD2H mmc1_clk HSSD3 HSSD4 mmc1_cmd HSSD7 HSSD8 mmc1_dat[3:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC1_03 Figure 7-63. MMC/SD/SDIO in - High Speed - Receiver Mode HSSD1 HSSD2L HSSD5 HSSD5 mmc1_cmd HSSD6 HSSD6 mmc1_dat[3:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC1_04 Figure 7-64. MMC/SD/SDIO in - High Speed - Transmitter Mode 7.24.1.3 SDR12, 4-bit data, half-cycle Table 7-90 and Table 7-91 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC1 - SDR12 in receiver and transmitter mode (see Figure 7-65 and Figure 7-66). Table 7-90. Timing Requirements for MMC1 - SD Card SDR12 Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MODE SDR12 tsu(cmdV-clkH) 5 Setup time, mmc1_cmd valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge SDR12 th(clkH-cmdV) 6 Hold time, mmc1_cmd valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge SDR12 tsu(dV-clkH) 7 Setup time, mmc1_dat[3:0] valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge SDR12 th(clkH-dV) 8 Hold time, mmc1_dat[3:0] valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge MIN MAX UNIT 27.33 ns Pad Loopback Clock 1.6 ns Internal Loopback Clock 1.6 ns 27.33 ns Pad Loopback Clock 1.6 ns Internal Loopback Clock 1.6 ns Table 7-91. Switching Characteristics for MMC1 - SD Card SDR12 Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SDR120 fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc1_clk SDR121 tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc1_clk high 0.5*P0.185 (1) ns SDR122 tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc1_clk low 0.5*P0.185(1) ns SDR123 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc1_clk falling clock edge to mmc1_cmd transition -19.13 16.93 ns SDR124 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc1_clk falling clock edge to mmc1_dat[3:0] transition -19.13 16.93 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated MIN MAX UNIT 24 MHz Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 303 ADVANCE INFORMATION HSSD2H mmc1_clk AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) P = output mmc1_clk period in ns SDR122 SDR121 SDR120 mmc1_clk SDR126 SDR125 mmc1_cmd SDR128 SDR127 mmc1_dat[3:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC1_05 Figure 7-65. MMC/SD/SDIO in - High Speed SDR12 - Receiver Mode SDR122 ADVANCE INFORMATION SDR121 SDR120 mmc1_clk SDR123 mmc1_cmd SDR124 mmc1_dat[3:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC1_06 Figure 7-66. MMC/SD/SDIO in - High Speed SDR12 - Transmitter Mode 7.24.1.4 SDR25, 4-bit data, half-cycle Table 7-92 and Table 7-93 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC1 - SDR25 in receiver and transmitter mode (see Figure 7-67 and Figure 7-68). Table 7-92. Timing Requirements for MMC1 - SD Card SDR25 Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MODE MIN MAX UNIT SDR25 tsu(cmdV-clkH) 3 Setup time, mmc1_cmd valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge 6.64 ns SDR25 th(clkH-cmdV) 4 Hold time, mmc1_cmd valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge 1.6 ns SDR25 tsu(dV-clkH) 7 Setup time, mmc1_dat[3:0] valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge 6.64 ns SDR25 th(clkH-dV) 8 Hold time, mmc1_dat[3:0] valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge Pad Loopback Clock 1.6 ns Internal Loopback Clock 1.6 ns Table 7-93. Switching Characteristics for MMC1 - SD Card SDR25 Mode PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SDR251 NO. fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc1_clk SDR252 H tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc1_clk high 0.5*P0.185 (1) ns SDR252L tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc1_clk low 0.5*P0.185 (1) ns SDR255 Delay time, mmc1_clk falling clock edge to mmc1_cmd transition 304 td(clkL-cmdV) Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback MIN -8.8 MAX UNIT 48 MHz 6.6 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-93. Switching Characteristics for MMC1 - SD Card SDR25 Mode (continued) NO. SDR256 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc1_clk falling clock edge to mmc1_dat[3:0] transition -8.8 6.6 ns (1) P = output mmc1_clk period in ns SDR251 SDR252L SDR252H mmc1_clk SDR253 SDR254 mmc1_cmd SDR257 SDR258 mmc1_dat[3:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC1_07 SDR251 SDR252H SDR252L mmc1_clk HSSDR255 SDR255 mmc1_cmd SDR256 SDR256 mmc1_dat[3:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC1_08 Figure 7-68. MMC/SD/SDIO in - High Speed SDR25 - Transmitter Mode 7.24.1.5 UHS-I SDR50, 4-bit data, half-cycle Table 7-94 and Table 7-95 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC1 - SDR50 in receiver and transmitter mode (see Figure 7-69 and Figure 7-70). Table 7-94. Timing Requirements for MMC1 - SD Card SDR50 Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MODE MIN MAX UNIT SDR50 tsu(cmdV-clkH) 3 Setup time, mmc1_cmd valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge 2.82 ns SDR50 th(clkH-cmdV) 4 Hold time, mmc1_cmd valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge 1.7 ns SDR50 tsu(dV-clkH) 7 Setup time, mmc1_dat[3:0] valid before mmc1_clk rising clock edge 2.82 ns SDR50 th(clkH-dV) 8 Hold time, mmc1_dat[3:0] valid after mmc1_clk rising clock edge Pad Loopback Clock 1.7 ns Internal Loopback Clock 1.6 ns Table 7-95. Switching Characteristics for MMC1 - SD Card SDR50 Mode PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SDR501 NO. fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc1_clk SDR502 H tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc1_clk high 0.5*P0.185 (1) ns SDR502L tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc1_clk low 0.5*P0.185 (1) ns SDR505 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc1_clk falling clock edge to mmc1_cmd transition -8.8 6.6 ns SDR506 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc1_clk falling clock edge to mmc1_dat[3:0] transition -3.66 1.46 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated MIN MAX 96 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback UNIT MHz 305 ADVANCE INFORMATION Figure 7-67. MMC/SD/SDIO in - High Speed SDR25 - Receiver Mode AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) P = output mmc1_clk period in ns SDR501 SDR502L SDR502H mmc1_clk SDR503 SDR504 mmc1_cmd SDR507 SDR508 mmc1_dat[3:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC1_09 Figure 7-69. MMC/SD/SDIO in - High Speed SDR50 - Receiver Mode SDR501 SDR502H SDR502L mmc1_clk ADVANCE INFORMATION SDR505 SDR505 mmc1_cmd SDR506 SDR506 mmc1_dat[3:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC1_10 Figure 7-70. MMC/SD/SDIO in - High Speed SDR50 - Transmitter Mode 7.24.1.6 UHS-I SDR104, 4-bit data, half-cycle Table 7-96 presents Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC1 - SDR104 in receiver and transmitter mode (see Figure 7-71 and Figure 7-72). Table 7-96. Switching Characteristics for MMC1 - SD Card SDR104 Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX 192 UNIT SDR1041 fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc1_clk SDR1042 tw(clkH) H Pulse duration, mmc1_clk high 0.5*P0.185 (1) MHz ns SDR1042 tw(clkL) L Pulse duration, mmc1_clk low 0.5*P0.185 (1) ns SDR1045 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc1_clk falling clock edge to mmc1_cmd transition -1.09 0.49 ns SDR1046 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc1_clk falling clock edge to mmc1_dat[3:0] transition -1.09 0.49 ns (1) P = output mmc1_clk period in ns SDR1041 SDR1042L SDR1042H mmc1_clk SDR1043 SDR1044 mmc1_cmd SDR1047 SDR1048 mmc1_dat[3:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC1_11 Figure 7-71. MMC/SD/SDIO in - High Speed SDR104 - Receiver Mode 306 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 SDR1041 SDR1042H SDR1042L mmc1_clk SDR1045 SDR1045 mmc1_cmd SDR1046 SDR1046 mmc1_dat[3:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC1_12 Figure 7-72. MMC/SD/SDIO in - High Speed SDR104 - Transmitter Mode 7.24.1.7 UHS-I DDR50, 4-bit data Table 7-97 and Table 7-98 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC1 - DDR50 in receiver and transmitter mode (see Figure 7-73 and Figure 7-74). NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MODE DDR505 tsu(cmdV-clk) Setup time, mmc1_cmd valid before mmc1_clk transition DDR506 th(clk-cmdV) Hold time, mmc1_cmd valid after mmc1_clk transition DDR507 tsu(dV-clk) Setup time, mmc1_dat[3:0] valid before mmc1_clk transition Pad Loopback Internal Loopback 3.13 ns DDR508 th(clk-dV) Hold time, mmc1_dat[3:0] valid after mmc1_clk transition Pad Loopback 2 ns 1.6 ns Internal Loopback MIN MAX UNIT 3.13 ns 2 ns 3.13 ns Table 7-98. Switching Characteristics for MMC1 - SD Card DDR50 Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX DDR500 fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc1_clk DDR501 tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc1_clk high 0.5*P0.185 (1) ns DDR502 tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc1_clk low 0.5*P0.185 (1) ns DDR503 td(clk-cmdV) Delay time, mmc1_clk transition to mmc1_cmd transition 1.225 6.6 ns DDR504 td(clk-dV) Delay time, mmc1_clk transition to mmc1_dat[3:0] transition 1.225 6.6 ns 48 UNIT MHz (1) P = output mmc1_clk period in ns DDR500 DDR502 DDR501 mmc1_clk DDR505 DDR506 mmc1_cmd DDR507 DDR508 DDR507 DDR508 mmc1_dat[3:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC1_13 Figure 7-73. SDMMC - High Speed SD - DDR - Data/Command Receive Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 307 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 7-97. Timing Requirements for MMC1 - SD Card DDR50 Mode AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com DDR500 DDR501 DDR502 mmc1_clk DDR503(max) DDR503(min) mmc1_cmd DDR504(max) DDR504(max) DDR504(min) DDR504(min) mmc1_dat[3:0] MMC1_14 Figure 7-74. SDMMC - High Speed SD - DDR - Data/Command Transmit NOTE To configure the desired virtual mode the user must set MODESELECT bit and DELAYMODE bitfield for each corresponding pad control register. The pad control registers are presented in Table 4-3 and described in Device TRM, Control Module Chapter. ADVANCE INFORMATION Virtual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for MMC1. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Virtual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-99 Virtual Functions Mapping for MMC1 for a definition of the Virtual modes. Table 7-99 presents the values for DELAYMODE bitfield. Table 7-99. Virtual Functions Mapping for MMC1 BALL BALL NAME Delay Mode Value MUXMODE MMC1_ VIRTUAL1 MMC1_ VIRTUAL4 MMC1_ VIRTUAL5 MMC1_ VIRTUAL6 0 W6 mmc1_clk 15 12 11 10 mmc1_clk Y6 mmc1_cmd 15 12 11 10 mmc1_cmd AA6 mmc1_dat0 15 12 11 10 mmc1_dat0 Y4 mmc1_dat1 15 12 11 10 mmc1_dat1 AA5 mmc1_dat2 15 12 11 10 mmc1_dat2 Y3 mmc1_dat3 15 12 11 10 mmc1_dat3 NOTE To configure the desired Manual IO Timing Mode the user must follow the steps described in section Manual IO Timing Modes of the Device TRM. The associated registers to configure are listed in the CFG REGISTER column. For more information see the Control Module chapter in the Device TRM. Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for MMC1. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-100 Manual Functions Mapping for MMC1 for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-100 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. 308 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-100. Manual Functions Mapping for MMC1 W6 BALL NAME MMC1_MANUAL1 MMC1_MANUAL2 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) 0 0 - - mmc1_clk CFG REGISTER MUXMODE CFG_MMC1_CLK_IN mmc1_clk 0 Y6 mmc1_cmd 0 0 - - CFG_MMC1_CMD_IN mmc1_cmd AA6 mmc1_dat0 495 0 - - CFG_MMC1_DAT0_IN mmc1_dat0 Y4 mmc1_dat1 116 0 - - CFG_MMC1_DAT1_IN mmc1_dat1 AA5 mmc1_dat2 117 0 - - CFG_MMC1_DAT2_IN mmc1_dat2 Y3 mmc1_dat3 32 0 - - CFG_MMC1_DAT3_IN mmc1_dat3 W6 mmc1_clk 1224 0 520 320 CFG_MMC1_CLK_OUT mmc1_clk Y6 mmc1_cmd 0 0 0 0 CFG_MMC1_CMD_OUT mmc1_cmd AA6 mmc1_dat0 44 0 40 0 CFG_MMC1_DAT0_OUT mmc1_dat0 Y4 mmc1_dat1 64 0 83 0 CFG_MMC1_DAT1_OUT mmc1_dat1 AA5 mmc1_dat2 79 0 98 0 CFG_MMC1_DAT2_OUT mmc1_dat2 Y3 mmc1_dat3 87 0 106 0 CFG_MMC1_DAT3_OUT mmc1_dat3 Y6 mmc1_cmd 0 0 51 0 CFG_MMC1_CMD_OEN mmc1_cmd AA6 mmc1_dat0 0 0 0 0 CFG_MMC1_DAT0_OEN mmc1_dat0 Y4 mmc1_dat1 0 0 363 0 CFG_MMC1_DAT1_OEN mmc1_dat1 AA5 mmc1_dat2 0 0 199 0 CFG_MMC1_DAT2_OEN mmc1_dat2 Y3 mmc1_dat3 0 0 273 0 CFG_MMC1_DAT3_OEN mmc1_dat3 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL 7.24.2 MMC2 — eMMC MMC2 interface is compliant with the JC64 eMMC Standard v4.5 and it supports the following eMMC applications: • Standard JC64 SDR, 8-bit data, half cycle • High-speed JC64 SDR, 8-bit data, half cycle • High-speed HS200 JEDS84, 8-bit data, half cycle • High-speed JC64 DDR, 8-bit data NOTE For more information, see the eMMC/SD/SDIO chapter of the Device TRM. Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 309 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 7.24.2.1 Standard JC64 SDR, 8-bit data, half cycle Table 7-101 and Table 7-102 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC2 - Standart SDR in receiver and transmitter mode (see Figure 7-75 and Figure 7-76). Table 7-101. Timing Requirements for MMC2 - JC64 Standard SDR Mode NO. ADVANCE INFORMATION 310 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SSDR5 tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc2_cmd valid before mmc2_clk rising clock edge MIN SSDR6 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc2_cmd valid after mmc2_clk rising clock edge SSDR7 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc2_dat[7:0] valid before mmc2_clk rising clock edge SSDR8 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc2_dat[7:0] valid after mmc2_clk rising clock edge Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics MAX UNIT 14.53 ns 8.4 ns 14.53 ns 8.4 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-102. Switching Characteristics for MMC2 - JC64 Standard SDR Mode NO. SSDR1 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc2_clk MIN MAX UNIT 24 MHz SSDR2H tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc2_clk high 0.5*P0.172 (1) ns SSDR2L tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc2_clk low 0.5*P0.172 (1) ns SSDR3 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc2_clk falling clock edge to mmc2_cmd transition -16.96 16.96 ns SSDR4 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc2_clk falling clock edge to mmc2_dat[7:0] transition -16.96 16.96 ns (1) P = output mmc2_clk period in ns SSDR2 SSDR2 SSDR1 mmc2_clk ADVANCE INFORMATION SSDR6 SSDR5 mmc2_cmd SSDR8 SSDR7 mmc2_dat[7:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC2_01 Figure 7-75. MMC/SD/SDIO in - Standard JC64 - Receiver Mode SSDR2 SSDR2 SSDR1 mmc2_clk SSDR3 mmc2_cmd SSDR4 mmc2_dat[7:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC2_02 Figure 7-76. MMC/SD/SDIO in - Standard JC64 - Transmitter Mode 7.24.2.2 High-speed JC64 SDR, 8-bit data, half cycle Table 7-103 and Table 7-104 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC2 - High speed SDR in receiver and transmitter mode (see Figure 7-77 and Figure 7-78). Table 7-103. Timing Requirements for MMC2 - JC64 High Speed SDR Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN JC643 tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc2_cmd valid before mmc2_clk rising clock edge 6.94 ns JC644 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc2_cmd valid after mmc2_clk rising clock edge 2.6 ns JC647 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc2_dat[7:0] valid before mmc2_clk rising clock edge 6.94 ns JC648 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc2_dat[7:0] valid after mmc2_clk rising clock edge 2.6 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated MAX Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback UNIT 311 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-104. Switching Characteristics for MMC2 - JC64 High Speed SDR Mode PARAMETER DESCRIPTION JC641 NO. fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc2_clk MIN MAX UNIT 48 JC642H tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc2_clk high 0.5*P0.172 (1) MHz ns JC642L tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc2_clk low 0.5*P0.172 (1) ns JC645 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc2_clk falling clock edge to mmc2_cmd transition -6.64 6.64 ns JC646 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc2_clk falling clock edge to mmc2_dat[7:0] transition -6.64 6.64 ns (1) P = output mmc2_clk period in ns JC641 JC642L JC642H mmc2_clk JC643 JC644 mmc2_cmd ADVANCE INFORMATION JC647 JC648 mmc2_dat[7:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC2_03 Figure 7-77. MMC/SD/SDIO in - High Speed JC64 - Receiver Mode JC641 JC642L JC642H mmc2_clk JC645 JC645 mmc2_cmd JC646 JC646 mmc2_dat[7:0] MMC2_04 Figure 7-78. MMC/SD/SDIO in - High Speed JC64 - Transmitter Mode 7.24.2.3 High-speed HS200 JEDS84, 8-bit data, half cycle Table 7-105 presents Switching characteristics for MMC2 - HS200 in transmitter mode (see Figure 7-79). Table 7-105. Switching Characteristics for MMC2 - JEDS84 HS200 Mode NO. HS2001 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc2_clk MIN MAX 192 UNIT MHz HS2002H tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc2_clk high 0.5*P0.172 (1) ns HS2002L tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc2_clk low 0.5*P0.172 (1) ns HS2005 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc2_clk falling clock edge to mmc2_cmd transition -1.136 0.536 ns HS2006 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc2_clk falling clock edge to mmc2_dat[7:0] transition -1.136 0.536 ns 312 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 (1) P = output mmc2_clk period in ns HS2001 HS2002L HS2002H mmc2_clk HS2005 HS2005 mmc2_cmd HS2006 HS2006 mmc2_dat[7:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC2_05 Figure 7-79. eMMC in - HS200 SDR - Transmitter Mode 7.24.2.4 High-speed JC64 DDR, 8-bit data Table 7-106. Timing Requirements for MMC2 - JC64 High Speed DDR Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MODE MIN MAX UNIT DDR3 tsu(cmdV-clk) Setup time, mmc2_cmd valid before mmc2_clk transition 3.14 ns DDR4 th(clk-cmdV) Hold time, mmc2_cmd valid after mmc2_clk transition 1.6 ns DDR7 tsu(dV-clk) Setup time, mmc2_dat[7:0] valid before mmc2_clk transition 3.14 ns DDR8 th(clk-dV) Hold time, mmc2_dat[7:0] valid after mmc2_clk transition Pad Loopback (1.8V and 3.3V), Boot 1.6 ns Internal Loopback (1.8V with MMC2_VIRTUAL2) 1.86 ns Internal Loopback (3.3V with MMC2_VIRTUAL2) 1.95 ns Internal Loopback (1.8V with MMC2_MANUAL2) Internal Loopback (3.3V with MMC2_MANUAL2) ns 1.6 ns Table 7-107. Switching Characteristics for MMC2 - JC64 High Speed DDR Mode PARAMETER DESCRIPTION DDR1 NO. fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc2_clk DDR2H tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc2_clk high 0.5*P0.172 (1) ns DDR2L tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc2_clk low 0.5*P0.172 (1) ns DDR5 td(clk-cmdV) Delay time, mmc2_clk transition to mmc2_cmd transition 2.9 7.14 ns DDR6 td(clk-dV) Delay time, mmc2_clk transition to mmc2_dat[7:0] transition 2.9 7.14 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated MIN MAX UNIT 48 MHz Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 313 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 7-106 and Table 7-107 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC2 - High speed DDR in receiver and transmitter mode (see Figure 7-80 and Figure 7-81). AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) P = output mmc2_clk period in ns DDR1 DDR2H DDR2L mmc2_clk DDR3 DDR4 mmc2_cmd DDR8 DDR8 DDR7 DDR8 DDR7 DDR7 DDR7 mmc2_dat[7:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC2_07 Figure 7-80. MMC/SD/SDIO in - High Speed DDR JC64 - Receiver Mode DDR1 DDR2 DDR2 mmc2_clk ADVANCE INFORMATION DDR5 DDR5 DDR5 DDR5 mmc2_cmd DDR6 DDR6 DDReMMC6 DDR6 DDReMMC6 DDR6 mmc2_dat[7:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC2_08 Figure 7-81. MMC/SD/SDIO in - High Speed DDR JC64 - Transmitter Mode NOTE To configure the desired Manual IO Timing Mode the user must follow the steps described in section Manual IO Timing Modes of the Device TRM. The associated registers to configure are listed in the CFG REGISTER column. For more information see the Control Module chapter in the Device TRM. Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for MMC2. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-108 Manual Functions Mapping for MMC2 for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-108 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-108. Manual Functions Mapping for MMC2 BAL BALL NAME L MMC2_MANUAL1 A_DELAY G_DELAY (ps) (ps) MMC2_MANUAL2 MMC2_MANUAL3 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) MMC2_MANUAL3 1 K7 gpmc_a19 0 0 0 11 - - CFG_GPMC_A19_IN mmc2_dat4 M7 gpmc_a20 121 0 124 0 - - CFG_GPMC_A20_IN mmc2_dat5 J5 gpmc_a21 0 0 19 0 - - CFG_GPMC_A21_IN mmc2_dat6 K6 gpmc_a22 20 0 70 0 - - CFG_GPMC_A22_IN mmc2_dat7 J7 gpmc_a23 108 0 667 3105 - - CFG_GPMC_A23_IN mmc2_clk J4 gpmc_a24 31 0 79 0 - - CFG_GPMC_A24_IN mmc2_dat0 J6 gpmc_a25 0 0 0 0 - - CFG_GPMC_A25_IN mmc2_dat1 H4 gpmc_a26 24 0 74 0 - - CFG_GPMC_A26_IN mmc2_dat2 314 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-108. Manual Functions Mapping for MMC2 (continued) MMC2_MANUAL1 A_DELAY G_DELAY (ps) (ps) MMC2_MANUAL2 MMC2_MANUAL3 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) MMC2_MANUAL3 1 H5 gpmc_a27 0 0 0 0 - - CFG_GPMC_A27_IN mmc2_dat3 H6 gpmc_cs1 0 0 0 0 - - CFG_GPMC_CS1_IN mmc2_cmd K7 gpmc_a19 152 0 152 0 135 0 CFG_GPMC_A19_OUT mmc2_dat4 M7 gpmc_a20 206 0 206 0 189 0 CFG_GPMC_A20_OUT mmc2_dat5 J5 gpmc_a21 78 0 78 0 0 120 CFG_GPMC_A21_OUT mmc2_dat6 K6 gpmc_a22 2 0 2 0 0 70 CFG_GPMC_A22_OUT mmc2_dat7 J7 gpmc_a23 266 0 266 0 730 360 CFG_GPMC_A23_OUT J4 gpmc_a24 0 0 0 0 0 0 CFG_GPMC_A24_OUT mmc2_dat0 J6 gpmc_a25 0 0 0 0 0 0 CFG_GPMC_A25_OUT mmc2_dat1 H4 gpmc_a26 43 0 43 0 70 0 CFG_GPMC_A26_OUT mmc2_dat2 H5 gpmc_a27 0 0 0 0 0 0 CFG_GPMC_A27_OUT mmc2_dat3 H6 gpmc_cs1 0 0 0 0 0 120 CFG_GPMC_CS1_OUT mmc2_cmd mmc2_clk K7 gpmc_a19 0 0 0 0 0 0 CFG_GPMC_A19_OEN mmc2_dat4 M7 gpmc_a20 0 0 0 0 231 0 CFG_GPMC_A20_OEN mmc2_dat5 J5 gpmc_a21 0 0 0 0 39 0 CFG_GPMC_A21_OEN mmc2_dat6 K6 gpmc_a22 0 0 0 0 91 0 CFG_GPMC_A22_OEN mmc2_dat7 J4 gpmc_a24 0 0 0 0 176 0 CFG_GPMC_A24_OEN mmc2_dat0 J6 gpmc_a25 0 0 0 0 0 0 CFG_GPMC_A25_OEN mmc2_dat1 H4 gpmc_a26 0 0 0 0 101 0 CFG_GPMC_A26_OEN mmc2_dat2 H5 gpmc_a27 0 0 0 0 0 0 CFG_GPMC_A27_OEN mmc2_dat3 H6 gpmc_cs1 0 0 0 0 360 0 CFG_GPMC_CS1_OE N mmc2_cmd 7.24.3 MMC3 and MMC4—SDIO/SD MMC3 and MMC4 interfaces are compliant with the SDIO3.0 standard v1.0, SD Part E1 and for generic SDIO devices, it supports the following applications: • MMC3 8-bit data and MMC4 4-bit data, SD Default speed, SDR • MMC3 8-bit data and MMC4 4-bit data, SD High speed, SDR • MMC3 8-bit data and MMC4 4-bit data, UHS-1 SDR12 (SD Standard v3.01), 4-bit data, SDR, half cycle • MMC3 8-bit data and MMC4 4-bit data, UHS-I SDR25 (SD Standard v3.01), 4-bit data, SDR, half cycle • MMC3 8-bit data, UHS-I SDR50 NOTE The eMMC/SD/SDIOj (j = 3 to 4) controller is also referred to as MMCj. NOTE For more information, see the MMC/SDIO chapter of the Device TRM. 7.24.3.1 MMC3 and MMC4, SD Default Speed Figure 7-82, Figure 7-83, and Table 7-109 through Table 7-112 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC3 and MMC4 - SD Default speed in receiver and transmitter mode. Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 315 ADVANCE INFORMATION BAL BALL NAME L AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-109. Timing Requirements for MMC3 - Default Speed Mode (1) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION DS5 tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc3_cmd valid before mmc3_clk rising clock edge 25.83 MIN MAX UNIT ns DS6 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc3_cmd valid after mmc3_clk rising clock edge 20.9 ns DS7 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc3_dat[i:0] valid before mmc3_clk rising clock edge 25.83 ns DS8 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc3_dat[i:0] valid after mmc3_clk rising clock edge 20.9 ns (1) i in [i:0] = 7 Table 7-110. Switching Characteristics for MMC3 - SD/SDIO Default Speed Mode (2) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION DS0 fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc3_clk MIN MAX UNIT 24 MHz DS1 tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc3_clk high 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns DS2 tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc3_clk low 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns DS3 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc3_clk falling clock edge to mmc3_cmd transition -14.93 14.93 ns DS4 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc3_clk falling clock edge to mmc3_dat[i:0] transition -14.93 14.93 ns ADVANCE INFORMATION (1) P = output mmc3_clk period in ns (2) i in [i:0] = 7 Table 7-111. Timing Requirements for MMC4 - Default Speed Mode (1) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION DS5 tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc4_cmd valid before mmc4_clk rising clock edge 25.83 MIN MAX UNIT ns DS6 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc4_cmd valid after mmc4_clk rising clock edge 20.9 ns DS7 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc4_dat[i:0] valid before mmc4_clk rising clock edge 25.83 ns DS8 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc4_dat[i:0] valid after mmc4_clk rising clock edge 20.9 ns (1) i in [i:0] = 3 Table 7-112. Switching Characteristics for MMC4 - Default Speed Mode (2) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION DS0 fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc4_clk DS1 tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc4_clk high 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns DS2 tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc4_clk low 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns DS3 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc4_clk falling clock edge to mmc4_cmd transition -14.93 14.93 ns DS4 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc4_clk falling clock edge to mmc4_dat[i:0] transition -14.93 14.93 ns 316 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback MIN MAX UNIT 24 MHz Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 (1) P = output mmc4_clk period in ns (2) i in [i:0] = 3 DS2 DS1 DS0 mmcj_clk DS6 DS5 mmcj_cmd DS8 DS7 mmcj_dat[i:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC3_07 DS2 DS1 DS0 mmcj_clk DS3 mmcj_cmd DS4 mmcj_dat[i:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC3_08 Figure 7-83. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - Default Speed - Transmitter Mode 7.24.3.2 MMC3 and MMC4, SD High Speed Figure 7-84, Figure 7-85, and Table 7-113 through Table 7-116 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC3 and MMC4 - SD and SDIO High speed in receiver and transmitter mode. Table 7-113. Timing Requirements for MMC3 - SD/SDIO High Speed Mode (1) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT HS3 tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc3_cmd valid before mmc3_clk rising clock edge 6.64 ns HS4 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc3_cmd valid after mmc3_clk rising clock edge 2.6 ns HS7 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc3_dat[i:0] valid before mmc3_clk rising clock edge 6.64 ns HS8 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc3_dat[i:0] valid after mmc3_clk rising clock edge 2.6 ns (1) i in [i:0] = 7 Table 7-114. Switching Characteristics for MMC3 - SD/SDIO High Speed Mode (2) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION HS1 fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc3_clk HS2H tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc3_clk high 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns HS2L tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc3_clk low 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns HS5 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc3_clk falling clock edge to mmc3_cmd transition Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated MIN -7.6 MAX UNIT 48 MHz 3.6 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback ns 317 ADVANCE INFORMATION Figure 7-82. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - Default Speed - Receiver Mode AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-114. Switching Characteristics for MMC3 - SD/SDIO High Speed Mode (2) (continued) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT HS6 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc3_clk falling clock edge to mmc3_dat[i:0] transition -7.6 3.6 ns MAX UNIT (1) P = output mmc3_clk period in ns (2) i in [i:0] = 7 Table 7-115. Timing Requirements for MMC4 - High Speed Mode (1) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN HS3 tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc4_cmd valid before mmc4_clk rising clock edge 6.64 ns HS4 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc4_cmd valid after mmc4_clk rising clock edge 1.6 ns HS7 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc4_dat[i:0] valid before mmc4_clk rising clock edge 6.64 ns HS8 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc4_dat[i:0] valid after mmc4_clk rising clock edge 1.6 ns (1) i in [i:0] = 3 Table 7-116. Switching Characteristics for MMC4 - High Speed Mode (2) ADVANCE INFORMATION NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION HS1 fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc4_clk MIN MAX UNIT 48 HS2H tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc4_clk high 0.5*P0.270 (1) MHz ns HS2L tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc4_clk low 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns HS5 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc4_clk falling clock edge to mmc4_cmd transition -8.8 6.6 ns HS6 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc4_clk falling clock edge to mmc4_dat[i:0] transition -8.8 6.6 ns (1) P = output mmc4_clk period in ns (2) i in [i:0] = 3 HS1 HS2L HS2H mmcj_clk HS3 HS4 mmcj_cmd HS7 HS8 mmcj_dat[i:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC3_09 Figure 7-84. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - High Speed Signaling - Receiver Mode HS1 HS2H HS2L mmcj_clk HS5 HS5 mmcj_cmd HS6 HS6 mmcj_dat[i:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC3_10 Figure 7-85. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - High Speed Signaling - Transmitter Mode 318 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 7.24.3.3 MMC3 and MMC4, SD and SDIO SDR12 Mode Figure 7-86, Figure 7-87, and Table 7-117, through Table 7-120 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC3 and MMC4 - SD and SDIO SDR12 in receiver and transmitter mode. Table 7-117. Timing Requirements for MMC3 - SDR12 Mode (1) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SDR125 NO. tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc3_cmd valid before mmc3_clk rising clock edge MIN SDR126 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc3_cmd valid after mmc3_clk rising clock edge SDR127 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc3_dat[i:0] valid before mmc3_clk rising clock edge SDR128 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc3_dat[i:0] valid after mmc3_clk rising clock edge MAX UNIT 27.33 ns 1.6 ns 27.33 ns 1.6 ns (1) i in [i:0] = 7 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SDR120 NO. fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc3_clk MIN MAX UNIT 24 MHz SDR121 tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc3_clk high 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns SDR122 tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc3_clk low 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns SDR123 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc3_clk falling clock edge to mmc3_cmd transition -19.13 16.93 ns SDR124 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc3_clk falling clock edge to mmc3_dat[i:0] transition -19.13 16.93 ns MAX UNIT (1) P = output mmc3_clk period in ns (2) i in [i:0] = 7 Table 7-119. Timing Requirements for MMC4 - SDR12 Mode (1) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SDR125 NO. tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc4_cmd valid before mmc4_clk rising clock edge MIN SDR126 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc4_cmd valid after mmc4_clk rising clock edge SDR127 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc4_dat[i:0] valid before mmc4_clk rising clock edge SDR128 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc4_dat[i:0] valid after mmc4_clk rising clock edge 27.33 ns 1.6 ns 27.33 ns 1.6 ns (1) j in [i:0] = 3 Table 7-120. Switching Characteristics for MMC4 - SDR12 Mode (2) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SDR120 fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc4_clk SDR121 tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc4_clk high 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns SDR122 tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc4_clk low 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns SDR125 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc4_clk falling clock edge to mmc4_cmd transition -19.13 16.93 ns SDR126 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc4_clk falling clock edge to mmc4_dat[i:0] transition -19.13 16.93 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated MIN MAX UNIT 24 MHz Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 319 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 7-118. Switching Characteristics for MMC3 - SDR12 Mode (2) AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) P = output mmc4_clk period in ns (2) j in [i:0] = 3 SDR122 SDR121 SDR120 mmcj_clk SDR126 SDR125 mmcj_cmd SDR128 SDR127 mmcj_dat[i:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC3_11 Figure 7-86. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - SDR12 - Receiver Mode ADVANCE INFORMATION SDR122 SDR121 SDR120 mmcj_clk SDR123 mmcj_cmd SDR124 mmcj_dat[i:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC3_12 Figure 7-87. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - SDR12 - Transmitter Mode 7.24.3.4 MMC3 and MMC4, SD SDR25 Mode Figure 7-88, Figure 7-89, and Table 7-121, through Table 7-124 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC3 and MMC4 - SD and SDIO SDR25 in receiver and transmitter mode. Table 7-121. Timing Requirements for MMC3 - SDR25 Mode (1) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT SDR253 tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc3_cmd valid before mmc3_clk rising clock edge 6.64 ns SDR254 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc3_cmd valid after mmc3_clk rising clock edge 1.6 ns SDR257 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc3_dat[i:0] valid before mmc3_clk rising clock edge 6.64 ns SDR258 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc3_dat[i:0] valid after mmc3_clk rising clock edge 1.6 ns (1) i in [i:0] = 7 Table 7-122. Switching Characteristics for MMC3 - SDR25 Mode (2) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SDR251 NO. fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc3_clk SDR252 H tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc3_clk high 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns SDR252L tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc3_clk low 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns SDR255 Delay time, mmc3_clk falling clock edge to mmc3_cmd transition 320 td(clkL-cmdV) Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback MIN -8.8 MAX UNIT 48 MHz 6.6 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-122. Switching Characteristics for MMC3 - SDR25 Mode (2) (continued) NO. SDR256 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc3_clk falling clock edge to mmc3_dat[i:0] transition -8.8 6.6 ns MAX UNIT (1) P = output mmc3_clk period in ns (2) i in [i:0] = 7 Table 7-123. Timing Requirements for MMC4 - SDR25 Mode (1) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN SDR255 NO. tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc4_cmd valid before mmc4_clk rising clock edge 6.64 ns SDR256 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc4_cmd valid after mmc4_clk rising clock edge 1.6 ns SDR257 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc4_dat[i:0] valid before mmc4_clk rising clock edge 6.64 ns SDR258 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc4_dat[i:0] valid after mmc4_clk rising clock edge 1.6 ns (1) i in [i:0] = 3 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SDR251 NO. fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc4_clk MIN MAX UNIT 48 SDR252 H tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc4_clk high 0.5*P0.270 (1) MHz ns SDR252L tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc4_clk low 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns SDR255 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc4_clk falling clock edge to mmc4_cmd transition -8.8 6.6 ns SDR256 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc4_clk falling clock edge to mmc4_dat[i:0] transition -8.8 6.6 ns (1) P = output mmc4_clk period in ns (2) i in [i:0] = 3 SDR251 SDR252L SDR252H mmcj_clk SDR253 SDR254 mmcj_cmd SDR257 SDR258 mmcj_dat[i:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC3_13 Figure 7-88. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - SDR25 - Receiver Mode SDR251 SDR252H SDR252L mmcj_clk SDR255 SDR255 mmcj_cmd SDR256 SDR256 mmcj_dat[i:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC3_14 Figure 7-89. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - SDR25 - Transmitter Mode Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 321 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 7-124. Switching Characteristics for MMC4 - SDR25 Mode (2) AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 7.24.3.5 MMC3 SDIO High-Speed UHS-I SDR50 Mode, Half Cycle Figure 7-90, Figure 7-91, Table 7-125, and Table 7-126 present Timing requirements and Switching characteristics for MMC3 - SDIO High speed SDR50 in receiver and transmitter mode. Table 7-125. Timing Requirements for MMC3 - SDR50 Mode (1) PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SDR503 NO. tsu(cmdV-clkH) Setup time, mmc3_cmd valid before mmc3_clk rising clock edge 2.82 MIN MAX UNIT ns SDR504 th(clkH-cmdV) Hold time, mmc3_cmd valid after mmc3_clk rising clock edge 1.6 ns SDR507 tsu(dV-clkH) Setup time, mmc3_dat[i:0] valid before mmc3_clk rising clock edge 2.82 ns SDR508 th(clkH-dV) Hold time, mmc3_dat[i:0] valid after mmc3_clk rising clock edge 1.6 ns (1) i in [i:0] = 7 Table 7-126. Switching Characteristics for MMC3 - SDR50 Mode (2) NO. ADVANCE INFORMATION PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SDR501 fop(clk) Operating frequency, mmc3_clk MIN MAX UNIT 64 MHz SDR502 H tw(clkH) Pulse duration, mmc3_clk high 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns SDR502L tw(clkL) Pulse duration, mmc3_clk low 0.5*P0.270 (1) ns SDR505 td(clkL-cmdV) Delay time, mmc3_clk falling clock edge to mmc3_cmd transition -3.66 1.46 ns SDR506 td(clkL-dV) Delay time, mmc3_clk falling clock edge to mmc3_dat[i:0] transition -3.66 1.46 ns (1) P = output mmc3_clk period in ns (2) i in [i:0] = 7 SDR501 SDR502L SDR502H mmcj_clk SDR503 SDR504 mmcj_cmd SDR507 SDR508 mmcj_dat[7:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC3_05 Figure 7-90. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - High Speed SDR50 - Receiver Mode SDR501 SDR502H SDR502L mmcj_clk SDR505 SDR505 mmcj_cmd SDR506 SDR506 mmcj_dat[7:0] SPRS906_TIMING_MMC3_06 Figure 7-91. MMC/SD/SDIOj in - High Speed SDR50 - Transmitter Mode 322 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 NOTE To configure the desired Manual IO Timing Mode the user must follow the steps described in section Manual IO Timing Modes of the Device TRM. The associated registers to configure are listed in the CFG REGISTER column. For more information see the Control Module chapter in the Device TRM. Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for MMC3. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-127 Manual Functions Mapping for MMC3 for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-127 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-127. Manual Functions Mapping for MMC3 BALL NAME MMC3_MANUAL1 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) AD4 mmc3_clk 117 0 CFG_MMC3_CLK_IN mmc3_clk AD4 mmc3_clk AC4 mmc3_cmd 1269 0 CFG_MMC3_CLK_OUT mmc3_clk 0 0 CFG_MMC3_CMD_IN mmc3_cmd AC4 AC4 mmc3_cmd 128 0 CFG_MMC3_CMD_OEN mmc3_cmd mmc3_cmd 98 0 CFG_MMC3_CMD_OUT mmc3_cmd AC7 mmc3_dat0 0 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT0_IN mmc3_dat0 AC7 mmc3_dat0 362 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT0_OEN mmc3_dat0 AC7 mmc3_dat0 0 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT0_OUT mmc3_dat0 AC6 mmc3_dat1 0 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT1_IN mmc3_dat1 AC6 mmc3_dat1 333 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT1_OEN mmc3_dat1 AC6 mmc3_dat1 0 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT1_OUT mmc3_dat1 AC9 mmc3_dat2 0 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT2_IN mmc3_dat2 AC9 mmc3_dat2 402 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT2_OEN mmc3_dat2 AC9 mmc3_dat2 0 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT2_OUT mmc3_dat2 AC3 mmc3_dat3 0 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT3_IN mmc3_dat3 AC3 mmc3_dat3 549 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT3_OEN mmc3_dat3 AC3 mmc3_dat3 1 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT3_OUT mmc3_dat3 AC8 mmc3_dat4 0 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT4_IN mmc3_dat4 AC8 mmc3_dat4 440 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT4_OEN mmc3_dat4 AC8 mmc3_dat4 206 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT4_OUT mmc3_dat4 AD6 mmc3_dat5 0 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT5_IN mmc3_dat5 AD6 mmc3_dat5 283 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT5_OEN mmc3_dat5 AD6 mmc3_dat5 174 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT5_OUT mmc3_dat5 AB8 mmc3_dat6 0 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT6_IN mmc3_dat6 AB8 mmc3_dat6 443 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT6_OEN mmc3_dat6 AB8 mmc3_dat6 0 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT6_OUT mmc3_dat6 AB5 mmc3_dat7 0 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT7_IN mmc3_dat7 AB5 mmc3_dat7 344 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT7_OEN mmc3_dat7 AB5 mmc3_dat7 0 0 CFG_MMC3_DAT7_OUT mmc3_dat7 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated 0 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL 323 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com NOTE To configure the desired virtual mode the user must set MODESELECT bit and DELAYMODE bitfield for each corresponding pad control register. The pad control registers are presented in Table 4-3 and described in Device TRM, Control Module Chapter. 7.25 General-Purpose Interface (GPIO) The general-purpose interface combines eight general-purpose input/output (GPIO) banks. Each GPIO module provides up to 32 dedicated general-purpose pins with input and output capabilities; thus, the general-purpose interface supports up to 215 pins. ADVANCE INFORMATION These pins can be configured for the following applications: • Data input (capture)/output (drive) • Keyboard interface with a debounce cell • Interrupt generation in active mode upon the detection of external events. Detected events are processed by two parallel independent interrupt-generation submodules to support biprocessor operations • Wake-up request generation in idle mode upon the detection of external events NOTE For more information, see the General-Purpose Interface chapter of the Device TRM. NOTE The general-purpose input/output i (i = 1 to 8) bank is also referred to as GPIOi. 7.26 PRU-ICSS Interfaces The device Programmable Real-Time Unit Subsystem and Industrial Communication Subsystem (PRUICSS) consists of dual 32-bit Load / Store RISC CPU cores - Programmable Real-Time Units (PRU0 and PRU1), shared, data, and instruction memories, internal peripheral modules, and an interrupt controller (PRU-ICSS_INTC). The programmable nature of the PRUs, along with their access to pins, events and all SoC resources, provides flexibility in implementing fast real-time responses, specialized data handling operations, customer peripheral interfaces, and in off-loading tasks from the other processor cores of the system-on-chip (SoC). The each PRU-ICSS includes the following main features: • 21x Enhanced GPIs (EGPIs) and 21x Enhanced GPOs (EGPOs) with asynchronous capture and serial support per each PRU CPU core • One Ethernet MII_RT module (PRU-ICSS_MII_RT) with two MII ports and configurable connections to PRUs • 1 MDIO Port (PRU-ICSS_MII_MDIO) • One Industrial Ethernet Peripheral (IEP) to manage/generate Industrial Ethernet functions • 1 x 16550-compatible UART with a dedicated 192 MHz clock to support 12Mbps Profibus • 1 Industrial Ethernet timer with 7/9 capture and 8 compare events • 1 Enhanced Capture Module (ECAP) • 1 Interrupt Controller (PRU-ICSS_INTC) • A flexible power management support • Integrated switched central resource with programmable priority • Parity control supported by all memories 324 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 CAUTION The I/O timings provided in this section are valid only if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in the Table 7-150 and Table 7-151. NOTE For more information about PRU-ICSS subsystems interfaces, please see the device TRM. NOTE To configure the desired virtual mode the user must set MODESELECT bit and DELAYMODE bitfield for each corresponding pad control register. 7.26.1 Programmable Real-Time Unit (PRU-ICSS PRU) 7.26.1.1 PRU-ICSS PRU Direct Input/Output Mode Electrical Data and Timing Table 7-128. PRU-ICSS PRU Timing Requirements - Direct Input Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 1 tw(GPI) Pulse width, GPI MIN 2 tsk(GPI) Skew between GPI[20:0] signals 2*P MAX (1) UNIT ns 4.5 ns (1) PRUSS_GICLK clock period 1 GPI[m:0] 2 SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_01 Figure 7-92. PRU-ICSS PRU Direct Input Timing (1) m in GPI[m:0] = 20 Table 7-129. PRU-ICSS PRU Switching Requirements – Direct Output Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 1 tw(GPO) Pulse width, GPO MIN 2 tsk(GPO) Skew between GPO[20:0] signals 2*P MAX (1) UNIT ns 4.5 ns (1) PRUSS_GICLK clock period 1 GPO[n:0] 2 SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_02 Figure 7-93. PRU-ICSS PRU Direct Output Timing (1) n in GPO[n:0] = 20 7.26.1.2 PRU-ICSS PRU Parallel Capture Mode Electrical Data and Timing Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 325 ADVANCE INFORMATION The pad control registers are presented in Table 4-3 and described in Device TRM, Control Module Chapter. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-130. PRU-ICSS PRU Timing Requirements - Parallel Capture Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 1 tw(CLOCKIN) Cyle time, CLOCKIN MIN MAX 2 tw(CLOCKIN_L) Pulse duration, CLOCKIN low 9 11 ns 3 tw(CLOCKIN_H) Pulse duration, CLOCKIN high 9 11 ns 4 tsu(DATAIN-CLOCKIN) Setup time, DATAIN valid before CLOCKIN 5 th(CLOCKIN-DATAIN) Hold time, DATAIN valid after CLOCKIN 20 UNIT ns 4.5 ns 0 ns (1) PRUSS_GICLK clock period 1 3 2 CLOCKIN DATAIN ADVANCE INFORMATION 5 4 SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_03 Figure 7-94. PRU-ICSS PRU Parallel Capture Timing - Rising Edge Mode 1 3 2 CLOCKIN DATAIN 5 4 SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_04 Figure 7-95. PRU-ICSS PRU Parallel Capture Timing - Falling Edge Mode 7.26.1.3 PRU-ICSS PRU Shift Mode Electrical Data and Timing Table 7-131. PRU-ICSS PRU Timing Requirements – Shift In Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 1 tc(DATAIN) Cycle time, DATAIN MIN 2 tw(DATAIN) Pulse width, DATAIN MAX UNIT 10.00 ns (1) ns 0.45*P (1) P = 10.00ns 1 2 DATAIN SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_05 Figure 7-96. PRU-ICSS PRU Shift In Timing 326 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-132. PRU-ICSS PRU Switching Requirements - Shift Out Mode NO. 1 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION tc(CLOCKOUT) Cycle time, CLOCKOUT MIN MAX 10.00 2 tw(CLOCKOUT) Pulse width, CLOCKOUT 3 td(CLOCKOUT-DATAOUT) Delay time, CLOCKOUT to DATAOUT Valid 0.45*P UNIT ns (1) ns -3.00 3.60 ns MAX UNIT (1) P = 10.00ns 1 2 CLOCKOUT DATAOUT 3 Figure 7-97. PRU-ICSS PRU Shift Out Timing 7.26.1.4 PRU-ICSS PRU Sigma Delta and EnDAT Modes Table 7-133. PRU-ICSS PRU Timing Requirements - Sigma Delta Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 1 tw(SDx_CLK) Pulse width, SDx_CLK MIN 2 tsu(SDx_D-SDx_CLK) Setup time, SDx_D valid before SDx_CLK active edge 3 th(SDx_CLK-SDx_D) Hold time, SDx_D valid before SDx_CLK active edge 20 ns 10 ns 5 ns 1 SDx_CLK SDx_D 2 3 SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_07 Figure 7-98. PRU-ICSS PRU SD_CLK Falling Active Edge 1 SDx_CLK SDx_D 2 3 SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_08 Figure 7-99. PRU-ICSS PRU SD_CLK Rising Active Edge Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 327 ADVANCE INFORMATION SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_06 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-134. PRU-ICSS PRU Timing Requirements - EnDAT Mode NO. 1 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION tw(ENDATx_IN) Pulse width, ENDATx_IN MIN MAX 40 UNIT ns Table 7-135. PRU-ICSS PRU Switching Requirements - EnDAT Mode NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 2 tw(ENDATx_CLK) Pulse width, ENDATx_CLK MIN 3 td(ENDATx_OUTENDATx_CLK) Delay time, ENDATx_CLK fall to ENDATx_OUT 4 td(ENDATx_OUT_EN- Delay time, ENDATx_CLK Fall to ENDATx_OUT_EN ENDATx_CLK) MAX 20 UNIT ns -10 10 ns -10 10 ns ENDATx_IN 1 ADVANCE INFORMATION 2 ENDATx_CLK ENDATx_OUT 3 ENDATx_OUT_EN 4 SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_09 Figure 7-100. PRU-ICSS PRU EnDAT Timing 7.26.2 PRU-ICSS EtherCAT (PRU-ICSS ECAT) 7.26.2.1 PRU-ICSS ECAT Electrical Data and Timing Table 7-136. PRU-ICSS ECAT Timing Requirements – Input Validated With LATCH_IN NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 1 tw(EDIO_LATCH_IN) Pulse width, EDIO_LATCH_IN 2 tsu(EDIO_DATA_IN- 3 MIN MAX UNIT 100.00 ns 20.00 ns EDIO_LATCH_IN) Setup time, EDIO_DATA_IN valid before EDIO_LATCH_IN active edge th(EDIO_LATCH_IN- Hold time, EDIO_DATA_IN valid after EDIO_LATCH_IN active edge 20.00 ns EDIO_DATA_IN) 328 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 EDIO_LATCH_IN 1 2 3 EDIO_DATA_IN[7:0] SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_ECAT_01 Figure 7-101. PRU-ICSS ECAT Input Validated with LATCH_IN Timing Table 7-137. PRU-ICSS ECAT Timing Requirements – Input Validated With SYNCx PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 1 tw(EDC_SYNCx_OUT) Pulse width, EDC_SYNCx_OUT 2 tsu(EDIO_DATA_INEDC_SYNCx_OUT) th(EDC_SYNCx_OUT- 3 MIN MAX UNIT 100.00 ns Setup time, EDIO_DATA_IN valid before EDC_SYNCx_OUT active edge 20.00 ns Hold time, EDIO_DATA_IN valid after EDC_SYNCx_OUT active edge 20.00 ns ADVANCE INFORMATION NO. EDIO_DATA_IN) EDC_SYNCx_OUT 1 2 3 EDIO_DATA_IN[7:0] SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_ECAT_02 Figure 7-102. PRU-ICSS ECAT Input Validated With SYNCx Timing Table 7-138. PRU-ICSS ECAT Timing Requirements – Input Validated With Start of Frame (SOF) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX (1) (1) 4*P 5*P UNIT 1 tw(EDIO_SOF) Pulse duration, EDIO_SOF 2 tsu(EDIO_DATA_IN- Setup time, EDIO_DATA_IN valid before EDIO_SOF active edge 20.00 ns ns Hold time, EDIO_DATA_IN valid after EDIO_SOF active edge 20.00 ns EDIO_SOF) 3 th(EDIO_SOFEDIO_DATA_IN) Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 329 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) PRUSS_IEP_CLK clock period EDIO_SOF 1 2 3 EDIO_DATA_IN[7:0] SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_ECAT_03 Figure 7-103. PRU-ICSS ECAT Input Validated With SOF Table 7-139. PRU-ICSS ECAT Timing Requirements - LATCHx_IN ADVANCE INFORMATION NO. 1 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION tw(EDC_LATCHx_IN) Pulse duration, EDC_LATCHx_IN MIN 3*P MAX (1) UNIT ns (1) PRUSS_IEP_CLK clock period EDC_LATCHx_IN 1 SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_ECAT_04 Figure 7-104. PRU-ICSS ECAT LATCHx_IN Timing Table 7-140. PRU-ICSS ECAT Switching Requirements - Digital IOs NO. 1 2 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION tw(EDIO_OUTVALID) Pulse duration, EDIO_OUTVALID td(EDIO_OUTVALID- Delay time, EDIO_OUTVALID to EDIO_DATA_OUT MIN (1) MAX UNIT 32*P (1) ns 0.00 18 × P (1) ns 8 ns 14*P EDIO_DATA_OUT) 1 tsk(EDIO_DATA_OUT) EDIO_DATA_OUT skew (1) PRUSS_IEP_CLK clock period 7.26.3 PRU-ICSS MII_RT and Switch 7.26.3.1 PRU-ICSS MDIO Electrical Data and Timing Table 7-141. PRU-ICSS MDIO Timing Requirements – MDIO_DATA NO. 330 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 1 tsu(MDIO-MDC) Setup time, MDIO valid before MDC high 2 th(MDIO-MDC) Hold time, MDIO valid from MDC high Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback MIN MAX UNIT 90 ns 0 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 1 2 MDIO_CLK (Output) MDIO_DATA (Input) SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_MII_RT_01 Figure 7-105. PRU-ICSS MDIO_DATA Timing - Input Mode Table 7-142. PRU-ICSS MDIO Switching Characteristics - MDIO_CLK PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN 1 tc(MDC) Cycle time, MDC 400 MAX UNIT ns 2 tw(MDCH) Pulse duration, MDC high 160 ns 3 tw(MDCL) Pulse duration, MDC low 160 4 tt(MDC) Transition time, MDC ns 5 ns 4 1 3 2 MDIO_CLK 4 SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_MII_RT_02 Figure 7-106. PRU-ICSS MDIO_CLK Timing Table 7-143. PRU-ICSS MDIO Switching Characteristics – MDIO_DATA NO. 1 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION td(MDC-MDIO) Delay time, MDC high to MDIO valid MIN MAX UNIT 0 390 ns 1 MDIO_CLK (Output) MDIO_DATA (Output) SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_MII_RT_03 Figure 7-107. PRU-ICSS MDIO_DATA Timing – Output Mode 7.26.3.2 PRU-ICSS MII_RT Electrical Data and Timing Table 7-144. PRU-ICSS MII_RT Timing Requirements – MII[x]_RXCLK NO. 1 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SPEED MIN MAX tc(RX_CLK) Cycle time, RX_CLK 10 Mbps 399.96 400.04 ns 100 Mbps 39.996 40.004 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback UNIT 331 ADVANCE INFORMATION NO. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-144. PRU-ICSS MII_RT Timing Requirements – MII[x]_RXCLK (continued) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SPEED MIN MAX UNIT 2 tw(RX_CLKH) Pulse duration, RX_CLK high 10 Mbps 140 260 ns 3 tw(RX_CLKL) Pulse duration, RX_CLK low 100 Mbps 14 26 ns 10 Mbps 140 260 ns 100 Mbps 14 26 ns 4 1 3 2 MII_RXCLK 4 SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_MII_RT_04 Figure 7-108. PRU-ICSS MII[x]_RXCLK Timing ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 7-145. PRU-ICSS MII_RT Timing Requirements - MII[x]_TXCLK NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SPEED MIN MAX 1 tc(TX_CLK) Cycle time, TX_CLK 10 Mbps 399.96 400.04 ns 100 Mbps 39.996 40.004 ns 2 tw(TX_CLKH) Pulse duration, TX_CLK high 10 Mbps 140 260 ns 100 Mbps 14 26 ns 10 Mbps 140 260 ns 100 Mbps 14 26 ns 10 Mbps 3 ns 100 Mbps 3 ns 3 4 tw(TX_CLKL) tt(TX_CLK) Pulse duration, TX_CLK low Transition time, TX_CLK UNIT 4 1 3 2 MII_TXCLK 4 SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_MII_RT_05 Figure 7-109. PRU-ICSS MII[x]_TXCLK Timing Table 7-146. PRU-ICSS MII_RT Timing Requirements - MII_RXD[3:0], MII_RXDV, and MII_RXER NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SPEED MIN 1 tsu(RXD-RX_CLK) Setup time, RXD[3:0] valid before RX_CLK 10 Mbps 8 ns tsu(RX_DV-RX_CLK) Setup time, RX_DV valid before RX_CLK tsu(RX_ER-RX_CLK) Setup time, RX_ER valid before RX_CLK tsu(RXD-RX_CLK) Setup time, RXD[3:0] valid before RX_CLK 100 Mbps 8 ns tsu(RX_DV-RX_CLK) Setup time, RX_DV valid before RX_CLK tsu(RX_ER-RX_CLK) Setup time, RX_ER valid before RX_CLK 332 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback MAX UNIT Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-146. PRU-ICSS MII_RT Timing Requirements - MII_RXD[3:0], MII_RXDV, and MII_RXER (continued) NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SPEED MIN 2 th(RX_CLK-RXD) Hold time RXD[3:0] valid after RX_CLK 10 Mbps 8 MAX UNIT ns th(RX_CLK-RX_DV) Hold time RX_DV valid after RX_CLK th(RX_CLK-RX_ER) Hold time RX_ER valid after RX_CLK th(RX_CLK-RXD) Hold time RXD[3:0] valid after RX_CLK 100 Mbps 8 ns th(RX_CLK-RX_DV) Hold time RX_DV valid after RX_CLK th(RX_CLK-RX_ER) Hold time RX_ER valid after RX_CLK 1 2 MII_RXD[3:0], MII_RXDV, MII_RXER (Inputs) SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_MII_RT_06 Figure 7-110. PRU-ICSS MII_RXD[3:0], MII_RXDV, and MII_RXER Timing Table 7-147. PRU-ICSS MII_RT Switching Characteristics - MII_TXD[3:0] and MII_TXEN NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION SPEED MIN MAX 1 td(TX_CLK-TXD) Delay time, TX_CLK high to TXD[3:0] valid 10 Mbps 5 25 UNIT ns td(TX_CLK-TX_EN) Delay time, TX_CLK to TX_EN valid td(TX_CLK-TXD) Delay time, TX_CLK high to TXD[3:0] valid 100 Mbps 5 25 ns td(TX_CLK-TX_EN) Delay time, TX_CLK to TX_EN valid 1 MII_TXCLK (input) MII_TXD[3:0], MII_TXEN (outputs) SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_MII_RT_07 Figure 7-111. PRU-ICSS MII_TXD[3:0], MII_TXEN Timing 7.26.4 PRU-ICSS Universal Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter (PRU-ICSS UART) Table 7-148. Timing Requirements for PRU-ICSS UART Receive NO. 3 PARAMETER DESCRIPTION tw(RX) Pulse duration, receive start, stop, data bit MIN MAX UNIT (1) 1.05U ns 0.96U (1) U = UART baud time = 1/programmed baud rate. Table 7-149. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for PRU-ICSS UART Transmit NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION 1 ƒbaud(baud) Maximum programmable baud rate 2 tw(TX) Pulse duration, transmit start, stop, data bit Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated MIN MAX UNIT 0 12 MHz (1) U+2 U-2 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback ns 333 ADVANCE INFORMATION MII_MRCLK (Input) AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (1) U = UART baud time = 1/programmed baud rate. 3 2 UART_TXD Start Bit Data Bits 5 4 UART_RXD Start Bit Data Bits SPRS91x_TIMING_PRU_UART_01 Figure 7-112. PRU-ICSS UART Timing In Table 7-150 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with PRU-ICSS1. ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 7-150. PRU-ICSS1 IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL MUX pr1_pru1_gpi20 A4 12 pr1_pru1_gpi19 B5 12 pr1_pru1_gpi18 B4 12 pr1_pru1_gpi17 B3 12 pr1_pru1_gpi16 A3 12 pr1_pru1_gpi15 C5 12 pr1_pru1_gpi14 D6 12 pr1_pru1_gpi13 B2 12 pr1_pru1_gpi12 C4 12 pr1_pru1_gpi11 C3 12 pr1_pru1_gpi10 C2 12 pr1_pru1_gpo20 A4 13 pr1_pru1_gpo19 B5 13 pr1_pru1_gpo18 B4 13 pr1_pru1_gpo17 B3 13 pr1_pru1_gpo16 A3 13 pr1_pru1_gpo15 C5 13 pr1_pru1_gpo14 D6 13 pr1_pru1_gpo13 B2 13 pr1_pru1_gpo12 C4 13 pr1_pru1_gpo11 C3 13 pr1_pru1_gpo10 C2 13 pr1_pru1_gpi9 D5 12 pr1_pru1_gpi8 F6 12 pr1_pru1_gpi7 D3 12 pr1_pru1_gpi6 E6 12 pr1_pru1_gpi5 F5 12 pr1_pru1_gpi4 E4 12 pr1_pru1_gpi3 C1 12 BALL IOSET3 MUX BALL IOSET4 MUX BALL MUX PRU-ICSS 1 334 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-150. PRU-ICSS1 IOSETs (continued) IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL MUX pr1_pru1_gpi2 F4 12 pr1_pru1_gpi1 D2 12 pr1_pru1_gpi0 E2 12 pr1_pru1_gpo9 D5 13 pr1_pru1_gpo8 F6 13 pr1_pru1_gpo7 D3 13 pr1_pru1_gpo6 E6 13 pr1_pru1_gpo5 F5 13 pr1_pru1_gpo4 E4 13 pr1_pru1_gpo3 C1 13 pr1_pru1_gpo2 F4 13 pr1_pru1_gpo1 D2 13 pr1_pru1_gpo0 E2 13 BALL IOSET3 MUX BALL IOSET4 MUX BALL MUX pr1_mii1_crs A4 11 G10 12 pr1_mii1_rxlink B4 11 F11 12 pr1_mii1_col B5 11 E2 12 pr1_mii0_col V1 11 B9 12 pr1_mii0_rxlink U4 11 A9 12 pr1_mii0_crs V7 11 A10 12 pr1_edio_data_ out7 D1 13 pr1_edio_data_ out6 F3 13 pr1_edio_data_ out5 F2 13 pr1_edio_data_ out4 G6 13 pr1_edio_data_ out3 G1 13 pr1_edio_data_ out2 H7 13 pr1_edio_data_ out1 G2 13 pr1_edio_data_ out0 E1 13 pr1_edio_data_i n7 D1 12 pr1_edio_data_i n6 F3 12 pr1_edio_data_i n5 F2 12 pr1_edio_data_i n4 G6 12 pr1_edio_data_i n3 G1 12 pr1_edio_data_i n2 H7 12 pr1_edio_data_i n1 G2 12 pr1_edio_data_i n0 E1 12 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION SIGNALS 335 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-150. PRU-ICSS1 IOSETs (continued) SIGNALS IOSET1 BALL IOSET2 MUX IOSET3 BALL MUX pr1_edio_sof F4 11 pr1_edc_latch0 _in E2 11 pr1_edc_sync0_ out D2 11 pr1_uart0_cts_n G1 11 F11 10 pr1_uart0_rts_n G6 11 G10 10 BALL IOSET4 MUX BALL MUX F5 11 pr1_uart0_txd F3 11 G11 10 pr1_uart0_rxd F2 11 F10 10 pr1_ecap0_eca p_capin_apwm_ o D1 11 E9 10 pr1_mii1_txd3 F5 11 pr1_mii1_txd2 E6 11 E6 11 pr1_mii1_txd1 D5 11 D2 13 pr1_mii1_txd0 C2 11 F4 13 pr1_mii1_rxd3 B2 11 E9 12 pr1_mii1_rxd2 D6 11 F9 12 pr1_mii1_rxd1 C5 11 F8 12 pr1_mii1_rxd0 A3 11 E7 12 pr1_mii1_rxdv C4 11 G11 12 pr1_mii1_txen E4 11 E4 11 pr1_mii1_rxer B3 11 E11 12 pr1_mii_mr1_clk C3 11 F10 12 pr1_mii_mt1_clk C1 11 C1 11 pr1_mii0_txd3 V5 11 D9 13 pr1_mii0_txd2 V4 11 D7 13 pr1_mii0_txd1 Y2 11 A5 13 pr1_mii0_txd0 W2 11 C6 13 pr1_mii0_rxd3 W9 11 B7 12 pr1_mii0_rxd2 V9 11 B8 12 pr1_mii0_rxd1 V6 11 A7 12 pr1_mii0_rxd0 U6 11 A8 12 pr1_mii0_rxdv V2 11 C7 12 pr1_mii0_txen V3 11 D8 13 pr1_mii0_rxer U7 11 C9 12 PRU-ICSS 1 MII ADVANCE INFORMATION pr1_mii_mt0_clk U5 11 E8 12 pr1_mii_mr0_clk Y1 11 C8 12 pr1_mdio_mdclk D3 11 pr1_mdio_data F6 11 336 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 In Table 7-151, Table 7-152 and Table 7-153 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with PRU-ICSS2. Table 7-151. PRU-ICSS2 IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET1 BALL IOSET2 MUX BALL MUX F10 12 F10 12 pr2_pru1_gpi19 G10 12 G10 12 pr2_pru1_gpi18 F11 12 F11 12 pr2_pru1_gpi17 E11 12 E11 12 pr2_pru1_gpi16 W2 12 G14 12 pr2_pru1_gpi15 Y2 12 A13 12 pr2_pru1_gpi14 V3 12 E14 12 pr2_pru1_gpi13 V4 12 A12 12 pr2_pru1_gpi12 V5 12 B13 12 pr2_pru1_gpi11 U5 12 A11 12 pr2_pru1_gpi10 U6 12 B12 12 pr2_pru1_gpi9 V6 12 F12 12 pr2_pru1_gpi8 U7 12 G12 12 pr2_pru1_gpi7 V7 12 C14 12 pr2_pru1_gpi6 V9 12 E17 12 pr2_pru1_gpi5 W9 12 D18 12 pr2_pru1_gpi4 Y1 12 AA4 12 pr2_pru1_gpi3 V2 12 AB3 12 pr2_pru1_gpi2 U3 12 AB9 12 pr2_pru1_gpi1 U4 12 AA3 12 pr2_pru1_gpi0 V1 12 D17 12 pr2_pru1_gpo20 F10 13 F10 13 pr2_pru1_gpo19 G10 13 G10 13 pr2_pru1_gpo18 F11 13 F11 13 pr2_pru1_gpo17 E11 13 E11 13 pr2_pru1_gpo16 W2 13 G14 13 pr2_pru1_gpo15 Y2 13 A13 13 pr2_pru1_gpo14 V3 13 E14 13 pr2_pru1_gpo13 V4 13 A12 13 pr2_pru1_gpo12 V5 13 B13 13 pr2_pru1_gpo11 U5 13 A11 13 pr2_pru1_gpo10 U6 13 B12 13 pr2_pru1_gpo9 V6 13 F12 13 pr2_pru1_gpo8 U7 13 G12 13 pr2_pru1_gpo7 V7 13 C14 13 pr2_pru1_gpo6 V9 13 E17 13 pr2_pru1_gpo5 W9 13 D18 13 pr2_pru1_gpo4 Y1 13 AA4 13 pr2_pru1_gpo3 V2 13 AB3 13 pr2_pru1_gpo2 U3 13 AB9 13 pr2_pru1_gpo1 U4 13 AA3 13 pr2_pru1_gpo0 V1 13 D17 13 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback ADVANCE INFORMATION PRU-ICSS 2 pr2_pru1_gpi20 337 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-151. PRU-ICSS2 IOSETs (continued) SIGNALS ADVANCE INFORMATION 338 IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL MUX BALL MUX pr2_pru0_gpi20 A10 pr2_pru0_gpi19 B9 12 F14 12 12 A18 pr2_pru0_gpi18 12 A9 12 A19 12 pr2_pru0_gpi17 C9 12 A16 12 pr2_pru0_gpi16 A8 12 C15 12 pr2_pru0_gpi15 A7 12 C17 12 pr2_pru0_gpi14 B8 12 B19 12 pr2_pru0_gpi13 B7 12 F15 12 pr2_pru0_gpi12 C7 12 B18 12 pr2_pru0_gpi11 C8 12 AB5 12 pr2_pru0_gpi10 C6 12 AB8 12 pr2_pru0_gpi9 A5 12 AD6 12 pr2_pru0_gpi8 D8 12 AC8 12 pr2_pru0_gpi7 D7 12 AC3 12 pr2_pru0_gpi6 D9 12 AC9 12 pr2_pru0_gpi5 E8 12 AC6 12 pr2_pru0_gpi4 E7 12 AC7 12 pr2_pru0_gpi3 F8 12 AC4 12 pr2_pru0_gpi2 F9 12 AD4 12 pr2_pru0_gpi1 E9 12 AB4 12 pr2_pru0_gpi0 G11 12 AC5 12 pr2_pru0_gpo20 A10 13 F14 13 pr2_pru0_gpo19 B9 13 A18 13 pr2_pru0_gpo18 A9 13 A19 13 pr2_pru0_gpo17 C9 13 A16 13 pr2_pru0_gpo16 A8 13 C15 13 pr2_pru0_gpo15 A7 13 C17 13 pr2_pru0_gpo14 B8 13 B19 13 pr2_pru0_gpo13 B7 13 F15 13 pr2_pru0_gpo12 C7 13 B18 13 pr2_pru0_gpo11 C8 13 AB5 13 pr2_pru0_gpo10 C6 13 AB8 13 pr2_pru0_gpo9 A5 13 AD6 13 pr2_pru0_gpo8 D8 13 AC8 13 pr2_pru0_gpo7 D7 13 AC3 13 pr2_pru0_gpo6 D9 13 AC9 13 pr2_pru0_gpo5 E8 13 AC6 13 pr2_pru0_gpo4 E7 13 AC7 13 pr2_pru0_gpo3 F8 13 AC4 13 pr2_pru0_gpo2 F9 13 AD4 13 pr2_pru0_gpo1 E9 13 AB4 13 pr2_pru0_gpo0 G11 13 AC5 13 pr2_mii1_crs E17 11 pr2_mii1_rxlink C17 11 pr2_mii0_crs B18 11 pr2_mii0_rxlink A16 11 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-151. PRU-ICSS2 IOSETs (continued) IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL MUX pr2_mii0_col F15 11 pr2_mii1_col D18 11 pr2_edio_data_out7 A10 11 pr2_edio_data_out6 B9 11 pr2_edio_data_out5 A9 11 pr2_edio_data_out4 C9 11 pr2_edio_data_out3 A8 11 pr2_edio_data_out2 A7 11 pr2_edio_data_out1 B8 11 pr2_edio_data_out0 B7 11 pr2_edio_data_in7 A10 10 pr2_edio_data_in6 B9 10 pr2_edio_data_in5 A9 10 pr2_edio_data_in4 C9 10 pr2_edio_data_in3 A8 10 pr2_edio_data_in2 A7 10 pr2_edio_data_in1 B8 10 pr2_edio_data_in0 B7 10 pr2_edio_latch_in D9 10 pr2_edio_sof D7 10 pr2_edc_sync0_out E7 10 pr2_edc_sync1_out E8 10 pr2_edc_latch0_in F9 10 pr2_edc_latch1_in F8 10 pr2_uart0_rxd C6 10 pr2_uart0_txd C8 10 pr2_uart0_cts_n D8 10 pr2_uart0_rts_n A5 10 pr2_ecap0_ecap_capin_apwm_ o C7 10 pr2_mii1_txd3 AD4 11 pr2_mii1_txd2 AC4 11 pr2_mii1_txd1 AC7 11 pr2_mii1_txd0 AC6 11 pr2_mii1_rxd3 AC8 11 pr2_mii1_rxd2 AD6 11 pr2_mii1_rxd1 AB8 11 pr2_mii1_rxd0 AB5 11 pr2_mii_mr1_clk AC9 11 BALL MUX ADVANCE INFORMATION SIGNALS PRU-ICSS 2 MII pr2_mii1_rxer B19 11 pr2_mii_mt1_clk AC5 11 pr2_mii1_rxdv AC3 11 pr2_mii1_txen AB4 11 pr2_mii0_txd3 A11 11 pr2_mii0_txd2 B13 11 pr2_mii0_txd1 A12 11 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 339 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-151. PRU-ICSS2 IOSETs (continued) SIGNALS IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL MUX pr2_mii0_txd0 E14 11 pr2_mii0_rxd3 F14 11 pr2_mii0_rxd2 A19 11 pr2_mii0_rxd1 A18 11 pr2_mii0_rxd0 C15 11 pr2_mii_mr0_clk A13 11 BALL MUX pr2_mii0_rxer G12 11 pr2_mii_mt0_clk F12 11 pr2_mii0_rxdv G14 11 pr2_mii0_txen B12 11 pr2_mdio_mdclk C14 11 AB3 11 pr2_mdio_data D14 11 AA4 11 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 7-152. PRU-ICSS2 IOSETs (EnDAT)(1) SIGNALS IOSET3 BALL IOSET4 MUX BALL MUX PRU-ICSS 2 EnDAT pr2_pru1_endat0_clk V1 13 D17 13 pr2_pru1_endat0_out U4 13 AA3 13 pr2_pru1_endat0_out_en U3 13 AB9 13 pr2_pru1_endat1_clk V2 13 AB3 13 pr2_pru1_endat1_out Y1 13 AA4 13 pr2_pru1_endat1_out_en W9 13 D18 13 pr2_pru1_endat2_clk V9 13 E17 13 pr2_pru1_endat2_out V7 13 C14 13 pr2_pru1_endat2_out_en U7 13 G12 13 pr2_pru1_endat0_in V6 12 F12 12 pr2_pru1_endat1_in U6 12 B12 12 pr2_pru1_endat2_in U5 12 A11 12 (1) These signals are internally muxed with the PRU GPI/GPO signals. Refer to the PRU chapter in the TRM for more details about the PRU-ICSS internal wrapper multiplexing. Table 7-153. PRU-ICSS2 IOSETs (Sigma Delta)(1) SIGNALS IOSET3 BALL IOSET4 MUX BALL MUX PRU-ICSS 2 SD 340 pr2_pru0_sd0_clk G11 12 AC5 12 pr2_pru0_sd0_d E9 12 AB4 12 pr2_pru0_sd1_clk F9 12 AD4 12 pr2_pru0_sd1_d F8 12 AC4 12 pr2_pru0_sd2_clk E7 12 AC7 12 pr2_pru0_sd2_d E8 12 AC6 12 pr2_pru0_sd3_clk D9 12 AC9 12 pr2_pru0_sd3_d D7 12 AC3 12 pr2_pru0_sd4_clk D8 12 AC8 12 pr2_pru0_sd4_d A5 12 AD6 12 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-153. PRU-ICSS2 IOSETs (Sigma Delta)(1) (continued) SIGNALS IOSET3 IOSET4 BALL MUX BALL MUX pr2_pru0_sd5_clk C6 12 AB8 12 pr2_pru0_sd5_d C8 12 AB5 12 pr2_pru0_sd6_clk C7 12 B18 12 pr2_pru0_sd6_d B7 12 F15 12 pr2_pru0_sd7_clk B8 12 B19 12 pr2_pru0_sd7_d A7 12 C17 12 pr2_pru0_sd8_clk A8 12 C15 12 pr2_pru0_sd8_d C9 12 A16 12 (1) These signals are internally muxed with the PRU GPI/GPO signals. Refer to the PRU chapter in the TRM for more details about the PRU-ICSS internal wrapper multiplexing. NOTE To configure the desired Manual IO Timing Mode the user must follow the steps described in section "Manual IO Timing Modes" of the Device TRM. The associated registers to configure are listed in the CFG REGISTER column. For more information see the Control Module Chapter in the Device TRM. Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for PRU-ICSS1 PRU1 Direct Input mode. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-154 Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS1 PRU1 Direct Input mode for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-154 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-154. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS1 PRU1 Direct Input mode BALL BALL NAME PR1_PRU1_DIR_IN_MANUAL A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) CFG REGISTER MUXMODE 12 D3 vin2a_d10 0 800 CFG_VIN2A_D10_IN pr1_pru1_gpi7 F6 vin2a_d11 0 0 CFG_VIN2A_D11_IN pr1_pru1_gpi8 D5 vin2a_d12 0 200 CFG_VIN2A_D12_IN pr1_pru1_gpi9 C2 vin2a_d13 0 0 CFG_VIN2A_D13_IN pr1_pru1_gpi10 C3 vin2a_d14 0 0 CFG_VIN2A_D14_IN pr1_pru1_gpi11 C4 vin2a_d15 0 400 CFG_VIN2A_D15_IN pr1_pru1_gpi12 B2 vin2a_d16 0 300 CFG_VIN2A_D16_IN pr1_pru1_gpi13 D6 vin2a_d17 0 400 CFG_VIN2A_D17_IN pr1_pru1_gpi14 C5 vin2a_d18 0 900 CFG_VIN2A_D18_IN pr1_pru1_gpi15 A3 vin2a_d19 0 1500 CFG_VIN2A_D19_IN pr1_pru1_gpi16 B3 vin2a_d20 0 100 CFG_VIN2A_D20_IN pr1_pru1_gpi17 B4 vin2a_d21 0 500 CFG_VIN2A_D21_IN pr1_pru1_gpi18 B5 vin2a_d22 0 500 CFG_VIN2A_D22_IN pr1_pru1_gpi19 A4 vin2a_d23 0 600 CFG_VIN2A_D23_IN pr1_pru1_gpi20 E2 vin2a_d3 0 900 CFG_VIN2A_D3_IN pr1_pru1_gpi0 D2 vin2a_d4 0 100 CFG_VIN2A_D4_IN pr1_pru1_gpi1 F4 vin2a_d5 0 600 CFG_VIN2A_D5_IN pr1_pru1_gpi2 C1 vin2a_d6 0 200 CFG_VIN2A_D6_IN pr1_pru1_gpi3 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 341 ADVANCE INFORMATION 7.26.5 PRU-ICSS Manual Functional Mapping AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-154. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS1 PRU1 Direct Input mode (continued) BALL BALL NAME PR1_PRU1_DIR_IN_MANUAL A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) CFG REGISTER MUXMODE 12 E4 vin2a_d7 0 400 CFG_VIN2A_D7_IN pr1_pru1_gpi4 F5 vin2a_d8 0 500 CFG_VIN2A_D8_IN pr1_pru1_gpi5 E6 vin2a_d9 0 600 CFG_VIN2A_D9_IN pr1_pru1_gpi6 Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for PRU-ICSS1 PRU1 Direct Output mode. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-155 Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS1 PRU1 Direct Output mode for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-155 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-155. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS1 PRU1 Direct Output mode ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL BALL NAME PR1_PRU1_DIR_OUT_MANUAL CFG REGISTER MUXMODE A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) D3 vin2a_d10 0 1000 CFG_VIN2A_D10_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo7 13 F6 vin2a_d11 0 1300 CFG_VIN2A_D11_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo8 D5 vin2a_d12 0 2300 CFG_VIN2A_D12_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo9 C2 vin2a_d13 0 2200 CFG_VIN2A_D13_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo10 C3 vin2a_d14 0 1800 CFG_VIN2A_D14_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo11 C4 vin2a_d15 0 1800 CFG_VIN2A_D15_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo12 B2 vin2a_d16 0 1600 CFG_VIN2A_D16_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo13 D6 vin2a_d17 0 2000 CFG_VIN2A_D17_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo14 C5 vin2a_d18 0 700 CFG_VIN2A_D18_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo15 A3 vin2a_d19 0 700 CFG_VIN2A_D19_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo16 B3 vin2a_d20 0 500 CFG_VIN2A_D20_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo17 B4 vin2a_d21 0 400 CFG_VIN2A_D21_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo18 B5 vin2a_d22 0 0 CFG_VIN2A_D22_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo19 A4 vin2a_d23 0 400 CFG_VIN2A_D23_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo20 E2 vin2a_d3 0 2200 CFG_VIN2A_D3_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo0 D2 vin2a_d4 540 2800 CFG_VIN2A_D4_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo1 F4 vin2a_d5 0 400 CFG_VIN2A_D5_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo2 C1 vin2a_d6 0 1500 CFG_VIN2A_D6_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo3 E4 vin2a_d7 0 2200 CFG_VIN2A_D7_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo4 F5 vin2a_d8 0 2600 CFG_VIN2A_D8_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo5 E6 vin2a_d9 0 2300 CFG_VIN2A_D9_OUT pr1_pru1_gpo6 Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET1 Direct Input mode. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-156 Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET1 Direct Input mode for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-156 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-156. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET1 Direct Input mode BALL D7 342 BALL NAME vout1_d10 PR2_PRU0_DIR_IN_MANUAL1 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) 0 0 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback CFG REGISTER MUXMODE CFG_VOUT1_D10_IN pr2_pru0_gpi7 12 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-156. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET1 Direct Input mode (continued) BALL NAME PR2_PRU0_DIR_IN_MANUAL1 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) CFG REGISTER MUXMODE 12 D8 vout1_d11 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D11_IN A5 vout1_d12 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D12_IN pr2_pru0_gpi8 pr2_pru0_gpi9 C6 vout1_d13 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D13_IN pr2_pru0_gpi10 C8 vout1_d14 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D14_IN pr2_pru0_gpi11 C7 vout1_d15 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D15_IN pr2_pru0_gpi12 B7 vout1_d16 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D16_IN pr2_pru0_gpi13 B8 vout1_d17 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D17_IN pr2_pru0_gpi14 A7 vout1_d18 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D18_IN pr2_pru0_gpi15 A8 vout1_d19 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D19_IN pr2_pru0_gpi16 C9 vout1_d20 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D20_IN pr2_pru0_gpi17 A9 vout1_d21 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D21_IN pr2_pru0_gpi18 B9 vout1_d22 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D22_IN pr2_pru0_gpi19 A10 vout1_d23 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D23_IN pr2_pru0_gpi20 G11 vout1_d3 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D3_IN pr2_pru0_gpi0 E9 vout1_d4 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D4_IN pr2_pru0_gpi1 F9 vout1_d5 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D5_IN pr2_pru0_gpi2 F8 vout1_d6 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D6_IN pr2_pru0_gpi3 E7 vout1_d7 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D7_IN pr2_pru0_gpi4 E8 vout1_d8 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D8_IN pr2_pru0_gpi5 D9 vout1_d9 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D9_IN pr2_pru0_gpi6 Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET2 Direct Input mode. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-157 Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET2 Direct Input mode for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-157 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-157. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET2 Direct Input mode BALL BALL NAME PR2_PRU0_DIR_IN_MANUAL2 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) AC5 gpio6_10 1000 3300 CFG_GPIO6_10_IN pr2_pru0_gpi0 AB4 gpio6_11 1000 3400 CFG_GPIO6_11_IN pr2_pru0_gpi1 12 F14 mcasp1_axr15 0 1300 CFG_MCASP1_AXR15_IN pr2_pru0_gpi20 A19 mcasp2_aclkx 0 800 CFG_MCASP2_ACLKX_IN pr2_pru0_gpi18 C15 mcasp2_axr2 0 1900 CFG_MCASP2_AXR2_IN pr2_pru0_gpi16 A16 mcasp2_axr3 0 1400 CFG_MCASP2_AXR3_IN pr2_pru0_gpi17 A18 mcasp2_fsx 0 1400 CFG_MCASP2_FSX_IN pr2_pru0_gpi19 B19 mcasp3_axr0 0 1400 CFG_MCASP3_AXR0_IN pr2_pru0_gpi14 C17 mcasp3_axr1 0 1000 CFG_MCASP3_AXR1_IN pr2_pru0_gpi15 F15 mcasp3_fsx 0 1300 CFG_MCASP3_FSX_IN pr2_pru0_gpi13 AD4 mmc3_clk 1000 3700 CFG_MMC3_CLK_IN pr2_pru0_gpi2 AC4 mmc3_cmd 1000 3500 CFG_MMC3_CMD_IN pr2_pru0_gpi3 AC7 mmc3_dat0 1000 3500 CFG_MMC3_DAT0_IN pr2_pru0_gpi4 AC6 mmc3_dat1 1000 4000 CFG_MMC3_DAT1_IN pr2_pru0_gpi5 AC9 mmc3_dat2 1000 3300 CFG_MMC3_DAT2_IN pr2_pru0_gpi6 AC3 mmc3_dat3 1000 3900 CFG_MMC3_DAT3_IN pr2_pru0_gpi7 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 343 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-157. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET2 Direct Input mode (continued) BALL BALL NAME PR2_PRU0_DIR_IN_MANUAL2 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) CFG REGISTER MUXMODE 12 AC8 mmc3_dat4 1000 3500 CFG_MMC3_DAT4_IN AD6 mmc3_dat5 1000 3600 CFG_MMC3_DAT5_IN pr2_pru0_gpi8 pr2_pru0_gpi9 AB8 mmc3_dat6 1000 3500 CFG_MMC3_DAT6_IN pr2_pru0_gpi10 AB5 mmc3_dat7 1000 3100 CFG_MMC3_DAT7_IN pr2_pru0_gpi11 B18 mcasp3_aclkx 0 0 CFG_MCASP3_ACLKX_IN pr2_pru0_gpi12 Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET1 Direct Output mode. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-158 Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET1 Direct Output mode for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-158 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-158. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET1 Direct Output mode ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL BALL NAME PR2_PRU0_DIR_OUT_MANUAL1 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE 600 CFG_VOUT1_D10_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo7 pr2_pru0_gpo8 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) 0 13 D7 vout1_d10 D8 vout1_d11 0 700 CFG_VOUT1_D11_OUT A5 vout1_d12 1200 200 CFG_VOUT1_D12_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo9 C6 vout1_d13 0 600 CFG_VOUT1_D13_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo10 C8 vout1_d14 200 300 CFG_VOUT1_D14_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo11 C7 vout1_d15 400 0 CFG_VOUT1_D15_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo12 B7 vout1_d16 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D16_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo13 B8 vout1_d17 0 300 CFG_VOUT1_D17_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo14 A7 vout1_d18 120 300 CFG_VOUT1_D18_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo15 A8 vout1_d19 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D19_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo16 C9 vout1_d20 250 200 CFG_VOUT1_D20_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo17 A9 vout1_d21 300 200 CFG_VOUT1_D21_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo18 B9 vout1_d22 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D22_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo19 A10 vout1_d23 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D23_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo20 G11 vout1_d3 920 0 CFG_VOUT1_D3_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo0 E9 vout1_d4 1500 300 CFG_VOUT1_D4_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo1 F9 vout1_d5 460 100 CFG_VOUT1_D5_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo2 F8 vout1_d6 300 300 CFG_VOUT1_D6_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo3 E7 vout1_d7 160 0 CFG_VOUT1_D7_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo4 E8 vout1_d8 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D8_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo5 D9 vout1_d9 0 1200 CFG_VOUT1_D9_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo6 Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET2 Direct Output mode. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-159 Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET2 Direct Output mode for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-159 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. 344 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-159. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU0 IOSET2 Direct Output mode BALL NAME PR2_PRU0_DIR_OUT_MANUAL2 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) CFG REGISTER MUXMODE 13 AC5 gpio6_10 1800 1900 CFG_GPIO6_10_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo0 AB4 gpio6_11 2500 2100 CFG_GPIO6_11_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo1 F14 mcasp1_axr15 0 400 CFG_MCASP1_AXR15_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo20 A19 mcasp2_aclkx 0 400 CFG_MCASP2_ACLKX_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo18 C15 mcasp2_axr2 0 500 CFG_MCASP2_AXR2_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo16 A16 mcasp2_axr3 0 500 CFG_MCASP2_AXR3_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo17 A18 mcasp2_fsx 0 0 CFG_MCASP2_FSX_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo19 B18 mcasp3_aclkx 0 500 CFG_MCASP3_ACLKX_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo12 B19 mcasp3_axr0 0 0 CFG_MCASP3_AXR0_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo14 C17 mcasp3_axr1 0 200 CFG_MCASP3_AXR1_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo15 F15 mcasp3_fsx 0 300 CFG_MCASP3_FSX_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo13 AD4 mmc3_clk 2100 2200 CFG_MMC3_CLK_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo2 AC4 mmc3_cmd 2300 2300 CFG_MMC3_CMD_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo3 AC7 mmc3_dat0 2000 1600 CFG_MMC3_DAT0_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo4 AC6 mmc3_dat1 2000 1700 CFG_MMC3_DAT1_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo5 AC9 mmc3_dat2 2050 2200 CFG_MMC3_DAT2_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo6 AC3 mmc3_dat3 2000 2000 CFG_MMC3_DAT3_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo7 AC8 mmc3_dat4 2150 2600 CFG_MMC3_DAT4_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo8 AD6 mmc3_dat5 2400 2600 CFG_MMC3_DAT5_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo9 AB8 mmc3_dat6 2200 2300 CFG_MMC3_DAT6_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo10 AB5 mmc3_dat7 1800 2400 CFG_MMC3_DAT7_OUT pr2_pru0_gpo11 Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET1 Direct Input mode. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-160 Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET1 Direct Input mode for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-160 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-160. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET1 Direct Input mode BALL BALL NAME PR2_PRU1_DIR_IN_MANUAL1 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) RMII_MHZ_50_CL K 1400 1200 U4 mdio_d 1300 V1 mdio_mclk 1400 U5 rgmii0_rxc 1400 V5 rgmii0_rxctl 1400 W2 rgmii0_rxd0 1400 Y2 rgmii0_rxd1 V3 rgmii0_rxd2 V4 U3 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE 12 CFG_RMII_MHZ_50_CLK_IN pr2_pru1_gpi2 1600 CFG_MDIO_D_IN pr2_pru1_gpi1 800 CFG_MDIO_MCLK_IN pr2_pru1_gpi0 500 CFG_RGMII0_RXC_IN pr2_pru1_gpi11 1800 CFG_RGMII0_RXCTL_IN pr2_pru1_gpi12 1300 CFG_RGMII0_RXD0_IN pr2_pru1_gpi16 1400 1650 CFG_RGMII0_RXD1_IN pr2_pru1_gpi15 1400 1400 CFG_RGMII0_RXD2_IN pr2_pru1_gpi14 rgmii0_rxd3 1400 1650 CFG_RGMII0_RXD3_IN pr2_pru1_gpi13 W9 rgmii0_txc 1400 900 CFG_RGMII0_TXC_IN pr2_pru1_gpi5 V9 rgmii0_txctl 1400 1300 CFG_RGMII0_TXCTL_IN pr2_pru1_gpi6 U6 rgmii0_txd0 1400 900 CFG_RGMII0_TXD0_IN pr2_pru1_gpi10 V6 rgmii0_txd1 1300 1400 CFG_RGMII0_TXD1_IN pr2_pru1_gpi9 U7 rgmii0_txd2 1300 1100 CFG_RGMII0_TXD2_IN pr2_pru1_gpi8 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 345 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-160. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET1 Direct Input mode (continued) BALL BALL NAME PR2_PRU1_DIR_IN_MANUAL1 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) CFG REGISTER MUXMODE 12 V7 rgmii0_txd3 1300 1300 CFG_RGMII0_TXD3_IN pr2_pru1_gpi7 V2 uart3_rxd 1300 1000 CFG_UART3_RXD_IN pr2_pru1_gpi3 Y1 uart3_txd 1300 800 CFG_UART3_TXD_IN pr2_pru1_gpi4 E11 vout1_vsync 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_VSYNC_IN pr2_pru1_gpi17 F11 vout1_d0 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D0_IN pr2_pru1_gpi18 G10 vout1_d1 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D1_IN pr2_pru1_gpi19 F10 vout1_d2 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D2_IN pr2_pru1_gpi20 Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET2 Direct Input mode. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-161 Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET2 Direct Input mode for a definition of the Manual modes. ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 7-161 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-161. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET2 Direct Input mode BALL BALL NAME PR2_PRU1_DIR_IN_MANUAL2 CFG REGISTER MUXMODE A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) C14 mcasp1_aclkx 400 0 CFG_MCASP1_ACLKX_IN pr2_pru1_gpi7 G12 mcasp1_axr0 700 200 CFG_MCASP1_AXR0_IN pr2_pru1_gpi8 12 F12 mcasp1_axr1 600 300 CFG_MCASP1_AXR1_IN pr2_pru1_gpi9 B13 mcasp1_axr10 600 500 CFG_MCASP1_AXR10_IN pr2_pru1_gpi12 A12 mcasp1_axr11 700 500 CFG_MCASP1_AXR11_IN pr2_pru1_gpi13 E14 mcasp1_axr12 500 0 CFG_MCASP1_AXR12_IN pr2_pru1_gpi14 A13 mcasp1_axr13 600 200 CFG_MCASP1_AXR13_IN pr2_pru1_gpi15 G14 mcasp1_axr14 600 0 CFG_MCASP1_AXR14_IN pr2_pru1_gpi16 E11 vout1_vsync 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_VSYNC_IN pr2_pru1_gpi17 F11 vout1_d0 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D0_IN pr2_pru1_gpi18 G10 vout1_d1 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D1_IN pr2_pru1_gpi19 F10 vout1_d2 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D2_IN pr2_pru1_gpi20 B12 mcasp1_axr8 800 0 CFG_MCASP1_AXR8_IN pr2_pru1_gpi10 A11 mcasp1_axr9 600 300 CFG_MCASP1_AXR9_IN pr2_pru1_gpi11 D17 mcasp4_axr1 500 0 CFG_MCASP4_AXR1_IN pr2_pru1_gpi0 AA3 mcasp5_aclkx 2100 1959 CFG_MCASP5_ACLKX_IN pr2_pru1_gpi1 AB3 mcasp5_axr0 2300 2000 CFG_MCASP5_AXR0_IN pr2_pru1_gpi3 AA4 mcasp5_axr1 2300 1800 CFG_MCASP5_AXR1_IN pr2_pru1_gpi4 AB9 mcasp5_fsx 2100 1780 CFG_MCASP5_FSX_IN pr2_pru1_gpi2 D18 xref_clk0 0 0 CFG_XREF_CLK0_IN pr2_pru1_gpi5 E17 xref_clk1 0 0 CFG_XREF_CLK1_IN pr2_pru1_gpi6 Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET1 Direct Output mode. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-162 Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET1 Direct Output mode for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-162 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. 346 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-162. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET1 Direct Output mode BALL NAME PR2_PRU1_DIR_OUT_MANUAL1 A_DELAY (ps) G_DELAY (ps) CFG REGISTER MUXMODE 13 U3 RMII_MHZ_50_CLK 2306 100 CFG_RMII_MHZ_50_CLK_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo2 U4 mdio_d 1900 2000 CFG_MDIO_D_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo1 V1 mdio_mclk 2000 1100 CFG_MDIO_MCLK_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo0 U5 rgmii0_rxc 2000 1200 CFG_RGMII0_RXC_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo11 V5 rgmii0_rxctl 2000 1700 CFG_RGMII0_RXCTL_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo12 W2 rgmii0_rxd0 2000 1000 CFG_RGMII0_RXD0_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo16 Y2 rgmii0_rxd1 2200 1000 CFG_RGMII0_RXD1_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo15 V3 rgmii0_rxd2 2200 1300 CFG_RGMII0_RXD2_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo14 V4 rgmii0_rxd3 2250 1100 CFG_RGMII0_RXD3_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo13 W9 rgmii0_txc 2350 1000 CFG_RGMII0_TXC_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo5 V9 rgmii0_txctl 2000 1200 CFG_RGMII0_TXCTL_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo6 U6 rgmii0_txd0 2000 1500 CFG_RGMII0_TXD0_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo10 V6 rgmii0_txd1 1850 1000 CFG_RGMII0_TXD1_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo9 U7 rgmii0_txd2 2100 1100 CFG_RGMII0_TXD2_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo8 V7 rgmii0_txd3 2200 1000 CFG_RGMII0_TXD3_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo7 V2 uart3_rxd 2000 1600 CFG_UART3_RXD_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo3 Y1 uart3_txd 2000 1000 CFG_UART3_TXD_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo4 F11 vout1_d0 400 0 CFG_VOUT1_D0_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo18 G10 vout1_d1 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D1_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo19 F10 vout1_d2 200 0 CFG_VOUT1_D2_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo20 E11 vout1_vsync 500 0 CFG_VOUT1_VSYNC_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo17 Manual IO Timings Modes must be used to guaranteed some IO timings for PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET2 Direct Output mode. See Table 7-2 Modes Summary for a list of IO timings requiring the use of Manual IO Timings Modes. See Table 7-163 Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET2 Direct Output mode for a definition of the Manual modes. Table 7-163 lists the A_DELAY and G_DELAY values needed to calculate the correct values to be set in the CFG_x registers. Table 7-163. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET2 Direct Output mode BALL BALL NAME PR2_PRU1_DIR_OUT_MANUAL2 A_DELAY (ps) CFG REGISTER G_DELAY (ps) MUXMODE 13 C14 mcasp1_aclkx 200 800 CFG_MCASP1_ACLKX_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo7 G12 mcasp1_axr0 200 1000 CFG_MCASP1_AXR0_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo8 F12 mcasp1_axr1 0 1110 CFG_MCASP1_AXR1_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo9 B13 mcasp1_axr10 0 2500 CFG_MCASP1_AXR10_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo12 A12 mcasp1_axr11 0 1900 CFG_MCASP1_AXR11_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo13 E14 mcasp1_axr12 0 2300 CFG_MCASP1_AXR12_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo14 A13 mcasp1_axr13 200 1200 CFG_MCASP1_AXR13_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo15 G14 mcasp1_axr14 200 1100 CFG_MCASP1_AXR14_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo16 E11 vout1_vsync 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_VSYNC_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo17 F11 vout1_d0 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D0_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo18 G10 vout1_d1 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D1_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo19 F10 vout1_d2 0 0 CFG_VOUT1_D2_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo20 B12 mcasp1_axr8 200 1600 CFG_MCASP1_AXR8_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo10 A11 mcasp1_axr9 0 1900 CFG_MCASP1_AXR9_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo11 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 347 ADVANCE INFORMATION BALL AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-163. Manual Functions Mapping for PRU-ICSS2 PRU1 IOSET2 Direct Output mode (continued) BALL BALL NAME PR2_PRU1_DIR_OUT_MANUAL2 A_DELAY (ps) CFG REGISTER G_DELAY (ps) MUXMODE 13 D17 mcasp4_axr1 0 700 CFG_MCASP4_AXR1_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo0 AA3 mcasp5_aclkx 1400 4000 CFG_MCASP5_ACLKX_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo1 AB3 mcasp5_axr0 1500 3000 CFG_MCASP5_AXR0_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo3 AA4 mcasp5_axr1 1500 1900 CFG_MCASP5_AXR1_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo4 AB9 mcasp5_fsx 1300 2700 CFG_MCASP5_FSX_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo2 D18 xref_clk0 0 160 CFG_XREF_CLK0_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo5 E17 xref_clk1 0 0 CFG_XREF_CLK1_OUT pr2_pru1_gpo6 7.27 System and Miscellaneous interfaces ADVANCE INFORMATION The Device includes the following System and Miscellaneous interfaces: • Sysboot Interface • System DMA Interface • Interrupt Controllers (INTC) Interface • Observability Signal (OBS) Interface 7.28 Test Interfaces The Device includes the following Test interfaces: • IEEE 1149.1 Standard-Test-Access Port (JTAG) • Compact JTAG Interface (cJTAG) • Trace Port Interface Unit (TPIU) • Advanced Event Triggering Interface (AET) 7.28.1 IEEE 1149.1 Standard-Test-Access Port (JTAG) The JTAG (IEEE Standard 1149.1-1990 Standard-Test-Access Port and Boundary Scan Architecture) interface is used for BSDL testing and emulation of the device. The trstn pin only needs to be released when it is necessary to use a JTAG controller to debug the device or exercise the device's boundary scan functionality. For maximum reliability, the device includes an internal Pulldown (IPD) on the trstn pin to ensure that trstn is always asserted upon power up and the device's internal emulation logic is always properly initialized. JTAG controllers from Texas Instruments actively drive trstn high. However, some third-party JTAG controllers may not drive trstn high but expect the use of a Pullup resistor on trstn. When using this type of JTAG controller, assert trstn to initialize the device after powerup and externally drive trstn high before attempting any emulation or boundary-scan operations. The main JTAG features include: • 32KB embedded trace buffer (ETB) • 5-pin system trace interface for debug • Supports Advanced Event Triggering (AET) • All processors can be emulated via JTAG ports • All functions on EMU pins of the device: – EMU[1:0] - cross-triggering, boot mode (WIR), STM trace – EMU[4:2] - STM trace only (single direction) 7.28.1.1 JTAG Electrical Data/Timing Table 7-164, Table 7-165 and Figure 7-113 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below. 348 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 7-164. Timing Requirements for IEEE 1149.1 JTAG NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT 1 tc(TCK) Cycle time, TCK 62.29 ns 1a tw(TCKH) Pulse duration, TCK high (40% of tc) 24.92 ns 1b tw(TCKL) Pulse duration, TCK low (40% of tc) 24.92 ns tsu(TDI-TCK) Input setup time, TDI valid to TCK high 6.23 ns tsu(TMS-TCK) Input setup time, TMS valid to TCK high 6.23 ns th(TCK-TDI) Input hold time, TDI valid from TCK high 31.15 ns th(TCK-TMS) Input hold time, TMS valid from TCK high 31.15 ns 3 4 Table 7-165. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for IEEE 1149.1 JTAG NO. 2 PARAMETER td(TCKL-TDOV) DESCRIPTION Delay time, TCK low to TDO valid MIN MAX UNIT 0 30.5 ns 1 1b TCK 2 TDO 3 4 TDI/TMS SPRS906_TIMING_JTAG_01 Figure 7-113. JTAG Timing Table 7-166, Table 7-167 and Figure 7-114 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below. Table 7-166. Timing Requirements for IEEE 1149.1 JTAG With RTCK NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT 1 tc(TCK) Cycle time, TCK 62.29 ns 1a tw(TCKH) Pulse duration, TCK high (40% of tc) 24.92 ns 1b tw(TCKL) Pulse duration, TCK low (40% of tc) 24.92 ns tsu(TDI-TCK) Input setup time, TDI valid to TCK high 6.23 ns tsu(TMS-TCK) Input setup time, TMS valid to TCK high 6.23 ns th(TCK-TDI) Input hold time, TDI valid from TCK high 31.15 ns th(TCK-TMS) Input hold time, TMS valid from TCK high 31.15 ns 3 4 Table 7-167. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for IEEE 1149.1 JTAG With RTCK NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT 0 27 ns 5 td(TCK-RTCK) Delay time, TCK to RTCK with no selected subpaths (i.e. ICEPick is the only tap selected - when the ARM is in the scan chain, the delay time is a function of the ARM functional clock). 6 tc(RTCK) Cycle time, RTCK 62.29 ns 7 tw(RTCKH) Pulse duration, RTCK high (40% of tc) 24.92 ns 8 tw(RTCKL) Pulse duration, RTCK low (40% of tc) 24.92 ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 349 ADVANCE INFORMATION 1a AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 5 TCK 6 7 8 RTCK SPRS906_TIMING_JTAG_02 Figure 7-114. JTAG With RTCK Timing 7.28.1.2 Compact JTAG Interface (cJTAG) The cJTAG module is a component which can run a 2-pin communication protocol on top of an IEEE 1149.1 JTAG Test Access Port (TAP). The cJTAG logic serializes the IEEE 1149.1 transactions, using a variety of compression formats, to reduce the number of pins needed to implement a JTAG debug and boundary scan port. ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 7-168, Table 7-169 and Figure 7-115 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below. Table 7-168. Timing Requirements for IEEE 1149.7 cJTAG NO. PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT CJ1 tc(TCK) Cycle time, TCK 62.29 ns CJ1a tw(TCKH) Pulse duration, TCK high (40% of tc) 24.92 ns CJ1b tw(TCKL) Pulse duration, TCK low(40% of tc) 24.92 ns CJ9a tsu(TMSC-TCKre) Input setup time, TMSC valid to TCK high (RE timing selected) 12.46 ns CJ10a tsu(TMSC-TCKfe) Input setup time, TMSC valid to TCK low (FE timing selected) 12.46 ns CJ9b th(TCKre-TMSC) Input hold time, TMSC valid from TCK high (RE timing selected) 0.00 ns CJ10b th(TCKfe-TMSC) Input hold time, TMSC valid from TCK low (FE timing selected) 0.00 ns Table 7-169. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for IEEE 1149.7 cJTAG MIN MAX UNIT CJ11 NO. td(TCKL-TMSCV) PARAMETER Delay time, TCK low to TMSC valid DESCRIPTION 0 12.45 ns CJ13 td(TCKH-TMSCZ) Delay time, TCK high to TMSC HiZ 0 20.7 ns CJ12 td(TMSCV-KPRV) Delay time, TMSC valid to Keeper Valid 0 18 ns CJ2 td(TCKL-TDOV) Delay time, TCK low to TDO valid 0 29.14 ns CJ1 CJ1b CJ1a jtag_tck CJ9a CJ9b CJ10a CJ10b CJ11 CJ13 jtag_tms_tmsc(IN) CJ2 jtag_tms_tmsc(OUT) SPRS906_TIMING_JTAG_03 Figure 7-115. cJTAG Interface Timing—Normal Mode 350 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 7.28.2 Trace Port Interface Unit (TPIU) CAUTION The I/O timings provided in this section are valid only if signals within a single IOSET are used. The IOSETs are defined in Table 7-171. 7.28.2.1 TPIU PLL DDR Mode Table 7-170 and Figure 7-116 assume testing over the recommended operating conditions and electrical characteristic conditions below. Table 7-170. Switching Characteristics for TPIU PARAMETER DESCRIPTION MIN MAX UNIT tc(clk) Cycle time, TRACECLK period 5.56 ns TPIU4 td(clk-ctlV) Skew time, TRACECLK transition to TRACECTL transition -1.61 1.98 ns TPIU5 td(clk-dataV) Skew time, TRACECLK transition to TRACEDATA[17:0] -1.61 1.98 ns ADVANCE INFORMATION NO. TPIU1 TPIU1 TPIU2 TPIU3 TRACECLK TPIU4 TPIU4 TRACECTL TPIU5 TPIU5 TRACEDATA[X:0] SPRS906_TIMING_TIMER_01 (1) Figure 7-116. TPIU—PLL DDR Transmit Mode (1) In d[X:0], X is equal to 15 or 17. In Table 7-171 are presented the specific groupings of signals (IOSET) for use with TPIU signals. Table 7-171. TPIU IOSETs SIGNALS IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL MUX BALL MUX E6 5 A10 2 emu18 F5 5 B9 2 emu17 E4 5 A9 2 emu16 C1 5 C9 2 emu15 F4 5 A8 2 emu14 D2 5 C7 2 emu13 E2 5 C8 2 emu12 D1 5 C6 2 emu11 F3 5 A5 2 emu10 F2 5 D8 2 emu9 G6 5 E7 2 emu8 G1 5 F8 2 emu7 H7 5 F9 2 emu6 G2 5 E9 2 emu19 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback 351 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 7-171. TPIU IOSETs (continued) SIGNALS IOSET1 IOSET2 BALL MUX BALL MUX emu5 E1 5 G11 2 emu4 A7 2 A7 2 emu3 D7 2 D7 2 emu2 F10 2 F10 2 emu1 D24 0 D24 0 emu0 G21 0 G21 0 ADVANCE INFORMATION 352 Timing Requirements and Switching Characteristics Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 8 Applications, Implementation, and Layout NOTE Information in the following Applications section is not part of the TI component specification, and TI does not warrant its accuracy or completeness. TI's customers are responsible for determining suitability of components for their purposes. Customers should validate and test their design implementation to confirm system functionality. 8.1 Power Supply Mapping Whenever we allow for combining of rails mapped on any of the SMPSes, the PDN guidelines that are the most stringent of the rails combined should be implemented for the particular supply rail. It is possible that some voltage domains on the device are unused in some systems. In such cases, to ensure device reliability, it is still required that the supply pins for the specific voltage domains are connected to some core power supply output. These unused supplies though can be combined with any of the core supplies that are used (active) in the system. e.g. if IVA and GPU domains are not used, they can be combined with the CORE domain, thereby having a single power supply driving the combined CORE, IVA and GPU domains. For the combined rail, the following relaxations do apply: • The AVS voltage of active rail in the combined rail needs to be used to set the power supply • The decoupling capacitance should be set according to the active rail in the combined rail Table 8-1 illustrates the approved and validated power supply connections to the Device for the SMPS outputs of the TPS659037 PMIC. Table 8-1. TPS659037 Power Supply Connections(1) TPS659037 POWER SUPPLY (2) SMPS1/2 VALID COMBINATION 1: VALID COMBINATION 2: vdd_mpu vdd_mpu SMPS3 DDR Memory (1.35V / 1.5V) DDR Memory (1.35V / 1.5V) SMPS4/5 vdd_dsp, vdd_gpu, vdd_iva vdd_dsp SMPS6 vdd vdd_gpu SMPS7 SW configuration after boot vdd SMPS8 vdds18v vdd_iva SMPS9 SW configuration after boot 3.3V vddshvx LDO1 vddshv8 vddshv8 LDO2 vddshv5 vdds18v LDO3 vdda_usb1, vdda_usb2, vdda_csi,vdda_sata vdda_usb1, vdda_usb2, vdda_csi, vdda_sata LDO4 vdda_hdmi, vdda_pcie, vdda_pcie0, vdda_usb3 vdda_hdmi, vdda_pcie, vdda_pcie0, vdda_usb3 LDO9 vdd_rtc vdd_rtc LDOLN 1.8V PLLs 1.8V PLLs Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 353 ADVANCE INFORMATION TPS65916 or TPS659037 is the Power Management IC (PMIC) that should be used for the Device designs. TI requires use of this PMIC for the following reasons: • TI has validated its use with the Device • Board level margins including transient response and output accuracy are analyzed and optimized for the entire system • Support for power sequencing requirements (refer to Section 5.8 Power Supply Sequences) • Support for Adaptive Voltage Scaling (AVS) Class 0 requirements, including TI provided software AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 8-1. TPS659037 Power Supply Connections(1) (continued) TPS659037 POWER SUPPLY VALID COMBINATION 1: VALID COMBINATION 2: LDOUSB vdda_usb3v3 vdda_usb3v3 (1) Power consumption is highly application-specific. Separate analysis must be performed to ensure output current ratings (average and peak) is within the limits of the PMIC for all rails of the device. (2) Refer to the PMIC data manual for the latest TPS659037 specifications. (3) For more information on connectivity with the TPS659037 PMIC, see the TPS659037 User’s Guide to Power AM572x (SLIU011). (4) A product’s maximum ambient temperature, thermal system design & heat spreading performance could limit the maximum power dissipation below the full PMIC capacity in order to not exceed recommended SoC max Tj. Table 8-2 illustrates the approved and validated power supply connections to the Device for the SMPS outputs of the TPS65916 PMIC. Table 8-2. TPS65916 Power Supply Connections ADVANCE INFORMATION 8.2 TPS65916 POWER SUPPLY VALID COMBINATION 1: SMPS1 vdd_mpu SMPS2 vdd SMPS3 vdd_dsp, vdd_gpu, vdd_iva SMPS4 vdds18v SMPS5 DDR Memory (1.35V / 1.5V) DDR3 Board Design and Layout Guidelines 8.2.1 DDR3 General Board Layout Guidelines To • • • • • • • • • • • 8.2.2 help ensure good signaling performance, consider the following board design guidelines: Avoid crossing splits in the power plane. Minimize Vref noise. Use the widest trace that is practical between decoupling capacitors and memory module. Maintain a single reference. Minimize ISI by keeping impedances matched. Minimize crosstalk by isolating sensitive bits, such as strobes, and avoiding return path discontinuities. Use proper low-pass filtering on the Vref pins. Keep the stub length as short as possible. Add additional spacing for on-clock and strobe nets to eliminate crosstalk. Maintain a common ground reference for all bypass and decoupling capacitors. Take into account the differences in propagation delays between microstrip and stripline nets when evaluating timing constraints. DDR3 Board Design and Layout Guidelines 8.2.2.1 Board Designs TI only supports board designs using DDR3 memory that follow the guidelines in this document. The switching characteristics and timing diagram for the DDR3 memory controller are shown in Table 8-3 and Figure 8-1. Table 8-3. Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for DDR3 Memory Controller NO. 1 354 PARAMETER tc(DDR_CLK) Cycle time, DDR_CLK Applications, Implementation, and Layout MIN MAX UNIT 1.5 2.5(1) ns Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 (1) This is the absolute maximum the clock period can be. Actual maximum clock period may be limited by DDR3 speed grade and operating frequency (see the DDR3 memory device data sheet). 1 DDR_CLK SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_01 Figure 8-1. DDR3 Memory Controller Clock Timing 8.2.2.2 DDR3 EMIF The processor contains one DDR3 EMIF. 8.2.2.3 DDR3 Device Combinations Because there are several possible combinations of device counts and single- or dual-side mounting, Table 8-4 summarizes the supported device configurations. NUMBER OF DDR3 DEVICES DDR3 DEVICE WIDTH (BITS) MIRRORED? DDR3 EMIF WIDTH (BITS) 1 16 N 16 Y (1) 2 8 2 16 N 16 32 2 16 Y(1) 32 3 16 N (3) 32 4 8 N 32 4 8 Y(2) 32 5 8 N (3) 32 (1) Two DDR3 devices are mirrored when one device is placed on the top of the board and the second device is placed on the bottom of the board. (2) This is two mirrored pairs of DDR3 devices. (3) Three or five DDR3 device combination is not available on this device, but combination types are retained for consistency with the AM57xx family of devices. 8.2.2.4 DDR3 Interface Schematic 8.2.2.4.1 32-Bit DDR3 Interface The DDR3 interface schematic varies, depending upon the width of the DDR3 devices used and the width of the bus used (16 or 32 bits). General connectivity is straightforward and very similar. 16-bit DDR devices look like two 8-bit devices. Figure 8-2 and Figure 8-3 show the schematic connections for 32-bit interfaces using x16 devices. 8.2.2.4.2 16-Bit DDR3 Interface Note that the 16-bit wide interface schematic is practically identical to the 32-bit interface (see Figure 8-2 and Figure 8-3); only the high-word DDR memories are removed and the unused DQS inputs are tied off. When not using all or part of a DDR interface, the proper method of handling the unused pins is to tie off the ddrx_dqsi pins to ground via a 1k-Ω resistor and to tie off the ddrx_dqsni pins to the corresponding vdds_ddrx supply via a 1k-Ω resistor. This needs to be done for each byte not used. Although these signals have internal pullups and pulldowns, external pullups and pulldowns provide additional protection against external electrical noise causing activity on the signals. The vdds_ddrx and ddrx_vref0 power supply pins need to be connected to their respective power supplies even if ddrx is not being used. All other DDR interface pins can be left unconnected. Note that the supported modes for use of the DDR EMIF are 32-bits wide, 16-bits wide, or not used. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 355 ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 8-4. Supported DDR3 Device Combinations AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 32-bit DDR3 EMIF 16-Bit DDR3 Devices ddr1_d31 DQ15 8 ddr1_d24 DQ8 ddr1_dqm3 ddr1_dqs3 ddr1_dqsn3 UDM UDQS UDQS ddr1_d23 DQ7 8 ddr1_d16 ddr1_dqm2 ddr1_dqs2 ddr1_dqsn2 D08 LDM LDQS LDQS ddr1_d15 DQ15 8 ddr1_d8 ADVANCE INFORMATION ddr1_dqm1 ddr1_dqs1 ddr1_dqsn1 ddr1_d7 DQ8 UDM UDQS UDQS DQ7 8 ddr1_d0 ddr1_dqm0 ddr1_dqs0 ddr1_dqsn0 ddr1_ck ddr1_nck ddr1_odt0 ddr1_csn0 ddr1_odt1 ddr1_csn1 ddr1_ba0 ddr1_ba1 ddr1_ba2 ddr1_a0 DQ0 LDM LDQS LDQS CK CK ODT CS 16 ddr1_a15 ddr1_casn ddr1_rasn ddr1_wen ddr1_cke ddr1_rst ZQ ddr1_vref0 0.1 µF Zo ZQ CK CK Zo ODT CS Zo BA0 BA1 BA2 A0 BA0 BA1 BA2 A0 A15 CAS RAS WE CKE RST ZQ VREFDQ VREFCA A15 CAS RAS WE CKE RST 0.1 µF 0.1 µF DDR_1V5 DDR_VTT Zo Zo DDR_VREF ZQ VREFDQ VREFCA ZQ 0.1 µF Termination is required. See terminator comments. Value determined according to the DDR memory device data sheet. SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_02 Figure 8-2. 32-Bit, One-Bank DDR3 Interface Schematic Using Two 16-Bit DDR3 Devices 356 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 32-bit DDR3 EMIF 8-Bit DDR3 Devices 8-Bit DDR3 Devices ddrx_d31 DQ7 8 ddrx_d24 ddrx_dqm3 DQ0 NC ddrx_dqs3 ddrx_dqsn3 DM/TQS TDQS DQS DQS ddrx_d23 DQ7 8 ddrx_d16 ddrx_dqm2 DQ0 DM/TQS TDQS DQS DQS NC ddrx_dqs2 ddrx_dqsn2 ddrx_d15 DQ7 ddrx_d8 ddrx_dqm1 NC ddrx_dqs1 ddrx_dqsn1 ddrx_d7 DQ0 DM/TQS TDQS DQS DQS DQ7 8 ddrx_d0 ddrx_dqm0 ddrx_dqs0 ddrx_dqsn0 ddrx_ck ddrx_nck ddrx_odt0 ddrx_csn0 ddrx_odt1 ddrx_csn1 ddrx_ba0 ddrx_ba1 ddrx_ba2 ddrx_a0 NC 16 ddrx_a15 ddrx_casn ddrx_rasn ddrx_wen ddrx_cke ddrx_rst ZQ ddrx_vref0 0.1 µF Zo ZQ DQ0 TDQS DM/TQS DQS DQS CK CK ODT CS ODT CS BA0 BA1 BA2 A0 A15 CAS RAS WE CKE RST ZQ VREFDQ VREFCA CK CK ODT CS ODT CS BA0 BA1 BA2 A0 CK CK ODT CS ODT CS BA0 BA1 BA2 A0 CK CK ODT CS ODT CS BA0 BA1 BA2 A0 A15 CAS RAS WE CKE RST A15 CAS RAS WE CKE RST ZQ VREFDQ VREFCA A15 CAS RAS WE CKE RST ZQ VREFDQ VREFCA 0.1 µF 0.1 µF ZQ ZQ 0.1 µF ZQ VREFDQ VREFCA Zo 0.1 µF DDR_1V5 Zo DDR_VTT Zo Zo DDR_VREF ZQ 0.1 µF Termination is required. See terminator comments. Value determined according to the DDR memory device data sheet. SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_03 Figure 8-3. 32-Bit, One-Bank DDR3 Interface Schematic Using Four 8-Bit DDR3 Devices Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 357 ADVANCE INFORMATION 8 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 8.2.2.5 www.ti.com Compatible JEDEC DDR3 Devices Table 8-5 shows the parameters of the JEDEC DDR3 devices that are compatible with this interface. Generally, the DDR3 interface is compatible with DDR3-1333 devices in the x8 or x16 widths. Table 8-5. Compatible JEDEC DDR3 Devices (Per Interface) NO. 1 PARAMETER CONDITION JEDEC DDR3 device speed grade(1) MIN MAX DDR clock rate = 400MHz DDR3-800 DDR3-1600 400MHz< DDR clock rate ≤ 533MHz DDR3-1066 DDR3-1600 533MHz < DDR clock rate ≤ 667MHz DDR3-1333 DDR3-1600 UNIT 2 JEDEC DDR3 device bit width x8 x16 Bits 3 JEDEC DDR3 device count(2) 2 4 Devices (1) Refer to Table 8-3 Switching Characteristics Over Recommended Operating Conditions for DDR3 Memory Controller for the range of supported DDR clock rates. (2) For valid DDR3 device configurations and device counts, see Section 8.2.2.4, Figure 8-2, and Figure 8-3. 8.2.2.6 PCB Stackup ADVANCE INFORMATION The minimum stackup for routing the DDR3 interface is a six-layer stack up as shown in Table 8-6. Additional layers may be added to the PCB stackup to accommodate other circuitry, enhance SI/EMI performance, or to reduce the size of the PCB footprint. Complete stackup specifications are provided in Table 8-7. Table 8-6. Six-Layer PCB Stackup Suggestion 358 LAYER TYPE DESCRIPTION 1 Signal Top routing mostly vertical 2 Plane Ground 3 Plane Split power plane 4 Plane Split power plane or Internal routing 5 Plane Ground 6 Signal Bottom routing mostly horizontal Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 8-7. PCB Stackup Specifications NO. PARAMETER MIN PS1 PCB routing/plane layers 6 PS2 Signal routing layers 3 PS3 Full ground reference layers under DDR3 routing region(1) TYP MAX 1 (1) PS4 Full 1.5-V power reference layers under the DDR3 routing region PS5 Number of reference plane cuts allowed within DDR routing region(2) 0 PS6 Number of layers between DDR3 routing layer and reference plane(3) 0 PS7 PCB routing feature size 4 PS8 PCB trace width, w 4 PS9 Single-ended impedance, Zo PS10 UNIT 1 Mils Mils 50 (5) Impedance control Z-5 Z 75 Ω Z+5 Ω (1) Ground reference layers are preferred over power reference layers. Be sure to include bypass caps to accommodate reference layer return current as the trace routes switch routing layers. (2) No traces should cross reference plane cuts within the DDR routing region. High-speed signal traces crossing reference plane cuts create large return current paths which can lead to excessive crosstalk and EMI radiation. (4) An 18-mil pad assumes Via Channel is the most economical BGA escape. A 20-mil pad may be used if additional layers are available for power routing. An 18-mil pad is required for minimum layer count escape. (5) Z is the nominal singled-ended impedance selected for the PCB specified by PS9. 8.2.2.7 Placement Figure 8-4 shows the required placement for the processor as well as the DDR3 devices. The dimensions for this figure are defined in Table 8-8. The placement does not restrict the side of the PCB on which the devices are mounted. The ultimate purpose of the placement is to limit the maximum trace lengths and allow for proper routing space. For a 16-bit DDR memory system, the high-word DDR3 devices are omitted from the placement. x3 x2 x1 y2 y1 x1+x2+x3 y2 y2 DDR3 Controller DDR3 Controller y2 y2 Four Devices Five Devices SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_04 Figure 8-4. Placement Specifications Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 359 ADVANCE INFORMATION (3) Reference planes are to be directly adjacent to the signal plane to minimize the size of the return current loop. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Table 8-8. Placement Specifications DDR3 MAX UNIT KOD31 NO. X1 PARAMETER MIN 500 Mils KOD32 X2 600 Mils KOD33 X3 600 Mils KOD34 Y1 1800 Mils KOD35 Y2 600 Mils KOD36 DDR3 keepout region (1) KOD37 Clearance from non-DDR3 signal to DDR3 keepout region (2) (3) 4 W (1) DDR3 keepout region to encompass entire DDR3 routing area. (2) Non-DDR3 signals allowed within DDR3 keepout region provided they are separated from DDR3 routing layers by a ground plane. (3) If a device has more than one DDR controller, the signals from the other controller(s) are considered non-DDR3 and should be separated by this specification. 8.2.2.8 DDR3 Keepout Region ADVANCE INFORMATION The region of the PCB used for DDR3 circuitry must be isolated from other signals. The DDR3 keepout region is defined for this purpose and is shown in Figure 8-5. The size of this region varies with the placement and DDR routing. Additional clearances required for the keepout region are shown in Table 88. Non-DDR3 signals should not be routed on the DDR signal layers within the DDR3 keepout region. Non-DDR3 signals may be routed in the region, provided they are routed on layers separated from the DDR signal layers by a ground layer. No breaks should be allowed in the reference ground layers in this region. In addition, the 1.5-V DDR3 power plane should cover the entire keepout region. Also note that the two signals from the DDR3 controller should be separated from each other by the specification in Table 88, (see KOD37). DDR3 Keepout Region DDR3 Keepout Region DDR3 Controller Five Devices DDR3 Controller Four Devices SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_05 Figure 8-5. DDR3 Keepout Region 360 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com 8.2.2.9 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Bulk Bypass Capacitors Bulk bypass capacitors are required for moderate speed bypassing of the DDR3 and other circuitry. Table 8-9 contains the minimum numbers and capacitance required for the bulk bypass capacitors. Note that this table only covers the bypass needs of the DDR3 controllers and DDR3 devices. Additional bulk bypass capacitance may be needed for other circuitry. Table 8-9. Bulk Bypass Capacitors NO. PARAMETER MIN MAX UNIT 1 vdds_ddrx bulk bypass capacitor count(1) 1 Devices 2 vdds_ddrx bulk bypass total capacitance 22 μF (1) These devices should be placed near the devices they are bypassing, but preference should be given to the placement of the highspeed (HS) bypass capacitors and DDR3 signal routing. High-speed (HS) bypass capacitors are critcal for proper DDR3 interface operation. It is particularly important to minimize the parasitic series inductance of the HS bypass capacitors, processor/DDR power, and processor/DDR ground connections. Table 8-10 contains the specification for the HS bypass capacitors as well as for the power connections on the PCB. Generally speaking, it is good to: 1. Fit as many HS bypass capacitors as possible. 2. Minimize the distance from the bypass cap to the pins/balls being bypassed. 3. Use the smallest physical sized capacitors possible with the highest capacitance readily available. 4. Connect the bypass capacitor pads to their vias using the widest traces possible and using the largest hole size via possible. 5. Minimize via sharing. Note the limites on via sharing shown in Table 8-10. Table 8-10. High-Speed Bypass Capacitors NO. PARAMETER MIN 1 HS bypass capacitor package size(1) 2 Distance, HS bypass capacitor to processor being bypassed(2)(3)(4) 3 Processor HS bypass capacitor count per vdds_ddrx rail 4 Processor HS bypass capacitor total capacitance per vdds_ddrx rail TYP MAX UNIT 0201 0402 10 Mils 400 See (11) Mils Devices See (11) μF (5) 5 Number of connection vias for each device power/ground ball 6 Trace length from device power/ground ball to connection via(2) 7 Distance, HS bypass capacitor to DDR device being bypassed 8 DDR3 device HS bypass capacitor count(7) 9 DDR3 device HS bypass capacitor total capacitance(7) Vias 35 (6) (8)(9) 10 Number of connection vias for each HS capacitor 11 Trace length from bypass capacitor connect to connection via(2)(9) 12 Number of connection vias for each DDR3 device power/ground ball(10) 13 Trace length from DDR3 device power/ground ball to connection via(2)(8) 70 Mils 150 Mils 12 Devices 0.85 μF 2 Vias 35 100 1 Mils Vias 35 60 Mils (1) LxW, 10-mil units, that is, a 0402 is a 40x20-mil surface-mount capacitor. (2) Closer/shorter is better. (3) Measured from the nearest processor power/ground ball to the center of the capacitor package. (4) Three of these capacitors should be located underneath the processor, between the cluster of DDR_1V5 balls and ground balls, between the DDR interfaces on the package. (5) See the Via Channel™ escape for the processor package. (6) Measured from the DDR3 device power/ground ball to the center of the capacitor package. (7) Per DDR3 device. (8) An additional HS bypass capacitor can share the connection vias only if it is mounted on the opposite side of the board. No sharing of vias is permitted on the same side of the board. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 361 ADVANCE INFORMATION 8.2.2.10 High-Speed Bypass Capacitors AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (9) An HS bypass capacitor may share a via with a DDR device mounted on the same side of the PCB. A wide trace should be used for the connection and the length from the capacitor pad to the DDR device pad should be less than 150 mils. (10) Up to a total of two pairs of DDR power/ground balls may share a via. (11) The capacitor recommendations in this data manual reflect only the needs of this processor. Please see the memory vendor’s guidelines for determining the appropriate decoupling capacitor arrangement for the memory device itself. 8.2.2.10.1 Return Current Bypass Capacitors Use additional bypass capacitors if the return current reference plane changes due to DDR3 signals hopping from one signal layer to another. The bypass capacitor here provides a path for the return current to hop planes along with the signal. As many of these return current bypass capacitors should be used as possible. Because these are returns for signal current, the signal via size may be used for these capacitors. 8.2.2.11 Net Classes Table 8-11 lists the clock net classes for the DDR3 interface. Table 8-12 lists the signal net classes, and associated clock net classes, for signals in the DDR3 interface. These net classes are used for the termination and routing rules that follow. ADVANCE INFORMATION Table 8-11. Clock Net Class Definitions CLOCK NET CLASS CK Processor PIN NAMES ddrx_ck/ddrx_nck DQS0 ddrx_dqs0 / ddrx_dqsn0 DQS1 ddrx_dqs1 / ddrx_dqsn1 DQS2(1) ddrx_dqs2 / ddrx_dqsn2 (1) ddrx_dqs3 / ddrx_dqsn3 DQS3 (1) Only used on 32-bit wide DDR3 memory systems. Table 8-12. Signal Net Class Definitions SIGNAL NET CLASS ASSOCIATED CLOCK NET CLASS ADDR_CTRL CK DQ0 DQS0 ddrx_d[7:0], ddrx_dqm0 DQ1 DQS1 ddrx_d[15:8], ddrx_dqm1 DQ2 (1) DQS2 ddrx_d[23:16], ddrx_dqm2 DQ3(1) DQS3 ddrx_d[31:24], ddrx_dqm3 Processor PIN NAMES ddrx_ba[2:0], ddrx_a[14:0], ddrx_csnj, ddrx_casn, ddrx_rasn, ddrx_wen, ddrx_cke, ddrx_odti (1) Only used on 32-bit wide DDR3 memory systems. 8.2.2.12 DDR3 Signal Termination Signal terminators are required for the CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes. The data lines are terminated by ODT and, thus, the PCB traces should be unterminated. Detailed termination specifications are covered in the routing rules in the following sections. 8.2.2.13 VREF_DDR Routing ddrx_vref0 (VREF) is used as a reference by the input buffers of the DDR3 memories as well as the processor. VREF is intended to be half the DDR3 power supply voltage and is typically generated with the DDR3 VDDS and VTT power supply. It should be routed as a nominal 20-mil wide trace with 0.1 µF bypass capacitors near each device connection. Narrowing of VREF is allowed to accommodate routing congestion. 362 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 8.2.2.14 VTT Like VREF, the nominal value of the VTT supply is half the DDR3 supply voltage. Unlike VREF, VTT is expected to source and sink current, specifically the termination current for the ADDR_CTRL net class Thevinen terminators. VTT is needed at the end of the address bus and it should be routed as a power sub-plane. VTT should be bypassed near the terminator resistors. 8.2.2.15 CK and ADDR_CTRL Topologies and Routing Definition The CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes are routed similarly and are length matched to minimize skew between them. CK is a bit more complicated because it runs at a higher transition rate and is differential. The following subsections show the topology and routing for various DDR3 configurations for CK and ADDR_CTRL. The figures in the following subsections define the terms for the routing specification detailed in Table 8-13. 8.2.2.15.1 Four DDR3 Devices 8.2.2.15.1.1 CK and ADDR_CTRL Topologies, Four DDR3 Devices Figure 8-6 shows the topology of the CK net classes and Figure 8-7 shows the topology for the corresponding ADDR_CTRL net classes. + – + – + – + – AS+ AS- AS+ AS- AS+ AS- AS+ AS- DDR Differential CK Input Buffers Clock Parallel Terminator DDR_1V5 Rcp A1 Processor Differential Clock Output Buffer A2 A3 A4 A3 AT Cac + – Rcp A1 A2 A3 A4 A3 0.1 µF AT Routed as Differential Pair SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_06 Figure 8-6. CK Topology for Four x8 DDR3 Devices Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 363 ADVANCE INFORMATION Four DDR3 devices are supported on the DDR EMIF consisting of four x8 DDR3 devices arranged as one bank (CS). These four devices may be mounted on a single side of the PCB, or may be mirrored in two pairs to save board space at a cost of increased routing complexity and parts on the backside of the PCB. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Processor Address and Control Output Buffer A1 A3 A2 AS AS AS AS DDR Address and Control Input Buffers A3 A4 Address and Control Terminator Rtt Vtt AT SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_07 Figure 8-7. ADDR_CTRL Topology for Four x8 DDR3 Devices 8.2.2.15.1.2 CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing, Four DDR3 Devices A1 A1 ADVANCE INFORMATION Figure 8-8 shows the CK routing for four DDR3 devices placed on the same side of the PCB. Figure 8-9 shows the corresponding ADDR_CTRL routing. DDR_1V5 A3 A3 = A4 A4 A3 A3 Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT AS+ AS- A2 A2 SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_08 Figure 8-8. CK Routing for Four Single-Side DDR3 Devices 364 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 A1 www.ti.com Rtt A3 = A3 A4 AT Vtt AS A2 Figure 8-9. ADDR_CTRL Routing for Four Single-Side DDR3 Devices A1 A1 To save PCB space, the four DDR3 memories may be mounted as two mirrored pairs at a cost of increased routing and assembly complexity. Figure 8-10 and Figure 8-11 show the routing for CK and ADDR_CTRL, respectively, for four DDR3 devices mirrored in a two-pair configuration. DDR_1V5 = A4 A4 A3 A3 Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT AS+ AS- A3 A3 A2 A2 SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_10 Figure 8-10. CK Routing for Four Mirrored DDR3 Devices Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 365 ADVANCE INFORMATION SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_09 AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com A1 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Rtt = A3 A4 AT Vtt AS A3 A2 SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_11 8.2.2.15.2 Two DDR3 Devices Two DDR3 devices are supported on the DDR EMIF consisting of two x8 DDR3 devices arranged as one bank (CS), 16 bits wide, or two x16 DDR3 devices arranged as one bank (CS), 32 bits wide. These two devices may be mounted on a single side of the PCB, or may be mirrored in a pair to save board space at a cost of increased routing complexity and parts on the backside of the PCB. 8.2.2.15.2.1 CK and ADDR_CTRL Topologies, Two DDR3 Devices Figure 8-12 shows the topology of the CK net classes and Figure 8-13 shows the topology for the corresponding ADDR_CTRL net classes. + – + – AS+ AS- DDR Differential CK Input Buffers AS+ AS- ADVANCE INFORMATION Figure 8-11. ADDR_CTRL Routing for Four Mirrored DDR3 Devices Clock Parallel Terminator DDR_1V5 Rcp A1 Processor Differential Clock Output Buffer A2 A3 AT Cac + – Rcp A1 A2 A3 0.1 µF AT Routed as Differential Pair SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_12 Figure 8-12. CK Topology for Two DDR3 Devices 366 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Processor Address and Control Output Buffer A1 AS AS DDR Address and Control Input Buffers Address and Control Terminator Rtt Vtt AT A3 A2 SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_13 Figure 8-13. ADDR_CTRL Topology for Two DDR3 Devices 8.2.2.15.2.2 CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing, Two DDR3 Devices ADVANCE INFORMATION A1 A1 Figure 8-14 shows the CK routing for two DDR3 devices placed on the same side of the PCB. Figure 8-15 shows the corresponding ADDR_CTRL routing. DDR_1V5 A3 A3 = Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT AS+ AS- A2 A2 SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_14 Figure 8-14. CK Routing for Two Single-Side DDR3 Devices Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 367 AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com A1 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Rtt A3 = Vtt AT AS A2 SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_15 ADVANCE INFORMATION Figure 8-15. ADDR_CTRL Routing for Two Single-Side DDR3 Devices A1 A1 To save PCB space, the two DDR3 memories may be mounted as a mirrored pair at a cost of increased routing and assembly complexity. Figure 8-16 and Figure 8-17 show the routing for CK and ADDR_CTRL, respectively, for two DDR3 devices mirrored in a single-pair configuration. DDR_1V5 = Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT AS+ AS- A3 A3 A2 A2 SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_16 Figure 8-16. CK Routing for Two Mirrored DDR3 Devices 368 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 A1 www.ti.com Rtt = Vtt AT AS A3 A2 Figure 8-17. ADDR_CTRL Routing for Two Mirrored DDR3 Devices 8.2.2.15.3 One DDR3 Device A single DDR3 device is supported on the DDR EMIF consisting of one x16 DDR3 device arranged as one bank (CS), 16 bits wide. 8.2.2.15.3.1 CK and ADDR_CTRL Topologies, One DDR3 Device Figure 8-18 shows the topology of the CK net classes and Figure 8-19 shows the topology for the corresponding ADDR_CTRL net classes. DDR Differential CK Input Buffer AS+ AS- + – Clock Parallel Terminator DDR_1V5 Rcp A1 Processor Differential Clock Output Buffer A2 AT Cac + – Rcp A1 A2 0.1 µF AT Routed as Differential Pair SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_18 Figure 8-18. CK Topology for One DDR3 Device Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 369 ADVANCE INFORMATION SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_17 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com AS DDR Address and Control Input Buffers Processor Address and Control Output Buffer A1 Address and Control Terminator Rtt AT Vtt A2 SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_19 Figure 8-19. ADDR_CTRL Topology for One DDR3 Device 8.2.2.15.3.2 CK and ADDR/CTRL Routing, One DDR3 Device A1 A1 ADVANCE INFORMATION Figure 8-20 shows the CK routing for one DDR3 device placed on the same side of the PCB. Figure 8-21 shows the corresponding ADDR_CTRL routing. DDR_1V5 Rcp Cac Rcp 0.1 µF AT AT = AS+ AS- A2 A2 SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_20 Figure 8-20. CK Routing for One DDR3 Device 370 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 A1 www.ti.com Rtt AT = Vtt AS A2 Figure 8-21. ADDR_CTRL Routing for One DDR3 Device 8.2.2.16 Data Topologies and Routing Definition No matter the number of DDR3 devices used, the data line topology is always point to point, so its definition is simple. Care should be taken to minimize layer transitions during routing. If a layer transition is necessary, it is better to transition to a layer using the same reference plane. If this cannot be accommodated, ensure there are nearby ground vias to allow the return currents to transition between reference planes if both reference planes are ground or vdds_ddr. Ensure there are nearby bypass capacitors to allow the return currents to transition between reference planes if one of the reference planes is ground. The goal is to minimize the size of the return current loops. 8.2.2.16.1 DQS and DQ/DM Topologies, Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices DQS lines are point-to-point differential, and DQ/DM lines are point-to-point singled ended. Figure 8-22 and Figure 8-23 show these topologies. Processor DQS IO Buffer DQSn+ DQSn- DDR DQS IO Buffer Routed Differentially n = 0, 1, 2, 3 SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_22 Figure 8-22. DQS Topology Processor DQ and DM IO Buffer Dn DDR DQ and DM IO Buffer n = 0, 1, 2, 3 SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_23 Figure 8-23. DQ/DM Topology Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 371 ADVANCE INFORMATION SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_21 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 8.2.2.16.2 DQS and DQ/DM Routing, Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices Figure 8-24 and Figure 8-25 show the DQS and DQ/DM routing. DQS DQSn+ DQSn- Routed Differentially n = 0, 1, 2, 3 ADVANCE INFORMATION SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_24 Figure 8-24. DQS Routing With Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices Dn DQ and DM n = 0, 1, 2, 3 SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_25 Figure 8-25. DQ/DM Routing With Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices 8.2.2.17 Routing Specification 8.2.2.17.1 CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification Skew within the CK and ADDR_CTRL net classes directly reduces setup and hold margin and, thus, this skew must be controlled. The only way to practically match lengths on a PCB is to lengthen the shorter traces up to the length of the longest net in the net class and its associated clock. A metric to establish this maximum length is Manhattan distance. The Manhattan distance between two points on a PCB is the length between the points when connecting them only with horizontal or vertical segments. A reasonable trace route length is to within a percentage of its Manhattan distance. CACLM is defined as Clock Address Control Longest Manhattan distance. 372 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Given the clock and address pin locations on the processor and the DDR3 memories, the maximum possible Manhattan distance can be determined given the placement. Figure 8-26 and Figure 8-27 show this distance for four loads and two loads, respectively. It is from this distance that the specifications on the lengths of the transmission lines for the address bus are determined. CACLM is determined similarly for other address bus configurations; that is, it is based on the longest net of the CK/ADDR_CTRL net class. For CK and ADDR_CTRL routing, these specifications are contained in Table 8-13. (A) A1 A8 CACLMY A8 (A) A8 (A) A8 (A) A8 ADVANCE INFORMATION CACLMX (A) Rtt A3 = A4 A3 AT Vtt AS A2 SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_26 A. It is very likely that the longest CK/ADDR_CTRL Manhattan distance will be for Address Input 8 (A8) on the DDR3 memories. CACLM is based on the longest Manhattan distance due to the device placement. Verify the net class that satisfies this criteria and use as the baseline for CK/ADDR_CTRL skew matching and length control. The length of shorter CK/ADDR_CTRL stubs as well as the length of the terminator stub are not included in this length calculation. Non-included lengths are grayed out in the figure. Assuming A8 is the longest, CALM = CACLMY + CACLMX + 300 mils. The extra 300 mils allows for routing down lower than the DDR3 memories and returning up to reach A8. Figure 8-26. CACLM for Four Address Loads on One Side of PCB Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 373 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com (A) A1 A8 CACLMY CACLMX A8 (A) A8 (A) Rtt A3 = AT Vtt AS A2 ADVANCE INFORMATION SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_27 A. It is very likely that the longest CK/ADDR_CTRL Manhattan distance will be for Address Input 8 (A8) on the DDR3 memories. CACLM is based on the longest Manhattan distance due to the device placement. Verify the net class that satisfies this criteria and use as the baseline for CK/ADDR_CTRL skew matching and length control. The length of shorter CK/ADDR_CTRL stubs as well as the length of the terminator stub are not included in this length calculation. Non-included lengths are grayed out in the figure. Assuming A8 is the longest, CALM = CACLMY + CACLMX + 300 mils. The extra 300 mils allows for routing down lower than the DDR3 memories and returning up to reach A8. Figure 8-27. CACLM for Two Address Loads on One Side of PCB Table 8-13. CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification(2)(3) NO. PARAMETER MAX UNIT 500(1) ps A1+A2 skew 29 ps A3 length 125 ps CARS34 A3 skew(4) 6 ps CARS35 (5) A3 skew 6 ps CARS36 A4 length 125 ps CARS37 A4 skew 6 ps CARS38 AS length 17 ps 1.3 14 ps 5 12 ps 1 ps CARS31 A1+A2 length CARS32 CARS33 MIN TYP 5(1) (1) CARS39 AS skew CARS310 AS+/AS- length CARS311 AS+/AS- skew (6) CARS312 AT length 75 CARS313 AT skew(7) 14 CARS314 AT skew(8) CARS315 CK/ADDR_CTRL trace length 1020 ps CARS316 Vias per trace 3(1) vias CARS317 Via count difference 1(15) vias CARS318 Center-to-center CK to other DDR3 trace spacing(9) 4w CARS319 Center-to-center ADDR_CTRL to other DDR3 trace spacing(9)(10) 4w CARS320 Center-to-center ADDR_CTRL to other ADDR_CTRL trace spacing(9) 3w CARS321 CK center-to-center spacing(11) (12) 374 ps ps 1 Applications, Implementation, and Layout ps Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Table 8-13. CK and ADDR_CTRL Routing Specification(2)(3) (continued) NO. PARAMETER CARS322 CK spacing to other net(9) CARS323 Rcp(13) CARS324 Rtt(13)(14) MIN TYP MAX UNIT Zo-1 Zo Zo+1 Ω Zo-5 Zo Zo+5 Ω 4w (1) Max value is based upon conservative signal integrity approach. This value could be extended only if detailed signal integrity analysis of rice time and fall time confirms desired operation. (2) The use of vias should be minimized. (3) Additional bypass capacitors are required when using the DDR_1V5 plane as the reference plane to allow the return current to jump between the DDR_1V5 plane and the ground plane when the net class switches layers at a via. (4) Non-mirrored configuration (all DDR3 memories on same side of PCB). (5) Mirrored configuration (one DDR3 device on top of the board and one DDR3 device on the bottom). (6) While this length can be increased for convenience, its length should be minimized. (7) ADDR_CTRL net class only (not CK net class). Minimizing this skew is recommended, but not required. (8) CK net class only. (9) Center-to-center spacing is allowed to fall to minimum 2w for up to 1250 mils of routed length. (11) CK spacing set to ensure proper differential impedance. (12) The most important thing to do is control the impedance so inadvertent impedance mismatches are not created. Generally speaking, center-to-center spacing should be either 2w or slightly larger than 2w to achieve a differential impedance equal to twice the singleended impedance, Zo. (13) Source termination (series resistor at driver) is specifically not allowed. (14) Termination values should be uniform across the net class. (15) Via count difference may increase by 1 only if accurate 3-D modeling of the signal flight times – including accurately modeled signal propagation through vias – has been applied to ensure all segment skew maximums are not exceeded. 8.2.2.17.2 DQS and DQ Routing Specification Skew within the DQS and DQ/DM net classes directly reduces setup and hold margin and thus this skew must be controlled. The only way to practically match lengths on a PCB is to lengthen the shorter traces up to the length of the longest net in the net class and its associated clock. As with CK and ADDR_CTRL, a reasonable trace route length is to within a percentage of its Manhattan distance. DQLMn is defined as DQ Longest Manhattan distance n, where n is the byte number. For a 32-bit interface, there are four DQLMs, DQLM0-DQLM3. Likewise, for a 16-bit interface, there are two DQLMs, DQLM0-DQLM1. NOTE It is not required, nor is it recommended, to match the lengths across all bytes. Length matching is only required within each byte. Given the DQS and DQ/DM pin locations on the processor and the DDR3 memories, the maximum possible Manhattan distance can be determined given the placement. Figure 8-28 shows this distance for four loads. It is from this distance that the specifications on the lengths of the transmission lines for the data bus are determined. For DQS and DQ/DM routing, these specifications are contained in Table 8-14. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 375 ADVANCE INFORMATION (10) The ADDR_CTRL net class of the other DDR EMIF is considered other DDR3 trace spacing. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com DQLMX0 DB0 DB1 DQ[0:7]/DM0/DQS0 DQ[8:15]/DM1/DQS1 DQLMX1 DQ[16:23]/DM2/DQS2 DB2 DQLMY0 DQLMX2 DQLMY3 DQLMY2 DB3 DQLMY1 DQ[23:31]/DM3/DQS3 DQLMX3 3 2 1 0 DB0 - DB3 represent data bytes 0 - 3. SPRS906_PCB_DDR3_28 ADVANCE INFORMATION There are four DQLMs, one for each byte (32-bit interface). Each DQLM is the longest Manhattan distance of the byte; therefore: DQLM0 = DQLMX0 + DQLMY0 DQLM1 = DQLMX1 + DQLMY1 DQLM2 = DQLMX2 + DQLMY2 DQLM3 = DQLMX3 + DQLMY3 Figure 8-28. DQLM for Any Number of Allowed DDR3 Devices Table 8-14. Data Routing Specification(2) NO. PARAMETER MIN TYP MAX UNIT DRS31 DB0 length 340 ps DRS32 DB1 length 340 ps DRS33 DB2 length 340 ps DRS34 DB3 length 340 ps DRS35 (3) DBn skew 5 ps DRS36 DQSn+ to DQSn- skew 1 ps DRS37 DQSn to DBn skew(3)(4) 5(10) ps (1) vias vias DRS38 Vias per trace 2 DRS39 Via count difference 0(10) DRS310 Center-to-center DBn to other DDR3 trace spacing(6) 4 w(5) DRS311 Center-to-center DBn to other DBn trace spacing(7) 3 w(5) 4 w(5) (8) (9) DRS312 DQSn center-to-center spacing DRS313 DQSn center-to-center spacing to other net (1) Max value is based upon conservative signal integrity approach. This value could be extended only if detailed signal integrity analysis of rice time and fall time confirms desired operation. (2) External termination disallowed. Data termination should use built-in ODT functionality. (3) Length matching is only done within a byte. Length matching across bytes is neither required nor recommended. (4) Each DQS pair is length matched to its associated byte. (5) Center-to-center spacing is allowed to fall to minimum 2w for up to 1250 mils of routed length. (6) Other DDR3 trace spacing means other DDR3 net classes not within the byte. (7) This applies to spacing within the net classes of a byte. (8) DQS pair spacing is set to ensure proper differential impedance. (9) The most important thing to do is control the impedance so inadvertent impedance mismatches are not created. Generally speaking, center-to-center spacing should be either 2w or slightly larger than 2w to achieve a differential impedance equal to twice the singleended impedance, Zo. (10) Via count difference may increase by 1 only if accurate 3-D modeling of the signal flight times – including accurately modeled signal propagation through vias – has been applied to ensure DBn skew and DQSn to DBn skew maximums are not exceeded. 376 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com 8.3 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 High Speed Differential Signal Routing Guidance The High-Speed Interface Layout Guidelines Application Report (SPRAAR7) available from http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spraar7 provides guidance for successful routing of the high speed differential signals. This includes PCB stackup and materials guidance as well as routing skew, length and spacing limits. TI supports only designs that follow the board design guidelines contained in the application report. 8.4 Power Distribution Network Implementation Guidance The Power Distribution Network Implementation Guidelines Application Report (SPRABY8) available from http://www.ti.com/lit/pdf/spraby8 provides guidance for successful implementation of the power distribution network. This includes PCB stackup guidance as well as guidance for optimizing the selection and placement of the decoupling capacitors. TI supports only designs that follow the board design guidelines contained in the application report. Single-Ended Interfaces 8.5.1 General Routing Guidelines The following paragraphs detail the routing guidelines that must be observed when routing the various functional LVCMOS interfaces. • Line spacing: – For a line width equal to W, the spacing between two lines must be 2W, at least. This minimizes the crosstalk between switching signals between the different lines. On the PCB, this is not achievable everywhere (for example, when breaking signals out from the device package), but it is recommended to follow this rule as much as possible. When violating this guideline, minimize the length of the traces running parallel to each other (see Figure 8-29). W D+ S = 2 W = 200 µm SPRS906_PCB_SE_GND_01 • • • Figure 8-29. Ground Guard Illustration Length matching (unless otherwise specified): – For bus or traces at frequencies less than 10 MHz, the trace length matching (maximum length difference between the longest and the shortest lines) must be less than 25 mm. – For bus or traces at frequencies greater than 10 MHz, the trace length matching (maximum length difference between the longest and the shortest lines) must be less than 2.5 mm. Characteristic impedance – Unless otherwise specified, the characteristic impedance for single-ended interfaces is recommended to be between 35-Ω and 65-Ω. Multiple peripheral support – For interfaces where multiple peripherals have to be supported in the star topology, the length of each branch has to be balanced. Before closing the PCB design, it is highly recommended to verify signal integrity based on simulations including actual PCB extraction. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 377 ADVANCE INFORMATION 8.5 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 8.5.2 www.ti.com QSPI Board Design and Layout Guidelines ADVANCE INFORMATION The following section details the routing guidelines that must be observed when routing the QSPI interfaces. • The qspi1_sclk output signal must be looped back into the qspi1_rtclk input. • The signal propagation delay from the qspi1_sclk ball to the QSPI device CLK input pin (A to C) must be approximately equal to the signal propagation delay from the QSPI device CLK pin to the qspi1_rtclk ball (C to D). • The signal propagation delay from the QSPI device CLK pin to the qspi1_rtclk ball (C to D) must be approximately equal to the signal propagation delay of the control and data signals between the QSPI device and the SoC device (E to F, or F to E). • The signal propagation delay from the qspi1_sclk signal to the series terminators (R2 = 10 Ω) near the QSPI device must be < 450pS (~7cm as stripline or ~8cm as microstrip) • 50 Ω PCB routing is recommended along with series terminations, as shown in Figure 8-30. • Propagation delays and matching: – A to C = C to D = E to F. – Matching skew: < 60pS – A to B < 450pS – B to C = as small as possible (<60pS) Locate both R2 resistors close together near the QSPI device A B C R1 R2 0 Ω* 10 Ω R2 10 Ω qspi1_sclk QSPI device clock input D qspi1_rtclk E F QSPI device IOx, CS# qspi1_d[x], qspi1_cs[y] SPRS906_PCB_QSPI_01 Figure 8-30. QSPI Interface High Level Schematic NOTE *0 Ω resistor (R1), located as close as possible to the qspi1_sclk pin, is placeholder for finetuning if needed. 8.6 Clock Routing Guidelines 378 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com 8.6.1 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 32-kHz Oscillator Routing When designing the printed-circuit board: • Keep the crystal as close as possible to the crystal pins X1 and X2. • Keep the trace lengths short and small to reduce capacitor loading and prevent unwanted noise pickup. • Place a guard ring around the crystal and tie the ring to ground to help isolate the crystal from unwanted noise pickup. • Keep all signals out from beneath the crystal and the X1 and X2 pins to prevent noise coupling. • Finally, an additional local ground plane on an adjacent PCB layer can be added under the crystal to shield it from unwanted pickup from traces on other layers of the board. This plane must be isolated from the regular PCB ground plane and tied to the GND pin of the RTC. The plane must not be any larger than the perimeter of the guard ring. Make sure that this ground plane does not contribute to significant capacitance (a few pF) between the signal line and ground on the connections that run from X1 and X2 to the crystal. Cap ADVANCE INFORMATION IC X 1 Crystal Via to GND Cap X 2 Local ground plane SPRS906_PCB_CLK_OSC_01 Figure 8-31. Slow Clock PCB Requirements 8.6.2 Oscillator Ground Connection Although the impedance of a ground plane is low it is, of course, not zero. Therefore, any noise current in the ground plane causes a voltage drop in the ground. Figure 8-32 shows the grounding scheme for slow (low frequency) clock generated from the internal oscillator. Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 379 AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com Device rtc_osc_xo rtc_osc_xi_clkin32 Rd (Optional) Crystal Cf2 Cf1 SPRS906_PCB_CLK_OSC_02 ADVANCE INFORMATION Figure 8-32. Grounding Scheme for Low-Frequency Clock Figure 8-33 shows the grounding scheme for high-frequency clock. Device xi_oscj xo_oscj Rd (Optional) Crystal Cf1 vssa_oscj Cf2 SPRS906_PCB_CLK_OSC_03 (1) j in *_osc = 0 or 1 Figure 8-33. Grounding Scheme for High-Frequency Clock 380 Applications, Implementation, and Layout Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 9 Device and Documentation Support 9.1 Device Support 9.1.1 Development Support The following products support development for AM571x platforms: AM571x Register Descriptor Tool is an interactive device register configuration tool that allows users to visualize the register state on power-on reset, and then customize the configuration of the device for the specific use-case. AM571x Clock Tree Tool is interactive clock tree configuration software that allows the user to visualize the device clock tree, interact with clock tree elements and view the effect on PRCM registers, interact with the PRCM registers and view the effect on the device clock tree, and view a trace of all the device registers affected by the user interaction with the clock tree. AM571x Pin Mux Utility is an interactive application that helps a system designer select the appropriate pin-multiplexing configuration for their device-based product design. The Pin Mux Utility provides a way to select valid IO Sets of specific peripheral interfaces to ensure the pinmultiplexing configuration selected for a design only uses valid IO Sets supported by the device. For a complete listing of development-support tools for the processor platform, visit the Texas Instruments website at www.ti.com. For information on pricing and availability, contact the nearest TI field sales office or authorized distributor. 9.1.2 9.1.2.1 Device Nomenclature Standard Package Symbolization SITARA TM aBBBBBBrPPPzSsYyT PIN ONE INDICATOR XXXXXXX PPP G1 842 O SPRS906_PACK_01 Figure 9-1. Printed Device Reference Device and Documentation Support Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 381 ADVANCE INFORMATION TI offers an extensive line of development tools, including tools to evaluate the performance of the processors, generate code, develop algorithm implementations, and fully integrate and debug software and hardware modules. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com NOTE Some devices have a cosmetic circular marking visible on the top of the device package which results from the production test process. These markings are cosmetic only with no reliability impact. 9.1.2.2 Device Naming Convention Table 9-1. Nomenclature Description FIELD PARAMETER FIELD DESCRIPTION VALUE a Device evolution stage X Prototype P Preproduction (production test flow, no reliability data) BBBBBB r ADVANCE INFORMATION PPP z BLANK Production Base production part number AM5718 High Tier (See Table 3-1, Device Comparison) AM5716 Low Tier (See Table 3-1, Device Comparison) Device revision BLANK SR 1.0 A SR 2.0 Package designator Device Speed ABC X D Ss Security Identifier Yy Device type T Temperature (2) TU 842 ABC S-PBGA-N760 (23 mm × 23 mm) Package Indicates the speed grade for each of the cores in the device. For more information see Table 5-5, Speed Grade Maximum Frequency Dummy key secure device BLANK General purpose device E Ethercat slave enabled BLANK Ethercat slave disabled Yn Letter followed by number indicates HS device with customer key A Extended (see Table 5-4, Recommended Operating Conditions) BLANK XXXXXXX DESCRIPTION Commercial (see Table 5-4, Recommended Operating Conditions) Lot Trace Code (LTC) Production Code, For TI use only O Pin one designator G1 ECAT—Green package designator (1) To designate the stages in the product development cycle, TI assigns prefixes to the part numbers. These prefixes represent evolutionary stages of product development from engineering prototypes through fully qualified production devices. Prototype devices are shipped against the following disclaimer: “This product is still under development and is intended for internal evaluation purposes.” Notwithstanding any provision to the contrary, TI makes no warranty expressed, implied, or statutory, including any implied warranty of merchantability of fitness for a specific purpose, of this device. (2) Applies to device max junction temperature. NOTE BLANK in the symbol or part number is collapsed so there are no gaps between characters. 9.2 Documentation Support The following documents describe the AM571x devices. 382 SPRUHZ7 AM571x SitaraTM Processors Technical Reference Manual details the integration, the environment, the functional description, and the programming models for each peripheral and subsystem in the AM571x family of devices. SPRZ436 AM571x SitaraTM Processors Silicon Errata (Silicon Revision 1.0) describes known advisories, limitations, and cautions on silicon and provides workarounds. Device and Documentation Support Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback AM5718, AM5716 www.ti.com 9.3 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 Related Links The table below lists quick access links. Categories include technical documents, support and community resources, tools and software, and quick access to sample or buy. Table 9-2. Related Links 9.4 PARTS PRODUCT FOLDER SAMPLE & BUY TECHNICAL DOCUMENTS TOOLS & SOFTWARE SUPPORT & COMMUNITY AM5718 Click here Click here Click here Click here Click here AM5716 Click here Click here Click here Click here Click here Community Resources TI Embedded Processors Wiki Texas Instruments Embedded Processors Wiki. Established to help developers get started with Embedded Processors from Texas Instruments and to foster innovation and growth of general knowledge about the hardware and software surrounding these devices. 9.5 Trademarks ICEPick and SmartReflex are trademarks of Texas Instruments Incorporated. ARM and Cortex are registered trademark of ARM Limited. ETB, ARM9, CoreSight, and Neon are trademarks of ARM Limited. HDMI is a trademark of HDMI Licensing, LLC. HDQ is a trademark of Benchmarq. 1-Wire is a registered trademark of Maxim Integrated. PowerVR is a registered trademark of Imagination Technologies Ltd. SD is a registered trademark of Toshiba Corporation. MMC and eMMC are trademarks of MultiMediaCard Association. MIPI is a registered trademark of the Mobile Industry Processor Interface (MIPI) Alliance. PCI-Express is a registered trademark of PCI-SIG. MediaLB is a trademark of Standard Microsystems Corporation. Vivante is a registered trademark of Vivante Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. 9.6 Electrostatic Discharge Caution This integrated circuit can be damaged by ESD. Texas Instruments recommends that all integrated circuits be handled with appropriate precautions. Failure to observe proper handling and installation procedures can cause damage. ESD damage can range from subtle performance degradation to complete device failure. Precision integrated circuits may be more susceptible to damage because very small parametric changes could cause the device not to meet its published specifications. 9.7 Glossary TI Glossary This glossary lists and explains terms, acronyms, and definitions. Device and Documentation Support Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated Submit Documentation Feedback 383 ADVANCE INFORMATION The following links connect to TI community resources. Linked contents are provided "AS IS" by the respective contributors. They do not constitute TI specifications and do not necessarily reflect TI's views; see TI's Terms of Use. AM5718, AM5716 SPRS957A – MARCH 2016 – REVISED JUNE 2016 www.ti.com 10 Mechanical Packaging and Orderable Information The following pages include mechanical packaging and orderable information. This information is the most current data available for the designated devices. This data is subject to change without notice and revision of this document. For browser-based versions of this data sheet, refer to the left-hand navigation. 10.1 Mechanical Data ADVANCE INFORMATION 384 Mechanical Packaging and Orderable Information Submit Documentation Feedback Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 12-Jun-2016 PACKAGING INFORMATION Orderable Device Status (1) Package Type Package Pins Package Drawing Qty Eco Plan Lead/Ball Finish MSL Peak Temp (2) (6) (3) Op Temp (°C) Device Marking (4/5) XAM5718AABCXEA ACTIVE FCBGA ABC 760 1 TBD Call TI Call TI 0 to 90 XAM5718ABCXE ACTIVE FCBGA ABC 760 60 Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) SNAGCU Level-3-250C-168 HR 0 to 90 XAM5718ABCXE SITARATM (1) The marketing status values are defined as follows: ACTIVE: Product device recommended for new designs. LIFEBUY: TI has announced that the device will be discontinued, and a lifetime-buy period is in effect. NRND: Not recommended for new designs. Device is in production to support existing customers, but TI does not recommend using this part in a new design. PREVIEW: Device has been announced but is not in production. Samples may or may not be available. OBSOLETE: TI has discontinued the production of the device. (2) Eco Plan - The planned eco-friendly classification: Pb-Free (RoHS), Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt), or Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br) - please check http://www.ti.com/productcontent for the latest availability information and additional product content details. TBD: The Pb-Free/Green conversion plan has not been defined. Pb-Free (RoHS): TI's terms "Lead-Free" or "Pb-Free" mean semiconductor products that are compatible with the current RoHS requirements for all 6 substances, including the requirement that lead not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous materials. Where designed to be soldered at high temperatures, TI Pb-Free products are suitable for use in specified lead-free processes. Pb-Free (RoHS Exempt): This component has a RoHS exemption for either 1) lead-based flip-chip solder bumps used between the die and package, or 2) lead-based die adhesive used between the die and leadframe. The component is otherwise considered Pb-Free (RoHS compatible) as defined above. Green (RoHS & no Sb/Br): TI defines "Green" to mean Pb-Free (RoHS compatible), and free of Bromine (Br) and Antimony (Sb) based flame retardants (Br or Sb do not exceed 0.1% by weight in homogeneous material) (3) MSL, Peak Temp. - The Moisture Sensitivity Level rating according to the JEDEC industry standard classifications, and peak solder temperature. (4) There may be additional marking, which relates to the logo, the lot trace code information, or the environmental category on the device. (5) Multiple Device Markings will be inside parentheses. Only one Device Marking contained in parentheses and separated by a "~" will appear on a device. If a line is indented then it is a continuation of the previous line and the two combined represent the entire Device Marking for that device. (6) Lead/Ball Finish - Orderable Devices may have multiple material finish options. Finish options are separated by a vertical ruled line. Lead/Ball Finish values may wrap to two lines if the finish value exceeds the maximum column width. Important Information and Disclaimer:The information provided on this page represents TI's knowledge and belief as of the date that it is provided. TI bases its knowledge and belief on information provided by third parties, and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of such information. Efforts are underway to better integrate information from third parties. TI has taken and continues to take reasonable steps to provide representative and accurate information but may not have conducted destructive testing or chemical analysis on incoming materials and chemicals. TI and TI suppliers consider certain information to be proprietary, and thus CAS numbers and other limited information may not be available for release. Addendum-Page 1 Samples PACKAGE OPTION ADDENDUM www.ti.com 12-Jun-2016 In no event shall TI's liability arising out of such information exceed the total purchase price of the TI part(s) at issue in this document sold by TI to Customer on an annual basis. Addendum-Page 2 IMPORTANT NOTICE Texas Instruments Incorporated and its subsidiaries (TI) reserve the right to make corrections, enhancements, improvements and other changes to its semiconductor products and services per JESD46, latest issue, and to discontinue any product or service per JESD48, latest issue. Buyers should obtain the latest relevant information before placing orders and should verify that such information is current and complete. All semiconductor products (also referred to herein as “components”) are sold subject to TI’s terms and conditions of sale supplied at the time of order acknowledgment. TI warrants performance of its components to the specifications applicable at the time of sale, in accordance with the warranty in TI’s terms and conditions of sale of semiconductor products. Testing and other quality control techniques are used to the extent TI deems necessary to support this warranty. Except where mandated by applicable law, testing of all parameters of each component is not necessarily performed. TI assumes no liability for applications assistance or the design of Buyers’ products. Buyers are responsible for their products and applications using TI components. To minimize the risks associated with Buyers’ products and applications, Buyers should provide adequate design and operating safeguards. TI does not warrant or represent that any license, either express or implied, is granted under any patent right, copyright, mask work right, or other intellectual property right relating to any combination, machine, or process in which TI components or services are used. Information published by TI regarding third-party products or services does not constitute a license to use such products or services or a warranty or endorsement thereof. Use of such information may require a license from a third party under the patents or other intellectual property of the third party, or a license from TI under the patents or other intellectual property of TI. Reproduction of significant portions of TI information in TI data books or data sheets is permissible only if reproduction is without alteration and is accompanied by all associated warranties, conditions, limitations, and notices. TI is not responsible or liable for such altered documentation. Information of third parties may be subject to additional restrictions. Resale of TI components or services with statements different from or beyond the parameters stated by TI for that component or service voids all express and any implied warranties for the associated TI component or service and is an unfair and deceptive business practice. TI is not responsible or liable for any such statements. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that it is solely responsible for compliance with all legal, regulatory and safety-related requirements concerning its products, and any use of TI components in its applications, notwithstanding any applications-related information or support that may be provided by TI. Buyer represents and agrees that it has all the necessary expertise to create and implement safeguards which anticipate dangerous consequences of failures, monitor failures and their consequences, lessen the likelihood of failures that might cause harm and take appropriate remedial actions. Buyer will fully indemnify TI and its representatives against any damages arising out of the use of any TI components in safety-critical applications. In some cases, TI components may be promoted specifically to facilitate safety-related applications. With such components, TI’s goal is to help enable customers to design and create their own end-product solutions that meet applicable functional safety standards and requirements. Nonetheless, such components are subject to these terms. No TI components are authorized for use in FDA Class III (or similar life-critical medical equipment) unless authorized officers of the parties have executed a special agreement specifically governing such use. Only those TI components which TI has specifically designated as military grade or “enhanced plastic” are designed and intended for use in military/aerospace applications or environments. Buyer acknowledges and agrees that any military or aerospace use of TI components which have not been so designated is solely at the Buyer's risk, and that Buyer is solely responsible for compliance with all legal and regulatory requirements in connection with such use. TI has specifically designated certain components as meeting ISO/TS16949 requirements, mainly for automotive use. In any case of use of non-designated products, TI will not be responsible for any failure to meet ISO/TS16949. Products Applications Audio www.ti.com/audio Automotive and Transportation www.ti.com/automotive Amplifiers amplifier.ti.com Communications and Telecom www.ti.com/communications Data Converters dataconverter.ti.com Computers and Peripherals www.ti.com/computers DLP® Products www.dlp.com Consumer Electronics www.ti.com/consumer-apps DSP dsp.ti.com Energy and Lighting www.ti.com/energy Clocks and Timers www.ti.com/clocks Industrial www.ti.com/industrial Interface interface.ti.com Medical www.ti.com/medical Logic logic.ti.com Security www.ti.com/security Power Mgmt power.ti.com Space, Avionics and Defense www.ti.com/space-avionics-defense Microcontrollers microcontroller.ti.com Video and Imaging www.ti.com/video RFID www.ti-rfid.com OMAP Applications Processors www.ti.com/omap TI E2E Community e2e.ti.com Wireless Connectivity www.ti.com/wirelessconnectivity Mailing Address: Texas Instruments, Post Office Box 655303, Dallas, Texas 75265 Copyright © 2016, Texas Instruments Incorporated